- Manuals
- Brands
- Yamaha Manuals
- Motorcycle
- 2008 Fazer FZ1-N
- Service manual
-
Contents
-
Table of Contents
-
Troubleshooting
-
Bookmarks
Related Manuals for Yamaha FZ1-N
Summary of Contents for Yamaha FZ1-N
-
Page 1
2006 FZ1-N(V) FZ1-S(V) SERVICE MANUAL 2D1-28197-E0… -
Page 2
EAS20040 FZ1-N (V)/FZ1-S (V) SERVICE MANUAL ©2005 by Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd. First edition, December 2005 All rights reserved. Any reproduction or unauthorized use without the written permission of Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd. is expressly prohibited. -
Page 3
If there is any question about a service procedure, it is imperative that you contact a Yamaha dealer for any service information changes that apply to this model. This policy is intended to provide the customer with the most satisfaction from his vehicle and to conform to federal environmental quality objectives. -
Page 4: How To Use This Manual
EAS20090 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL This manual is intended as a handy, easy-to-read reference book for the mechanic. Comprehensive explanations of all installation, removal, disassembly, assembly, repair and check procedures are laid out with the individual steps in sequential order. •…
-
Page 5
EAS20100 16.Replace the part SYMBOLS The following symbols are used in this manual for easier understanding. NOTE: The following symbols are not relevant to every vehicle. 1. Serviceable with engine mounted 2. Filling fluid 3. Lubricant 4. Special tool 5. Tightening torque 6. -
Page 7: Table Of Contents
EAS20110 TABLE OF CONTENTS GENERAL INFORMATION SPECIFICATIONS PERIODIC CHECKS AND ADJUSTMENTS CHASSIS ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM FUEL SYSTEM ELECTRICAL SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING…
-
Page 9: General Information
GENERAL INFORMATION IDENTIFICATION………………1-1 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER……….. 1-1 MODEL LABEL………………1-1 FEATURES ………………..1-2 FI SYSTEM ………………..1-3 INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS……………..1-4 IMPORTANT INFORMATION …………… 1-8 PREPARATION FOR REMOVAL AND DISASSEMBLY……1-8 REPLACEMENT PARTS ……………. 1-8 GASKETS, OIL SEALS AND O-RINGS……….1-8 LOCK WASHERS/PLATES AND COTTER PINS ……..1-8 BEARINGS AND OIL SEALS …………..1-9 CIRCLIPS ………………..1-9 CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS ………….1-10…
-
Page 10: Identification
IDENTIFICATION EAS20130 IDENTIFICATION EAS20140 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER The vehicle identification number “1” is stamped into the right side of the steering head pipe. EAS20150 MODEL LABEL The model label “1” is affixed to the frame. This information will be needed to order spare parts.
-
Page 11: Features
FEATURES EAS20170 FEATURES OUTLINE OF THE FI SYSTEM The main function of a fuel supply system is to provide fuel to the combustion chamber at the opti- mum air-fuel ratio in accordance with the engine operating conditions and the atmospheric tempera- ture.
-
Page 12: Fi System
FI SYSTEM ET2D1001 FI SYSTEM The fuel pump delivers fuel to the fuel injector via the fuel filter. The pressure regulator maintains the fuel pressure that is applied to the fuel injector at only 324 kPa (3.24 kg/cm , 46.1 psi). Accordingly, when the energizing signal from the ECU energizes the fuel injector, the fuel passage opens, caus- ing the fuel to be injected into the intake manifold only during the time the passage remain open.
-
Page 13: Instrument Functions
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS ET2D1002 kilometers and miles, press the “SELECT” INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS button for at least one second. Multi-function meter unit Tachometer 1. Coolant temperature display/air intake tem- 1. Tachometer perature display 2. Tachometer red zone 2. Speedometer The electric tachometer allows the rider to 3.
-
Page 14
“ODO” and off for approximately 3 seconds. If this occurs, the tripmeter modes “TRIP A” and “TRIP B” in have a Yamaha dealer check the electrical cir- the following order: cuit. TRIP A → TRIP B → ODO → TRIP A… -
Page 15
• When the key is turned to “ON”, the coolant to a Yamaha dealer and have the standard temperature is automatically displayed, even keys re-registered. if the air intake temperature was displayed If the display indicates any error codes, note prior to turning the key to “OFF”. -
Page 16
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS 1. Turn the key to “OFF”. 2. Push and hold the “SELECT” button. 3. Turn the key to “ON”, and then release the “SELECT” button after five seconds. 4. Push the “RESET” button to select the desired brightness level. 5. -
Page 17: Important Information
EAS20200 REPLACEMENT PARTS Use only genuine Yamaha parts for all replace- ments. Use oil and grease recommended by Yamaha for all lubrication jobs. Other brands may be similar in function and appearance, but…
-
Page 18: Bearings And Oil Seals
IMPORTANT INFORMATION EAS20230 BEARINGS AND OIL SEALS Install bearings “1” and oil seals “2” so that the manufacturer’s marks or numbers are visible. When installing oil seals, lubricate the oil seal lips with a light coat of lithium-soap-based grease. Oil bearings liberally when installing, if appropriate.
-
Page 19: Checking The Connections
CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS EAS20250 CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS Pocket tester 90890-03112 Check the leads, couplers, and connectors for Analog Pocket tester stains, rust, moisture, etc. YU-03112-C 1. Disconnect: • Lead NOTE: • Coupler • If there is no continuity, clean the terminals. •…
-
Page 20
SPECIAL TOOLS EAS20260 SPECIAL TOOLS The following special tools are necessary for complete and accurate tune-up and assembly. Use only the appropriate special tools as this will help prevent damage caused by the use of inappropri- ate tools or improvised techniques. Special tools, part numbers or both may differ depending on the country. -
Page 21
SPECIAL TOOLS Reference Tool name/Tool No. Illustration pages Oil filter wrench 3-13 90890-01426 YU-38411 Rod holder 4-50, 4-55 90890-01434 Damper rod holder double ended YM-01434 Rod puller 4-54 90890-01437 Universal damping rod bleeding tool set YM-A8703 Rod puller attachment (M10) 4-54 90890-01436 Universal damping rod bleeding tool set… -
Page 22
SPECIAL TOOLS Reference Tool name/Tool No. Illustration pages Compression gauge 3-11 90890-03081 Engine compression tester YU-33223 Valve spring compressor 5-23, 5-29 90890-04019 YM-04019 Valve spring compressor attachment 5-23, 5-29 90890-04108 Valve spring compressor adapter (22 mm) YM-04108 Valve spring compressor attachment 5-23, 5-29 90890-04114 Valve spring compressor adapter… -
Page 23
SPECIAL TOOLS Reference Tool name/Tool No. Illustration pages Valve guide remover (ø4) 5-25 90890-04111 Valve guide remover (4.0 mm) YM-04111 Valve guide remover (ø4.5) 5-25 90890-04116 Valve guide remover (4.5 mm) YM-04116 Valve guide installer (ø4) 5-25 90890-04112 Valve guide installer (4.0 mm) YM-04112 Valve guide installer (ø4.5) 5-25… -
Page 24: Special Tools
SPECIAL TOOLS Reference Tool name/Tool No. Illustration pages Yamaha bond No.1215 5-67, 6-12 (Three Bond No.1215®) 90890-85505 Digital circuit tester 7-9, 7-10 90890-03174 Model 88 Multimeter with tachometer YU-A1927 Pivot shaft wrench 90890-01518 Frame spanner socket YM-01518 Pivot shaft wrench adapter…
-
Page 25
SPECIAL TOOLS Reference Tool name/Tool No. Illustration pages Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set 90890-06756 Valve lapper 90890-04101 Valve lapping tool YM-A8998 Fuel pressure adapter 90890-03176 YM-03176 Pressure gauge 3-14, 7-8 90890-03153 YU-03153 Camshaft wrench 5-11, 5-16 90890-04143 YM-04143 1-16… -
Page 26
SPECIAL TOOLS 1-17… -
Page 27: Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS…………..2-1 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS…………….2-1 CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS …………… 2-8 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS……………2-10 TIGHTENING TORQUES…………….2-12 GENERAL TIGHTENING TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS…….2-12 ENGINE TIGHTENING TORQUES …………2-13 CHASSIS TIGHTENING TORQUES …………2-17 LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES ……..2-20 ENGINE ………………..2-20 CHASSIS ………………..2-22 LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS ………2-23 ENGINE OIL LUBRICATION CHART ………..2-23 LUBRICATION DIAGRAMS …………..
-
Page 28: General Specifications
3C39 (AUS) Dimensions Overall length 2140 mm (84.3 in) Overall width 770 mm (30.3 in) Overall height 1060 mm (41.7 in) (FZ1-N) 1205 mm (47.4 in) (FZ1-S) Seat height 815 mm (32.1 in) Wheelbase 1460 mm (57.5 in) Ground clearance 135 mm (5.31 in)
-
Page 29: Engine Specifications
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Inner-rotor-to-outer-rotor-tip clearance 0.010–0.100 mm (0.0004–0.0039 in) Limit 0.18 mm (0.0071 in) Outer-rotor-to-oil-pump-housing clearance 0.090–0.150 mm (0.0035–0.0059 in) Limit 0.22 mm (0.0087 in) Oil-pump-housing-to-inner-and-outer-rotor clearance 0.06–0.13 mm (0.0024–0.0051 in) Limit 0.20 mm (0.0079 in) Bypass valve opening pressure 80.0–120.0 kPa (11.6–17.4 psi) (0.80–1.20 kgf/cm²) Relief valve operating pressure 600.0–680.0 kPa (87.0–98.6 psi) (6.00–6.80…
-
Page 30
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Camshaft runout limit 0.030 mm (0.0012 in) Timing chain Model/number of links RH2020/122 Tensioning system Automatic Valve, valve seat, valve guide Valve clearance (cold) Intake 0.11–0.20 mm (0.0043–0.0079 in) Exhaust 0.21–0.25 mm (0.0083–0.0098 in) Valve dimensions Valve head diameter A (intake) 23.40–23.60 mm (0.9213–0.9291 in) Valve head diameter A (exhaust) 24.90–25.10 mm (0.9803–0.9882 in) -
Page 31
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Limit 4.425 mm (0.1742 in) Valve guide inside diameter (intake) 4.000–4.012 mm (0.1575–0.1580 in) Limit 4.050 mm (0.1594 in) Valve guide inside diameter (exhaust) 4.500–4.512 mm (0.1772–0.1776 in) Limit 4.550 mm (0.1791 in) Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance (intake) 0.010–0.037 mm (0.0004–0.0015 in) Limit 0.080 mm (0.0032 in) Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance (exhaust) -
Page 32
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Offset 0.50 mm (0.0197 in) Offset direction Intake side Piston pin bore inside diameter 17.002–17.013 mm (0.6694–0.6698 in) Piston pin outside diameter 16.991–17.000 mm (0.6689–0.6693 in) Piston ring Top ring Ring type Barrel Dimensions (B × T) 0.90 × 2.75 mm (0.04 × 0.11 in) End gap (installed) 0.15–0.25 mm (0.0059–0.0098 in) Ring side clearance… -
Page 33
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Journal oil clearance (using plastigauge®) 0.014–0.037 mm (0.0006–0.0015 in) Bearing color code 0.White 1.Blue 2.Black 3.Brown 4.Green Clutch Clutch type Wet, multiple-disc Clutch release method Outer pull, rack and pinion pull Clutch lever free play 10.0–15.0 mm (0.39–0.59 in) Friction plate thickness 2.90–3.10 mm (0.114–0.122 in) Wear limit… -
Page 34
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS Idling condition Engine idling speed 1100–1300 r/min Intake vacuum 30.0 kPa (8.9 inHg) (225 mmHg) 95.0–105.0 °C (203.00–221.00 °F) Water temperature 80.0–90.0 °C (176.00–194.00 °F) Oil temperature Throttle cable free play 3.0–5.0 mm (0.12–0.20 in) -
Page 35: Chassis Specifications
Front 250 kPa (36 psi) (2.50 kgf/cm²) (2.50 bar) Rear 290 kPa (42 psi) (2.90 kgf/cm²) (2.90 bar) Loading condition 90–196 kg (198–432 lb) (FZ1-N) 90–190 kg (198–419 lb) (FZ1-S) Front 250 kPa (36 psi) (2.50 kgf/cm²) (2.50 bar) Rear 290 kPa (42 psi) (2.90 kgf/cm²) (2.90 bar)
-
Page 36
CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS Master cylinder inside diameter 16.00 mm (0.63 in) Caliper cylinder inside diameter 30.20 mm (1.19 in) Caliper cylinder inside diameter 27.00 mm (1.06 in) Recommended fluid DOT 4 Rear brake Type Single disc brake Operation Right foot operation Brake pedal free play 4.3–9.3 mm (0.17–0.37 in) Rear disc brake… -
Page 37: Electrical Specifications
1.12 A Headlight Bulb type Halogen bulb Bulb voltage, wattage × quantity 12 V, 60 W/55.0 W × 1 (FZ1-N) Headlight 12 V, 60 W/55.0 W × 2 (FZ1-S) 12 V, 5.0 W × 2 Auxiliary light 12 V, 5.0 W/21.0 W × 1 Tail/brake light 12 V, 10.0 W ×…
-
Page 38
Model/manufacturer 5VY/SOMIC ISHIKAWA Servo motor Model/manufacturer 2D1/YAMAHA Fuses Main fuse 50.0 A Headlight fuse 15.0 A (FZ1-N) 25.0 A (FZ1-S) Taillight fuse 10.0 A Signaling system fuse 10.0 A Ignition fuse 15.0 A 10.0 A × 2 Radiator fan fuse Fuel injection system fuse 15.0 A… -
Page 39: Tightening Torques
TIGHTENING TORQUES EAS20320 TIGHTENING TORQUES EAS20330 GENERAL TIGHTENING TORQUE SPECIFI- CATIONS This chart specifies tightening torques for stan- dard fasteners with a standard ISO thread pitch. Tightening torque specifications for spe- cial components or assemblies are provided for each chapter of this manual. To avoid warpage, tighten multi-fastener assemblies in a crisscross pattern and progressive stages until the specified tightening torque is reached.
-
Page 40: Engine Tightening Torques
TIGHTENING TORQUES EAS20340 ENGINE TIGHTENING TORQUES Thread Item Q’ty Tightening torque Remarks size Spark plug 13 Nm (1.3 m·kg, 9.4 ft·lb) Cylinder head nut See NOTE Cylinder head bolt 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) Camshaft caps bolt 10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb) Cylinder head cover bolt 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) Cylinder head stud bolt (exhaust…
-
Page 41
TIGHTENING TORQUES Thread Item Q’ty Tightening torque Remarks size Cylinder head and exhaust pipe 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) Exhaust pipe and muffler bolt 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) EXUP pulley and shaft arm nut 7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb) EXUP valve pulley cover bolt 14 Nm (1.4 m·kg, 10 ft·lb) EXUP cable nut… -
Page 42
TIGHTENING TORQUES Thread Item Q’ty Tightening torque Remarks size Clutch spring bolt 10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb) Use a lock washer Drive sprocket nut 85 Nm (8.5 m·kg, 61 ft·lb) Bearing plate bolt 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) Shift fork stopper plate bolt 10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb) Stopper screw… -
Page 43
TIGHTENING TORQUES 2-16… -
Page 44: Chassis Tightening Torques
TIGHTENING TORQUES EAS20350 CHASSIS TIGHTENING TORQUES Thread Item Q’ty Tightening torque Remarks size Upper bracket pinch bolt 26 Nm (2.6 m·kg, 19 ft·lb) Steering stem nut 113 Nm (11.3 m·kg, 82 ft·lb) Upper handlebar holder bolt 24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb) Lower handlebar holder nut 32 Nm (3.2 m·kg, 23 ft·lb) Lower bracket pinch bolt…
-
Page 45
TIGHTENING TORQUES Thread Item Q’ty Tightening torque Remarks size Rear brake hose holder screw 7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb) Fuel tank bolt (front) 7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb) Fuel tank bolt (rear) 7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb) Fuel tank bracket screw 7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb) Fuel tank cap bolt… -
Page 46
TIGHTENING TORQUES Thread Item Q’ty Tightening torque Remarks size Clutch cable adjust nut 7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb) NOTE: 1 First, tighten the ring nut to approximately 52 Nm (5.2 m•kg, 38 ft•lb) with a torque wrench, then loosen the lower ring nut completely. 2 Retighten the lower ring nut 18 Nm (1.8 m•kg, 13 ft•lb). -
Page 47: Lubrication Points And Lubricant Types
Main axle and drive axle Shift drum Shift forks and shift fork guide bars Shift shaft Shift shaft boss Cylinder head cover mating surface Yamaha bond No. 1215 Crankcase mating surface Yamaha bond No. 1215 Clutch cover (crankcase mating surface) Yamaha bond No.
-
Page 48
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES Lubrication point Lubricant Pickup rotor cover Yamaha bond No. 1215 2-21… -
Page 49: Chassis
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES EAS20380 CHASSIS Lubrication point Lubricant Steering bearings and bearing races (upper and lower) Throttle grip inner surface Brake lever pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts Clutch lever pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts Engine mount bolts (rear upper and lower) Engine mount bolts (front left and right) Relay arm, connecting rod and rear shock absorber collar Pivot shaft…
-
Page 50: Lubrication System Chart And Diagrams
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS EAS20390 LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS EAS20400 ENGINE OIL LUBRICATION CHART 2-23…
-
Page 51
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 1. Oil strainer 2. Oil pump 3. Relief valve 4. Oil cooler 5. Oil filter 6. Main gallery 7. AC magneto drive gear shower 8. Shift fork (upper) 9. Main axle 10.Mission shower 11.Drive axle 12.AC magneto axle 13.Piston cooler 14.Chain tensioner… -
Page 52: Lubrication Diagrams
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS EAS20410 LUBRICATION DIAGRAMS 2-25…
-
Page 53
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 1. Intake camshaft 2. Exhaust camshaft 3. Oil filter cartridge 4. Oil level switch 2-26… -
Page 54
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 2-27… -
Page 55
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 1. Intake camshaft 2. Exhaust camshaft 3. Crankshaft 4. Oil cooler 5. Relief valve 6. Oil pipe 7. Oil strainer 8. Oil pump 2-28… -
Page 56
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 2-29… -
Page 57
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 1. Oil filter cartridge 2. Oil level switch 3. Oil pump 4. Oil strainer 5. Oil pipe 6. Oil cooler 2-30… -
Page 58
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 2-31… -
Page 59
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 1. Main axle 2. Oil delivery pipe 3. Drive axle 2-32… -
Page 60
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 2-33… -
Page 61
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS 1. Cylinder head 2. Crankshaft 2-34… -
Page 62: Cooling System Diagrams
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS EAS20420 COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS 2-35…
-
Page 63
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS 1. Water pump 2. Radiator 3. Radiator fan 2-36… -
Page 64
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS 2-37… -
Page 65
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS 1. Radiator cap 2. Radiator 3. Oil cooler 4. Thermostat 2-38… -
Page 66: Cable Routing
CABLE ROUTING EAS20430 CABLE ROUTING 2-39…
-
Page 67
CABLE ROUTING 1. Clutch cable 2. Left handlebar switch lead 3. Main switch lead 4. Immobilizer lead 5. Horn lead 6. Horn stay assembly 7. Throttle cable (pull side) 8. Throttle cable (return side) 9. Wire harness 10.Brake hose 11.Throttle cables 12.Right handlebar switch lead A. -
Page 68
CABLE ROUTING 2-41… -
Page 69
CABLE ROUTING M. Pass the radiator fan motor lead (right) 1. Wire harness above the coolant reservoir hose and route 2. Right handlebar switch lead it to the inside of the frame. 3. Throttle cable N. Pass the coolant reservoir hose to the vehi- 4. -
Page 70
CABLE ROUTING 2-43… -
Page 71
CABLE ROUTING H. Route the hose assembly 1 by the vehicle 1. Clutch cable front side where the water pump inlet pipe 2. Water pump breather hose is routed. For the hose tip position, route 3. Oil level switch lead the hose so that 10 mm (0.39 in) or more 4. -
Page 72
CABLE ROUTING 2-45… -
Page 73
CABLE ROUTING AF.The coolant reservoir tank drain hose shall cross with the speed sensor lead under the rear arm bracket. The coolant reservoir tank drain hose shall be positioned above the vehicle. 2-46… -
Page 74
CABLE ROUTING 2-47… -
Page 75
CABLE ROUTING 53.Direct ignition coil lead 1. Throttle cables 54.Speed sensor lead 2. Right handlebar switch lead 55.Lean angle sensor lead 3. Wire harness 56.Battery box 4. Throttle cable (pull side) 57.Turn signal light relay lead 5. Throttle cable (return side) 58.Rear frame 6. -
Page 76
CABLE ROUTING 2-49… -
Page 77
CABLE ROUTING AJ.Clamp each lead at the positioning taping Q. Pass the turn signal light lead (right) and section (white) and then insert it to the license plate light lead under the rear cover. (In random order) fender bracket and route between the ribs of the battery box. -
Page 78
CABLE ROUTING 2-51… -
Page 79
CABLE ROUTING FZ1-S 1. Clutch cable 2. Left handlebar switch lead 3. Immobilizer lead 4. Main switch lead 5. Protector 6. Throttle cables 7. Right handlebar switch lead 8. Throttle cable (pull side) 9. Throttle cable (return side) 10.Bracket 11.Wire harness 12.Turn signal light lead 13.Seat lock cable 14.Tail/brake light lead… -
Page 80
CABLE ROUTING 2-53… -
Page 81
CABLE ROUTING 1. Fuel tank 2. Fuel tank drain hose 3. Fuel tank breather hose 4. Clip 5. Air filter bracket 6. 3 way connector 7. Hose 8. Fuel hose 9. Damper 10.Collar 11.Fuel tank bracket 12.O-ring 13.Fuel pump A. Hook the cover pawl to the fuel tank bracket. -
Page 82
CABLE ROUTING 2-55… -
Page 83: Periodic Checks And Adjustments
PERIODIC CHECKS AND ADJUSTMENTS PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ……………..3-1 INTRODUCTION ………………3-1 ENGINE………………….3-4 ADJUSTING THE VALVE CLEARANCE ……….3-4 SYNCHRONIZING THE THROTTLE BODIES ……..3-6 ADJUSTING THE EXHAUST GAS VOLUME………3-8 ADJUSTING THE ENGINE IDLING SPEED ……….3-9 ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE CABLE FREE PLAY ……3-9 CHECKING THE SPARK PLUGS…………
-
Page 84
LUBRICATING THE CENTERSTAND (FZ1-S) ……..3-34 LUBRICATING THE REAR SUSPENSION ……….3-34 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM…………….3-35 CHECKING AND CHARGING THE BATTERY……..3-35 CHECKING THE FUSES…………..3-35 REPLACING THE HEADLIGHT BULBS……….3-35 ADJUSTING THE HEADLIGHT BEAM ……….3-36… -
Page 86: Periodic Maintenance
• The annual checks must be performed every year, except if a kilometer-based maintenance is performed instead. • From 50000 km, repeat the maintenance intervals starting from 10000 km. • Items marked with an asterisk should be performed by a Yamaha dealer as they require special tools, data and technical skills. ODOMETER READ-…
-
Page 87
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ODOMETER READ- Annual ING (X 1000 km) ITEM CHECK OR MAINTENANCE JOB check 10 20 30 40 • Check chain slack, alignment and condition. Every 1000 km and after wash- Drive chain • Adjust and lubricate chain with a ing the motorcycle or riding in special O-ring chain lubricant thor- the rain… -
Page 88
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ODOMETER READ- Annual ING (X 1000 km) ITEM CHECK OR MAINTENANCE JOB check 10 20 30 40 • Check the air cut-off valve, reed Air induction valve, and hose for damage. ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ system • Replace the entire air induction sys- tem if necessary. -
Page 89: Engine
ENGINE EAS20470 • Valve clearance ENGINE Out of specification → Adjust. Valve clearance (cold) EAS20490 ADJUSTING THE VALVE CLEARANCE Intake valve The following procedure applies to all of the 0.11–0.20 mm (0.0043–0.0079 valves. Exhaust valve NOTE: • Valve clearance adjustment should be made 0.21–0.25 mm (0.0083–0.0098 on a cold engine, at room temperature.
-
Page 90
ENGINE 6. Adjust: • Valve clearance ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the valve lifter “1” and the valve pad “2” with a valve lapper “3”. Valve lapper 90890-04101 NOTE: • Cover the timing chain opening with a rag to prevent the valve pad from falling into the crankcase. -
Page 91: Synchronizing The Throttle Bodies
ENGINE If the valve pad is marked “158”, the pad thickness is 1.58 mm (0.062in) g. Install the exhaust and intake camshafts, d. Calculate the sum of the values obtained in timing chain and camshaft caps. steps (b) and (c) to determine the required valve pad thickness and the valve pad Camshaft cap bolt number.
-
Page 92
ENGINE Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4- • Throttle body synchronization ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ • Fuel tank a. With throttle body #3 as standard, adjust Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. throttle bodies #1, #2, and #4 using the air 3. -
Page 93: Adjusting The Exhaust Gas Volume
ENGINE Make sure that the vacuum pressure is within specification. 10. Stop the engine and remove the measuring equipment. 11. Adjust: • Throttle cable free play Refer to «ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE CABLE FREE PLAY» on page 3-9. Throttle cable free play (at the flange of the throttle grip) 4.
-
Page 94: Adjusting The Engine Idling Speed
ENGINE 8. Simultaneously press the “SELECT” and Throttle cable free play “RESET” buttons to return to the cylinder (at the flange of the throttle selection (step 5). grip) 9. Turn the main switch to “OFF” to cancel the 3.0–5.0 mm (0.12–0.20 in) mode.
-
Page 95: Checking The Spark Plugs
ENGINE 6. Measure: • Spark plug gap “a” (with a wire thickness gauge) Out of specification → Regap. Spark plug gap 0.6–0.7 mm (0.0236–0.0276 in) c. Tighten the locknut. EW2D1001 WARNING After adjusting the throttle cable free play, start the engine and turn the handlebars to the right and to the left to ensure that this does not cause the engine idling speed to change.
-
Page 96: Checking The Engine Oil Level
ENGINE ECA13340 NOTE: CAUTION: The difference in compression pressure Before removing the spark plugs, use com- between cylinders should not exceed 100 kPa pressed air to blow away any dirt accumu- (1 kg/cm², 1 bar, 14.22 psi). lated in the spark plug wells to prevent it c.
-
Page 97: Changing The Engine Oil
ENGINE Recommended oil Refer to the chart for the engine oil grade which is best suited for certain atmo- spheric temperatures. API standard SE or higher grade ACEA standard G4 or G5 ECA13360 4. Start the engine, warm it up for several CAUTION: minutes, and then turn it off.
-
Page 98: Measuring The Engine Oil Pressure
ENGINE 5. If the oil filter cartridge is also to be 8. Fill: replaced, perform the following procedure. • Crankcase (with the specified amount of the recom- ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the oil filter cartridge “1” with an oil mended engine oil) filter wrench “2”.
-
Page 99: Adjusting The Clutch Cable Free Play
ENGINE to measure the engine oil pressure after NOTE: warming up the engine. Regarding the oil pressure as its own data may fluctuate depending on the oil temperature and 3. Remove: • Oil gallery bolt “1” viscosity, the oil pressure may fluctuate when measuring.
-
Page 100: Replacing The Air Filter Element
ENGINE 2. Adjust • Clutch cable free play ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ EAS20960 Handlebar side REPLACING THE AIR FILTER ELEMENT a. Turn the adjusting dial “1” in direction “b” or 1. Remove: “c” until the specified clutch cable free play • Rider and passenger seat is obtained.
-
Page 101: Checking The Throttle Body Joints
ENGINE 4. Install: 1. Remove: • Air filter case cover • Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4- ECA14400 CAUTION: • Fuel tank Never operate the engine without the air fil- ter element installed. Unfiltered air will Refer to «FUEL TANK»…
-
Page 102: Checking The Exhaust System
ENGINE Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Exhaust pipe nut 2. Check: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) • Crankcase breather hose “1” Exhaust pipe and exhaust pipe Cracks/damage → Replace. bracket bolt Loose connection → Connect properly. 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) ECA13450 Exhaust pipe and muffler bolt CAUTION:…
-
Page 103: Checking The Exup Servo Motor
ENGINE 2. Check: • EXUP system operation ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Activate the diagnostic mode and select the diagnostic code number “53”. Refer to «FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM» on page 8-31. b. Set the engine stop switch to “ ”. c. Check that the EXUP valve operates prop- erly.
-
Page 104: Checking The Cooling System
ENGINE • Coolant level The coolant level should be between the maximum level mark “a” and minimum level mark “b”. Below the minimum level mark → Add the recommended coolant to the proper level. ECA13470 CAUTION: • Adding water instead of coolant lowers the antifreeze content of the coolant.
-
Page 105
ENGINE 7. Drain: 4. Drain: • Coolant • Coolant (from the water pump inlet pipe and outlet (from the coolant reservoir) pipe) 5. Remove: 8. Check: • Radiator cap “1” • Copper washers “1” EWA13030 WARNING 9. Install: • Coolant drain bolts “2” A hot radiator is under pressure. -
Page 106
ENGINE Coolant is potentially harmful and should NOTE: be handled with special care. Before checking the coolant level, wait a few EWA13040 minutes until the coolant has settled. WARNING 18. Install: • If coolant splashes in your eyes, thor- • Rider and passenger seat oughly wash them with water and consult Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS»… -
Page 107: Chassis
CHASSIS EAS21140 EAS21190 CHASSIS ADJUSTING THE REAR DISC BRAKE 1. Adjust: • Brake pedal position EAS21160 ADJUSTING THE FRONT DISC BRAKE ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ 1. Adjust: a. Loosen the locknut “1”. • Brake lever position b. Turn the adjusting bolt “2” in direction “a” or (distance “a”…
-
Page 108: Checking The Brake Fluid Level
CHASSIS EAS21240 the brake fluid and could cause vapor CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID LEVEL lock. 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. ECA13540 NOTE: CAUTION: • Place the vehicle on a suitable stand. Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces •…
-
Page 109: Checking The Front Brake Hoses
CHASSIS EAS21280 CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE HOSES The following procedure applies to all of the brake hoses and brake hose clamps. 1. Check: • Brake hose “1” Cracks/damage/wear → Replace. 2. Check: • Brake hose clamp “2” Loose Connection → Tighten the clamp bolt.
-
Page 110: Bleeding The Hydraulic Brake System
CHASSIS nut “2” in direction “a” or “b” until the rear c. Connect a clear plastic hose “1” tightly to brake light comes on at the proper time. the bleed screw “2”. Direction “a” Brake light comes on sooner. Direction “b” Brake light comes on later.
-
Page 111: Adjusting The Shift Pedal
CHASSIS EWA13110 NOTE: WARNING Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that After bleeding the hydraulic brake system, the rear wheel is elevated. check the brake operation. 2. Spin the rear wheel several times and find ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ the tightest position of drive chain. 3.
-
Page 112: Lubricating The Drive Chain
CHASSIS d. Tighten both locknuts to specification. Refer to «STEERING HEAD» on page 4-57. 4. Adjust: Locknut • Steering head 16 Nm (1.6 m·kg, 12 ft·lb) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the lock washer “1”, the upper ring e. Tighten the wheel axle nut to specification. nut “2”, and the rubber washer “3”.
-
Page 113: Checking The Front Fork
CHASSIS d. Check the steering head for looseness or binding by turning the front fork all the way in both directions. If any binding is felt, remove the lower bracket and check the upper and lower bearings. Refer to «STEERING HEAD» on page 4-57. e.
-
Page 114: Adjusting The Front Fork Legs
CHASSIS EWA13120 EWA13150 WARNING WARNING Securely support the vehicle so that there • Always adjust both front fork legs evenly. is no danger of it falling over. Uneven adjustment can result in poor handling and loss of stability. 2. Check: •…
-
Page 115
CHASSIS ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ Rebound damping (Right side front fork) Compression damping (Left side front fork) EC2D1006 CAUTION: ECA13590 CAUTION: • Never go beyond the maximum or mini- • Never go beyond the maximum or mini- mum adjustment positions. mum adjustment positions. •… -
Page 116: Adjusting The Rear Shock Absorber Assembly
CHASSIS ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ Rebound damping EAS21620 ADJUSTING THE REAR SHOCK ECA13590 ABSORBER ASSEMBLY CAUTION: EWA13120 Never go beyond the maximum or minimum WARNING adjustment positions. Securely support the vehicle so that there 1. Adjust: is no danger of it falling over. •…
-
Page 117: Checking The Tires
EAS21650 CHECKING THE TIRES Basic weight (with oil and a full The following procedure applies to both of the fuel tank) tires. FZ1-N 1. Check: 214kg (472lb) • Tire pressure FZ1-S Out of specification → Regulate. 220kg (485lb) Loading condition* 0–90 kg (0–198 lb)
-
Page 118
No guarantee concerning handling characteristics can be given if a tire combination other than one approved by Yamaha is used on this vehi- cle. 1. Tire tread depth Front tire 2. -
Page 119: Checking The Wheels
CHASSIS EAS21670 EAS21710 CHECKING THE WHEELS LUBRICATING THE PEDAL The following procedure applies to both of the Lubricate the pivoting point and metal-to-metal wheels. moving parts of the pedal. 1. Check: Recommended lubricant • Wheel Damage/out-of-round → Replace. Lithium — soap — based grease EWA13260 WARNING EAS21720…
-
Page 120
A. FZ1-N EAS21780 REPLACING THE HEADLIGHT BULBS B. FZ1-S 1. Remove: 4. Remove: • Headlight side cover bolts “1” (FZ1-N) • Headlight bulb cover “1” (FZ1-S) 2. Disconnect: 5. Remove: • Headlight sub-wire harness coupler “2” • Headlight bulb holder “1”… -
Page 121
Turn the adjusting screw “1” in direction “a” or “b”. Direction “a” Headlight beam is raised. Direction “b” Headlight beam is lowered. A. FZ1-N B. FZ1-S EWA13320 WARNING Since the headlight bulb gets extremely hot, keep flammable products and your hands away from the bulb until it has cooled down. -
Page 122
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM A. FZ1-N B. FZ1-S ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ 3-37… -
Page 123
CHASSIS GENERAL CHASSIS………………4-1 REMOVING THE COVER…………… 4-7 INSTALLING THE COVER …………..4-7 FRONT WHEEL ……………….. 4-8 REMOVING THE FRONT WHEEL …………4-10 CHECKING THE FRONT WHEEL…………4-10 ADJUSTING THE FRONT WHEEL STATIC BALANCE …….4-11 INSTALLING THE FRONT WHEEL (DISC) ……….4-12 REAR WHEEL ………………..4-14 REMOVING THE REAR WHEEL (DISC) ………. -
Page 124
REMOVING THE HANDLEBAR …………4-45 CHECKING THE HANDLEBAR…………4-45 INSTALLING THE HANDLEBAR …………4-45 FRONT FORK…………………4-48 REMOVING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ……….4-50 DISASSEMBLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ……..4-50 CHECKING THE FRONT FORK LEGS……….4-51 ASSEMBLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ………..4-52 INSTALLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ………. -
Page 126
GENERAL CHASSIS EAS21830 GENERAL CHASSIS Removing the seat and battery Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Passenger seat Rider seat Battery band Battery cover Battery negative lead Battery positive lead Battery Battery seat For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 127
GENERAL CHASSIS Removing the headlight and meter assembly (FZ1-N) Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Headlight side cover bolt (left and right) Headlight coupler Disconnect. Headlight sub-wire harness coupler Disconnect. Headlight assembly Headlight bracket Headlight side cover (left and right) -
Page 128
GENERAL CHASSIS Removing the front cowling (FZ1-S) Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Inner panel Headlight assembly coupler Disconnect. Meter coupler Disconnect. Front cowling assembly Rear view mirror Cowling stay Meter assembly Headlight unit For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 129
GENERAL CHASSIS Removing the rear fender (FZ1-N) Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Licence plate light lead coupler Disconnect. Turn signal light lead coupler Disconnect. Mud guard assembly Rear fender Tail/brake light lead coupler Disconnect. -
Page 130
GENERAL CHASSIS Removing the rear fender (FZ1-S) Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Licence plate light lead coupler Disconnect. Turn signal light lead coupler Disconnect. Mud guard assembly Rear fender Tail/brake light lead coupler Disconnect. -
Page 131
GENERAL CHASSIS Removing the air filter case Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Intake air temperature sensor lead cou- Disconnect. pler Intake air temperature sensor Air filter case cover… -
Page 132: General Chassis
GENERAL CHASSIS EAS21840 REMOVING THE COVER 1. Remove: • Tail cover • Rear fender NOTE: To remove the quick fastener, push its center with a screwdriver, then pull the fastener out. EAS21850 INSTALLING THE COVER 1. Install: • Rear fender •…
-
Page 133
FRONT WHEEL EAS21870 FRONT WHEEL Removing the front wheel and brake discs Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake hose holder (left and right) Front brake caliper (left and right) Front wheel axle pinch bolt Front wheel axle Collar (left and right) Dust cover Front wheel Front brake disc (left and right) -
Page 134
FRONT WHEEL Disassembling the front wheel Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil seal (left and right) Wheel bearing (left and right) Spacer For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. -
Page 135: Front Wheel
FRONT WHEEL EAS21900 Refer to «CHECKING THE TIRES» on page REMOVING THE FRONT WHEEL 3-32 and «CHECKING THE WHEELS» on 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. page 3-34. EWA13120 3. Measure: WARNING • Radial wheel runout “1” Securely support the vehicle so that there •…
-
Page 136: Adjusting The Front Wheel Static Balance
FRONT WHEEL • Adjust the front wheel static balance with the brake disc installed. 1. Remove: • Balancing weight(s) 2. Find: • Front wheel’s heavy spot NOTE: Place the front wheel on a suitable balancing stand. ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ c. Remove the wheel bearings “3” with a gen- a.
-
Page 137: Installing The Front Wheel (Disc)
FRONT WHEEL a. Install a balancing weight “1” onto the rim EAS22000 INSTALLING THE FRONT WHEEL (DISC) exactly opposite the heavy spot “X”. The following procedure applies to both of the NOTE: brake discs. Start with the lightest weight. 1. Lubricate: •…
-
Page 138
FRONT WHEEL EWA13490 WARNING Make sure the brake cable is routed prop- erly. NOTE: Make sure that there is enough space between the brake pads before installing the brake cali- pers onto the brake discs. 4-13… -
Page 139
REAR WHEEL EAS22020 REAR WHEEL Removing the rear wheel Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rear brake caliper Locknut (left and right) Loosen. Adjusting bolt (left and right) Loosen. Wheel axle nut Washer Rear wheel axle Adjusting block (left) Adjusting block (right) Rear wheel Brake caliper bracket For installation, reverse the removal… -
Page 140
REAR WHEEL Removing the brake disc and rear wheel sprocket Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rear brake disc Rear wheel sprocket Coller (left and right) Dust cover Oil seal Bearing Rear wheel drive hub Rear wheel drive hub damper Rear wheel For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 141
REAR WHEEL Disassembling the rear wheel Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Coller Bearing Spacer Oil seal Circlip Bearing For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 4-16… -
Page 142: Rear Wheel
REAR WHEEL EAS22040 REMOVING THE REAR WHEEL (DISC) 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. EWA13120 WARNING Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over. NOTE: Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the rear wheel is elevated.
-
Page 143: Checking And Replacing The Rear Wheel Sprocket
REAR WHEEL Damage/wear → Replace. ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ EAS22120 CHECKING AND REPLACING THE REAR EAS22150 WHEEL SPROCKET ADJUSTING THE REAR WHEEL STATIC 1. Check: BALANCE • Rear wheel sprocket NOTE: More than 1/4 tooth “a” wear → Replace • After replacing the tire, wheel or both, the the rear wheel sprocket.
-
Page 144
REAR WHEEL EWA13500 WARNING Make sure the brake hose is routed prop- erly. 4-19… -
Page 145: Front Brake
FRONT BRAKE EAS22210 FRONT BRAKE Removing the front brake pads Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake hose holder Front brake caliper Brake pad clip Brake pad pin Brake pad spring Brake pad Bleed screw For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
-
Page 146
Q’ty Remarks Brake fluid Drain. Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAU- LIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3- Right rearview mirror (FZ1-N) Brake master cylinder reservoir cap Brake master cylinder reservoir dia- phragm holder Brake master cylinder diaphragm Brake lever Front brake light switch lead coupler Disconnect. -
Page 147
FRONT BRAKE Disassembling the front brake master cylinder Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake master cylinder kit Brake master cylinder body For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 4-22… -
Page 148
FRONT BRAKE Removing the front brake calipers Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake fluid Drain. Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAU- LIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3- Union bolt Copper washer Brake hose Brake caliper For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 149
FRONT BRAKE Disassembling the front brake calipers Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake pad clip Brake pad pin Brake pad spring Brake pad Brake caliper piston Brake caliper piston seal Bleed screw For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 4-24… -
Page 150: Introduction
FRONT BRAKE EAS22220 INTRODUCTION EWA14100 WARNING Disc brake components rarely require dis- assembly. Therefore, always follow these preventive measures: • Never disassemble brake components unless absolutely necessary. • If any connection on the hydraulic brake system is disconnected, the entire brake system must be disassembled, drained, ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼…
-
Page 151: Replacing The Front Brake Pads
FRONT BRAKE NOTE: Brake pad lining thickness Tighten the brake disc bolts in stages and in a (inner) crisscross pattern. 4.5 mm (0.18 in) Limit Brake disc bolt 0.5 mm (0.02 in) 18 Nm (1.8 m·kg, 13 ft·lb) Brake pad lining thickness LOCTITE®…
-
Page 152: Removing The Front Brake Calipers
FRONT BRAKE NOTE: NOTE: The arrow mark “a” on the brake pad spring Before removing the brake caliper, drain the must point in the direction of disc rotation. brake fluid from the entire brake system. 1. Remove: • Union bolt “1” •…
-
Page 153: Checking The Front Brake Calipers
FRONT BRAKE c. Remove the brake caliper piston seals. EAS22410 d. Repeat the previous steps to force out the ASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE CALI- right side pistons from the brake caliper. PERS EWA13620 ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ WARNING • Before installation, all internal brake com- EAS22390 CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS ponents should be cleaned and lubricated…
-
Page 154: Removing The Front Brake Master Cylinder
FRONT BRAKE “a” touches the projection “b” on the brake ECA13540 CAUTION: caliper. Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately. 5. Bleed: • Brake system Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM»…
-
Page 155: Checking The Front Brake Master Cylinder
FRONT BRAKE EAS22520 ASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE MAS- TER CYLINDER EWA13520 WARNING • Before installation, all internal brake com- ponents should be cleaned and lubricated with clean or new brake fluid. • Never use solvents on internal brake components. 2. Remove: Recommended fluid •…
-
Page 156
FRONT BRAKE • When refilling, be careful that water does Brake hose union bolt not enter the brake master cylinder reser- 30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb) voir. Water will significantly lower the boiling point of the brake fluid and could EWA13530 cause vapor lock. -
Page 157: Rear Brake
REAR BRAKE EAS22550 REAR BRAKE Removing the rear brake pads Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Screw plug Brake pad pin Rear brake caliper Brake pad shim Brake pad Bleed screw Brake pad spring For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 4-32…
-
Page 158
REAR BRAKE Removing the rear brake master cylinder Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake fluid Drain. Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAU- LIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3- Brake fluid reservoir cap Brake fluid reservoir diaphragm holder Brake fluid reservoir diaphragm Brake fluid reservoir tank Brake fluid reservoir hose Hose joint… -
Page 159
REAR BRAKE Disassembling the rear brake master cylinder Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Brake master cylinder kit Hose joint Bushing Brake master cylinder body For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 4-34… -
Page 160
REAR BRAKE Removing the rear brake caliper Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Union bolt Copper washer Brake hose Barke caliper For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 4-35… -
Page 161
REAR BRAKE Disassembling the rear brake caliper Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Screw plug Brake pad pin Brake pad Brake pad shim Brake pad spring Brake caliper piston Brake caliper piston seal Bleed screw For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. -
Page 162: Introduction
REAR BRAKE EAS22560 INTRODUCTION Brake disc thickness limit EWA14100 4.5 mm (0.18 in) WARNING 5. Adjust: Disc brake components rarely require dis- • Brake disc deflection assembly. Therefore, always follow these Refer to «CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE preventive measures: DISCS» on page 4-25. •…
-
Page 163: Removing The Rear Brake Caliper
REAR BRAKE a. Connect a clear plastic hose “1” tightly to Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID the bleed screw “2”. Put the other end of LEVEL» on page 3-23. the hose into an open container. 5. Check: • Brake pedal operation b.
-
Page 164: Checking The Rear Brake Caliper
REAR BRAKE Scratches/wear → Replace the brake cali- per assembly. • Brake caliper body “3” Cracks/damage → Replace the brake cali- per assembly. • Brake fluid delivery passages (brake caliper body) Obstruction → Blow out with compressed air. EWA13610 ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ WARNING a.
-
Page 165: Installing The Rear Brake Caliper
REAR BRAKE EAS22670 • Brake caliper INSTALLING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER Refer to «REPLACING THE REAR BRAKE 1. Install: PADS» on page 4-37. • Brake caliper “1” (temporarily) Brake caliper bolt (front) 27 Nm (2.7 m·kg, 20 ft·lb) • Copper washers “2” Brake caliper bolt (rear) •…
-
Page 166: Removing The Rear Brake Master Cylinder
REAR BRAKE 3. Check: • Brake fluid reservoir Cracks/damage → Replace. • Brake fluid reservoir diaphragm Cracks/damage → Replace. 4. Check: • Brake hose Cracks/damage/wear → Replace. EAS22730 ASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER 7. Check: EWA13520 • Brake pedal operation WARNING Soft or spongy feeling →…
-
Page 167
REAR BRAKE 5. Check: 2. Fill: • Brake pedal operation • Brake fluid reservoir Soft or spongy feeling → Bleed the brake (with the specified amount of the recom- system. mended brake fluid) Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25. Recommended fluid 6. -
Page 168: Handlebar
Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Front cowling (FZ1-S) Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Rear view mirror (FZ1-N) Front brake light switch connector Disconnect. Front master cylinder bracket Front brake master cylinder assembly Right handlebar switch Throttle cable housing…
-
Page 169
HANDLEBAR Removing the handlebar Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Handlebar Lower handlebar holder For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 4-44… -
Page 170: Removing The Handlebar
HANDLEBAR EAS22860 EAS22930 REMOVING THE HANDLEBAR INSTALLING THE HANDLEBAR 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. EWA13120 EWA13120 WARNING WARNING Securely support the vehicle so that there Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
-
Page 171
HANDLEBAR Grip end 26 Nm (2.6 m·kg, 19 ft·lb) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Apply a thin coat of rubber adhesive onto the left end of the handlebar. b. Side the handlebar grip over the left end of the handlebar. c. Wipe off any excess rubber adhesive with a clean rag. -
Page 172
HANDLEBAR NOTE: • Align the projections «a» on the handlebar switch with the holes «b» in the handlebar. • Threre should be 1–3 mm (0.04–0.12 in) of clearance “c” between the handlebar grip and the grip end. 10. Install: • Front brake master cylinder assembly •… -
Page 173: Front Fork
FRONT FORK EAS22950 FRONT FORK Removing the front fork legs Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Front wheel Refer to «CHECKING THE TIRES» Front brake calipers on page 3-32 and «CHECKING THE WHEELS» on page 3-34. Front fender Cap bolt Loosen.
-
Page 174
FRONT FORK Disassembling the front fork legs Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Cap bolt O-ring Damper adjusting rod Washer Spacer Fork spring Dust seal Oil seal clip Oil seal Washer Damper rod assembly bolt Copper washer Damper rod assembly Inner tube Outer tube For assembly, reverse the disassem-… -
Page 175: Removing The Front Fork Legs
FRONT FORK EAS22970 • Nut “3” REMOVING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ The following procedure applies to both of the a. Press down on the spacer with the fork front fork legs. spring compressor “4”. NOTE: b. Install the rod holder “5” between the nut Each front fork leg is eqipped with a spring “3”…
-
Page 176: Checking The Front Fork Legs
FRONT FORK A. Compression side B. Rebound side NOTE: While holding the damper rod with the damper rod holder “1”, loosen the damper rod assem- bly bolt. Damper rod holder 90890-01423 Damping rod holder YM-01423 3. Remove: • Oil seal clip “1” (with a flat-head screwdriver) ECA14180 CAUTION:…
-
Page 177: Assembling The Front Fork Legs
FRONT FORK • Damper rod assembly bolt • Copper washer EC2D1080 CAUTION: For the damper rod assembly, the right side is used for the rebound operation and left side for the compression. Pay attention not to mistake the right and left. NOTE: 3.
-
Page 178
FRONT FORK 6. Install: 4. Install: • Oil seal clip “1” • Dust seal “1” • Oil seal clip “2” NOTE: • Oil seal “3” Adjust the oil seal clip so that it fits into the • Washer “4” outer tube’s groove. ECA14220 CAUTION: Make sure the numbered side of the oil seal… -
Page 179
FRONT FORK Rod puller 90890-01437 Rod puller attachment (M10) 90890-01436 11. Before measuring the fork oil level, wait ten minutes until the oil has settled and the air bubbles have dispersed. NOTE: Be sure to bleed the front fork leg of any resid- 9. -
Page 180
FRONT FORK ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the rod puller and adapter. f. Remove the rod puller and the rod puller b. Install the nut. attachment. c. Install the fork spring and spacer. g. Install the nut “1” and position it as speci- fied “b”. -
Page 181: Installing The Front Fork Legs
FRONT FORK EW2D1003 WARNING • The fork spring is compressed. • Always use a new cap bolt O-ring. ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ EAS23050 INSTALLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs. NOTE: 3. Adjust: Each front fork leg is eqipped with a spring •…
-
Page 182: Steering Head
Front brake calipers Refer to «FRONT BRAKE» on page 4-20. Front cowling (FZ1-S) Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Headlight and meter assembly (FZ1-N) Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Handlebar Refer to «HANDLEBAR» on page 4- Front fork legs Refer to «FRONT FORK»…
-
Page 183
STEERING HEAD Removing the lower bracket Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Front brake hose joint bracket Horn Horn bracket Lock washer Upper ring nut Rubber washer Lower ring nut Lower bracket Lower bearing Lower bearing dust seal Lower bearing inner race Bearing cover Upper bearing inner race Upper bearing… -
Page 184: Removing The Lower Bracket
STEERING HEAD Damage/pitting → Replace. EAS23110 REMOVING THE LOWER BRACKET 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. EWA13120 WARNING Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over. 2. Remove: • Upper ring nut “1” 3.
-
Page 185: Installing The Steering Head
STEERING HEAD 4. Check: Steering stem nut • Upper bracket 113 Nm (11.3 m·kg, 82 ft·lb) • Lower bracket (along with the steering stem) Bends/cracks/damage → Replace. EAS23140 INSTALLING THE STEERING HEAD 1. Lubricate: • Upper bearing • Lower bearing •…
-
Page 186: Rear Shock Absorber Assembly
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY EAS23160 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY Removing the rear shock absorber assembly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Side cover (left and right) Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
-
Page 187
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY Removing the rear shock absorber assembly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 4-62… -
Page 188: Handling The Rear Shock Absorber
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY EAS23180 NOTE: HANDLING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that EWA13740 the rear wheel is elevated. WARNING This rear shock absorber contains highly 2. Remove: compressed nitrogen gas. Before handling •…
-
Page 189: Checking The Connecting Arm And Relay Arm
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY Gas leaks/oil leaks → Replace the rear 3. Tighten: shock absorber assembly. • Rear shock absorber assembly upper nut • Spring Rear shock absorber assembly Damage/wear → Replace the rear shock upper nut absorber assembly. 44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb) •…
-
Page 190: Swingarm
SWINGARM EAS23330 SWINGARM Removing the swingarm Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rear wheel Refer to «REAR WHEEL» on page 4- Rear brake caliper Refer to «REAR BRAKE» on page 4- Rear shock absorber Refer to «REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY» on page 4-61.
-
Page 191
SWINGARM Removing the swingarm Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Drive chain Dust cover Drive chain guide Spacer Bearing For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 4-66… -
Page 192: Removing The Swingarm
SWINGARM EAS23350 If swingarm vertical movement is not REMOVING THE SWINGARM smooth or if there is binding, check the 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. spacers, bearings, washers, and dust cov- EWA13120 ers. WARNING Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
-
Page 193: Installing The Swingarm
SWINGARM 5. Check: • Connecting arms “1” • Relay arm “2” Damage/wear → Replace. 3. Install: 6. Check: • Bearings “3” • Rear shock absorber assembly • Oil seals “4” • Rear wheel Damage/pitting → Replace. Refer to «INSTALLING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY»…
-
Page 194: Chain Drive
CHAIN DRIVE EAS23400 CHAIN DRIVE Removing the drive chain Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Drive sprocket Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2. Drive chain guard Drive chain For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 4-69…
-
Page 195: Removing The Drive Chain
CHAIN DRIVE EAS23410 REMOVING THE DRIVE CHAIN 1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface. EWA13120 WARNING Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over. NOTE: 2. Check: Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that •…
-
Page 196: Checking The Drive Sprocket
CHAIN DRIVE • Drive sprocket More than 1/4 tooth “a” wear → Replace the drive chain sprockets as a set. Bent teeth → Replace the drive chain sprockets as a set. b. Correct 1. Drive chain roller 2. Drive chain sprocket EAS23470 CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL SPROCKET Refer to «CHECKING AND REPLACING THE…
-
Page 197: Engine
ENGINE ENGINE REMOVAL ………………5-2 INSTALLING THE ENGINE …………..5-8 CAMSHAFTS………………..5-10 REMOVING THE CAMSHAFTS …………5-12 CHECKING THE CAMSHAFTS …………5-13 CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN AND CAMSHAFT SPROCKET..5-14 CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN GUIDES ……….5-14 CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN TENSIONER……..5-14 INSTALLING THE CAMSHAFTS…………
-
Page 198
CHECKING THE FRICTION PLATES ……….5-49 CHECKING THE CLUTCH PLATES………….5-49 CHECKING THE CLUTCH SPRINGS……….5-50 CHECKING THE CLUTCH HOUSING ……….5-50 CHECKING THE CLUTCH BOSS …………5-50 CHECKING THE PRESSURE PLATE ……….5-50 CHECKING THE PULL LEVER SHAFT AND PULL ROD….5-50 INSTALLING THE CLUTCH …………..5-51 SHIFT SHAFT …………………5-54 REMOVING THE SHIFT SHAFT ………… -
Page 199
CHECKING THE TRANSMISSION …………5-91 INSTALLING THE TRANSMISSION………….5-92… -
Page 200: Engine Removal
ENGINE REMOVAL EAS23710 ENGINE REMOVAL Removing the drive sprocket Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Locknut Shift rod Shift arm Drive sprocket cover Drive sprocket nut Lock washer Drive sprocket Plate For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
-
Page 201
ENGINE REMOVAL Removing the exhaust pipe Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. EXUP pulley cover EXUP servo motor cover EXUP cables EXUP servo motor sensor Exhaust pipe assembly Exhaust pipe gasket Muffler Muffler gasket Muffler cover… -
Page 202
ENGINE REMOVAL Disassembling the exhaust valve pipe Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Pulley Spring Spring seat For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. -
Page 203
ENGINE REMOVAL Disconnecting the leads and hoses Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Air filter case Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Throttle body assembly Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4. -
Page 204
ENGINE REMOVAL Disconnecting the leads and hoses Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Crankshaft position sensor lead coupler Disconnect. Oil level switch connector Disconnect. Neutral switch connector Disconnect. Cylinder identification sensor coupler Disconnect. Speed sensor coupler Disconnect. For assembly, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 205
ENGINE REMOVAL Removing the engine Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Right front engine mounting bolt 1 Left front engine mounting bolt Upper self-locking nut Upper engine mounting bolt Lower self-locking nut Lower engine mounting bolt Engine mounting adjust bolt Engine For assembly, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 206: Installing The Engine
ENGINE REMOVAL EAS23720 INSTALLING THE ENGINE 1. Install: • Right front engine mounting bolt 2 “1” Refer to «CYLINDER HEAD» on page 5-19. 2. Tighten: • Right front engine mounting bolt 2 Right front engine mounting bolt 2 7. Tighten: 50 Nm (5.0 m·kg, 36 ft·lb) •…
-
Page 207
ENGINE REMOVAL Left front engine mounting bolt 45 Nm (4.5 m·kg, 33 ft·lb) Right front engine mounting bolt 1 45 Nm (4.5 m·kg, 33 ft·lb) 8. Tighten: • Lower self-locking nut “1” • Upper self-locking nut “2” Upper self-locking nut 51 Nm (5.1 m·kg, 37 ft·lb) Lower self-locking nut 51 Nm (5.1 m·kg, 37 ft·lb) -
Page 208: Camshafts
CAMSHAFTS EAS23760 CAMSHAFTS Removing the cylinder head cover Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Throttle body assembly Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4. Radiator assembly Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1. Air cut-off valve Refer to «AIR INDUCTION SYS- TEM»…
-
Page 209
CAMSHAFTS Removing the camshafts Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Pickup rotor cover Refer to «CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR» on page 5-38. Camshaft sprocket bolt Loosen. Timing chain tensioner Timing chain tensioner gasket Intake camshaft cap Dowel pin Refer to «REMOVING THE CAM- SHAFTS»… -
Page 210: Removing The Camshafts
CAMSHAFTS EAS23810 REMOVING THE CAMSHAFTS 1. Remove: • Pickup rotor cover Refer to «CRANKSHAFT POSITION SEN- SOR» on page 5-38. 2. Align: • “T” mark “a” on the pickup rotor (with the crankcase mating surface “b”) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the crankshaft clockwise. b.
-
Page 211: Checking The Camshafts
CAMSHAFTS 3. Measure: EAS23850 • Camshaft runout CHECKING THE CAMSHAFTS Out of specification → Replace. 1. Check: • Camshaft lobes Camshaft runout limit Blue discoloration/pitting/scratches → 0.03 mm (0.0012 in) Replace the camshaft. 2. Measure: • Camshaft lobe dimensions “a” and “b” Out of specification →…
-
Page 212: Checking The Timing Chain And Camshaft Sprocket
CAMSHAFTS 2. Check: • Camshaft sprocket More than 1/4 tooth wear “a” → Replace the camshaft sprockets and the timing chain as a set. a. 1/4 tooth ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ b. Correct 5. Measure: 1. Timing chain roller • Camshaft journal diameter “a” 2.
-
Page 213
CAMSHAFTS b. Squeeze the timing chain tensioner clip “2” NOTE: and push the timing chain tensioner rod “3”. Squeeze the timing chain tensioner clip, and then remove the timing chain tensioner spring NOTE: and timing chain tensioner rod. When the timing chain tensioner rod “3” is pushed while holding the grip of the timing chain tensioner clip “2”, make sure not to release the timing chain tensioner rod “3”… -
Page 214: Installing The Camshafts
CAMSHAFTS EAS24000 INSTALLING THE CAMSHAFTS 1. Align: • “T” mark “a” on the pickup rotor (with the crankcase mating surface “b”) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the crankshaft clockwise. b. When position #1 is at TDC, align the “T” mark “a” with the crankcase mating surface “b”.
-
Page 215
CAMSHAFTS • The camshaft cap bolts must be tightened • Timing chain tensioner “1” evenly or damage to the cylinder head, • Timing chain tensioner bolts “2” camshaft caps, and camshafts will result. Timing chain tensioner bolt • Do not turn the crankshaft when installing 10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb) the camshaft to avoid damage or improper valve timing. -
Page 216
CAMSHAFTS 11. Measure: • Valve clearance Out of specification → Adjust. Refer to «ADJUSTING THE VALVE CLEARANCE» on page 3-4. 12. Install: • Pickup coil rotor cover «CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR» on page 5-38. 5-18… -
Page 217: Cylinder Head
CYLINDER HEAD EAS24100 CYLINDER HEAD Removing the cylinder head Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Engine Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2. Intake camshaft Refer to «CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10. Exhaust camshaft Refer to «CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10. Cylinder head Cylinder head gasket Dowel pin Coolant pipe…
-
Page 218: Removing The Cylinder Head
CYLINDER HEAD EAS24120 REMOVING THE CYLINDER HEAD 1. Remove: • Intake camshaft • Exhaust camshaft Refer to «REMOVING THE CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-12. ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ 2. Remove: a. Place a straightedge “1” and a thickness • Cylinder head nuts gauge “2” across the cylinder head. •…
-
Page 219
CYLINDER HEAD 5. Install: • Gasket “1” • Exhaust camshaft • Dowel pins • Intake camshaft Refer to «INSTALLING THE CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-16. 3. Install: • Cylinder head NOTE: Pass the timing chain through the timing chain cavity. 4. Tighten: •… -
Page 220
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS EAS24270 VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS Removing the valves and valve springs Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Cylinder head Refer to «CYLINDER HEAD» on page 5-19. Intake valve lifter Intake valve pad Intake valve cotter Intake valve upper spring seat Intake valve spring Intake valve stem seal Intake valve lower spring seat… -
Page 221: Valves And Valve Springs
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS Removing the valves and valve springs Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Exhaust valve lower spring seat Exhaust valve Exhaust valve guide For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 5-23…
-
Page 222: Removing The Valves
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS EAS24280 NOTE: REMOVING THE VALVES Remove the valve cotters by compressing the The following procedure applies to all of the valve spring with the valve spring compressor valves and related components. “2” and the valve spring compressor attach- NOTE: ment “3”.
-
Page 223: Checking The Valves And Valve Guides
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS EAS24290 NOTE: CHECKING THE VALVES AND VALVE To ease valve guide removal and installation, GUIDES and to maintain the correct fit, heat the cylinder The following procedure applies to all of the head to 100°C (212°F) in an oven. valves and valve guides.
-
Page 224: Checking The Valve Seats
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS Intake Valve guide remover (ø4) 90890-04111 YM-04111 Exhaust Valve guide remover (ø4.5) 90890-04116 YM-04116 Intake Valve guide installer (ø4) 90890-04112 6. Measure: YM-04112 • Valve stem runout Out of specification → Replace the valve. Exhaust Valve guide installer (ø4.5) NOTE: 90890-04117 •…
-
Page 225
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS NOTE: Valve seat width After replacing the cylinder head or replacing Intake the valve and valve guide, the valve seat and 0.90–1.10 mm valve face should be lapped. (0.0354–0.0433 in) Exhaust ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ 0.90–1.10 mm a. Apply a coarse lapping compound “a” to (0.0354–0.0433 in) the valve face. -
Page 226: Checking The Valve Springs
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS h. Install the valve into the cylinder head. 2. Measure: i. Press the valve through the valve guide • Compressed valve spring force “a” Out of specification → Replace the valve and onto the valve seat to make a clear impression.
-
Page 227: Checking The Valve Lifters
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS 3. Install: EAS24320 • Valve “1” CHECKING THE VALVE LIFTERS • Lower spring seat “2” The following procedure applies to all of the • Valve stem seal “3” valve lifters. • Valve spring “4” 1. Check: •…
-
Page 228
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS • Each valve lifter and valve pad must be rein- Valve spring compressor stalled in its original position. 90890-04019 YM-04019 Intake Valve spring compressor attachment 90890-04114 YM-04114 Exhaust Valve spring compressor attachment 90890-04108 YM-04108 5. To secure the valve cotters onto the valve stem, lightly tap the valve tip with a soft- face hammer. -
Page 229: Generator
GENERATOR EAS24480 GENERATOR Removing the generator Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Engine oil Drain. Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL»…
-
Page 230
GENERATOR Removing the generator Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Bearing Stator coil assembly lead holder Idler gear Idler gear shaft Washer Bearing For assembly, reverse the removal procedure. 5-32… -
Page 231: Removing The Generator
GENERATOR EAS24490 REMOVING THE GENERATOR 1. Remove: • Plug • Generator rotor cover “1” NOTE: • While pushing generator rotor, remove the generator rotor cover. • Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern. •…
-
Page 232
GENERATOR Generator rotor cover bolt (M6) 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) Generator rotor cover bolt (M8) 22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb) NOTE: • First tighten the M8 bolts and then tighten the M6 bolts. • Tighten the generator rotor cover bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern. -
Page 233: Starter Clutch
STARTER CLUTCH EAS24550 STARTER CLUTCH Removing the starter clutch Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Generator rotor Damper Driven gear Washer Starter clutch drive gear Collar Washer Spacer O-ring For assembly, reverse the removal procedure. 5-35…
-
Page 234: Removing The Starter Clutch
STARTER CLUTCH EAS24560 REMOVING THE STARTER CLUTCH 1. Remove: • Spacer “1” • O-ring “2” • Washer “3” EAS24570 CHECKING THE STARTER CLUTCH 1. Check: • Starter clutch rollers “1” Damage/wear → Replace. 2. Remove: • Starter clutch drive gear “1” •…
-
Page 235: Installing The Starter Clutch
STARTER CLUTCH otherwise the starter clutch is faulty and 3. Install: must be replaced. • Washer “1” c. When turning the starter clutch drive gear • O-ring “2” clockwise “B”, it should turn freely, other- • Spacer “3” wise the starter clutch is faulty and must be NOTE: replaced.
-
Page 236: Crankshaft Position Sensor
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR EAS24520 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR Removing the crankshaft position sensor Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Engine oil Drain.
-
Page 237: Removing The Crankshaft Position Sensor
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR EAS24530 REMOVING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR 1. Disconnect: • Crankshaft position sensor lead coupler 2. Remove: • Crankshaft position sensor • O-ring • Pickup coil rotor cover “1” NOTE: Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn at a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
-
Page 238: Electric Starter
ELECTRIC STARTER EAS24780 ELECTRIC STARTER Removing the starter motor Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Throttle body assembly Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4.
-
Page 239
ELECTRIC STARTER Disassembling the starter motor Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks O-ring Front cover Lock washer Washer Starter motor yoke Armature assembly O-ring Starter motor lead Brush holder Rear cover For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 5-41… -
Page 240: Checking The Starter Motor
ELECTRIC STARTER EAS24790 CHECKING THE STARTER MOTOR Pocket tester 1. Check: 90890-03112 • Commutator Analog pocket tester Dirt → Clean with 600 grit sandpaper. YU-03112-C 2. Measure: • Commutator diameter “a” Armature coil Out of specification → Replace the starter Commutator resistance “1”…
-
Page 241: Assembling The Starter Motor
ELECTRIC STARTER NOTE: Align the match marks “a” on the starter motor yoke with the match marks “b” on the front and starter motor rear covers. 7. Check: • Gear teeth Damage/wear → Replace the gear. EAS24800 ASSEMBLING THE STARTER MOTOR EAS24810 1.
-
Page 242: Clutch
CLUTCH EAS25060 CLUTCH Removing the clutch cover Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Engine oil Drain. Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL» on page 3-12. Clutch cable Clutch cover Clutch cover gasket Dowel pin Oil filler cap For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
-
Page 243
CLUTCH Removing the pull lever shaft Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Circlip Pull lever Pull lever spring Pull lever shaft Oil seal Bearing For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 5-45… -
Page 244
CLUTCH Removing the clutch Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Compression spring Pressure plate Pull rod Bearing Friction plate 1 Clutch plate 1 Friction plate 2 Wire circlip Clutch plate 2 Friction plate 3 Clutch damper spring Clutch damper spring seat Clutch boss nut Washer Clutch boss assembly… -
Page 245
CLUTCH Removing the clutch Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks For assembly, reverse the removal procedure. 5-47… -
Page 246: Removing The Clutch
CLUTCH EAS25080 4. Remove: REMOVING THE CLUTCH • Clutch plate 1 “1” 1. Remove: • Friction plate 2 • Clutch cover “1” • Gasket NOTE: Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn at a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern. After all of the bolts are fully loosened, remove them.
-
Page 247: Checking The Friction Plates
CLUTCH • Thrust plate 1. Check: 8. Remove: • Friction plate Damage/wear → Replace the friction • Wire circlip “1” plates as a set. NOTE: 2. Measure: There is a built-in damper between the clutch • Friction plate thickness boss and the clutch plate. It is not necessary to Out of specification →…
-
Page 248: Checking The Clutch Springs
CLUTCH 2. Check: • Bearing Damage/wear → Replace the bearing and EAS25140 CHECKING THE CLUTCH SPRINGS clutch housing. The following procedure applies to all of the clutch springs. EAS25160 CHECKING THE CLUTCH BOSS 1. Check: 1. Check: • Clutch spring Damage →…
-
Page 249: Installing The Clutch
CLUTCH • Pull lever shaft pinion gear teeth “1” • Pull rod teeth “2” Damage/wear → Replace the pull rod and pull lever shaft pinion gear as a set. 3. Install: • Wire circlip “1” 2. Check: • Pull rod bearing Damage/wear →…
-
Page 250
CLUTCH • Lock the threads on the clutch boss nut by staking them with a drift punch at the point aligned with the groove in the axle. • While holding the clutch boss assembly “1” with the clutch holding tool “3”, tighten the clutch boss nut. -
Page 251
CLUTCH 12. Tighten 10. Install: • Clutch cover bolts “1” • Pull lever Clutch cover bolt NOTE: 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) Install the pull lever with the “O“ mark facing toward lower side. • Clutch cover bolt “2” Clutch cover bolt 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) LOCTITE®… -
Page 252: Shift Shaft
SHIFT SHAFT EAS25410 SHIFT SHAFT Removing the shift shaft and stopper lever Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Clutch assembly Refer to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44. Shift arm and shift rod Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2. Circlip Washer Shift shaft Collar Shift shaft spring…
-
Page 253
SHIFT SHAFT Removing the shift shaft and stopper lever Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 5-55… -
Page 254: Removing The Shift Shaft
SHIFT SHAFT ET2D1011 REMOVING THE SHIFT SHAFT 1. Remove: • Clutch assembly Refetr to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44 2. Remove: • Shift arm • Shift rod Refetr to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5- 3. Remove: • Circlip “1” • Washer “2” EAS25420 CHECKING THE SHIFT SHAFT (left side of the engine)
-
Page 255
SHIFT SHAFT • Stopper lever spring “3” • Shift rod • Shift arm Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5- 5. Install: • Clutch assembly Refer to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44. 2. Install: • Washer • Collar • Shift shaft spring “1” •… -
Page 256: Oil Pump
OIL PUMP EAS24920 OIL PUMP Removing the oil pan and oil pump Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Engine oil Drain. Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL» on page 3-12. EXUP cables Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2. sensor Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL»…
-
Page 257
OIL PUMP Removing the oil pan and oil pump Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil level switch Oil level switch lead holder Oil pan Oil pan gasket Dowel pin Drain pipe Oil strainer Oil pipe Oil delivery pipe Relief valve assembly Oil/water pump assembly drive chain guide Collar… -
Page 258
OIL PUMP Removing the oil pan and oil pump Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil/water pump assembly For assembly, reverse the removal procedure. 5-60… -
Page 259
OIL PUMP Disassembling the oil pump Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil/water pump driven sprocket Collar Oil pump housing Bearing Oil pump outer roter Oil pump inner roter For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 5-61… -
Page 260: Removing The Oil Pan
OIL PUMP EAS24930 EAS24960 REMOVING THE OIL PAN CHECKING THE OIL PUMP 1. Remove: 1. Check: • Oil level switch “1” • Oil pump driven gear “1” • Oil pan “2” • Oil pump rotor housing “2” • Oil pan gasket •…
-
Page 261: Checking The Relief Valve
OIL PUMP EAS24970 CHECKING THE RELIEF VALVE ET2D1013 CHECKING THE OIL NOZZLES 1. Check: The following procedure applies to all of the oil • Relief valve body “1” nozzles. • Relief valve “2” 1. Check: • Spring “3” • Oil nozzle “1” •…
-
Page 262: Installing The Oil/Water Pump Assembly
OIL PUMP NOTE: When installing the inner rotor, align the pin “1” in the oil pump shaft with the groove in the inner rotor “2”. 2. Install: • Washer • Oil/water pump assembly drive chain “1” • Oil/water pump assembly drive sprocket “2” •…
-
Page 263: Installing The Oil Pan
OIL PUMP EAS25050 4. Install: INSTALLING THE OIL PAN 1. Install: • Oil delivery pipe “1” • Dowel pins Oil delivery pipe bolt • Gasket 10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb) • Oil pan “1” LOCTITE® Oil pan bolt 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) •…
-
Page 264: Crankcase
CRANKCASE EAS25540 CRANKCASE Separating the crankcase Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Air filter case Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Throttle body assembly Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4. Engine Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2. Cylinder head Refer to «CYLINDER HEAD»…
-
Page 265
CRANKCASE Separating the crankcase Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil pump Refer to «OIL PUMP» on page 5-58. Starter motor Refer to «ELECTRIC STARTER» on page 5-40. Timing chain Timing chain guide (intake side) Timing chain guide (exhaust side) Left side cover O-ring Lower crankcase… -
Page 266: Disassembling The Crankcase
Engine oil 2. Apply: 3. Remove: • Sealant • Lower crankcase ECA13900 Yamaha bond No. 1215 CAUTION: (Three Bond No.1215®) Tap on one side of the crankcase with a 90890-85505 soft-face hammer. Tap only on reinforced portions of the crankcase, not on the NOTE: crankcase mating surfaces.
-
Page 267
CRANKCASE Crankcase bolt Bolt “1”–“10” 1st: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) 2nd*: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) 3rd: +60° Bolt “11”–“16” 24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb) Bolt “17”–“26” 12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) *Following the tightening order, loosen the 3. -
Page 268: Crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT EAS25950 CRANKSHAFT Removing the connecting rods and pistons Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Lower crankcase Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5- Connecting rod cap Big end lower bearing Big end upper bearing Piston pin clip Piston pin Piston Connecting rod Top ring 2nd ring…
-
Page 269
CRANKSHAFT Removing the crankshaft Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Crankcase Separate. Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5- Connecting rod and connecting rod Refer to «REMOVING THE CON- caps NECTING RODS AND PISTONS» on page 5-72. Crankshaft Crankshaft journal lower bearing Crankshaft journal upper bearing Washer Crankshaft drive gear… -
Page 270: Removing The Connecting Rods And Pistons
CRANKSHAFT EAS26030 REMOVING THE CONNECTING RODS AND Piston pin puller set PISTONS 90890-01304 The following procedure applies to all of the Piston pin puller connecting rods and pistons. YU-01304 1. Remove: • Connecting rod cap “1” • Big end bearings NOTE: •…
-
Page 271: Checking The Cylinder And Piston
CRANKSHAFT 4 mm (0.16 in) “a” from the bottom edge of NOTE: the piston Identify the position of each crankshaft journal upper bearing so that it can be reinstalled in its Piston size “P” original place. 76.975 — 76.990 mm (3.0305 — 3.0311 in) ET2D1032 CHECKING THE CYLINDER AND PISTON…
-
Page 272: Checking The Piston Pins
CRANKSHAFT Piston ring side clearance Piston ring end gap Top ring Top ring 0.030–0.065 mm 0.15–0.25 mm (0.0012–0.0026 in) (0.0059–0.0098 in) Limit Limit 0.115 mm (0.0045 in) 0.50 mm (0.0197 in) 2nd ring 2nd ring 0.020–0.055 mm 0.30–0.45 mm (0.0008–0.0022 in) (0.0118–0.0177 in) Limit Limit…
-
Page 273: Checking The Big End Bearings
CRANKSHAFT end bearings must be installed in their orig- Piston pin bore inside diameter inal positions. 17.002–17.013 mm a. Clean the big end bearings, crankshaft (0.6694–0.6698 in) pins, and the inside of the connecting rods Limit halves. 17.043 mm (0.6710 in) b.
-
Page 274
CRANKSHAFT Loosen the connecting rod bolt, remove the connecting rod and connecting rod cap and install these parts to the crankshaft with the big end bearing kept in the current condi- tion. k. Tighten the connecting rod bolts. e. Tighten the connecting rod bolts. Connecting rod bolt 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) NOTE:… -
Page 275
CRANKSHAFT p. After the installation, check that the section ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ shown “a” is flush with each other by touch- 2. Select: ing the surface. • Big end bearings (P1 – P4) • Side machined face “a” NOTE: EWA13120 • The numbers “A” stamped into the crank- WARNING shaft wed and the numbers “1”… -
Page 276: Installing The Connecting Rod And Piston
CRANKSHAFT EAS26190 (with the recommended lubricant) INSTALLING THE CONNECTING ROD AND PISTON Recommended lubricant The following procedure applies to all of the Engine oil connecting rods and pistons. 4. Offset: 1. Install: • Piston ring end gaps • Top ring “1” •…
-
Page 277
CRANKSHAFT NOTE: • Install by carrying out the following proce- dures in order to assemble in the most suit- able condition. • First tighten the bolts to 15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb) • Retighten the bolts to 29.4 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 21 ft·lb) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼… -
Page 278
CRANKSHAFT ECA14980 CAUTION: Tighten the connecting rod bolts using the plastic-region tightening angle method. a. Clean the connecting rod bolts. b. Tighten the connecting rod bolts. c. Put a mark “1” on the connecting rod bolt “2” and the connecting rod cap “3”. 11. -
Page 279: Checking The Crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT • If they are not flush with each other, remove the connecting rod bolt and big end bearing and restart from step “9”. In this case, make sure to replace the con- necting rod bolt. ECA14680 CAUTION: • Do not use a torque wrench to tighten the bolt to the specified angle.
-
Page 280
CRANKSHAFT Crankcase bolt Bolt “1”–“10” 1st: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) 2nd: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) 3rd: +60° Bolt “11”–“16” 24 Nm (2.4m·kg, 17 ft·lb) Bolt “17”–“26” 12 Nm (1.2m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb) M9 x 105 mm (4.1 in) bolts: “1”–“10” d. -
Page 281: Installing The Crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ 2. Select: • Crankshaft journal bearings (J1–J5) NOTE: • The numbers “A” stamped into the crank- shaft web and the numbers “1” stamped into the lower crankcase are used to determine the replacement crankshaft journal bearing sizes. • “J1–J5” refer to the bearings shown in the crankshaft illustration.
-
Page 282
CRANKSHAFT NOTE: • Align the projections “a” on the crankshaft journal upper bearings with the notches “b” in the upper crankcase. • Be sure to install each crankshaft journal upper bearing in its original place. 3. Install: • Crankshaft 4. Install: •… -
Page 283: Transmission
TRANSMISSION EAS26240 TRANSMISSION Removing the transmission, shift drum assembly, and shift forks Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Crankcase lower Separate. Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5- Drive axle assembly Circlip Oil seal Bearing Washer Shift fork guide bar retainer Spring Shift fork guide bar Shift fork “L”…
-
Page 284
TRANSMISSION Removing the transmission, shift drum assembly, and shift forks Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Main axle assembly Oil pipe O-ring Oil baffle plate For installation, reverse the removal procedure. 5-86… -
Page 285
TRANSMISSION Disassembling the main axle assenbly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks 2nd pinion gear Toothed lock washer Toothed lock washer retainer 6th pinion gear Collar Washer Circlip 3rd pinion gear Circlip Washer 5th pinion gear Collar Main axle Bearing housing Bearing For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. -
Page 286
TRANSMISSION Disassembling the drive axle assenbly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Washer 1st wheel gear Collar 5th wheel gear Circlip Washer 3rd wheel gear Collar Toothed lock washer Toothed lock washer retainer 4th wheel gear Collar Washer Circlip 6th wheel gear Circlip Washer Collar… -
Page 287
TRANSMISSION Disassembling the drive axle assenbly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil seal Bearing Drive axle For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. 5-89… -
Page 288: Removing The Transmission
TRANSMISSION EAS26250 REMOVING THE TRANSMISSION 1. Remove: • Drive axle asseembly “1” • Shift drum retainers “2” • Shift fork guide bars • Shift fork “L” and “R” • Shift drum assembly • Shift fork “C” EAS26260 CHECKING THE SHIFT FORKS The following procedure applies to all of the shift forks.
-
Page 289: Checking The Shift Drum Assembly
TRANSMISSION Out of specification → Replace the main axle. Main axle runout limit 0.08 mm (0.0032 in) 3. Check: • Shift fork movement (along the shift fork guide bar) Rough movement → Replace the shift forks and shift fork guide bar as a set. 2.
-
Page 290
TRANSMISSION ET2D1022 INSTALLING THE TRANSMISSION 1. Install: • Bearing “1” NOTE: Make the seal side of bearing face to the out- side and install it close to the right end face of the crankcase. • Oil pipe “2” 3. Install: •… -
Page 291
TRANSMISSION 4. Check: • Transmission Rough movement → Repair. NOTE: Oil each gear, shaft, and bearing thoroughly. 5-93… -
Page 292
COOLING SYSTEM RADIATOR………………..6-1 CHECKING THE RADIATOR…………..6-3 INSTALLING THE RADIATOR …………..6-3 OIL COOLER ………………..6-4 CHECKING THE OIL COOLER………….. 6-5 INSTALLING THE OIL COOLER …………6-5 THERMOSTAT ………………..6-6 CHECKING THE THERMOSTAT…………6-8 ASSEMBLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEMBLY ……..6-8 INSTALLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEMBLY ……..6-8 WATER PUMP ………………..6-10 DISASSEMBLING THE WATER PUMP ………. -
Page 293
RADIATOR EAS26380 RADIATOR Removing the radiator Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Air filter case Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. -
Page 294
RADIATOR Removing the radiator Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Water pump inlet pipe O-ring For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 295
RADIATOR EAS26390 CHECKING THE RADIATOR 1. Check: • Radiator fins Obstruction → Clean. Apply compressed air to the rear of the radiator. Damage → Repair or replace. NOTE: Straighten any flattened fins with a thin, flat- head screwdriver. b. Apply the specified pressure for ten sec- onds and make sure there is no drop in pressure. -
Page 296
OIL COOLER EAS26410 OIL COOLER Removing the oil cooler Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Engine oil Drain. Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL» on page 3-12. Oil cooler inlet hose Oil cooler bolt Washer Oil cooler O-ring Water pump outlet pipe O-ring Water jacket joint inlet hose O-ring… -
Page 297: Oil Cooler
OIL COOLER EAS26420 3. Fill: CHECKING THE OIL COOLER • Cooling system 1. Check: (with the specified amount of the recom- • Oil cooler mended coolant) Cracks/damage → Replace. Refer to «CHANGING THE COOLANT» on page 3-19. • Crankcase (with the specified amount of the recom- mended engine oil) Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL»…
-
Page 298
THERMOSTAT EAS26440 THERMOSTAT Removing the thermostat assembly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Air filter case Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. -
Page 299
THERMOSTAT Disassembling the thermostat assembly Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Thermostat housing cover Thermostat Thermostat housing O-ring For assembly, reverse the disassem- bly procedure. -
Page 300
THERMOSTAT EAS26450 • Thermostat housing “2” CHECKING THE THERMOSTAT Cracks/damage → Replace. 1. Check: • Thermostat Does not open at 71 – 85°C (160 – 185°F) → Replace. EAS26460 ASSEMBLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEM- ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Suspend the thermostat “3” in a container 1. -
Page 301
THERMOSTAT Below the specified pressure → Replace the radiator cap. Refer to «CHECKING THE RADIATOR» on page 6-3. -
Page 302: Water Pump
WATER PUMP EAS26500 WATER PUMP Removing the impeller shaft Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Oil/water pump assembly Refer to «OIL PUMP» on page 5-58. Oil pump roter Refer to «OIL PUMP» on page 5-58. Water pump cover O-ring Impeller shaft (along with the impeller) Water pump seal Oil seal Bearing…
-
Page 303
WATER PUMP EAS26520 DISASSEMBLING THE WATER PUMP 1. Remove: • Water pump seal “1” • Water pump housing “2” NOTE: Tap out the water pump seal from the inside of the water pump housing. EAS26540 CHECKING THE WATER PUMP 1. Check: •… -
Page 304
(4). tools. ECA14090 • Before installing the water pump seal, apply CAUTION: Yamaha bond No.1215 (Three Bond Make sure the rubber damper and rubber No.1215® ) “2” to the water pump housing damper holder are flush with the impeller. “3”. -
Page 305
WATER PUMP 6-13… -
Page 306
FUEL SYSTEM FUEL TANK ………………..7-1 REMOVING THE FUEL TANK…………..7-2 REMOVING THE FUEL PUMP……………7-2 CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP BODY …………7-2 CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP OPERATION ………7-2 INSTALLING THE FUEL PUMP …………. 7-2 INSTALLING THE FUEL TANK……………7-3 THROTTLE BODIES………………7-4 CHECKING THE INJECTORS ……………7-8 CHECKING THE THROTTLE BODIES ………. -
Page 307
FUEL TANK EAS26620 FUEL TANK Removing the fuel tank Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel hose Disconnect. Fuel sender coupler Disconnect. Fuel pump coupler Disconnect. Fuel tank drain hose Disconnect. -
Page 308: Fuel Tank
FUEL TANK EAS26630 ECA14720 REMOVING THE FUEL TANK CAUTION: 1. Extract the fuel in the fuel tank through the • Do not drop the fuel pump or give it a fuel tank cap with a pump. strong shock. 2. Remove: •…
-
Page 309
FUEL TANK ET2D1023 INSTALLING THE FUEL TANK 1. Install: • Fuel hose • Fuel hose connector cover ECA14740 CAUTION: When installing the fuel hose, make sure that it is securely connected, and that the fuel hose holders are in the correct posi- tion, otherwise the fuel hose will not be properly installed. -
Page 310: Throttle Bodies
THROTTLE BODIES EAS26970 THROTTLE BODIES Removing the throttle bodies Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Rider and passenger seat Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1. Fuel tank Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1. Air filter case Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
-
Page 311
THROTTLE BODIES Removing the throttle bodies Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 312
THROTTLE BODIES Removing the injectors Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Throttle position sensor coupler Disconnect. Sub-throttle position sensor coupler Disconnect. Sub-throttle motor assembly coupler Disconnect. Intake air pressure sensor coupler Disconnect. Cylinder #1-injector coupler Disconnect. Cylinder #2-injector coupler Disconnect. Cylinder #3-injector coupler Disconnect. -
Page 313
THROTTLE BODIES Removing the injectors Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Washer Link Sub-throttle servo motor assembly Throttle position sensor Throttle body assembly For installation, reverse the removal procedure. -
Page 314
THROTTLE BODIES EAS26980 CHECKING THE INJECTORS 1. Check: • Injectors Damage → Replace. c. Connect the pressure gauge “2” and adapter “3” to the fuel hose (fuel tank to pri- mary injector fuel rail). EAS26990 CHECKING THE THROTTLE BODIES Vacuum/pressure pump gauge 1. -
Page 315
THROTTLE BODIES 1. Check: ET2D1024 ADJUSTING THE SUB-THROTTLE POSI- • Throttle position sensor TION SENSOR Refer to «CHECKING THE THROTTLE 1. Check: POSITION SENSOR» on page 8-109. • Sub-throttle position sensor 2. Adjust: Refer to «CHECKING THE SUB-THROT- • Throttle position sensor angle TLE POSITION SENSOR»… -
Page 316
THROTTLE BODIES 4. Adjust: • Sub-throttle position sensor voltage ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the sub-throttle position sensor coupler to the wire harness. b. Connect the digital circuit tester to the sub- throttle position sensor. • Positive tester probe Green/Yellow terminal “1” •… -
Page 317
THROTTLE BODIES Out of specification → Replace. a. Before adjusting the distance, push the rod ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ “b” in order to be fitted in several times by hand. a. Check whether or not the sub-throttle valve is seized. b. Measure the outside air temperature, and 1 Turn the nut of worm shaft of the sub-throt- adjust the distance “a”… -
Page 318
THROTTLE BODIES it shorter when the coolant temperature is high.) • In case of turning the adjusting bolt two-third turn, the temperature varies about 10°C (50°F). 7-12… -
Page 319: Air Induction System
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM EAS27040 AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM Removing the air cut-off valve assembly and hoses Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks Air cut-off valve coupler Disconnect. Air cut-off valve hose 1 Disconnect. Air cut-off valve hose 2 Disconnect. Air cut-off valve hose 3 Disconnect.
-
Page 320
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM EAS27060 CHECKING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM Air injection The air induction system burns unburned exhaust gases by injecting fresh air (second- ary air) into the exhaust port, reducing the emission of hydrocarbons. When there is neg- ative pressure at the exhaust port, the reed valve opens, allowing secondary air to flow into the exhaust port. -
Page 321
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM Out of specification → Replace the reed • Plate valve. • Reed valve assembly • Reed valve cap Reed valve bending limit 2. Install: 0.4 mm (0.016 in) • Air cut-off valve • Air cut-off valve hose 1 •… -
Page 322: General Information
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………….8-5 STARTING CIRCUIT CUT-OFF SYSTEM OPERATION……8-7 TROUBLESHOOTING…………….8-9 CHARGING SYSTEM …………….. 8-11 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………….8-11 TROUBLESHOOTING…………….8-13 LIGHTING SYSTEM ……………….8-15 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-N) …………..8-15 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-S) …………..8-17 TROUBLESHOOTING…………….8-19 SIGNALING SYSTEM…………….. 8-21 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………….8-21 TROUBLESHOOTING…………….8-23 COOLING SYSTEM………………8-27 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………….8-27 TROUBLESHOOTING…………….8-29…
-
Page 323
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS…………..8-89 CHECKING THE SWITCHES……………8-93 CHECKING THE BULBS AND BULB SOCKETS………8-96 CHECKING THE FUSES…………..8-97 CHECKING AND CHARGING THE BATTERY……..8-97 CHECKING THE RELAYS…………..8-100 CHECKING THE TURN SIGNAL/HAZARD RELAY ……8-102 CHECKING THE RELAY UNIT (DIODE) ……….8-102 CHECKING THE IGNITION COILS…………8-103 CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR…..8-104 CHECKING THE LEAN ANGLE SENSOR………8-105 CHECKING THE STARTOR MOTOR OPERATION ……8-105… -
Page 325: Ignition System
IGNITION SYSTEM EAS27090 IGNITION SYSTEM EAS27110 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…
-
Page 326
IGNITION SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 11.Relay unit 12.Starting circuit cut-off relay 14.Neutral switch 15.Sidestand switch 17.Crankshaft position sensor 21.Lean angle sensor 23.ECU 24.Ignition coil #1 25.Ignition coil #2 26.Ignition coil #3 27.Ignition coil #4 28.Spark plug 56.Engine stop switch 60.Clutch switch 78.Fuse (ignition) -
Page 327
IGNITION SYSTEM EAS27150 TROUBLESHOOTING The ignition system fails to operate (no spark or intermittent spark). NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 1 Check the fuses. NG→ (Main and ignition) Replace the fuse(s). Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES»… -
Page 328
IGNITION SYSTEM 8 Check the engine stop switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the right handlebar switch. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓ 9 Check the neutral switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the neutral switch. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓… -
Page 329: Electric Starting System
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM EAS27160 ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM EAS27170 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…
-
Page 330
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 9. Starter relay 10.Starter motor 11.Relay unit 12.Starting circuit cut-off relay 14.Neutral switch 15.Sidestand switch 56.Engine stop switch 57.Start switch 60.Clutch switch 78.Fuse (ignition) -
Page 331
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM EAS27180 STARTING CIRCUIT CUT-OFF SYSTEM OPERATION If the engine stop switch is set to “ ” and the main switch is set to “ON” (both switches are closed), the starter motor can only operate if at least one of the following conditions is met: •… -
Page 332
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM a. WHEN THE TRANSMISSION IS IN NEU- TRAL b. WHEN THE SIDESTAND IS UP AND THE CLUTCH LEVER IS PULLED TO THE HANDLEBAR 1. Battery 2. Main fuse 3. Main switch 4. Ignition fuse 5. Engine stop switch 6. -
Page 333
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM EAS27190 TROUBLESHOOTING The starter motor fails to turn. NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 3 Air filter case NG→ 1 Check the fuses. (Main and ignition) Replace the fuse(s). Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES»… -
Page 334
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM 8 Check the main switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the immobilizer kit. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓ 9 Check the engine stop switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the right handlebar switch. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓… -
Page 335: Charging System
CHARGING SYSTEM EAS27200 CHARGING SYSTEM EAS27210 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM 8-11…
-
Page 336
CHARGING SYSTEM 2. Rectifier/regulator 3. A.C.magneto 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 8-12… -
Page 337
CHARGING SYSTEM EAS27230 TROUBLESHOOTING The battery is not being charged. NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 1 Check the fuse. NG→ (Main) Replace the fuse. Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97. OK↓… -
Page 338
CHARGING SYSTEM 8-14… -
Page 339: Lighting System
LIGHTING SYSTEM EAS27240 LIGHTING SYSTEM EAS27250 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-N) 8-15…
-
Page 340
LIGHTING SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 23.ECU 49.High beam indicator light 52.Meter light 61.Pass switch 62.Dimmer switch 72.Auxiliary light 73.Headlight 74.License plate light 75.Tail/brake light 76.Headlight relay (on/off) 77.Fuse (tail light)) 81.Fuse (headlight) 8-16… -
Page 341
LIGHTING SYSTEM ET2D1026 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-S) 8-17… -
Page 342
LIGHTING SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 23.ECU 49.High beam indicator light 52.Meter light 61.Pass switch 62.Dimmer switch 72.Auxiliary light 73.Headlight 74.License plate light 75.Tail/brake light 76.Headlight relay (on/off) 77.Headlight relay (dimmer) 78.Fuse (tail light) 82.Fuse (headlight) 8-18… -
Page 343
LIGHTING SYSTEM EAS27260 TROUBLESHOOTING Any of the following fail to light: headlight, high beam indicator light, taillight, license light or meter light. NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 3 Air filter case 1 Check the each bulbs and bulb NG→… -
Page 344
Replace the headlight relay. Refer to «CHECKING THE RELAYS» on page 8-100. OK↓ 10 Check the entire lighting system’s NG→ wiring. Properly connect or repair the lighting Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM system’s wiring. (FZ1-N)» on page 8-15. OK↓ This circuit is OK. 8-20… -
Page 345: Signaling System
SIGNALING SYSTEM EAS27270 SIGNALING SYSTEM EAS27280 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM 8-21…
-
Page 346
SIGNALING SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 11.Relay unit 14.Neutral switch 16.Fuel pump 19.Speed sensor 23.ECU 42.Fuel level warning light 43.Oil level warning light 44.Neutral indicator light 45.Tacho meter 46.Multi function meter 48.Coolant temperature indicator light 50.Turn signal indicator light (left) 51.Turn signal indicator light (right) 53.Oil level switch 55.Front brake light switch… -
Page 347
SIGNALING SYSTEM EAS27290 TROUBLESHOOTING • Any of the following fail to light: turn signal light, brake light or an indicator light. • The horn fails to sound. NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 3 Air filter case 1 Check the fuses. -
Page 348
SIGNALING SYSTEM 3 Check the entire signaling system’s NG→ wiring. Properly connect or repair the signal- Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on ing system wiring. page 8-21. OK↓ This circuit is OK. The tail/brake light fails to come on. 1 Check the tail/brake light bulb and NG→… -
Page 349
SIGNALING SYSTEM 3 Check the hazard switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the left handlebar switch. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓ 4 Check the turn signal/hazard relay. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the turn signal/hazard relay. RELAYS» on page 8-100. OK↓… -
Page 350
SIGNALING SYSTEM 1 Check the fuel sender. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE FUEL Replace the fuel pump assembly. SENDER» on page 8-107. OK↓ 2 Check the entire signaling system’s NG→ wiring. Properly connect or repair the signal- Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on ing system’s wiring. -
Page 351: Cooling System
COOLING SYSTEM EAS27300 COOLING SYSTEM EAS27310 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM 8-27…
-
Page 352
COOLING SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 23.ECU 38.Coolant temperature sensor 78.Fuse (ignition) 82.Radiator fan motor relay 83.Fuse (radiator fan motor left) 84.Fuse (radiator fan motor right) 85.Radiator fan motor (left) 86.Radiator fan motor (right) 8-28… -
Page 353
COOLING SYSTEM EAS27320 TROUBLESHOOTING NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 3 Air filter case 1 Check the fuses. NG→ (Main, ignition and radiator fan motor) Replace the fuse(s). Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97. -
Page 354
COOLING SYSTEM 8-30… -
Page 355: Fuel Injection System
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM EAS27330 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM EAS27340 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM 8-31…
-
Page 356
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM 1. Main switch 4. Fuse (backup) 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 8. Fuse (fuel injection) 11.Relay unit 12.Starting circuit cut-off relay 13.Fuel pump relay 14.Neutral switch 15.Sidestand switch 16.Fuel pump 17.Crankshaft position sensor 18.Cylinder identification sensor 19.Speed sensor 20.Atmospheric pressure sensor 21.Lean angle sensor 22.O… -
Page 357
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM EAS27370 TROUBLESHOOTING The ignition system fails to operate (no spark or intermittent spark). NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 3 Air filter case NG→ 1 Check the fuses. (Main, backup, fuel injection and ignition) Replace the fuse(s). -
Page 358
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM 8 Check the main switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the immobilizer kit. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓ 9 Check the engine stop switch. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE Replace the right handlebar switch. SWITCHES» on page 8-93. OK↓… -
Page 359
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM 17 Checking the aomospheric pres- NG→ sure sensor. Replace the atomospheric pressure Refer to «CHECKING THE ATMO- sensor. SPHERIC PRESSURE SENSOR» on page 8-111. OK↓ 18 Check the injector. NG→ Refer to «CHECKING THE INJEC- Replace the injector. TORS»… -
Page 360
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM 24 Check the entire ignition system’s NG→ wiring. Properly connect or repair the ignition Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on system’s wiring page 8-1. OK↓ Replace the ECU. 8-36… -
Page 361
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM EAS27350 ECU SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION The ECU is equipped with a self-diagnostic function in order to ensure that the fuel injection system is operating normally. If this function detects a malfunction in the system, it immediately operates the engine under substitute characteristics and illuminates the engine trouble warning light to alert the rider that a malfunction has occurred in the system. -
Page 362: Self-Diagnostic Function Table
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM a. Main switch “OFF” b. Main switch “ON” c. Engine trouble warning light off d. Engine trouble warning light on for 1.4 sec- onds ET2D1027 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION TABLE If the ECU detects an abnormal signal from a sensor while the vehicle is being driven, the ECU illu- minates the engine trouble warning light and provides the engine with alternate operating instruc- tions that are appropriate for the type of malfunction.
-
Page 363
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Able/ Able/ Fault Item Symptom unable unable code No. to start to drive Coolant temperature Coolant temperature sensor: sensor open or short circuit detected. Able Able (open or short circuit) Intake air temperature Intake air temperature sensor: sensor open or short circuit detected. -
Page 364
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Able/ Able/ Fault Item Symptom unable unable code No. to start to drive Injector Injector: Able Able (open circuit) open circuit detected. (depend- (depend- ing on ing on the num- the num- ber of ber of faulty faulty cylin- cylin-… -
Page 365
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Able/ Able/ Fault Item Symptom unable unable code No. to start to drive ECU internal malfunc- No signals are received from the ECU Er-2 tion within the specified duration. Unable Unable (output signal error) ECU internal malfunc- Data from the ECU cannot be received Er-3 tion… -
Page 366
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM If a malfunction is detected in the sensors If no malfunction is detected in the sensors or actuators, repair or replace all faulty and actuators, check and repair inner parts parts. of the engine. EAS27420 DIAGNOSTIC MODE Setting the diagnostic mode 1. -
Page 367
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM The data representing the operating conditions of the sensor appears on the odometer/tripme- ter/fuel reserve tripmeter LCD. • Actuator operation Set the engine stop switch to “ ” to operate the actuator. NOTE: If the engine stop switch is set to “ ”, set it to “… -
Page 368
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault Diagnostic code Symptom Probable cause of malfunction code No. When the main switch is • Atmospheric pressure sensor hose is turned to “ON”, the atmo- clogged. spheric pressure sensor • Intake air pressure sensor hose is clogged, voltage and intake air pres- kinked, or pinched. -
Page 369
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault Diagnostic code Symptom Probable cause of malfunction code No. Open circuit detected in the • Open or short circuit in wire harness. primary lead of the cylinder- • Malfunction in ignition coil. #4 ignition coil. • Malfunction in a component of ignition cut- off circuit system. -
Page 370
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault Diagnostic code Symptom Probable cause of malfunction code No. No signals are received • Improper connection in wire harness. Er-2 from the ECU within the • Malfunction in meter. — specified duration. • Malfunction in ECU. Data from the ECU cannot •… -
Page 371
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Diag- nostic Item Meter display Checking method code Fuel system voltage Approximately 12.0 Set the engine stop switch (battery voltage) to “ ” and then compare with the actually measured battery voltage. (If the bat- tery voltage is lower, recharge the battery.) Sidestand switch Set ON/OFF the sidestand… -
Page 372
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Diag- nostic Item Meter display Checking method code Malfunction code reinstate • No mulfunction code — • Malfunction code exists Fault code 24 To reinstate, set the engine • (If more than one code stop switch to “ “… -
Page 373
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Diag- nostic Item Actuation Checking method code Injector #3 Actuates the injector #3 five Check the operating sound times at one-second inter- of the injector #3 five times. vals. Illuminates the engine trou- ble warning light. Injector #4 Actuates the injector #4 five Check the operating sound times at one-second inter-… -
Page 374
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Diag- nostic Item Actuation Checking method code Sub-throttle servo motor Actuate the servo motor turns Check the operating sound to close side and to open of the Sub-throttle servo side. motor. Illuminates the engine trou- ble warning light only while the motor is runnning. -
Page 375
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM No normal signals are received from the crankshaft posi- Fault code No. Symptom tion sensor. Diagnostic code No. — — Orde Item/components and probable Reinstatement Check or maintenance job cause method Installed condition of crankshaft posi- Check for looseness or pinching. Cranking the tion sensor engine. -
Page 376
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. Symptom Intake air pressure sensor:open or short circuit detected. Diagnostic code No. Intake air pressure sensor Orde Item/components and probable Reinstatement Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turn the main •… -
Page 377
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. Symptom Throttle position sensor:open or short circuit detected. Diagnostic code No. Throttle position sensor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Installed condition of throttle position • Check for looseness or pinch- Turning the sensor. -
Page 378
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. 16 Symptom Stuck throttle position sensor detected. Diagnostic code No. Throttle position sensor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Installed condition of throttle position • Check the installed area for Reinstated by sensor. -
Page 379
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. 18 Symptom EXUP servo motor is stuck. Diagnostic code No. EXUP servo motor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the •… -
Page 380
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM When the main switch is turned to “ON”, the atmospheric Fault code No. Symptom pressure sensor voltage and intake air pressure sensor voltage differ greatly. Atmospheric pressure sensor Diagnostic code No. Intake air pressure sensor Orde Item/components and probable Reinstatement Check or maintenance job cause… -
Page 381
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Intake air temperature sensor:open or short circuit Fault code No. 22 Symptom detected. Diagnostic code No. Intake air temperature sensor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the •… -
Page 382
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Atmospheric pressure sensor:open or short circuit Fault code No. 23 Symptom detected. Diagnostic code No. Atmospheric pressure sensor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the •… -
Page 383
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM No normal signal is received from the O sensor. Fault code No. 24 Symptom Diagnostic code No. — — Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Installed state of O sensor. Check for looseness or pinching. Start and warm up the engine Connections •… -
Page 384
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder- Fault code No. 33 Symptom #1 ignition coil. Diagnostic code No. Cylinder-#1 ignition coil Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Starting the •… -
Page 385
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder- Fault code No. 34 Symptom #2 ignition coil Diagnostic code No. Cylinder-#2 ignition coil Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Starting the •… -
Page 386
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder- Fault code No. 35 Symptom #3 ignition coil Diagnostic code No. Cylinder-#3 ignition coil Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Starting the •… -
Page 387
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder- Fault code No. 36 Symptom #4 ignition coil Diagnostic code No. Cylinder-#4 ignition coil Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Starting the •… -
Page 388
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. 39 Symptom Open circuit detected in a injector. Injector #1 Injector #2 Diagnostic code No. Injector #3 Injector #4 Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Start the engine •… -
Page 389
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. Symptom Lean angle sensor:open or short circuit detected. Diagnostic code No. Lean angle sensor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the •… -
Page 390
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM A. No normal signals are received from the speed sen- Fault code No. 42 Symptom sor. B. Open circuit is detected in the neutral switch. Speed sensor Diagnostic code No. Neutral switch Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method… -
Page 391
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM A. No normal signals are received from the speed sen- Fault code No. 42 Symptom sor. B. Open circuit is detected in the neutral switch. Speed sensor Diagnostic code No. Neutral switch Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method… -
Page 392
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Power supply to the injectors and fuel pump is not nor- Fault code No. Symptom mal. Diagnostic code No. Fuel system voltage (battery voltage) Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Starting the •… -
Page 393
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM An error is detected while reading or writing on EEPROM Fault code No. Symptom (CO adjustment value). Diagnostic code No. EEPROM fault cylinder No. Orde Item/components and probable Reinstatement Check or maintenance job cause method Malfunction in ECU •… -
Page 394
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Power supply to the fuel injection system relay is not nor- Fault code No. 46 Symptom mal. Diagnostic code No. — — Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections. • Check the coupler for any pins Starting the •… -
Page 395
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Sub-throttle position sensor:open or short circuit Fault code No. 47 Symptom detected. Diagnostic monitor- Sub-throttle servo motor ing code No. Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Installed state of sub-throttle position • Check for looseness or pinch- Turning the sensor. -
Page 396
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. 48 Symptom Sub-throttle servo motor:stuck. Diagnostic code No. Sub-throttle servo motor Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the • Sub-throttle servo motor coupler that may be pulled out. -
Page 397
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. Er-1 Symptom No signals are received from the ECU. Diagnostic code No. — — Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the •… -
Page 398
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Fault code No. Er-3 Symptom Data from the ECU cannot be received correctly. Diagnostic code No. — — Item/components and probable Reinstatement Order Check or maintenance job cause method Connections • Check the couplers for any pins Turning the •… -
Page 399: Fuel Pump System
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM EAS27550 FUEL PUMP SYSTEM EAS27560 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM 8-75…
-
Page 400
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM 1. Main switch 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 8. Fuse (fuel injection) 13.Fuel pump relay 16.Fuel pump 23.ECU 46.Multi function meter 56.Engine stop switch 78.Fuse (ignition) 8-76… -
Page 401
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM EAS27570 TROUBLESHOOTING If the fuel pump fails to operate. NOTE: • Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s): 1 Rider and passenger seat 2 Fuel tank 3 Air filter case NG→ 1 Check the fuses. (Main, ignition and fuel injection system) Replace the fuse(s). -
Page 402
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM 8-78… -
Page 403: Immobilizer System
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM EAS27640 IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM EAS27650 CIRCUIT DIAGRAM 8-79…
-
Page 404
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM 1. Main switch 4. Fuse (backup) 5. Immobilizer unit 6. Fuse (main) 7. Battery 23.ECU 41.Immobilizer indicator 46.Multi function meter 78.Fuse (ignition) 8-80… -
Page 405
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM EAS27670 GENERAL INFORMATION This vehicle is equipped with an immobilizer system to help prevent theft by re-registering codes in the standard keys. This system consists of the following. • A code re-registering key (with a red bow) • Two standard keys (with a black bow) that can be re-registered with new codes •… -
Page 406
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM Parts to be replaced Main switch/immo- Key registration Acces- bilizer unit Standard requirement sory lock* Main Immobi- and key switch lizer unit All keys have been Code re-registering ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ lost (including code key and standard re-registering key) keys Code re-registering… -
Page 407
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM Standby mode d. LED off a. Main switch “ON” e. Standby mode on b. Main switch “OFF” f. Standby mode off c. LED on Standard key registration: Standard key registration is required when a standard key is lost and needs to be replaced, or when the code re-registering key is re-registered after the immobilizer unit or ECU are replaced. -
Page 408
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM Standard key registration h. Second standard key a. Main switch “ON” i. Registration mode b. Main switch “OFF” c. LED on A. Registration of the second standard key is complete. d. LED off B. Immobilizer system indicator light stops e. -
Page 409
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM EAS27700 TROUBLESHOOTING When the main switch is turn “ON”, the indicator light does not come on or flashing. 1 Check the fuses. NG→ (Main, ignition and backup) Replace the fuse(s). Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97. OK↓… -
Page 410
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM Error Detection Symptoms Trouble Measures code IMMOBILIZER Codes do not match 1 Disturbed by other 1 Place the immobi- UNIT between the key and transponder. lizer unit away immobilizer unit. Failed to verify continu- more than 50 mm ally for ten times. -
Page 411
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM a. Light on b. Light off 8-87… -
Page 412
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM 8-88… -
Page 413: Electrical Components
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS EAS27970 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 8-89…
-
Page 414
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1. Main switch (immobilizer unit) 2. Front brake light switch 3. Starter relay 4. Battery 5. Fuse box 6. Rear brake light switch 7. Neutral switch 8. Sidestand switch 9. Oil level switch 10.Radiator fan motor 11.Horn 12.Ignition coil 8-90… -
Page 415
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 8-91… -
Page 416
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1. Coolant temperature sensor 2. Intake air temperature sensor 3. Intake air pressure sensor 4. Fuel pump 5. ECU 6. Lean angle sensor 7. Starting circuit cut-off relay 8. Headlight relay (on/off) 9. Radiator fan motor relay 10.Turn signal relay 11.Recifier/regulator 12.Throttle position sensor 13.Sub-throttle position sensor… -
Page 417
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS EAS27980 CHECKING THE SWITCHES 8-93… -
Page 418
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1. Main switch 2. Horn switch 3. Dimmer switch 4. Pass switch 5. Turn signal switch 6. Hazard switch 7. Clutch switch 8. Sidestand switch 9. Engine stop switch 10.Front brake light switch 11.Start switch 12.Oil level switch 13.Neutral switch 14.Rear brake light switch 15.Fuse box… -
Page 419
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS Check each switch for continuity with the pocket tester. If the continuity reading is incorrect, check the wiring connections and if necessary, replace the switch. ECA14370 CAUTION: Never insert the tester probes into the coupler terminal slots “1”. Always insert the probes from the opposite end of the coupler, taking care not to loosen or damage the leads. -
Page 420
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS EAS27990 hands away from the bulb until it has CHECKING THE BULBS AND BULB SOCK- cooled down. ECA14380 Check each bulb and bulb socket for damage CAUTION: or wear, proper connections, and also for conti- • Be sure to hold the socket firmly when nuity between the terminals. -
Page 421
Amperage Q’ty rating NOTE: Check each bulb socket for continuity in the Main 50 A same manner as described in the bulb section; Headlight (FZ1-N) 15 A however, note the following. Headlight (FZ1-S) 25 A Signaling system 10 A ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼… -
Page 422
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS • Keep batteries away from fire, sparks or open flames (e.g., welding equipment, lighted cigarettes). • DO NOT SMOKE when charging or han- dling batteries. • KEEP BATTERIES AND ELECTROLYTE OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN. • Avoid bodily contact with electrolyte as it can cause severe burns or permanent eye injury. -
Page 423
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS into the battery quickly and can cause c. Make sure that the current is higher than battery overheating and battery plate the standard charging current written on damage. the battery. • If it is impossible to regulate the charging NOTE: current on the battery charger, be careful If the current is lower than the standard charg-… -
Page 424
“2”. Relay operation Continuity/No continuity (between “3” to “4”) Relay unit (starting circuit cut-off relay) FZ1-N 8. Check: • Battery terminals Dirt → Clean with a wire brush. Loose connection → Connect properly. FZ1-S 9. -
Page 425
Result (between “3” to “4”) Continuity/No continuity (between “3” to “4”) Headlight relay (on/off) (FZ1-S) Relay unit (fuel pump relay) FZ1-N FZ1-S 1. Positive battery terminal 2. Negative battery terminal 3. Positive tester probe 4. Negative tester probe Result Continuity/No continuity (between “3”… -
Page 426
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS b. Turn the main switch to “ON”. c. Measure the turn signal/hazard relay input voltage. 1. Positive battery terminal ▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲ 2. Check: 2. Negative battery terminal • Turn signal/hazard relay output voltage 3. Positive tester probe Out of specification → Replace. 4. -
Page 427
Continuity FZ1-S Positive tester probe → Sky blue “1” Negative tester probe → Yel- low/Black “2” (FZ1-N) Black/ Yellow “2” (FZ1-S) No continuity Positive tester probe → Yel- low/Black “2” (FZ1-N) Black/ Yellow “2” (FZ1-S) Negative tester probe →… -
Page 428
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 3. Check: • Positive tester probe • Ignition spark gap “a” Ignition coil terminal Out of specification → Replace. • Negative tester probe Ignition coil terminal Minimum ignition spark gap 6.0 mm (0.24 in) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the spark plug cap from the spark plug. -
Page 429
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS a. Connect the pocket tester (Ω × 100) to the crankshaft position sensor coupler as shown. Pocket tester 90890-03112 Analog pocket tester YU-03112-C • Positive tester probe Gray “1” • Negative tester probe c. When turn the lean angle sensor to 65°. Black “2”… -
Page 430
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS Out of specification → Replace the startor • Charging voltage Out of specification → Replace the rectifier/ coil. regulator. EAS28150 CHECKING THE STATOR COIL Charging voltage 1. Disconnect: 14 V at 5000 r/min • Stator coil coupler (from the wire harness) ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼… -
Page 431
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS (from the fuel tank) Pocket tester 4. Check: 90890-03112 • Fuel sender resistance Analog pocket tester YU-03112-C Fuel sender resistance Full position of the float • Positive tester probe 19–21Ω at 20°C (68°F) Horn terminal “1” Empty position of the float 139–141 Ω… -
Page 432
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS EWA14130 • Positive tester probe WARNING White/Yellow “1” • Handle the coolant temperature sensor • Negative tester probe with special care. Black/Blue “2” • Never subject the coolant temperature sensor to strong shocks. If the coolant temperature sensor is dropped, replace it. 2. -
Page 433
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS • Tester positive lead → Blue “1” • Tester negative lead → Black/Blue “2” b. Check the throttle position sensor maxi- mum resistance. Out of specification → Replace the throttle position sensor. Maximum throttle position sen- sor resistance 4–6 kΩ… -
Page 434
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS NOTE: When installing the throttle position sensor, adjust its angle properly. Refer to «ADJUST- ING THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR» on page 7-8. EAS2D1010 g. While slowly opening the sub-throttle worm CHECKING THE SUB-THROTTLE POSITION nut, check that the sub-throttle position SENSOR sensor resistance is within the specified 1. -
Page 435
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS Air induction system solenoid Pocket tester resistance 90890-03112 18–22 Ω at 20°C (68°F) Analog pocket tester YU-03112-C ▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the Air induction system solenoid • Positive tester probe coupler from the wire harness. Pink “1” b. Connect the pocket tester (Ω × 1) to the Air •… -
Page 436
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS EAS28420 CHECKING THE INTAKE AIR TEMPERA- TURE SENSOR 1. Remove: • Intake air temperature sensor (from the air filter case.) EWA14110 WARNING b. Set the main switch to “ON”. • Handle the intake air temperature sensor c. Rotate the crankshaft. with special care. -
Page 437
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 8-113… -
Page 438
TROUBLESHOOTING TROUBLESHOOTING ……………… 9-1 GENERAL INFORMATION…………..9-1 STARTING FAILURES…………….9-1 INCORRECT ENGINE IDLING SPEED ……….9-1 POOR MEDIUM-AND-HIGH-SPEED PERFORMANCE ……9-2 FAULTY GEAR SHIFTING …………..9-2 SHIFT PEDAL DOES NOT MOVE…………9-2 JUMPS OUT OF GEAR…………….9-2 FAULTY CLUTCH ………………. 9-2 OVERHEATING ………………9-2 OVERCOOLING ………………9-3 POOR BRAKING PERFORMANCE …………9-3 FAULTY FRONT FORK LEGS …………..9-3… -
Page 439: Fuel System
TROUBLESHOOTING EAS28450 • Sucked-in air TROUBLESHOOTING Electrical system EAS28460 1. Battery GENERAL INFORMATION • Discharged battery NOTE: • Faulty battery The following guide for troubleshooting does 2. Fuse(s) not cover all the possible causes of trouble. It • Blown, damaged or incorrect fuse should be helpful, however, as a guide to basic •…
-
Page 440: Troubleshooting
TROUBLESHOOTING • Improper throttle cable free play • Improperly assembled transmission • Flooded throttle body EAS28550 • Faulty air induction system JUMPS OUT OF GEAR Electrical system Shift shaft 1. Battery • Incorrect shift pedal position • Discharged battery • Improperly returned stopper lever •…
-
Page 441
TROUBLESHOOTING 2. Engine oil • Faulty brake caliper seal • Incorrect oil level • Loose union bolt • Incorrect oil viscosity • Damaged brake hose • Inferior oil quality • Oil or grease on the brake disc • Oil or grease on the brake pad Cooling system •… -
Page 442
TROUBLESHOOTING • Uneven tire pressures (front and rear) • Improperly grounded circuit • Incorrect tire pressure • Faulty battery • Uneven tire wear • Blown, damaged or incorrect fuse 7. Wheel(s) Turn signal blinks slowly • Incorrect wheel balance • Faulty turn signal relay •… -
Page 443
55. Front brake light switch Br/W Brown/White WIRING DIAGRAM 56. Engine stop switch Br/Y Brown/Yellow 57. Start switch FZ1-N (V) 2006 Green/Black 58. Rear brake light switch 1. Main switch Green/Red 59. Left handlebar switch 2. Rectifier/regulator Green/White 60. Clutch switch 3. -
Page 444
FZ1-S (V) 2006 58. Rear brake light switch Green/Black 59. Left handlebar switch 1. Main switch Green/Red 60. Clutch switch 2. Rectifier/regulator Green/White 61. Pass switch 3. A.C.magneto Green/Yellow 62. Dimmer switch 4. Fuse (backup) Gy/G Gray/Green 63. Hazard switch 5. -
Page 445
YAMAHA MOTOR CO., LTD. 2500 SHINGAI IWATA SHIZUOKA JAPAN… -
Page 446
FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES WIRING DIAGRAM SCHEMA DE CABLAGE SCHALTPLAN SCHEMA ELETTRICO DE FZ1-N (V) 2006… -
Page 447
FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES WIRING DIAGRAM SCHEMA DE CABLAGE SCHALTPLAN SCHEMA ELETTRICO DE FZ1-S (V) 2006… -
Page 448
FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES WIRING DIAGRAM SCHEMA DE CABLAGE SCHALTPLAN SCHEMA ELETTRICO DE FZ1-N (V) 2006 HEADLIGHT WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS FREE… -
Page 449
FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES WIRING DIAGRAM SCHEMA DE CABLAGE SCHALTPLAN SCHEMA ELETTRICO DE FZ1-S (V) 2006 HEADLIGHT WIRE HARNESS WIRE HARNESS HEADLIGHT SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2… -
Page 450
FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 FZ1-N (V) 2006 DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES WIRING DIAGRAM SCHEMA DE CABLAGE SCHALTPLAN SCHEMA ELETTRICO DE FZ1-N (V) 2006… -
Page 451
FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 FZ1-S (V) 2006 DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES WIRING DIAGRAM SCHEMA DE CABLAGE SCHALTPLAN SCHEMA ELETTRICO DE FZ1-S (V) 2006 HEADLIGHT WIRE HARNESS WIRE HARNESS HEADLIGHT SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2…
FZ1-N(V)
FZ1-S(V)
2006
SERVICE MANUAL
2D1-28197-E0
EAS20040
FZ1-N (V)/FZ1-S (V)
SERVICE MANUAL
©2005 by Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
First edition, December 2005
All rights reserved.
Any reproduction or unauthorized use without the written permission of Yamaha Motor Co.,
Ltd. is expressly prohibited.
EAS20070
NOTICE
This manual was produced by the Yamaha Motor Company, Ltd. primarily for use by Yamaha dealers and their qualified mechanics. It is not possible to include all the knowledge of a mechanic in one manual. Therefore, anyone who uses this book to perform maintenance and repairs on Yamaha vehicles should have a basic understanding of mechanics and the techniques to repair these types of vehicles. Repair and maintenance work attempted by anyone without this knowledge is likely to render the vehicle unsafe and unfit for use.
This model has been designed and manufactured to perform within certain specifications in regard to performance and emissions. Proper service with the correct tools is necessary to ensure that the vehicle will operate as designed. If there is any question about a service procedure, it is imperative that you contact a Yamaha dealer for any service information changes that apply to this model. This policy is intended to provide the customer with the most satisfaction from his vehicle and to conform to federal environmental quality objectives.
Yamaha Motor Company, Ltd. is continually striving to improve all of its models. Modifications and significant changes in specifications or procedures will be forwarded to all authorized Yamaha dealers and will appear in future editions of this manual where applicable.
NOTE:
• This Service Manual contains information regarding periodic maintenance to the emission control system. Please read this material carefully.
• Designs and specifications are subject to change without notice.
EAS20080
IMPORTANT MANUAL INFORMATION
Particularly important information is distinguished in this manual by the following.
The Safety Alert Symbol means ATTENTION! BECOME ALERT! YOUR
SAFETY IS INVOLVED!
WARNING
CAUTION:
NOTE:
Failure to follow WARNING instructions could result in severe injury or death to the vehicle operator, a bystander or a person checking or repairing the vehicle.
A CAUTION indicates special precautions that must be taken to avoid damage to the vehicle.
A NOTE provides key information to make procedures easier or clearer.
EAS20090
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
This manual is intended as a handy, easy-to-read reference book for the mechanic. Comprehensive explanations of all installation, removal, disassembly, assembly, repair and check procedures are laid out with the individual steps in sequential order.
• The manual is divided into chapters and each chapter is divided into sections. The current section title is shown at the top of each page “1”.
• Sub-section titles appear in smaller print than the section title “2”.
• To help identify parts and clarify procedure steps, there are exploded diagrams at the start of each removal and disassembly section “3”.
• Numbers are given in the order of the jobs in the exploded diagram. A number indicates a disassembly step “4”.
• Symbols indicate parts to be lubricated or replaced “5”.
Refer to “SYMBOLS”.
• A job instruction chart accompanies the exploded diagram, providing the order of jobs, names of parts, notes in jobs, etc “6”.
• Jobs requiring more information (such as special tools and technical data) are described sequentially “7”.
EAS20100
SYMBOLS
The following symbols are used in this manual for easier understanding.
NOTE:
The following symbols are not relevant to every vehicle.
1 2 3
16.Replace the part
4
7
5
8
.
T
R
.
6
9
12
15
E
B
10
G
13
LS
11
M
14
M
16
LT
New
1. Serviceable with engine mounted
2. Filling fluid
3. Lubricant
4. Special tool
5. Tightening torque
6. Wear limit, clearance
7. Engine speed
8. Electrical data
9. Engine oil
10.Gear oil
11.Molybdenum-disulfide oil
12.Wheel-bearing grease
13.Lithium-soap-based grease
14.Molybdenum-disulfide grease
15.Apply locking agent (LOCTITE®)
EAS20110
TABLE OF CONTENTS
GENERAL INFORMATION
SPECIFICATIONS
1
2
PERIODIC CHECKS AND ADJUSTMENTS
3
CHASSIS
ENGINE
COOLING SYSTEM
FUEL SYSTEM
6
7
4
5
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
TROUBLESHOOTING
8
9
GENERAL INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION
……………………………………………………………………………… 1-1
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER…………………………………………… 1-1
MODEL LABEL…………………………………………………………………………… 1-1
FEATURES
……………………………………………………………………………………… 1-2
FI SYSTEM
……………………………………………………………………………………… 1-3
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS
………………………………………………………………. 1-4
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
…………………………………………………………….. 1-8
PREPARATION FOR REMOVAL AND DISASSEMBLY…………………….. 1-8
REPLACEMENT PARTS ……………………………………………………………… 1-8
GASKETS, OIL SEALS AND O-RINGS………………………………………….. 1-8
LOCK WASHERS/PLATES AND COTTER PINS …………………………….. 1-8
BEARINGS AND OIL SEALS ……………………………………………………….. 1-9
CIRCLIPS ………………………………………………………………………………….. 1-9
CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS
……………………………………………………. 1-10
SPECIAL TOOLS
…………………………………………………………………………… 1-11
1
EAS20130
IDENTIFICATION
EAS20140
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number “1” is stamped into the right side of the steering head pipe.
EAS20150
MODEL LABEL
The model label “1” is affixed to the frame. This information will be needed to order spare parts.
IDENTIFICATION
1-1
FEATURES
EAS20170
FEATURES
OUTLINE OF THE FI SYSTEM
The main function of a fuel supply system is to provide fuel to the combustion chamber at the optimum air-fuel ratio in accordance with the engine operating conditions and the atmospheric temperature. In the conventional carburetor system, the air-fuel ratio of the mixture that is supplied to the combustion chamber is created by the volume of the intake air and the fuel that is metered by the jet used in the respective carburetor.
Despite the same volume of intake air, the fuel volume requirement varies by the engine operating conditions, such as acceleration, deceleration, or operating under a heavy load. Carburetors that meter the fuel through the use of jets have been provided with various auxiliary devices, so that an optimum air-fuel ratio can be achieved to accommodate the constant changes in the operating conditions of the engine.
As the requirements for the engine to deliver more performance and cleaner exhaust gases increase, it becomes necessary to control the air-fuel ratio in a more precise and finely tuned manner. To accommodate this need, this model has adopted an electronically controlled fuel injection
(FI) system, in place of the conventional carburetor system. This system can achieve an optimum air-fuel ratio required by the engine at all times by using a microprocessor that regulates the fuel injection volume according to the engine operating conditions detected by various sensors.
The adoption of the FI system has resulted in a highly precise fuel supply, improved engine response, better fuel economy, and reduced exhaust emissions.
1. Ignition coil
2. Air filter case
3. Intake air temperature sensor
4. Fuel delivery hose
5. Fuel tank
6. Fuel pump
7. Intake air pressure sensor
8. Throttle position sensor
9. Sub-throttle position sensor
10.Fuel injector
11.Catalytic converter
12.Crankshaft position sensor
13.Coolant temperature sensor
1-2
14.Spark plug
15.Cylinder identification sensor
16.Battery
17.ECU
18.Atomospheric pressure sensor
19.Relay unit (fuel pump relay)
20.Engine trouble warning light
21.Lean angle sensor
22.Air cut-off valve
23.O
2
sensor
FI SYSTEM
ET2D1001
FI SYSTEM
The fuel pump delivers fuel to the fuel injector via the fuel filter. The pressure regulator maintains the fuel pressure that is applied to the fuel injector at only 324 kPa (3.24 kg/cm
2
, 46.1 psi). Accordingly, when the energizing signal from the ECU energizes the fuel injector, the fuel passage opens, causing the fuel to be injected into the intake manifold only during the time the passage remain open.
Therefore, the longer the length of time the fuel injector is energized (injection duration), the greater the volume of fuel that is supplied. Conversely, the shorter the length of time the fuel injector is energized (injection duration), the lesser the volume of fuel that is supplied.
The injection duration and the injection timing are controlled by the ECU. Signals that are input from the throttle position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, intake air pressure sensor, air temperature sensor, coolant temperature sensor, speed sensor and O
2
sensor enable the ECU to determine the injection duration. The injection timing is determined through the signals from the crankshaft position sensor. As a result, the volume of fuel that is required by the engine can be supplied at all times in accordance with the driving conditions.
Illustration is for reference only.
1. Fuel pump
2. Fuel injector
3. Ignition coil
4. ECU (engine control unit)
5. Intake air temperature sensor
6. Throttle position sensor
7. Sub-throttle position sensor
8. O
2
sensor
9. Catalytic converter
10.Coolant temperature sensor
11.Crankshaft position sensor
12.Intake air pressure sensor
1-3
13.Throttle body
14.Air filter case
A. Fuel system
B. Air system
C. Control system
ET2D1002
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS
Multi-function meter unit
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS
kilometers and miles, press the “SELECT” button for at least one second.
Tachometer
1. Coolant temperature display/air intake temperature display
2. Speedometer
3. Tachometer
4. Odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter
5. “SELECT” button
6. “RESET” button
7. Clock
8. Fuel meter
EW2D1005
WARNING
Be sure to stop the vehicle before making any setting changes to the multi-function meter unit.
The multi-function meter unit is equipped with the following:
• a speedometer (which shows the riding speed)
• a tachometer (which shows engine speed)
• an odometer (which shows the total distance traveled)
• two tripmeters (which show the distance traveled since they were last set to zero)
• a fuel reserve tripmeter (which shows the distance traveled since the left segment of the fuel meter started flashing)
• a clock
• a fuel meter
• a coolant temperature display
• an air intake temperature display
• a self-diagnosis device
• an LCD and tachometer brightness control mode
NOTE:
• Be sure to turn the key to “ON” before using the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons.
• For the U.K. only: To switch the speedometer and odometer/tripmeter displays between
1. Tachometer
2. Tachometer red zone
The electric tachometer allows the rider to monitor the engine speed and keep it within the ideal power range.
When the key is turned to “ON”, the tachometer needle will sweep once across the r/min range and then return to zero r/min in order to test the electrical circuit.
EC2D1007
CAUTION:
Do not operate the engine in the tachometer red zone.
Red zone: 12000 r/min and above
Clock mode
1. Clock
2. Speedometer
The clock is displayed when the key is turned to “ON”. In addition, the clock can be displayed for 10 seconds by pushing the “SELECT” button when the main switch is in the “OFF” or
“LOCK” position.
To set the clock
1. Turn the key to “ON”.
2. Push the “SELECT” button and “RESET” button together for at least two seconds.
1-4
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS
3. When the hour digits start flashing, push the “RESET” button to set the hours.
4. Push the “SELECT” button, and the minute digits will start flashing.
5. Push the “RESET” button to set the minutes.
6. Push the “SELECT” button and then release it to start the clock.
Odometer and tripmeter modes
1. Odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter
Push the “SELECT” button to switch the display between the odometer mode “ODO” and the tripmeter modes “TRIP A” and “TRIP B” in the following order:
TRIP A
→
TRIP B
→
ODO
→
TRIP A
When the fuel amount in the fuel tank decreases to 3.4 L (0.90 US gal) (0.75
Imp.gal), the left segment of the fuel meter will start flashing, and the odometer display will automatically change to the fuel reserve tripmeter mode “FTRIP” and start counting the distance traveled from that point. In that case, push the “SELECT” button to switch the display between the various tripmeter and odometer modes in the following order:
F-TRIP
→
TRIP A
→
TRIP B
→
ODO
→
F-
TRIP
To reset a tripmeter, select it by pushing the
“SELECT” button, and then push the “RESET” button for at least one second. If you do not reset the fuel reserve tripmeter manually, it will reset itself automatically and the display will return to the prior mode after refueling and traveling 5 km (3 mi).
Fuel meter
1. Fuel meter
The fuel meter indicates the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The display segments of the fuel meter disappear towards “E” (Empty) as the fuel level decreases. When only one segment is left near “E”, refuel as soon as possible.
NOTE:
This fuel meter is equipped with a self-diagnosis system. If the electrical circuit is defective, the following cycle will be repeated until the malfunction is corrected: “E” (Empty), “F” (Full) and symbol “ ” will flash eight times, then go off for approximately 3 seconds. If this occurs, have a Yamaha dealer check the electrical circuit.
Coolant temperature mode
1. Coolant temperature display
The coolant temperature display indicates the temperature of the coolant.
Push the “RESET” button to switch the coolant temperature display to the air intake temperature display.
NOTE:
When the coolant temperature display is selected, “C” is displayed for one second, and then the coolant temperature is displayed.
EC2D1011
CAUTION:
Do not operate the engine if it is overheated.
1-5
Air intake temperature mode
1. Air intake temperature display
The air intake temperature display indicates the temperature of the air drawn into the air filter case. Push the “RESET” button to switch the coolant temperature display to the air intake temperature display.
NOTE:
• Even if the air intake temperature is set to be displayed, the coolant temperature warning light comes on when the engine overheats.
• When the key is turned to “ON”, the coolant temperature is automatically displayed, even if the air intake temperature was displayed prior to turning the key to “OFF”.
• When the air intake temperature display is selected, “A” is displayed for one second, and then the air intake temperature is displayed.
Self-diagnosis device
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS
light will flash, and then the display will indicate a two-digit error code (e.g., 51, 52, 53).
NOTE:
If the display indicates error code 52, this could be caused by transponder interference. If this error code appears, try the following.
1. Use the code re-registering key to start the engine.
NOTE:
Make sure there are no other immobilizer keys close to the main switch, and do not keep more than one immobilizer key on the same key ring!
Immobilizer system keys may cause signal interference, which may prevent the engine from starting
2. If the engine starts, turn it off and try starting the engine with the standard keys.
3. If one or both of the standard keys do not start the engine, take the vehicle, the code re-registering key and both standard keys to a Yamaha dealer and have the standard keys re-registered.
If the display indicates any error codes, note the code number, and then have a Yamaha dealer check the vehicle.
EC2D1012
CAUTION:
If the display indicates an error code, the vehicle should be checked as soon as possible in order to avoid engine damage.
LCD and tachometer brightness control mode
1. Error code display
This model is equipped with a self-diagnosis device for various electrical circuits.
If any of those circuits are defective, the engine trouble warning light will come on, and then the display will indicate a two-digit error code (e.g.,
11, 12, 13).
This model is also equipped with a self-diagnosis device for the immobilizer system.
If any of the immobilizer system circuits are defective, the immobilizer system indicator
1-6
1. Tachometer panel
2. Tachometer needle
3. LCD
4. Brightness level
This function allows you to adjust the brightness of the LCD and the tachometer panel and needle to suit the outside lighting conditions.
To set the brightness
1. Turn the key to “OFF”.
2. Push and hold the “SELECT” button.
3. Turn the key to “ON”, and then release the
“SELECT” button after five seconds.
4. Push the “RESET” button to select the desired brightness level.
5. Push the “SELECT” button to confirm the selected brightness level. The display will return to the odometer or tripmeter mode.
INSTRUMENT FUNCTIONS
1-7
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
EAS20180
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
EAS20190
PREPARATION FOR REMOVAL AND DISAS-
SEMBLY
1. Before removal and disassembly, remove all dirt, mud, dust and foreign material.
2. Use only the proper tools and cleaning equipment.
Refer to «SPECIAL TOOLS» on page 1-11.
3. When disassembling, always keep mated parts together. This includes gears, cylinders, pistons and other parts that have been “mated” through normal wear. Mated parts must always be reused or replaced as an assembly.
EAS20210
GASKETS, OIL SEALS AND O-RINGS
1. When overhauling the engine, replace all gaskets, seals and O-rings. All gasket surfaces, oil seal lips and O-rings must be cleaned.
2. During reassembly, properly oil all mating parts and bearings and lubricate the oil seal lips with grease.
4. During disassembly, clean all of the parts and place them in trays in the order of disassembly. This will speed up assembly and allow for the correct installation of all parts.
5. Keep all parts away from any source of fire.
EAS20200
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Use only genuine Yamaha parts for all replacements. Use oil and grease recommended by
Yamaha for all lubrication jobs. Other brands may be similar in function and appearance, but inferior in quality.
1. Oil
2. Lip
3. Spring
4. Grease
EAS20220
LOCK WASHERS/PLATES AND COTTER
PINS
After removal, replace all lock washers/plates
“1” and cotter pins. After the bolt or nut has been tightened to specification, bend the lock tabs along a flat of the bolt or nut.
1-8
EAS20230
BEARINGS AND OIL SEALS
Install bearings “1” and oil seals “2” so that the manufacturer’s marks or numbers are visible.
When installing oil seals, lubricate the oil seal lips with a light coat of lithium-soap-based grease. Oil bearings liberally when installing, if appropriate.
ECA13300
CAUTION:
Do not spin the bearing with compressed air because this will damage the bearing surfaces.
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
EAS20240
CIRCLIPS
Before reassembly, check all circlips carefully and replace damaged or distorted circlips.
Always replace piston pin clips after one use.
When installing a circlip “1”, make sure the sharp-edged corner “2” is positioned opposite the thrust “3” that the circlip receives.
1-9
EAS20250
CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS
Check the leads, couplers, and connectors for stains, rust, moisture, etc.
1. Disconnect:
• Lead
• Coupler
• Connector
2. Check:
• Lead
• Coupler
• Connector
Moisture
→
Dry with an air blower.
Rust/stains
→
Connect and disconnect several times.
CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog Pocket tester
YU-03112-C
NOTE:
• If there is no continuity, clean the terminals.
• When checking the wire harness, perform steps (1) to (3).
• As a quick remedy, use a contact revitalizer available at most part stores.
3. Check:
• All connections
Loose connection
→
Connect properly.
NOTE:
If the pin “1” on the terminal is flattened, bend it up.
4. Connect:
• Lead
• Coupler
• Connector
NOTE:
Make sure all connections are tight.
5. Check:
• Continuity
(with the pocket tester)
1-10
SPECIAL TOOLS
EAS20260
SPECIAL TOOLS
The following special tools are necessary for complete and accurate tune-up and assembly. Use only the appropriate special tools as this will help prevent damage caused by the use of inappropriate tools or improvised techniques. Special tools, part numbers or both may differ depending on the country.
When placing an order, refer to the list provided below to avoid any mistakes.
NOTE:
• For U.S.A. and Canada, use part number starting with “YM-”, “YU-”, or “ACC-”.
• For others, use part number starting with “90890-”.
Tool name/Tool No.
Piston pin puller set
90890-01304
Piston pin puller
YU-01304
Illustration
Reference pages
5-71
Radiator cap tester
90890-01325
Radiator pressure tester
YU-24460-01
6-3
Radiator cap tester adapter
90890-01352
Radiator pressure tester adapter
YU-33984
Steering nut wrench
90890-01403
Spanner wrench
YU-33975
Ring nut wrench
90890-01268
Spanner wrench
YU-01268
Damper rod holder
90890-01423
Damping rod holder
YM-01423
6-3
3-27, 4-59
4-59
4-51, 4-52
1-11
Tool name/Tool No.
Oil filter wrench
90890-01426
YU-38411
Rod holder
90890-01434
Damper rod holder double ended
YM-01434
Rod puller
90890-01437
Universal damping rod bleeding tool set
YM-A8703
Rod puller attachment (M10)
90890-01436
Universal damping rod bleeding tool set
YM-A8703
Fork spring compressor
90890-01441
YM-01441
Fork seal driver
90890-01442
Adjust table fork seal driver (36-46 mm)
YM-01442
Vacuum gauge
90890-03094
Carburetor synchronizer
YU-44456
Illustration
SPECIAL TOOLS
Reference pages
3-13
4-53
3-7
4-50, 4-55
4-54
4-54
4-50, 4-55
1-12
Tool name/Tool No.
Compression gauge
90890-03081
Engine compression tester
YU-33223
Valve spring compressor
90890-04019
YM-04019
Valve spring compressor attachment
90890-04108
Valve spring compressor adapter (22 mm)
YM-04108
Valve spring compressor attachment
90890-04114
Valve spring compressor adapter
YM-04114
Middle driven shaft bearing driver
90890-04058
Bearing driver (40 mm)
YM-04058
Mechanical seal installer
90890-04078
Water pump seal installer
YM-33221-A
Universal clutch holder
90890-04086
YM-91042
Illustration
SPECIAL TOOLS
Reference pages
3-11
5-23, 5-29
5-23, 5-29
5-23, 5-29
6-12
6-12
5-47, 5-51
1-13
Tool name/Tool No.
Valve guide remover (ø4)
90890-04111
Valve guide remover (4.0 mm)
YM-04111
Valve guide remover (ø4.5)
90890-04116
Valve guide remover (4.5 mm)
YM-04116
Valve guide installer (ø4)
90890-04112
Valve guide installer (4.0 mm)
YM-04112
Valve guide installer (ø4.5)
90890-04117
Valve guide installer (4.5 mm)
YM-04117
Valve guide reamer (ø4)
90890-04113
Valve guide reamer (4.0 mm)
YM-04113
Valve guide reamer (ø4.5)
90890-04118
Valve guide reamer (4.5 mm)
YM-04118
Ignition checker
90890-06754
Opama pet-4000 spark checker
YU-34487
Illustration
SPECIAL TOOLS
Reference pages
5-25
5-25
5-25
5-25
5-25
5-25
8-104
1-14
Tool name/Tool No.
Yamaha bond No.1215
(Three Bond No.1215®)
90890-85505
Digital circuit tester
90890-03174
Model 88 Multimeter with tachometer
YU-A1927
Pivot shaft wrench
90890-01518
Frame spanner socket
YM-01518
Pivot shaft wrench adapter
90890-01476
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
Oil pressure gauge
90890-03153
Pressure gauge
YU-03153
Oil pressure gauge adapter
90890-03139
Illustration
SPECIAL TOOLS
Reference pages
5-67, 6-12
7-9, 7-10
5-7
5-7
1-10, 5-41, 8-
95, 8-96, 8-97,
8-100, 8-102, 8-
103, 8-104, 8-
105, 8-106, 8-
107, 8-108, 8-
109, 8-110, 8-
111, 8-112
3-14
3-14
1-15
Tool name/Tool No.
Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set
90890-06756
Valve lapper
90890-04101
Valve lapping tool
YM-A8998
Fuel pressure adapter
90890-03176
YM-03176
Pressure gauge
90890-03153
YU-03153
Camshaft wrench
90890-04143
YM-04143
Illustration
SPECIAL TOOLS
7-8
Reference pages
3-5
7-8
3-14, 7-8
5-11, 5-16
1-16
1-17
SPECIAL TOOLS
SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
……………………………………………………………. 2-1
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
……………………………………………………………….. 2-1
CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS
…………………………………………………………….. 2-8
ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
……………………………………………………… 2-10
TIGHTENING TORQUES
…………………………………………………………………. 2-12
GENERAL TIGHTENING TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS………………….. 2-12
ENGINE TIGHTENING TORQUES ……………………………………………… 2-13
CHASSIS TIGHTENING TORQUES ……………………………………………. 2-17
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES
……………………………. 2-20
ENGINE …………………………………………………………………………………… 2-20
CHASSIS …………………………………………………………………………………. 2-22
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
…………………………… 2-23
ENGINE OIL LUBRICATION CHART …………………………………………… 2-23
LUBRICATION DIAGRAMS ………………………………………………………… 2-25
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
……………………………………………………… 2-35
CABLE ROUTING
………………………………………………………………………….. 2-39
2
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
EAS20280
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Model
Model 2D11 (EUR)
2D13 (AUS)
3C31 (EUR)
3C33 (AUS)
3C37 (EUR)
3C39 (AUS)
Dimensions
Overall length
Overall width
Overall height
Seat height
Wheelbase
Ground clearance
Minimum turning radius
Weight
With oil and fuel
Maximum load
EAS20290
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
Engine
Engine type
Displacement
Cylinder arrangement
Bore
×
stroke
Compression ratio
Standard compression pressure (at sea level)
Starting system
Fuel
Recommended fuel
Fuel tank capacity
Fuel reserve amount
Engine oil
Lubrication system
Type
Recommended engine oil grade
Engine oil quantity
Total amount
Without oil filter cartridge replacement
With oil filter cartridge replacement
Oil filter
Oil filter type
Oil pump
Oil pump type
2-1
2140 mm (84.3 in)
770 mm (30.3 in)
1060 mm (41.7 in) (FZ1-N)
1205 mm (47.4 in) (FZ1-S)
815 mm (32.1 in)
1460 mm (57.5 in)
135 mm (5.31 in)
3000 mm (118.1 in)
214.0 kg (472 lb) (FZ1-N)
220.0 kg (485 lb) (FZ1-S)
196 kg (432 lb) (FZ1-N)
190 kg (419 lb) (FZ1-S)
Liquid cooled 4-stroke, DOHC
998.0 cm³ (60.90 cu.in)
Forward-inclined parallel 4-cylinder
77.0
×
53.6 mm (3.03
×
2.11 in)
11.50 : 1
1480 kPa/350 r/min (210.5 psi/350 r/min) (14.8 kgf/cm²/350 r/min)
Electric starter
Regular unleaded gasoline only
18.0 L (4.76 US gal) (3.96 Imp.gal)
3.4 L (0.90 US gal) (0.75 Imp.gal)
Wet sump
SAE10W30 or SAE10W40 or SAE15W40 or
SAE20W40 or SAE20W50
API service SE, SF, SG type or higher
3.80 L (4.02 US qt) (3.34 Imp.qt)
2.90 L (3.07 US qt) (2.55 Imp.qt)
3.10 L (3.28 US qt) (2.73 Imp.qt)
Paper
Trochoid
Inner-rotor-to-outer-rotor-tip clearance
Limit
Outer-rotor-to-oil-pump-housing clearance
Limit
Oil-pump-housing-to-inner-and-outer-rotor clearance
Limit
Bypass valve opening pressure
Relief valve operating pressure
Cooling system
Radiator capacity (including all routes)
Coolant reservoir capacity (up to the maximum level mark)
Radiator cap opening pressure
Radiator core
Width
Height
Depth
Water pump
Water pump type
Reduction ratio
Max impeller shaft tilt limit
Spark plug (s)
Manufacturer/model
Spark plug gap
Cylinder head
Volume
Warpage limit*
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
0.010–0.100 mm (0.0004–0.0039 in)
0.18 mm (0.0071 in)
0.090–0.150 mm (0.0035–0.0059 in)
0.22 mm (0.0087 in)
0.06–0.13 mm (0.0024–0.0051 in)
0.20 mm (0.0079 in)
80.0–120.0 kPa (11.6–17.4 psi) (0.80–1.20 kgf/cm²)
600.0–680.0 kPa (87.0–98.6 psi) (6.00–6.80 kgf/cm²)
2.25 L (2.38 US qt) (1.98 Imp.qt)
0.25 L (0.26 US qt) (0.22 Imp.qt)
93.3–122.7 kPa (13.5–17.8 psi) (0.93–1.23 kgf/cm²)
222.6 mm (8.76 in)
360.0 mm (14.17 in)
22.0 mm (0.87 in)
Single suction centrifugal pump
65/43
×
25/32 (1.181)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in)
NGK/CR9EK
0.6–0.7 mm (0.024–0.028 in)
12.20–13.00 cm³ (0.74–0.79 cu.in)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in)
Camshaft
Drive system
Camshaft cap inside diameter
Camshaft journal diameter
Camshaft-journal-to-camshaft-cap clearance
Camshaft lobe dimensions
Intake A
Limit
Intake B
Limit
Exhaust A
Limit
Exhaust B
Limit
Chain drive (right)
22.500–22.521 mm (0.8858–0.8867 in)
22.459–22.472 mm (0.8842–0.8847 in)
0.028–0.062 mm (0.0011–0.0024 in)
32.500–32.600 mm (1.2795–1.2835 in)
32.400 mm (1.2756 in)
24.950–25.050 mm (0.9823–0.9862 in)
24.850 mm (0.9783 in)
30.699–30.799 mm (1.2086–1.2126 in)
30.599 mm (1.2047 in)
22.950–23.050 mm (0.9035–0.9075 in)
22.850 mm (0.8996 in)
2-2
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
Camshaft runout limit
Timing chain
Model/number of links
Tensioning system
Valve, valve seat, valve guide
Valve clearance (cold)
Intake
Exhaust
Valve dimensions
Valve head diameter A (intake)
Valve head diameter A (exhaust)
Valve face width B (intake)
Valve face width B (exhaust)
Valve seat width C (intake)
Valve seat width C (exhaust)
0.030 mm (0.0012 in)
RH2020/122
Automatic
0.11–0.20 mm (0.0043–0.0079 in)
0.21–0.25 mm (0.0083–0.0098 in)
23.40–23.60 mm (0.9213–0.9291 in)
24.90–25.10 mm (0.9803–0.9882 in)
1.760–2.900 mm (0.0693–0.1142 in)
1.760–2.900 mm (0.0693–0.1142 in)
0.90–1.10 mm (0.0354–0.0433 in)
0.90–1.10 mm (0.0354–0.0433 in)
Valve margin thickness D (intake)
Valve margin thickness D (exhaust)
0.50–0.90 mm (0.0197–0.0354 in)
0.50–0.90 mm (0.0197–0.0354 in)
Valve stem diameter (intake)
Limit
Valve stem diameter (exhaust)
2-3
3.975–3.990 mm (0.1565–0.1571 in)
3.945 mm (0.1553 in)
4.460–4.475 mm (0.1756–0.1762 in)
Limit
Valve guide inside diameter (intake)
Limit
Valve guide inside diameter (exhaust)
Limit
Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance (intake)
Limit
Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance (exhaust)
Limit
Valve stem runout
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
4.425 mm (0.1742 in)
4.000–4.012 mm (0.1575–0.1580 in)
4.050 mm (0.1594 in)
4.500–4.512 mm (0.1772–0.1776 in)
4.550 mm (0.1791 in)
0.010–0.037 mm (0.0004–0.0015 in)
0.080 mm (0.0032 in)
0.025–0.052 mm (0.0010–0.0020 in)
0.100 mm (0.0039 in)
0.010 mm (0.0004 in)
Cylinder head valve seat width (intake)
Cylinder head valve seat width (exhaust)
Valve spring
Inner spring
Free length (intake)
Free length (exhaust)
Installed length (intake)
Installed length (exhaust)
Spring rate K1 (intake)
Spring rate K2 (intake)
Spring rate K1 (exhaust)
Spring rate K2 (exhaust)
Installed compression spring force (intake)
Installed compression spring force (exhaust)
Spring tilt (intake)*
Spring tilt (exhaust)*
0.90–1.10 mm (0.0354–0.0433 in)
0.90–1.10 mm (0.0354–0.0433 in)
40.47 mm (1.59 in)
40.53 mm (1.60 in)
32.66 mm (1.29 in)
33.88 mm (1.33 in)
17.53 N/mm (100.10 lb/in) (1.79 kgf/mm)
22.86 N/mm (130.53 lb/in) (2.33 kgf/mm)
21.52 N/mm (122.88 lb/in) (2.19 kgf/mm)
27.99 N/mm (159.82 lb/in) (2.85 kgf/mm)
127.40–144.60 N (28.64–32.51 lb) (12.99–
14.74 kgf)
133.00–153.00 N (29.90–34.39 lb) (13.56–
15.60 kgf)
2.5
°
/1.8 mm
2.5
°
/1.8 mm
Winding direction (intake)
Winding direction (exhaust)
Cylinder
Bore
Taper limit
Out of round limit
Piston
Piston-to-cylinder clearance
Limit
Diameter D
Height H
2-4
Clockwise
Clockwise
77.000–77.010 mm (3.0315–3.0319 in)
0.050 mm (0.0020 in)
0.050 mm (0.0020 in)
0.010–0.035 mm (0.0004–0.0014 in)
0.12 mm (0.0047 in)
76.975–76.990 mm (3.0305–3.0311 in)
5.0 mm (0.20 in)
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
Offset
Offset direction
Piston pin bore inside diameter
Piston pin outside diameter
Piston ring
Top ring
Ring type
Dimensions (B
×
T)
End gap (installed)
Ring side clearance
2nd ring
Ring type
Dimensions (B
×
T)
End gap (installed)
Ring side clearance
Oil ring
Dimensions (B
×
T)
End gap (installed)
Connecting rod
Oil clearance (using plastigauge®)
Bearing color code
Crankshaft
Width A
Width B
Runout limit C
Big end side clearance D
0.50 mm (0.0197 in)
Intake side
17.002–17.013 mm (0.6694–0.6698 in)
16.991–17.000 mm (0.6689–0.6693 in)
Barrel
0.90
×
2.75 mm (0.04
×
0.11 in)
0.15–0.25 mm (0.0059–0.0098 in)
0.030–0.065 mm (0.0012–0.0026 in)
Taper
0.80
×
2.75 mm (0.03
×
0.11 in)
0.30–0.45 mm (0.0118–0.0177 in)
0.020–0.055 mm (0.0008–0.0022 in)
1.50
×
2.25 mm (0.06
×
0.09 in)
0.10–0.40 mm (0.0039–0.0157 in)
0.034–0.058 mm (0.0013–0.0023 in)
1.Blue 2.Black 3.Brown 4.Green
55.20–56.60 mm (2.173–2.228 in)
298.75–300.65 mm (11.76–11.84 in)
0.030 mm (0.0012 in)
0.160–0.262 mm (0.0063–0.0103 in)
2-5
Journal oil clearance (using plastigauge®)
Bearing color code
Clutch
Clutch type
Clutch release method
Clutch lever free play
Friction plate thickness
Wear limit
Plate quantity
Clutch plate thickness
Plate quantity
Warpage limit
Clutch spring free length
Spring quantity
Transmission
Transmission type
Primary reduction system
Primary reduction ratio
Secondary reduction system
Secondary reduction ratio
Operation
Gear ratio
1st
2nd
3rd
4th
5th
6th
Main axle runout limit
Drive axle runout limit
Shifting mechanism
Shift mechanism type
Shift fork guide bar bending limit
Shift fork thickness
Air filter
Air filter element
Fuel pump
Pump type
Model/manufacturer
Maximum consumption amperage
Output pressure
Fuel injection
Model/quantity
Manufacturer
Throttle body
Type/quantity
Manufacturer
ID mark
Throttle valve size
Throttle position sensor
Resistance
Output voltage (at idle)
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
0.014–0.037 mm (0.0006–0.0015 in)
0.White 1.Blue 2.Black 3.Brown 4.Green
Wet, multiple-disc
Outer pull, rack and pinion pull
10.0–15.0 mm (0.39–0.59 in)
2.90–3.10 mm (0.114–0.122 in)
2.80 mm (0.1102 in)
9 pcs
1.90–2.10 mm (0.075–0.083 in)
8 pcs
0.10 mm (0.0039 in)
52.50 mm (2.07 in)
6 pcs
Constant mesh 6-speed
Spur gear
65/43 (1.512)
Chain drive
45/17 (2.647)
Left foot operation
38/15 (2.533)
33/16 (2.063)
37/21 (1.762)
35/23 (1.522)
27/20 (1.350)
29/24 (1.208)
0.08 mm (0.0032 in)
0.08 mm (0.0032 in)
Guide bar
0.100 mm (0.0039 in)
5.80–5.88 mm (0.2283–0.2315 in)
Oil-coated paper element
Electrical
2D1/DENSO
4.3 A
324.0 kPa (47.0 psi) (3.24 kgf/cm²)
297500-0300/4
DENSO
2-6
SE 45EIDW-B10/1
MIKUNI
2D11 00
#100
4.9–5.1 k
Ω
0.63–0.73 V
Idling condition
Engine idling speed
Intake vacuum
Water temperature
Oil temperature
Throttle cable free play
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
1100–1300 r/min
30.0 kPa (8.9 inHg) (225 mmHg)
95.0–105.0
°
C (203.00–221.00
°
F)
80.0–90.0
°
C (176.00–194.00
°
F)
3.0–5.0 mm (0.12–0.20 in)
2-7
CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS
EAS20300
CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS
Chassis
Frame type
Caster angle
Trail
Front wheel
Wheel type
Rim size
Rim material
Wheel travel
Radial wheel runout limit
Lateral wheel runout limit
Rear wheel
Wheel type
Rim size
Rim material
Wheel travel
Radial wheel runout limit
Lateral wheel runout limit
Front tire
Size
Manufacturer/model
Manufacturer/model
Wear limit (front)
Rear tire
Size
Manufacturer/model
Manufacturer/model
Wear limit (rear)
Tire air pressure (measured on cold tires)
Loading condition
Front
Rear
Loading condition
Front
Rear
High-speed riding
Front
Rear
Front brake
Type
Operation
Front brake lever free play
Front disc brake
Disc outside diameter
×
thickness
Brake disc thickness limit
Brake disc deflection limit
Brake pad lining thickness (inner)
Limit
Brake pad lining thickness (outer)
Limit
Diamond
25.00
°
109.0 mm (4.29 in)
Cast wheel
17M/C x MT3.50
Aluminum
130.0 mm (5.12 in)
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
Cast wheel
17M/C x MT6.00
Aluminum
130.0 mm (5.12 in)
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
120/70 ZR17M/C (58W)
MICHELIN/Pilot Road S
DUNLOP/D221FA
0.8 mm (0.03 in)
190/50 ZR17M/C (73W)
MICHELIN/Pilot Road D
DUNLOP/D221G
0.8 mm (0.03 in)
0–90 kg (0–198 lb)
250 kPa (36 psi) (2.50 kgf/cm²) (2.50 bar)
290 kPa (42 psi) (2.90 kgf/cm²) (2.90 bar)
90–196 kg (198–432 lb) (FZ1-N)
90–190 kg (198–419 lb) (FZ1-S)
250 kPa (36 psi) (2.50 kgf/cm²) (2.50 bar)
290 kPa (42 psi) (2.90 kgf/cm²) (2.90 bar)
250 kPa (36 psi) (2.50 kgf/cm²) (2.50 bar)
290 kPa (42 psi) (2.90 kgf/cm²) (2.90 bar)
2-8
Dual disc brake
Right hand operation
2.3–11.5 mm (0.09–0.45 in)
320.0
×
4.5 mm (12.60
×
0.18 in)
4.0 mm (0.16 in)
0.10 mm (0.0039 in)
4.5 mm (0.18 in)
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
4.5 mm (0.18 in)
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
Master cylinder inside diameter
Caliper cylinder inside diameter
Caliper cylinder inside diameter
Recommended fluid
Rear brake
Type
Operation
Brake pedal free play
Rear disc brake
Disc outside diameter
×
thickness
Brake disc thickness limit
Brake disc deflection limit
Brake pad lining thickness (inner)
Limit
Brake pad lining thickness (outer)
Limit
Master cylinder inside diameter
Caliper cylinder inside diameter
Recommended fluid
Steering
Steering bearing type
Lock to lock angle (left)
Lock to lock angle (right)
Front suspension
Type
Spring/shock absorber type
Front fork travel
Fork spring free length
Collar length
Installed length
Spring rate K1
Spring stroke K1
Inner tube outer diameter
Inner tube bending limit
Optional spring available
Recommended oil
Quantity
Level
Rear suspension
Type
Spring/shock absorber type
Rear shock absorber assembly travel
Spring free length
Installed length
Spring rate K1
Spring stroke K1
Optional spring available
Enclosed gas/air pressure (STD)
Drive chain
Type/manufacturer
Link quantity
Drive chain slack
15-link length limit
2-9
CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS
16.00 mm (0.63 in)
30.20 mm (1.19 in)
27.00 mm (1.06 in)
DOT 4
Single disc brake
Right foot operation
4.3–9.3 mm (0.17–0.37 in)
245.0
×
5.0 mm (9.65
×
0.20 in)
4.5 mm (0.18 in)
0.15 mm (0.0059 in)
6.0 mm (0.24 in)
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
6.0 mm (0.24 in)
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
12.7 mm (0.50 in)
38.20 mm (1.50 in)
DOT 4
Angular bearing
33.0
°
33.0
°
Telescopic fork
Coil spring/oil damper
130.0 mm (5.12 in)
243.5 mm (9.59 in)
100.0 mm (3.94 in)
239.0 mm (9.41 in)
9.32 N/mm (53.22 lb/in) (0.95 kgf/mm)
0.0–130.0 mm (0.00–5.12 in)
43.0 mm (1.69 in)
0.2 mm (0.01 in)
No
Suspension oil 01 or equivalent
545.0 cm³ (18.43 US oz) (19.18 Imp.oz)
91.0 mm (3.58 in)
Swingarm (link suspension)
Coil spring/gas-oil damper
60.0 mm (2.36 in)
191.3 mm (7.53 in)
181.8 mm (7.16 in)
120.00 N/mm (685.20 lb/in) (12.24 kgf/mm)
0.0–60.0 mm (0.00–2.36 in)
No
1000 kPa (142.2 psi) (10.0 kgf/cm²)
50VA8/DAIDO
122
25.0–35.0 mm (0.98–1.38 in)
239.3 mm (9.42 in)
ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
EAS20310
ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Voltage
System voltage
Ignition system
Ignition system
Ignition timing (B.T.D.C.)
Engine control unit
Model/manufacturer
Transistorized coil ignition
Crankshaft position sensor resistance
Ignition coil
Model/manufacturer
Minimum ignition spark gap
Primary coil resistance
Secondary coil resistance
AC magneto
Model/manufacturer
Standard output
Stator coil resistance
Voltage regulator
Rectifier/regulator
Regulator type
Model/manufacturer
Regulated voltage (DC)
Rectifier capacity
Withstand voltage
Battery
Model
Voltage, capacity
Specific gravity
Manufacturer
Ten hour rate amperage
Headlight
Bulb type
Bulb voltage, wattage
×
quantity
Headlight
Auxiliary light
Tail/brake light
Front turn signal light
Rear turn signal light
License plate light
Meter lighting
Indicator light
Neutral indicator light
Turn signal indicator light
Oil level warning light
High beam indicator light
12 V
Transistorized coil ignition (digital)
5.0
°
/1200 r/min
TBDF20/DENSO
336–504
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
F6T558/MITSUBISHI
6.0 mm (0.24 in)
1.19–1.61
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
8.5–11.5 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
STATOR:F074T85073/MITSUBISHI
14.0 V40.0 A6500 r/min
0.14–0.18
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
Semi conductor-short circuit
FH012AA/SHINDENGEN
14.2–14.8 V
50.0 A
40.0 V
YTZ14S
12 V, 11.2 Ah
1.310
GYM
1.12 A
Halogen bulb
2-10
LED
LED
LED
LED
12 V, 60 W/55.0 W
×
1 (FZ1-N)
12 V, 60 W/55.0 W
×
2 (FZ1-S)
12 V, 5.0 W
×
2
12 V, 5.0 W/21.0 W
×
1
12 V, 10.0 W
×
2
12 V, 10.0 W
×
2
12 V, 5.0 W
×
1
LED
Coolant temperature warning light
Engine trouble warning light
Immobilizer system indicator light
Electric starting system
System type
Starter motor
Model/manufacturer
Power output
Armature coil resistance
Brush overall length
Limit
Brush spring force
Commutator diameter
Limit
Mica undercut (depth)
Starter relay
Model/manufacturer
Amperage
Coil resistance
Horn
Horn type
Quantity
Model/manufacturer
Maximum amperage
Coil resistance
Performance
Turn signal/hazard relay
Relay type
Model/manufacturer
Built-in, self-canceling device
Turn signal blinking frequency
Wattage
Oil level gauge
Model/manufacturer
Servo motor
Model/manufacturer
Fuses
Main fuse
Headlight fuse
Taillight fuse
Signaling system fuse
Ignition fuse
Radiator fan fuse
Fuel injection system fuse
Backup fuse
Reserve fuse
Reserve fuse
Reserve fuse
ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
LED
LED
LED
Constant mesh
SM13/MITSUBA
0.80 kW
0.0250–0.0350
Ω
12.5 mm (0.49 in)
5.00 mm (0.20 in)
7.65–10.01 N (27.54–36.03 oz) (780–1021 gf)
28.0 mm (1.10 in)
27.0 mm (1.06 in)
0.70 mm (0.03 in)
2768109-A/JIDECO
180.0 A
4.18–4.62
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
Plane
1 pcs
YF-12/NIKKO
3.0 A
1.15–1.25
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
105–113 dB/2m
Full transistor
FE218BH/DENSO
No
75.0–95.0 cycles/min
10 W
×
2.0 +3.4 W
5VY/SOMIC ISHIKAWA
2D1/YAMAHA
50.0 A
15.0 A (FZ1-N)
25.0 A (FZ1-S)
10.0 A
10.0 A
15.0 A
10.0 A
×
2
15.0 A
10.0 A
25.0 A (FZ1-S)
15.0 A
10.0 A
2-11
EAS20320
TIGHTENING TORQUES
EAS20330
GENERAL TIGHTENING TORQUE SPECIFI-
CATIONS
This chart specifies tightening torques for standard fasteners with a standard ISO thread pitch. Tightening torque specifications for special components or assemblies are provided for each chapter of this manual. To avoid warpage, tighten multi-fastener assemblies in a crisscross pattern and progressive stages until the specified tightening torque is reached.
Unless otherwise specified, tightening torque specifications require clean, dry threads. Components should be at room temperature.
TIGHTENING TORQUES
A. Distance between flats
B. Outside thread diameter
A (nut) B (bolt)
10 mm 6 mm
12 mm 8 mm
14 mm 10 mm
17 mm 12 mm
19 mm 14 mm 85
22 mm 16 mm 130
6
15
30
55
General tightening torques
Nm m·kg ft·lb
0.6
1.5
3.0
5.5
8.5
13.0
4.3
11
22
40
61
94
2-12
TIGHTENING TORQUES
EAS20340
ENGINE TIGHTENING TORQUES
Item
Spark plug
Cylinder head nut
Cylinder head bolt
Camshaft caps bolt
Cylinder head cover bolt
Cylinder head stud bolt (exhaust pipe)
Air indication system cap bolt
Camshaft sprocket bolt
Cylinder head and throttle body clamp
Connecting rod cap bolt (1st)
Connecting rod cap bolt (final)
Generator rotor bolt
Timing chain tensioner bolt
Water pump outlet pipe bolt
Water pump inlet pipe bolt (water pump side)
Water pump inlet pipe bolt (front side)
Oil/water pump drive sprocket bolt
Water pump bolt
Thermostat cover nut
Thermostat inlet pipe bolt
Oil cooler bolt
Engine oil drain bolt
Oil pipe bolt
Oil strainer bolt
Oil delivery pipe bolt
Oil filter union bolt
Oil filter
Oil pan bolt
Oil pan bolt
Air filter case cover screw
Throttle body and throttle body joint clamp
Throttle body and funnel bolt
Throttle cable adjusting bolt
Thread size
M10
M10
Q’ty
4
10
M6
M6
M6
M8
2
28
6
8
M6
M7
M5
M8
M8
M10
M6
M6
M6
M6
M6
M6
M6
M6
M20
M14
M6
M6
M6
M20
M20
M6
M6
M5
M5
M5
M6
4
4
4
1
1
3
1
1
1
2
3
14
1
11
4
5
2
1
1
6
1
8
8
1
2
1
1
2-13
Tightening torque
13 Nm (1.3 m·kg, 9.4 ft·lb)
See NOTE
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
3 Nm (0.3 m·kg, 2.2 ft·lb)
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
Specified angle 150
°
60 Nm (6.0 m·kg, 43 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
63 Nm (6.3 m·kg, 46 ft·lb)
43 Nm (4.3 m·kg, 31 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
70 Nm (7.0 m·kg, 51 ft·lb)
17 Nm (1.7 m·kg, 12 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
1.2 Nm (0.12 m·kg, 0.9 ft·lb)
3 Nm (0.3 m·kg, 2.2 ft·lb)
4.2 Nm (0.42 m·kg, 3.0 ft·lb)
4.5 Nm (0.45 m·kg, 3.3 ft·lb)
Remarks
Item
Cylinder head and exhaust pipe nut
Exhaust pipe and muffler bolt
EXUP pulley and shaft arm nut
EXUP valve pulley cover bolt
EXUP cable nut
Exhaust pipe and exhaust pipe bracket bolt
EXUP servo motor cover bolt
EXUP servo motor nut
Crankcase stud bolt
Crankcase bolt (main journal)
Crankcase bolt
Crankcase bolt
Crankcase bolt
Thread size
M8
Q’ty
8
M8
M6
M6
M6
M8
M5
M6
M10
M9
M6
M6
M8
1
1
2
2
2
8
1
2
1
10
10
2
Crankcase bolt
Generator rotor cover bolt
Generator rotor cover bolt
Drive sprocket cover bolt
Crankcase cover screw
Clutch cover bolt
Clutch cover bolt
Pickup rotor cover bolt
Breather cover bolt
Breather plate bolt
Plate bolt
Pickup rotor cover blind bolt
Generator rotor cover plug
Main gallery plug (oil return)
Main gallery plug
Oil return pipe bolt
Oil return plug
AC magneto lead bolt
Stator coil screw
Generator rotor cover screw
Thermostat assembly stay bolt
Starter clutch idler gear bolt
Clutch boss nut
5
1
3
3
2
1
1
6
4
3
2
3
7
1
4
3
3
3
1
1
1
2
2
M8
M6
M6
M6
M6
M6
M20
M6
M6
M6
M6
M6
M8
M6
M6
M6
M6
M8
M20
M16
M20
M6
M12
2-14
TIGHTENING TORQUES
Remarks Tightening torque
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
14 Nm (1.4 m·kg, 10 ft·lb)
6 Nm (0.6 m·kg, 4.3 ft·lb)
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
2 Nm (0.2 m·kg, 1.4 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
See NOTE
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb)
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
14 Nm (1.4 m·kg, 10 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
95 Nm (9.5 m·kg, 69 ft·lb) Stake
TIGHTENING TORQUES
Item
Clutch spring bolt
Drive sprocket nut
Bearing plate bolt
Shift fork stopper plate bolt
Stopper screw
Shift rod locknut (front)
Shift rod locknut (rear)
Shift rod joint bolt M6
Shift arm bolt
Neutral switch
Sub-throttle servo motor cover bolt
Coolant temperature sensor
Cylinder identification sensor bolt
M6
M10
M4
M12
M6
Atmospheric pressure sensor bolt M5
Crankshaft position sensor bolt M6
Oil level switch bolt
Starter motor bolt
M6
M6
Thread size
M6
Q’ty
6
M22
M6
M6
M8
M6
M6
1
1
1
1
3
2
1
1
1
3
2
1
1
1
2
2
Tightening torque
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
85 Nm (8.5 m·kg, 61 ft·lb)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
2 Nm (0.2 m·kg, 1.4 ft·lb)
18 Nm (1.8 m·kg, 13 ft·lb)
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
Remarks
Use a lock washer
Left thread
NOTE:
• Cylinder head nut
1 First, tighten the bolts to approximately 19 Nm (1.9 m•kg, 14 ft•lb) with a torque wrench following the tightening order.
2 Retighten the bolts 67 Nm (6.7 m•kg, 48 ft•lb) with a torque wrench.
• Connecting rod cap bolt
1 Tighten the connecting rod bolts to 20 Nm (2.0 m•kg, 14 ft•lb) and then tighten them further to reach the specified angle 150°.
• Crankcase bolt (main journal)
1 First, tighten the bolts to approximately 20 Nm (2.0 m•kg, 14 ft•lb) with a torque wrench following the tightening order.
2 Loosen all the bolts one by one following the tightening order and then tighten them to 20 Nm (2.0 m•kg, 14 ft•lb) again.
3 Retighten the bolts further to reach the specified angle (60°)
2-15
2-16
TIGHTENING TORQUES
TIGHTENING TORQUES
EAS20350
CHASSIS TIGHTENING TORQUES
Item
Upper bracket pinch bolt
Steering stem nut
Upper handlebar holder bolt
Lower handlebar holder nut
Lower bracket pinch bolt
Lower ring nut
Cap bolt
Damper rod assembly bolt
Brake master cylinder bracket bolt M6
Brake master cylinder reservoir cap screw
M4
Front brake hose union bolt
Front brake hose holder bolt
Cowling stay bolt (FZ1-S)
Cowling bracket bolt (FZ1-S)
M10
M6
M8
M6
Front fender bolt
Clutch lever holder pinch bolt
M6
M6
Right front engine mounting bolt 1 M10
Right front engine mounting bolt 2 M10
Left front engine mounting bolt M10
Upper self-locking nut
Lower self-locking nut
Engine mounting adjust bolt
(upper)
Engine mounting adjust bolt
(lower)
Pivot shaft nut
Connecting arm nut (connecting arm and frame)
Relay arm nut (relay arm and swingarm)
Relay arm nut (relay arm and connecting arm)
Main frame and rear frame nut
M10
M10
M11
M11
M18
M10
M10
M10
M10
Clutch cable locknut
Throttle cable locknut
Rear shock absorber assembly upper nut
Rear shock absorber assembly lower nut
Drive chain guard bolt
Drive chain guide bolt
Rear fender screw
M8
M6
M10
M10
M6
M6
M6
Thread size
M8
M28
M8
M10
M8
M30
M46
M10
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
2
3
4
1
1
1
1
2
2
3
2
1
1
1
4
1
2
1
2
1
4
1
4
2
2
1
2
2
2-17
Tightening torque
26 Nm (2.6 m·kg, 19 ft·lb)
113 Nm (11.3 m·kg, 82 ft·lb)
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
32 Nm (3.2 m·kg, 23 ft·lb)
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
SEE NOTE
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
2 Nm (0.2 m·kg, 1.4 ft·lb)
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
33 Nm (3.3 m·kg, 24 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
6 Nm (0.6 m·kg, 4.3 ft·lb)
11 Nm (1.1 m·kg, 8.0 ft·lb)
45 Nm (4.5 m·kg, 33 ft·lb)
50 Nm (5.0 m·kg, 36 ft·lb)
45 Nm (4.5 m·kg, 33 ft·lb)
51 Nm (5.1 m·kg, 37 ft·lb)
51 Nm (5.1 m·kg, 37 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
105 Nm (11 m·kg, 76 ft·lb)
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
41 Nm (4.1 m·kg, 30 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
Remarks
TIGHTENING TORQUES
Item
Rear brake hose holder screw
Fuel tank bolt (front)
Fuel tank bolt (rear)
Fuel tank bracket screw
Fuel tank cap bolt
Fuel pump bolt
Seat lock assembly nut
Mud guard assembly bolt
License plate light screw
Rear reflector nut
Mud guard assembly bracket screw
Tail/brake light bracket bolt
Rear fender bracket bolt
Seat bracket bolt
Exhaust pipe assembly bracket bolt
Side cover screw
Lean angle sensor bolt
Coolant reserver tank bolt
Front wheel axle shaft
Front wheel axle pinch bolt
Front brake caliper bolt
Front brake disc screw
M8
M6
M6
M8
Brake caliper bleed screw
Rear wheel axle nut
Rear brake disc screw
Rear brake caliper bolt (front)
Rear brake caliper bolt (rear)
Rear wheel sprocket nut
Drive chain adjusting locknut
Rear brake hose union bolt
Sidestand nut
Sidestand bracket bolt
Sidestand switch bolt
M10
M5
Footrest bracket bolt M8
Rear brake fluid reserver tank bolt M5
Rear brake master cylinder bolt
Centerstand nut (FZ1-S)
Centerstand bracket nut (FZ1-S)
Centerstand bracket adapter bolt
(FZ1-S)
Footrest bolt
Throttle cable adjust nut
M8
M10
M10
M10
M10
M6
M12
M8
M10
M8
M10
M10
M6
M4
M6
M18
M8
M10
M6
M8
M24
M8
Thread size
M6
M6
M6
M6
M5
M5
M6
M8
M5
M5
M5
Q’ty
4
2
3
2
4
2
6
2
4
5
2
3
1
2
6
4
2
1
4
10
1
1
2
2
3
1
5
4
2
2
2
4
1
2
2
2
1
6
2
1
1
2-18
Tightening torque
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
6 Nm (0.6 m·kg, 4.3 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
16 Nm (1.6 m·kg, 12 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
2 Nm (0.2 m·kg, 1.4 ft·lb)
16 Nm (1.6 m·kg, 12 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
2 Nm (0.2 m·kg, 1.4 ft·lb)
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
72 Nm (7.2 m·kg, 52 ft·lb)
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
40 Nm (4.0 m·kg, 29 ft·lb)
18 Nm (1.8 m·kg, 13 ft·lb)
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
150 Nm (15.0 m·kg, 108 ft·lb)
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
27 Nm (2.7 m·kg, 20 ft·lb)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
100 Nm (10.0 m·kg, 72 ft·lb)
16 Nm (1.6 m·kg, 12 ft·lb)
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
48 Nm (4.8 m·kg, 35 ft·lb)
63 Nm (6.3 m·kg, 46 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
56 Nm (5.6 m·kg, 41 ft·lb)
55 Nm (5.5 m·kg, 40 ft·lb)
73 Nm (7.3 m·kg, 53 ft·lb)
55 Nm (5.5 m·kg, 40 ft·lb)
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
Remarks
TIGHTENING TORQUES
Item
Clutch cable adjust nut
Thread size
M8
Q’ty
1
Tightening torque
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
Remarks
NOTE:
1 First, tighten the ring nut to approximately 52 Nm (5.2 m•kg, 38 ft•lb) with a torque wrench, then loosen the lower ring nut completely.
2 Retighten the lower ring nut 18 Nm (1.8 m•kg, 13 ft•lb).
2-19
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES
EAS20360
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES
EAS20370
ENGINE
Lubrication point
Oil seal lips
O-rings
Bearings
Crankshaft pins
Piston surfaces
Piston pins
Crankshaft journals
Camshaft lobes
Camshaft journals
Valve stems (intake and exhaust)
Valve stem ends (intake and exhaust)
Water pump impeller shaft
Oil pump rotors (inner and outer)
Oil pump housing
Oil strainer
Clutch (pull rod)
Oil/water pump drive sprocket and washer
Clutch (thrust plate)
Starter clutch idle gear inner surface
Starter clutch assembly
Primary driven gear
Transmission gears (wheel and pinion)
Main axle and drive axle
Shift drum
Shift forks and shift fork guide bars
Shift shaft
Shift shaft boss
Cylinder head cover mating surface
Lubricant
Crankcase mating surface
Clutch cover (crankcase mating surface)
Generator rotor cover (crankcase mating surface)
Yamaha bond No.
1215
Yamaha bond No.
1215
Yamaha bond No.
1215
Yamaha bond No.
1215
2-20
Pickup rotor cover
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES
Lubrication point Lubricant
Yamaha bond No.
1215
2-21
LUBRICATION POINTS AND LUBRICANT TYPES
EAS20380
CHASSIS
Lubrication point
Steering bearings and bearing races (upper and lower)
Throttle grip inner surface
Brake lever pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts
Clutch lever pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts
Engine mount bolts (rear upper and lower)
Engine mount bolts (front left and right)
Relay arm, connecting rod and rear shock absorber collar
Pivot shaft
Swingarm pivot bearing
Swingarm head pipe end, oil seal and bush
Oil seal (relay arm, connecting arm and rear shock absorber)
Seat lock assembly moving parts
Sidestand pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts
Sidestand switch contact point
Sidestand hook and spring contact point
Shift shaft joint rod moving parts
Shift pedal pivoting parts
Rear footrest ball and metal-to-metal moving parts
Centerstand metal-to-metal moving parts (FZ1-S)
Front wheel oil seal (left and right)
Rear wheel oil seal
Rear wheel drive hub oil seal
Rear wheel drive hub mating surface
Lubricant
2-22
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
EAS20390
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
EAS20400
ENGINE OIL LUBRICATION CHART
2-23
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
1. Oil strainer
2. Oil pump
3. Relief valve
4. Oil cooler
5. Oil filter
6. Main gallery
7. AC magneto drive gear shower
8. Shift fork (upper)
9. Main axle
10.Mission shower
11.Drive axle
12.AC magneto axle
13.Piston cooler
14.Chain tensioner
15.Intake camshaft
16.Exhaust camshaft
2-24
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
EAS20410
LUBRICATION DIAGRAMS
2-25
1. Intake camshaft
2. Exhaust camshaft
3. Oil filter cartridge
4. Oil level switch
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-26
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-27
1. Intake camshaft
2. Exhaust camshaft
3. Crankshaft
4. Oil cooler
5. Relief valve
6. Oil pipe
7. Oil strainer
8. Oil pump
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-28
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-29
1. Oil filter cartridge
2. Oil level switch
3. Oil pump
4. Oil strainer
5. Oil pipe
6. Oil cooler
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-30
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-31
1. Main axle
2. Oil delivery pipe
3. Drive axle
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-32
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-33
1. Cylinder head
2. Crankshaft
LUBRICATION SYSTEM CHART AND DIAGRAMS
2-34
EAS20420
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
2-35
1. Water pump
2. Radiator
3. Radiator fan
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
2-36
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
2-37
1. Radiator cap
2. Radiator
3. Oil cooler
4. Thermostat
COOLING SYSTEM DIAGRAMS
2-38
EAS20430
CABLE ROUTING
CABLE ROUTING
2-39
1. Clutch cable
2. Left handlebar switch lead
3. Main switch lead
4. Immobilizer lead
5. Horn lead
6. Horn stay assembly
7. Throttle cable (pull side)
8. Throttle cable (return side)
9. Wire harness
10.Brake hose
11.Throttle cables
12.Right handlebar switch lead
A. Wire is connected to the meter.
B. Route the stay assembly above central cable guide.
C. After branching the lead from the left handlebar switch, route it under the stay assembly and upper guide wire (from the vehicle front side to the rear side).
D. Route the stay assembly below central cable guide.
E. Clamp the horn lead to the stay assembly.
Position the binding section in front of the vehicle body and cut the tip to be between
2 to 4mm (0.08 to 0.16in).
F. Clamp the wire harness at the place of the white tape and insert it to the stay assembly. Point the clamp opening to the outside of the vehicle.
G. Lay on the front brake light switch lead above the throttle cables.
H. Secure the brake hose to the front fork.
I. Secure the horn lead to the front fork. Cut the tip of the clamp head leaving 2 to 4mm
(0.08 to 0.16in) toward the outside of the vehicle.
J. The center position of the clamp shall be within this numeric range.
K. The outside of the vehicle.
L. The inside of the vehicle.
M. Pass the brake hose in the space by the right side of the vehicle from this wire and pass the throttle cables and right handlebar switch lead in the left side space. Next, route the right handlebar switch lead to the vehicle rear side where the throttle cables are routed.
CABLE ROUTING
2-40
2-41
CABLE ROUTING
1. Wire harness
2. Right handlebar switch lead
3. Throttle cable
4. Radiator inlet hose
5. Wire guide
6. Brake fluid reservoir hose
7. Fuel tank breather hose
8. EXUP cable wire bending attachment
9. EXUP cables
10.Rear brake light switch lead
11.Radiator fan motor lead (Right)
12.Coolant reservoir tank hose
13.Brake hose
14.Clutch cable
15.Radiator stay
16.Throttle cable (return side)
17.Throttle cable (pull side)
18.Frame
19.Rear brake light switch stay
20.Footrest bracket (Right)
21.Rear brake light switch
A. Wire is connected to the meter.
B. Clamp the brake hose to the stay assembly. Clamping position should be 5 mm
(0.20 in) or more away and less than 10 mm (0.39 in) from the top end of the brake hose protector. Cut the tip to be between 2 to 4 mm (0.08 to 0.16 in).
C. To the throttle bodies
D. Clamp the coolant reservoir hose and radiator inlet hose. Point the clamp opening to the outside of the vehicle and the tip of the clamp to the front upper side of the vehicle, and pay attention so that the tip does not protrude from the radiator cover.
E. Route the fuel tank breather hose by the wire guide. The white paint position of the hose shall be lower than the wire guide.
F. To the EXUP
G. Pass the fuel tank breather hose, and
EXUP cable through the wire guide of the rear brake light switch stay.
H. The clamp position shall be at the center of bending section of the brake fluid reservoir hose as shown in the illustration.
I. Bind the two EXUP cables with the clamp.
For the clamping position, a part of the clamp should be located within a range of
10 mm (0.39 in) from the end of wire bending attachment. Any direction of the clamp opening can be accepted.
J. To the wire harness
K. To the coolant reservoir tank
L. Route the radiator fan motor lead (right) so that there is no slack as much as possible in this section.
CABLE ROUTING
M. Pass the radiator fan motor lead (right) above the coolant reservoir hose and route it to the inside of the frame.
N. Pass the coolant reservoir hose to the vehicle inner side of the radiator inlet hose and route it to the lower outside of the vehicle of the thermostat assembly.
O. Route in the concavity section of the radiator stay.
P. Route the wire guide of the radiator stay as shown in the illustration. (Twisting not allowed)
Q. The outside of the vehicle.
R. The inside of the vehicle.
S. The front side of the vehicle.
T. Point the clamp head to the outside of the vehicle and fit it so that the band tip is positioned at the vehicle front side.
U. Pass the fuel tank breather hose through the guide wire of the sidestand bracket.
Make sure to place the white paint position of the hose lower than the guide wire.
2-42
2-43
CABLE ROUTING
1. Clutch cable
2. Water pump breather hose
3. Oil level switch lead
4. Sidestand switch lead
5. O
2
sensor lead
6. Coolant reservoir tank drain hose
7. Wire harness
8. Battery negative lead
9. Seat lock cable
10.AC magneto lead
11.Rectifier/regulator lead
12.Water pump inlet pipe
13.Radiator fan motor lead (left)
14.Radiator stay
15.Main switch lead
16.Immobilizer lead
17.Left handlebar switch lead
18.Horn
19.Clutch cable swaging metal
20.Throttle cable
21.Stay assembly
22.Upper bracket
23.Right handlebar switch lead
24.Brake hose
25.Horn lead
26.Throttle body
27.Stay 1
28.Drive chain case cover
29.Starter motor lead
30.Fuel tank breather hose
31.EXUP cables
32.Rear brake light switch lead
33.Rear brake fluid reservoir hose
34.Speed sensor lead
A. Route in the concavity section of the radiator stay.
B. To the coolant reservoir tank
C. Clamp the wire harness, AC magneto lead, rectifier/regulator lead, starter motor lead and battery negative lead. Point the clamp head to the inside of the vehicle and fit it so that the band tip is pointed downward.
D. Pass the O
2
sensor lead through the vehicle inner side of the hose assembly 1 junction pipe of the water pump inlet pipe and route it by the outer down side of the hose assembly 1 and to the upper direction as shown in the illustration.
E. To the exhaust
F. Route the O
2
sensor lead to the vehicle rear side where the water pump inlet pipe is routed.
G. Physical relationship between the coolant reservoir tank drain hose tip and sidestand switch lead can be in random order.
2-44
CABLE ROUTING
H. Route the hose assembly 1 by the vehicle front side where the water pump inlet pipe is routed. For the hose tip position, route the hose so that 10 mm (0.39 in) or more can be assured as shown in the illustration.
I. More than 10 mm (0.39 in)
J. Route the sidestand switch lead by the vehicle front side where the hose assembly
1 and water pump inlet pipe are routed.
K. Pass the oil level switch lead to the vehicle front side of the water pump breather hose and water pipe.
L. Route the AC magneto lead by the inside of the frame.
M. There should be no exposure of bare conductors due to the misalignment of tubes.
N. Route the AC magneto lead by the inside of vehicle away from the water hose.
O. Clamp the clutch cable, radiator fan motor lead (left) and water pump breather hose.
Point the clamp head to the upper side of the vehicle and fit it so that the band tip is positioned inside. For the band position, install the band using the engine position as a guide as shown in the illustration.
P. Insert the clamp to the frame and clamp the clutch cable. For the clamping position, place the clamp so that the caulking attachment on the clutch cable side is positioned at the vehicle front side where the clamp is located. Clamp opening should be positioned at the outside of the vehicle.
Q. The inserting direction of the onion-head of the horn lead shall be as shown in the illustration.
R. The front side of the vehicle.
S. The outside of the vehicle.
T. The upper side of the vehicle.
U. The inside of the vehicle.
V. Route the clutch cable under the convexity sections of the throttle bodies.
W. Route the radiator fan motor lead (left) between the convexity sections of the throttle bodies.
X. Route the wire harness between the convexity sections of the throttle bodies.
Y. Innermost section of the vehicle.
Z. Can be routed in any order.
AA.Route the water pump breather hose finally in the guide after passing other hoses so that it can be positioned on the outside of the vehicle.
AB.Route the coolant reservoir tank drain hose so that it is positioned at the innermost part in hoses and leads.
AC.The rear side of the vehicle.
AD.To the radiator
AE.Open to the air
2-45
CABLE ROUTING
AF.The coolant reservoir tank drain hose shall cross with the speed sensor lead under the rear arm bracket. The coolant reservoir tank drain hose shall be positioned above the vehicle.
CABLE ROUTING
2-46
2-47
CABLE ROUTING
1. Throttle cables
2. Right handlebar switch lead
3. Wire harness
4. Throttle cable (pull side)
5. Throttle cable (return side)
6. Radiator fan motor lead (Right)
7. Coolant reservoir tank hose
8. Radiator inlet hose
9. Air filter drain hose
10.Crankshaft position sensor lead
11.Direct ignition coil lead coupler
12.Immobilizer anti safety alarm coupler
13.Engine ground lead
14.Neutral switch lead
15.Rear brake light switch lead
16.EXUP cable
17.EXUP servo motor
18.Main fuse
19.Atmospheric pressure sensor
20.Battery positive lead
21.Radiator fan motor relay
22.Starting circuit cut-off relay
23.Fuse box
24.Lean angle sensor
25.Turn signal light lead (right)
26.License plate light lead
27.Turn signal relay
28.Turn signal light lead (left)
29.Seat lock cable
30.Tail/brake light lead
31.Tail/brake light lead coupler
32.Headlight relay
33.Turn signal light lead coupler (left)
34.Starter relay
35.Fuel tank breather hose
36.Battery negative lead
37.AC magneto lead
38.Starter motor lead
39.Coolant reservoir tank drain hose
40.Fuel hose bend R section
41.Idle adjust screw wire
42.Throttle body lead
43.Air cut-off valve hose
44.ECU (engine control unit)
45.Water pump breather hose
46.Radiator fan motor lead (left)
47.Clutch cable
48.Left handlebar switch lead
49.Main switch lead
50.Immobilizer lead
51.Frame
52.Cover
2-48
CABLE ROUTING
53.Direct ignition coil lead
54.Speed sensor lead
55.Lean angle sensor lead
56.Battery box
57.Turn signal light relay lead
58.Rear frame
59.Battery
60.Sidestand switch lead
61.Oil level switch lead
62.O
2
sensor lead
63.Velcro
64.Protector
65.Mad guard
66.Fender
67.Fuel hose
A. Check that it is secured with the guide of the radiator stay.
B. To the direct ignition coil lead
C. Make sure to install the air filter after checking that the leads are positioned outside of the vehicle from the throttle body side cover.
D. To the engine
E. Direct ignition coil lead protector edge
F. Bind the left handle bar switch leads, main switch leads, right handle bar switch leads, immobilizer leads, radiator fan motor leads
(right), wire harness and direct ignition leads (in random order). Make sure to set the clamping position to be ahead of the immobilizer anti-safety alarm coupler and rear brake switch leadÅfs branch position, and to be within a range of 0 to 30 mm (0 to 1.18 inches) away from the protector end of the direct ignition coil lead. Install the band pointing its tip end downward inside the vehicle.
G. Route the pickup coil lead below the fuel hose, throttle body hoses and air filter drain hose.
H. Route the wire harness below the clutch cable and route the coupler branched from the wire harness below the clutch cable and then connect it.
I. Insert the wire harness wrapping clamp to the hole of the frame.
J. To the rear brake light switch
K. Open to the air
L. Insert the main fuse to the battery band.
Soapy water can be spread.
M. Route the battery positive lead under the relays.
N. Route the fuse box lead under the radiator fan motor relay.
O. Route the battery positive lead above the fuse box lead.
P. Pass the license plate light lead and turn signal light lead under the turn signal relay.
2-49
CABLE ROUTING
Q. Pass the turn signal light lead (right) and license plate light lead under the rear fender bracket and route between the ribs of the battery box.
R. Pass the turn signal light lead (left) and tail/ brake light lead under the rear fender bracket and route between the ribs of the battery box.
S. Route the tail/brake light lead by the inner side of the rear fender bracket and the outside of the battery box ribs. When installing the tail cover assembly, pay attention so that it does not catch anything between rear frame and rear fender bracket surface.
T. After wiring the coupler, make sure to cover the connector with the squid-shaped protective cover on the wire harness side and then insert it to the space made by the external side of rear frame and tail cover assembly. At this time, the lead should be pushed in so that the lead does not hook on the seat loading accepter.
U. Route the tail/brake light lead in the space made by the top surface of the rear frame and the bottom face of the seat bracket.
When installing the seat bracket, pay attention so that the lead is not caught by the rear frame surface.
V. Route the battery positive lead from the inner side of the vehicle to the down side of the wire harness. It is not allowed to route the lead over the wire harness.
W. Route it so that the branch connection of the main fuse lead is placed in the upper side.
X. To the rectifier/regulator. Route the AC. magneto lead and rectifier/regulator lead inside the battery box.
Y. To the speed sensor
Z. Route the AC. magneto lead under the clutch cable.
AA.To the fuel pump
AB.Fit so that the engine ground lead is positioned below and the battery negative lead above. Fit the leads so that each projection of lead is positioned on the upper side of the vehicle.
AC.To the starter motor
AD.Route the leads under the throttle bodies.
AE.Route the intake air temperature sensor by the upper side of the air filter drain hose.
AF.To the air filter case
AG.Check that the radiator fan motor lead
(left) is secured with the guide of the radiator stay.
AH.Positioning tape (shaded area)
AI. Fit the protector by aligning the positioning tape end and protector end for the main switch lead, immobilizer lead and left handlebar switch lead. The misalignment tolerance of ends is ±5 mm (0.20 in).
CABLE ROUTING
AJ.Clamp each lead at the positioning taping section (white) and then insert it to the cover. (In random order)
AK.Clamp each lead at the positioning taping section (blue) and then insert it to the cover. For routing leads, the wire harness shall be downside but others can be in random order. Positioning tape is only used for the wire harness and right handlebar switch.
AL.The upper side of the vehicle.
AM.The inside of the vehicle.
AN.Secure the leads with a clamp. The cut position of the tip of the clamp shall be on the upper side of the vehicle. (Cut it leaving
2 to 4mm (0.08 to 0.16in) of the tip). Route the leads over the frame plate and insert them through the hole into the inside of the vehicle.
AO.Route the lean angle sensor lead at the uppermost side of the vehicle. Also, it must not be protruded from the battery box ribs toward the upper side.
AP.Routing can be in random order.
AQ.Push the wire harness securely in as far as it will go.
AR.Secure the leads with a clamp. The cut position of the tip of the clamp shall be on the upper side of the vehicle. (Cut it leaving
2 to 4mm (0.08 to 0.16in) of the tip). Route the leads over the frame plate and insert them through the hole into the inside of the vehicle. Route the wire harness at the position shown in the illustration and other leads can be in random order. Inserting the band can be in any direction.
AS.15 X 20 mm (0.59 X 0.79 in) (shaded area)
AT. Installation procedure 1. Secure the main switch lead and immobilizer lead with Velcro strap. 2. Secure the left handlebar switch lead with Velcro strap. The main switch lead and immobilizer lead shall not be twisted in the protector. The installation position is where the protector end and lead positioning tape end align.
AU.20 X 58 mm (0.79 X 2.28 in) (shaded area)
AV.Route it between the battery box ribs in the order indicated in the figure.
AW.Clamp the fuel hose and direct ignition coil lead. Point the opening section of the clamp to the front side of the vehicle and install it at the position as shown in the illustration.
2-50
2-51
CABLE ROUTING
FZ1-S
1. Clutch cable
2. Left handlebar switch lead
3. Immobilizer lead
4. Main switch lead
5. Protector
6. Throttle cables
7. Right handlebar switch lead
8. Throttle cable (pull side)
9. Throttle cable (return side)
10.Bracket
11.Wire harness
12.Turn signal light lead
13.Seat lock cable
14.Tail/brake light lead
15.Battery box
16.Mud guard
17.Fender
18.Frame
19.Cover
A. Positioning tape (shaded area)
B. Secure the wire harness to the bracket.
Position the clamp head on the upper side of the vehicle and point the tip to the front side of the vehicle.
C. Attach the clamp to the front upper cowling. Clamp the turn signal light lead (left) and headlight lead.
D. Pass the turn signal light lead (left) and tail/ brake light lead under the rear fender bracket.
E. Pass the turn signal light lead (left) the route between the ribs of the battery box and tail/brake light lead.
F. Clamp each lead at the positioning taping section and then insert it to the cover. (In random order) Positioning tape is only used for the right handlebar switch. Fit other leads so that they are not slack.
G. Clamp each lead at the positioning taping section and then insert it to the cover. (In random order) Route the rear side of the vehicle to the wire harness.
CABLE ROUTING
2-52
2-53
CABLE ROUTING
1. Fuel tank
2. Fuel tank drain hose
3. Fuel tank breather hose
4. Clip
5. Air filter bracket
6. 3 way connector
7. Hose
8. Fuel hose
9. Damper
10.Collar
11.Fuel tank bracket
12.O-ring
13.Fuel pump
A. Hook the cover pawl to the fuel tank bracket.
B. The knob of the clip can be positioned in any direction.
C. Assemble the two folding sections of the collar flange as shown in the illustration.
D. Fit the knob of the clip as shown in the illustration.
E. Fit the white paint section of the hose pointed downward.
F. Pass the hose through the fuel tank bracket clamp. There should be no bend of the hose between the fuel tank nipple and clamp.
G. Align the projection part with the pump seat nut.
H. Fit the orange double lock side to the pump side.
I. Fit the black double lock side to the engine side.
J. The fuel tank bracket shall not run on the tank flange as shown in the illustration.
K. Fit the O-ring with its lip pointed upward.
L. Tightening sequence
M. Fuel piping connector attachment directions. (fuel pump side) Always perform the connection/disconnection works by hand.
Do not use tools.
N. 1. Insert the connector until the click sound is heard and check that the connector does not come off. Make sure that no foreign matter is caught in the sealing section. (It is prohibited to wear the cotton work gloves or equivalent coverings.)
O. This part works as a dropout stopper.
P. 2.After Step [N] as above is finished, check that the connector is completely attached by sliding the double lock (orange part) on the connector as shown in the illustration and seeing if it touches firmly or not.
2-54
CABLE ROUTING
2-55
CABLE ROUTING
PERIODIC CHECKS AND ADJUSTMENTS
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
………………………………………………………………. 3-1
INTRODUCTION ………………………………………………………………………… 3-1
ENGINE
…………………………………………………………………………………………… 3-4
ADJUSTING THE VALVE CLEARANCE ………………………………………… 3-4
SYNCHRONIZING THE THROTTLE BODIES ………………………………… 3-6
ADJUSTING THE EXHAUST GAS VOLUME………………………………….. 3-8
ADJUSTING THE ENGINE IDLING SPEED …………………………………… 3-9
ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE CABLE FREE PLAY ………………………… 3-9
CHECKING THE SPARK PLUGS………………………………………………… 3-10
MEASURING THE COMPRESSION PRESSURE …………………………. 3-10
CHECKING THE ENGINE OIL LEVEL…………………………………………. 3-11
CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL……………………………………………………. 3-12
MEASURING THE ENGINE OIL PRESSURE ………………………………. 3-13
ADJUSTING THE CLUTCH CABLE FREE PLAY ………………………….. 3-14
REPLACING THE AIR FILTER ELEMENT ……………………………………. 3-15
CHECKING THE THROTTLE BODY JOINTS ……………………………….. 3-16
CHECKING THE FUEL LINE ……………………………………………………… 3-16
CHECKING THE CRANKCASE BREATHER HOSE ………………………. 3-16
CHECKING THE EXHAUST SYSTEM …………………………………………. 3-17
ADJUSTING THE EXUP CABLES ………………………………………………. 3-17
CHECKING THE EXUP SERVO MOTOR …………………………………….. 3-18
CHECKING THE COOLANT LEVEL ……………………………………………. 3-18
CHECKING THE COOLING SYSTEM …………………………………………. 3-19
CHANGING THE COOLANT ………………………………………………………. 3-19
CHASSIS
………………………………………………………………………………………. 3-22
ADJUSTING THE FRONT DISC BRAKE ……………………………………… 3-22
ADJUSTING THE REAR DISC BRAKE ……………………………………….. 3-22
CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID LEVEL ………………………………………. 3-23
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE PADS………………………………………. 3-23
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE PADS ………………………………………… 3-23
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE HOSES……………………………………. 3-24
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE HOSE ……………………………………….. 3-24
ADJUSTING THE REAR BRAKE LIGHT SWITCH ………………………… 3-24
BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM…………………………… 3-25
ADJUSTING THE SHIFT PEDAL ………………………………………………… 3-26
ADJUSTING THE DRIVE CHAIN SLACK …………………………………….. 3-26
LUBRICATING THE DRIVE CHAIN……………………………………………… 3-27
CHECKING AND ADJUSTING THE STEERING HEAD …………………. 3-27
CHECKING THE FRONT FORK …………………………………………………. 3-28
ADJUSTING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ………………………………………. 3-29
ADJUSTING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY……………. 3-31
CHECKING THE TIRES …………………………………………………………….. 3-32
CHECKING THE WHEELS ………………………………………………………… 3-34
CHECKING AND LUBRICATING THE CABLES ……………………………. 3-34
LUBRICATING THE LEVERS……………………………………………………… 3-34
LUBRICATING THE PEDAL ……………………………………………………….. 3-34
LUBRICATING THE SIDESTAND………………………………………………… 3-34
3
LUBRICATING THE CENTERSTAND (FZ1-S) ………………………………. 3-34
LUBRICATING THE REAR SUSPENSION …………………………………… 3-34
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
…………………………………………………………………… 3-35
CHECKING AND CHARGING THE BATTERY………………………………. 3-35
CHECKING THE FUSES……………………………………………………………. 3-35
REPLACING THE HEADLIGHT BULBS……………………………………….. 3-35
ADJUSTING THE HEADLIGHT BEAM ………………………………………… 3-36
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
EAS20450
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
EAS20460
INTRODUCTION
This chapter includes all information necessary to perform recommended checks and adjustments.
If followed, these preventive maintenance procedures will ensure more reliable vehicle operation, a longer service life and reduce the need for costly overhaul work. This information applies to vehicles already in service as well as to new vehicles that are being prepared for sale. All service technicians should be familiar with this entire chapter.
Periodic maintenance and lubrication chart
NOTE:
•
The annual checks must be performed every year, except if a kilometer-based maintenance is performed instead.
• From 50000 km, repeat the maintenance intervals starting from 10000 km.
• Items marked with an asterisk should be performed by a Yamaha dealer as they require special tools, data and technical skills.
NO.
ITEM CHECK OR MAINTENANCE JOB
1
2
3
*
*
*
Fuel line
Spark plugs
Valves
• Check fuel hoses for cracks or damage.
• Check condition.
• Clean and regap.
• Replace.
• Check valve clearance.
• Adjust.
4 *
Air filter element
• Replace.
5
6
7
8
9
10
11 * Wheel bearings
12
*
*
*
*
*
*
Clutch
Front brake
Rear brake
Brake hoses
Wheels
Tires
Swingarm
• Check operation.
• Adjust.
• Check operation, fluid level and vehicle for fluid leakage.
• Replace brake pads.
• Check operation, fluid level and vehicle for fluid leakage.
• Replace brake pads.
• Check for cracks or damage.
• Replace.
• Check runout and for damage.
• Check tread depth and for damage.
• Replace if necessary.
• Check air pressure.
• Correct if necessary.
• Check bearing for looseness or damage.
• Check operation and for excessive play.
ODOMETER READ-
ING (X 1000 km)
1 10 20 30 40
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Annual check
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
Every 40000 km
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓ ✓
Whenever worn to the limit
✓ ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓ ✓
Whenever worn to the limit
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓ ✓ ✓
Every 4 years
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
3-1
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
NO.
ITEM CHECK OR MAINTENANCE JOB
ODOMETER READ-
ING (X 1000 km)
1 10 20 30 40
Annual check
13
14
15
16
*
*
Drive chain
Steering bearings
Chassis fasteners
Sidestand
• Check chain slack, alignment and condition.
• Adjust and lubricate chain with a special O-ring chain lubricant thoroughly.
• Check bearing play and steering for roughness.
• Lubricate with lithium-soap-based grease.
• Make sure that all nuts, bolts and screws are properly tightened.
• Check operation.
• Lubricate.
17 *
Sidestand switch
18 * Front fork
19
20
*
*
Shock absorber assembly
Rear suspension relay arm and connecting arm pivoting points
• Check operation.
• Check operation and for oil leakage.
• Check operation and shock absorber for oil leakage.
• Check operation.
21
22
23
24
*
*
Fuel injection
Engine oil
Cooling system
• Adjust engine idling speed and synchronization.
• Change.
• Check oil level and vehicle for oil leakage.
Engine oil filter cartridge
• Replace.
• Check coolant level and vehicle for coolant leakage.
• Change.
25
26
*
Front and rear brake switches
Moving parts and cables
• Check operation.
• Lubricate.
27 *
Throttle grip housing and cable
• Check operation and free play.
• Adjust the throttle cable free play if necessary.
• Lubricate the throttle grip housing and cable.
Every 1000 km and after washing the motorcycle or riding in the rain
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓ ✓ ✓
Every 20000 km
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
Every 3 years
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
3-2
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
NO.
ITEM CHECK OR MAINTENANCE JOB
ODOMETER READ-
ING (X 1000 km)
1 10 20 30 40
Annual check
28 *
29 *
30 *
Air induction system
Muffler and exhaust pipe
Lights, signals and switches
• Check the air cut-off valve, reed valve, and hose for damage.
• Replace the entire air induction system if necessary.
• Check the screw clamp for looseness.
• Check operation.
• Adjust headlight beam.
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
✓
✓
NOTE:
• Air filter
• This model’s air filter is equipped with a disposable oil-coated paper element, which must not be cleaned with compressed air to avoid damaging it.
• The air filter element needs to be replaced more frequently when riding in unusually wet or dusty areas.
• Hydraulic brake service
• Regularly check and, if necessary, correct the brake fluid level.
• Every two years replace the internal components of the brake master cylinders and calipers, and change the brake fluid.
• Replace the brake hoses every four years and if cracked or damaged.
3-3
EAS20470
ENGINE
EAS20490
ADJUSTING THE VALVE CLEARANCE
The following procedure applies to all of the valves.
NOTE:
• Valve clearance adjustment should be made on a cold engine, at room temperature.
• When the valve clearance is to be measured or adjusted, the piston must be at top dead center (TDC) on the compression stroke.
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
• Air filter case
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
• Throttle body assembly
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-
4.
• Air cut-off valve
Refer to «AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM» on page 7-13.
• Radiator
• Radiator fan motor
Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1.
2. Remove:
• Ignition coils
• Spark plugs
• Cylinder head cover
• Cylinder head cover gasket
Refer to «CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10.
3. Remove:
• Pickup rotor cover «1»
ENGINE
• Valve clearance
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Valve clearance (cold)
Intake valve
0.11–0.20 mm (0.0043–0.0079 in)
Exhaust valve
0.21–0.25 mm (0.0083–0.0098 in)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the crankshaft counterclockwise.
b. When piston #1 is at TDC on the compression stroke, align the TDC mark “a” on the pickup rotor with the crankcase mating surface “b”.
NOTE:
TDC on the compression stroke can be found when the camshaft lobes are turned away from each other.
c. Measure the valve clearance with a thickness gauge “1”.
NOTE:
• If the valve clearance is incorrect, record the measured reading.
• Measure the valve clearance in the following sequence.
Valve clearance measuring sequence
Cylinder #1
→
#2
→
#4
→
#3
4. Measure:
3-4
ENGINE
6. Adjust:
• Valve clearance
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the valve lifter “1” and the valve pad “2” with a valve lapper “3”.
Valve lapper
90890-04101
NOTE:
• Cover the timing chain opening with a rag to prevent the valve pad from falling into the crankcase.
• Make a note of the position of each valve lifter “1” and valve pad “2” so that they can be installed in the correct place.
A. Front d. To measure the valve clearances of the other cylinders, starting with cylinder #1 at
TDC, turn the crankshaft counterclockwise as specified in the following table.
Cylinder #2
Cylinder #4
Cylinder #3
180
°
360
°
540
°
A. Degrees that the crankshaft is turned counterclockwise
B. Cylinder
C. Combustion cycle
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Remove:
• Camshaft
NOTE:
• Refer to «CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10.
• When removing the timing chain and camshafts, fasten the timing chain with a wire to retrieve it if it falls into the crankcase.
3-5
b. Calculate the difference between the specified valve clearance and the measured valve clearance.
Example:
Specified valve clearance = 0.11–0.20 mm
(0.004–0.008 in)
Measure valve clearance = 0.25 mm (0.010 in)
0.25 mm (0.010 in)–0.20 mm (0.008 in) =
0.05 mm (0.002 in) c. Check the thickness of the current valve pad.
NOTE:
The thickness “a” of each valve pad is marked in hundredths of millimeters on the side that touches the valve lifter.
Example:
ENGINE
If the valve pad is marked “158”, the pad thickness is 1.58 mm (0.062in) d. Calculate the sum of the values obtained in steps (b) and (c) to determine the required valve pad thickness and the valve pad number.
Example:
1.58 mm (0.062 in) + 0.05 mm (0.002 in) =
1.63 mm (0.064 in)
The valve pad number is 163.
e. Round off the valve pad number according to the following table, and then select the suitable valve pad.
Last digit
0,1,2
3,4,5,6
7,8,9
Rounded value
0
5
10
NOTE:
Refer to the following table for the available valve pads.
Valve pad range
Valve pad thickness
Available valve pads
Nos. 150–240
1.50–2.40 mm
(0.0591–0.0945 in)
25 thicknesses in
0.05 mm (0.002 in) increments
Example:
Valve pad number = 163
Rounded value = 165
New valve pad number = 165 f.
Install the new valve pad “1” and the valve lifter “2”.
NOTE:
• Lubricate the valve lifter with engine oil.
• Install the valve lifter and the valve pad in the correct place.
• The valve lifter must turn smoothly when rotated by hand.
3-6
g. Install the exhaust and intake camshafts, timing chain and camshaft caps.
Camshaft cap bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• Refer to «CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10.
• Lubricate the camshaft bearings, camshaft lobes and camshaft journals.
• First, install the exhaust camshaft.
• Align the camshafts marks with the camshaft cap marks.
• Turn the crankshaft clockwise several full turns to seat the parts.
h. Measure the valve clearance again.
i.
If the valve clearance is still out of specification, repeat all of the valve clearance adjustment steps until the specified clearance is obtained.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
7. Install:
• All removed parts
NOTE:
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
EAS20570
SYNCHRONIZING THE THROTTLE BODIES
NOTE:
Prior to synchronizing the throttle bodies, the valve clearance and the engine idling speed should be properly adjusted and the ignition timing should be checked.
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand.
2. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
3. Remove:
• Synchronizing hoses “1”
4. Install:
• Vacuum gauge “1”
(onto the synchronizing hose)
• Digital tachometer
(near the spark plug)
Vacuum gauge
90890-03094
Carburetor synchronizer
YU-44456
ENGINE
• Throttle body synchronization
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. With throttle body #3 as standard, adjust throttle bodies #1, #2, and #4 using the air screw “1”.
NOTE:
• After each step, rev the engine two or three times, each time for less than a second, and check the synchronization again.
• If the air screw is removed, turn the screw 3/
4 turn in and be sure to synchronize the throttle body.
EC2D1080
CAUTION:
Do not use the throttle valve adjusting screws to adjust the throttle body synchronization.
Vacuum pressure at engine idling speed
30 kPa (225 mmHg, 8.9 inHg)
NOTE:
The difference in vacuum pressure between two throttle bodies should not exceed 1.33 kPa
(10mmHg, 0.39 inHg).
5. Install:
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
6. Start the engine and let it warm up for several minutes.
7. Check:
• Engine idling speed
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE ENGINE
IDLING SPEED» on page 3-9.
Engine idling speed
1.100–1.300 r/min
8. Adjust:
3-7
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
9. Measure:
• Engine idling speed
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
ENGINE
Make sure that the vacuum pressure is within specification.
10. Stop the engine and remove the measuring equipment.
11. Adjust:
• Throttle cable free play
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE
CABLE FREE PLAY» on page 3-9.
Throttle cable free play
(at the flange of the throttle grip)
3.0–5.0 mm (0.12–0.20 in)
12. Install:
• Synchronizing hoses
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
EAS20600
ADJUSTING THE EXHAUST GAS VOLUME
NOTE:
Be sure to set the CO density level to standard, and then adjust the exhaust gas volume.
1. Turn the main switch to “OFF” and set the engine stop switch to “ON”.
2. Simultaneously press and hold the
“SELECT” and “RESET” buttons, turn the main switch to “ON”, and continue to press the buttons for 8 seconds or more.
NOTE:
“dI” appears on the clock LCD.
3. Press the “SELECT” button to select the
CO adjustment mode “Co” “1” or the diagnostic mode “dI”.
4. After selecting “Co”, simultaneously press the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons for 2 seconds or more to execute the selection.
NOTE:
The selected cylinder number appears on the clock LCD.
• To decrease the selected cylinder number, press the “RESET” button.
• To increase the selected cylinder number, press the “SELECT” button.
5. After selecting the cylinder, simultaneously press the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons for 2 seconds or more to execute the selection.
6. Change the CO adjustment volume by pressing the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons.
NOTE:
The CO adjustment volume appears on the tripmeter LCD.
• To decrease the CO adjustment volume, press the “RESET” button.
• To increase the CO adjustment volume, press the “SELECT” button.
7. Release the switch to execute the selection.
3-8
8. Simultaneously press the “SELECT” and
“RESET” buttons to return to the cylinder selection (step 5).
9. Turn the main switch to “OFF” to cancel the mode.
EAS20610
ADJUSTING THE ENGINE IDLING SPEED
NOTE:
Prior to adjusting the engine idling speed, the throttle bodies’ synchronization should be adjusted properly, the air filter element should be clean, and the engine should have adequate compression.
1. Start the engine and let it warm up for several minutes.
2. Install:
• Digital tachometer
(onto the spark plug lead of cylinder #1)
3. Check:
• Engine idling speed
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Engine idling speed
1,100–1,300 r/min
4. Adjust:
• Engine idling speed
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the idle adjusting screw “1” in direction
“a” or “b” until the specified engine idling speed is obtained.
Direction “a”
Engine idling speed is increased.
Direction “b”
Engine idling speed is decreased.
ENGINE
Throttle cable free play
(at the flange of the throttle grip)
3.0–5.0 mm (0.12–0.20 in)
EAS20630
ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE CABLE FREE
PLAY
NOTE:
Prior to adjusting the throttle cable free play, the engine idling speed should be adjusted properly.
1. Check:
• Throttle cable free play “a”
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Throttle cable free play
(at the flange of the throttle grip)
3.0–5.0 mm (0.12–0.20 in)
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Adjust:
• Throttle cable free play
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE
CABLE FREE PLAY» on page 3-9.
3-9
2. Adjust:
• Throttle cable free play
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
Handlebar side
a. Loosen the locknut “1”.
b. Turn the adjusting nut “2” in direction “a” or
“b” until the specified throttle cable free play is obtained.
Direction “a”
Throttle cable free play is increased.
Direction “b”
Throttle cable free play is decreased.
6. Measure:
• Spark plug gap “a”
(with a wire thickness gauge)
Out of specification
→
Regap.
Spark plug gap
0.6–0.7 mm
(0.0236–0.0276 in)
ENGINE
c. Tighten the locknut.
EW2D1001
WARNING
After adjusting the throttle cable free play, start the engine and turn the handlebars to the right and to the left to ensure that this does not cause the engine idling speed to change.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS20680
CHECKING THE SPARK PLUGS
The following procedure applies to all of the spark plugs.
1. Remove:
• Radiator upper bolts
• Radiator lower bolt
Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1.
2. Remove:
• Ignition coils
• Spark plugs
ECA13320
CAUTION:
Before removing the spark plugs, blow away any dirt accumulated in the spark plug wells with compressed air to prevent it from falling into the cylinders.
3. Check:
• Spark plug type
Incorrect
→
Change.
Spark plug type (manufacturer)
CR9EK (NGK)
4. Check:
• Electrode “1”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the spark plug.
• Insulator “2”
Abnormal color
→
Replace the spark plug.
Normal color is medium-to-light tan.
5. Clean:
• Spark plug
(with a spark plug cleaner or wire brush)
3-10
7. Install:
• Spark plugs
• Ignition coils
Spark plug
13 Nm (1.3 m·kg, 9.4 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Before installing the spark plug, clean the spark plug and gasket surface.
8. Install:
• Radiator upper bolts
• Radiator lower bolt
Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1.
EAS20710
MEASURING THE COMPRESSION PRES-
SURE
The following procedure applies to all of the cylinders.
NOTE:
Insufficient compression pressure will result in a loss of performance.
1. Measure:
• Valve clearance
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE VALVE
CLEARANCE» on page 3-4.
2. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
3. Remove:
• Ignition coils
• Spark plugs
ECA13340
CAUTION:
Before removing the spark plugs, use compressed air to blow away any dirt accumulated in the spark plug wells to prevent it from falling into the cylinders.
4. Install:
• Compression gauge “1”
• Extension
Compression gauge
90890-03081
Engine compression tester
YU-33223
5. Measure:
• Compression pressure
Out of specification
→
Refer to steps (c) and (d).
Compression pressure (at sea level)
Minimum
1290 kPa (12.90 kg/cm
2
,12.90 bar, 183.5 psi)
Standard
1480 kPa (14.80 kg/cm
2
,14.80 bar, 210.5 psi)
Maximum
1660 kPa (16.60 kg/cm
2
, 16.60 bar, 236.1 psi)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Set the main switch to “ON”.
b. With the throttle wide open, crank the engine until the reading on the compression gauge stabilizes.
EW2D1002
WARNING
To prevent sparking, ground all spark plug leads before cranking the engine.
ENGINE
NOTE:
The difference in compression pressure between cylinders should not exceed 100 kPa
(1 kg/cm², 1 bar, 14.22 psi).
c. If the compression pressure is above the maximum specification, check the cylinder head, valve surfaces and piston crown for carbon deposits.
Carbon deposits
→
Eliminate.
d. If the compression pressure is below the minimum specification, pour a teaspoonful of engine oil into the spark plug bore and measure again.
Refer to the following table.
Compression pressure (with oil applied into the cylinder)
Higher than without oil
Reading Diagnosis
Piston ring(s) wear or damage
→
Repair.
Same as without oil Piston, valves, cylinder head gasket or piston possibly defective
→
Repair.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
6. Install:
• Spark plug
Spark plug
13 Nm (1.3 m·kg, 9.4 ft·lb)
7. Install:
• Ignition coils
EAS20730
CHECKING THE ENGINE OIL LEVEL
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
NOTE:
• Place the vehicle on a suitable stand.
• Make sure the vehicle is upright.
2. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
3. Check:
• Engine oil level
The engine oil level should be between the minimum level mark “a” and maximum level mark “b”.
Below the minimum level mark
→
Add the recommended engine oil to the proper level.
3-11
ENGINE
Recommended oil
Refer to the chart for the engine oil grade which is best suited for certain atmospheric temperatures.
API standard
SE or higher grade
ACEA standard
G4 or G5
ECA13360
CAUTION:
• Engine oil also lubricates the clutch and the wrong oil types or additives could cause clutch slippage. Therefore, do not add any chemical additives or use engine oils with a grade of CD “c” or higher and do not use oils labeled “ENERGY CON-
SERVING II” “d” or higher.
• Do not allow foreign materials to enter the crankcase.
NOTE:
Before checking the engine oil level, wait a few minutes until the oil has settled.
4. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
5. Check the engine oil level again.
NOTE:
Before checking the engine oil level, wait a few minutes until the oil has settled.
EAS20790
CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL
1. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
2. Place a container under the engine oil drain bolt.
3. Remove:
• Engine oil filler cap “1”
• Engine oil drain bolt “2”
(along with the gasket)
3-12
4. Drain:
• Engine oil
(completely from the crankcase)
5. If the oil filter cartridge is also to be replaced, perform the following procedure.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the oil filter cartridge “1” with an oil filter wrench “2”.
Oil filter wrench
90890-01426
YU-38411
b. Lubricate the O-ring “3” of the new oil filter cartridge with a thin coat of engine oil.
ECA13390
CAUTION:
Make sure the O-ring “3” is positioned correctly in the groove of the oil filter cartridge.
ENGINE
8. Fill:
• Crankcase
(with the specified amount of the recommended engine oil)
Quantity
Total amount
3.8 L (3.34 lmp qt, 4.02 US qt)
Without oil filter cartridge replacement
2.9 L (2.55 lmp qt, 3.07 US qt)
With oil filter cartridge replacement
3.1 L (2.73 lmp qt, 3.28 US qt)
9. Install:
• Engine oil filler cap
10. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
11. Check:
• Engine
(for engine oil leaks)
12. Check:
• Engine oil level
Refer to «CHECKING THE ENGINE OIL
LEVEL» on page 3-11.
EAS20820
MEASURING THE ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
1. Check:
• Engine oil level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended engine oil to the proper level.
c. Tighten the new oil filter cartridge to specification with an oil filter wrench.
Oil filter cartridge
17 Nm (1.7 m·kg, 12 ft·lb)
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
6. Replace:
• Engine oil drain bolt gasket
7. Install:
• Engine oil drain bolt
(along with the new gasket)
Engine oil drain bolt
43 Nm (4.3 m·kg, 31 ft·lb)
3-13
2. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
ECA13410
CAUTION:
When the engine is cold, the engine oil will have a higher viscosity, causing the engine oil pressure to increase. Therefore, be sure
to measure the engine oil pressure after warming up the engine.
3. Remove:
• Oil gallery bolt “1”
EWA12980
WARNING
The engine, muffler and engine oil are extremely hot.
4. Install:
• Oil pressure gauge “1”
• Adapter “2”
Pressure gauge
90890-03153
YU-03153
Oil pressure adapter H
90890-03139
ENGINE
NOTE:
Regarding the oil pressure as its own data may fluctuate depending on the oil temperature and viscosity, the oil pressure may fluctuate when measuring. The following data should be used only as a reference when measuring the engine oil pressure.
Engine oil pressure Possible causes
Below specification • Faulty oil pump
• Clogged oil filter
• Leaking oil passage
• Broken or damaged oil seal
Above specification • Leaking oil passage
• Faulty oil filter
• Oil viscosity too high
6. Install:
• Oil gallery bolt “1”
Oil gallery bolt
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
ECS2D1001
CAUTION:
Be careful to tighten too much.
5. Measure:
• Engine oil pressure
(at the following conditions)
Engine oil pressure
230 kPa
(2.3 kg/cm
2
, 2.3 bar, 32.71 psi)
Engine speed
Approx. 5,000 r/min
Engine oil temperature
100
°
C (212
°
F)
ET2D1004
ADJUSTING THE CLUTCH CABLE FREE
PLAY
1. Check
• Clutch cable free play “a”
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Clutch cable free play (at the end of the clutch lever)
10–15 mm (0.39–0.59 in)
3-14
ENGINE
2. Adjust
• Clutch cable free play
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
Handlebar side
a. Turn the adjusting dial “1” in direction “b” or
“c” until the specified clutch cable free play is obtained.
Direction “b”
Clutch cable free play is increased.
Direction “c”
Clutch cable free play is decreased.
NOTE:
If the specified clutch cable free play cannot be obtained on the handlebar side of the cable, use the adjusting nut on the engine side.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS20960
REPLACING THE AIR FILTER ELEMENT
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
2. Remove:
• Air filter case cover “1”
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
Engine side
a. Loosen the locknut “1” b. Turn the adjusting nut “2” in direction “a” or
“b” until the specified clutch cable free play is obtained.
Direction “a”
Clutch cable free play is increased.
Direction “b”
Clutch cable free play is decreased.
c. Tighten the locknuts.
Locknut
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
3. Check:
• Air filter element “1”
Damage
→
Replace.
NOTE:
• Replace the air filter element every 40000 km (2400 mi) of operation.
• The air filter needs more frequent service if you are riding in unusually wet or dusty areas.
3-15
4. Install:
• Air filter case cover
ECA14400
CAUTION:
Never operate the engine without the air filter element installed. Unfiltered air will cause rapid wear of engine parts and may damage the engine. Operating the engine without the air filter element will also affect throttle bodies synchronization, leading to poor engine performance and possible overheating.
NOTE:
When installing the air filter element into the air filter case cover, make sure that the sealing surfaces are aligned to prevent any air leaks.
5. Install:
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
EAS21010
CHECKING THE THROTTLE BODY JOINTS
The following procedure applies to all of the throttle body joints and intake manifolds.
1. Remove:
• Throttle bodies
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-
4.
2. Check:
• Throttle body joints “1”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
ENGINE
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
2. Check:
• Fuel hose “1”
• Vacuum hose “2”
• Breather hose “3”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
Loose connection
→
Connect properly.
NOTE:
Before removing the fuel hoses, place a few rags in the area under where it will be removed.
ECA14940
CAUTION:
Make sure the fuel tank breather hose is routed correctly.
3. Install:
• Throttle bodies
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-
4.
EAS21030
CHECKING THE FUEL LINE
The following procedure applies to all of the fuel, vacuum and breather hoses.
3-16
3. Install:
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
ECS2D002
CAUTION:
To install the fuel tank, check that the breather hose is not folded or pinched by the fuel tank.
EAS21070
CHECKING THE CRANKCASE BREATHER
HOSE
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
2. Check:
• Crankcase breather hose “1”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
Loose connection
→
Connect properly.
ECA13450
CAUTION:
Make sure the crankcase breather hose is routed correctly.
ENGINE
Exhaust pipe nut
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
Exhaust pipe and exhaust pipe bracket bolt
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
Exhaust pipe and muffler bolt
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
Muffler and rear footrest bracket bolt
48 Nm (4.8 m·kg, 35 ft·lb)
NOTE:
When installing the EXUP cables, make sure they are parallel and not twisted.
• Upper cable: White metal section “8”
• Lower cable: Black metal section “9”
3. Install:
• Fuel tank
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
ECS2D003
CAUTION:
To install the fuel tank, check that the breather hose is not folded or pinched by the fuel tank.
EAS21080
CHECKING THE EXHAUST SYSTEM
The following procedure applies to all of the exhaust pipes and gaskets.
1. Check:
• Exhaust pipe “1”
• Muffler “2”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Gaskets “3”
Exhaust gas leaks
→
Replace.
2. Check:
Tightening torque
• Exhaust pipe nut “4”
• Exhaust pipe and exhaust pipe bracket bolt
“5”
• Exhaust pipe and muffler bolt “6”
• Muffler and rear footrest bracket bolt “7”
ET2D1005
ADJUSTING THE EXUP CABLES
1. Remove:
• EXUP valve pulley cover “1”
3-17
ENGINE
2. Check:
• EXUP system operation
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Activate the diagnostic mode and select the diagnostic code number “53”.
Refer to «FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM» on page 8-31.
b. Set the engine stop switch to “ ”.
c. Check that the EXUP valve operates properly.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Check:
• EXUP cable free play (at the EXUP valve pulley) “a” and “b”
Maximum EXUP cable free play
(at the EXUP valve pulley) a: Less than 3 mm (0.12 in) b: Less than 3 mm (0.12 in)
4. Adjust:
• EXUP cable free play
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the main switch to “ON” b. Check the EXUP pulley position.
c. Loosen the locknut “1”.
d. Loosen the locknut “3” e. Turn the adjusting nut “2” in or out.
f.
Tighten the locknut.
g. Turn the adjusting nut “4” in or out.
h. Tighten the locknut.
EXUP cable locknut
6 Nm (0.6 m·kg, 4.3 ft·lb)
3-18
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Install:
• EXUP valve pulley cover
EXUP valve pulley cover bolt
14 Nm (1.4 m·kg, 10 ft·lb)
EAS28360
CHECKING THE EXUP SERVO MOTOR
1. Check:
• EXUP servo motor operation
Out of specification
→
Replace.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Check whether or not the EXUP valve is seized.
• Disconnect the EXUP cable and check that the EXUP valve is moved smoothly by hand.
• When the valve is not moved smoothly, repair or replace it.
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE EXUP
CABLES» on page 3-17.
b. When the EXUP valve is moved smoothly, replace the EXUP servo motor.
c. Perform the self-diagnosis mode and check the operation of EXUP valve by visual inspection (Code No: 53).
The operation should be carried out as 3second drive in the full open direction, 2second stop and 3-second drive in the full close direction.
d. Check that the EXUP servo motor pulley rotates several times.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS21110
CHECKING THE COOLANT LEVEL
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
NOTE:
• Place the vehicle on a suitable stand.
• Make sure the vehicle is upright.
2. Check:
ENGINE
• Coolant level
The coolant level should be between the maximum level mark “a” and minimum level mark “b”.
Below the minimum level mark
→
Add the recommended coolant to the proper level.
ECA13470
CAUTION:
• Adding water instead of coolant lowers the antifreeze content of the coolant. If water is used instead of coolant check, and if necessary, correct the antifreeze concentration of the coolant.
• Use only distilled water. However, if distilled water is not available, soft water may be used.
3. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then turn it off.
4. Check:
• Coolant level
NOTE:
Before checking the coolant level, wait a few minutes until it settles.
EAS21120
CHECKING THE COOLING SYSTEM
1. Check:
• Radiator “1”
• Radiator inlet hose “2”
• Radiator outlet hose “3”
• Oil cooler “4”
• Oil cooler inlet hose “5”
• Oil cooler outlet hose “6”
• Water jacket joint “7”
• Water jacket joint inlet hose “8”
• Water pump inlet pipe “9”
• Water pump outlet pipe “10”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1.
EAS21130
CHANGING THE COOLANT
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
2. Remove:
• Coolant reservoir tank
• Coolant reservoir hose
3. Disconnect:
• Coolant reservoir cap “1”
3-19
ENGINE
4. Drain:
• Coolant
(from the coolant reservoir)
5. Remove:
• Radiator cap “1”
EWA13030
WARNING
A hot radiator is under pressure. Therefore, do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Scalding hot fluid and steam may be blown out, which could cause serious injury. When the engine has cooled, open the radiator cap as follows:
Place a thick rag or a towel over the radiator cap and slowly turn the radiator cap counterclockwise toward the detent to allow any residual pressure to escape.
When the hissing sound has stopped, press down on the radiator cap and turn it counterclockwise to remove.
The following procedure applies to all of the coolant drain bolts and copper washers.
6. Remove:
• Coolant drain bolts “1”
(along with the copper washers)
7. Drain:
• Coolant
(from the water pump inlet pipe and outlet pipe)
8. Check:
• Copper washers “1”
9. Install:
• Coolant drain bolts “2”
Coolant drain bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·Kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
3-20
10. Install:
• Coolant reservoir tank
11. Connect:
• Coolant reservoir hose
12. Fill:
• Cooling system
(with the specified amount of the recommended coolant)
Recommended antifreeze
High-quality ethylene glycol antifreeze containing corrosion inhibitors for aluminum engines
Mixing ratio
1:1 (antifreeze: water)
Quantity
Total amount
2.25 L
(1.98 lmp qt, 2.38 US qt)
Coolant reservoir capacity
0.25 L
(0.22 lmp qt, 0.26 US qt)
Handling notes for coolant
Coolant is potentially harmful and should be handled with special care.
EWA13040
WARNING
• If coolant splashes in your eyes, thoroughly wash them with water and consult a doctor.
• If coolant splashes on your clothes, quickly wash it away with water and then with soap and water.
• If coolant is swallowed, induce vomiting and get immediate medical attention.
ECA13480
CAUTION:
• Adding water instead of coolant lowers the antifreeze content of the coolant. If water is used instead of coolant check, and if necessary, correct the antifreeze concentration of the coolant.
• Use only distilled water. However, if distilled water is not available, soft water may be used.
• If coolant comes into contact with painted surfaces, immediately wash them with water.
• Do not mix different types of antifreeze.
13. Install:
• Radiator cap
14. Fill:
• Coolant reservoir tank
(with the recommended coolant to the maximum level mark “a”)
ENGINE
NOTE:
Before checking the coolant level, wait a few minutes until the coolant has settled.
18. Install:
• Rider and passenger seat
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
15. Install:
• Coolant reservoir cap
16. Start the engine, warm it up for several minutes, and then stop it.
17. Check:
• Coolant level
Refer to «CHECKING THE COOLANT
LEVEL» on page 3-18.
3-21
EAS21140
CHASSIS
EAS21160
ADJUSTING THE FRONT DISC BRAKE
1. Adjust:
• Brake lever position
(distance “a” from the throttle grip to the brake lever)
NOTE:
• While pushing the brake lever forward, turn the adjusting dial “1” until the brake lever is in the desired position.
• Be sure to align the setting on the adjusting dial with the arrow mark “2” on the brake lever holder.
Direction “b”
Distance “a” is the largest.
Direction “c”
Distance “a” is the smallest.
EWA13060
WARNING
• After adjusting the brake lever position, make sure the pin on the brake lever holder is firmly inserted in the hole in the adjusting dial.
• A soft or spongy feeling in the brake lever can indicate the presence of air in the brake system. Before the vehicle is operated, the air must be removed by bleeding the brake system. Air in the brake system will considerably reduce in loss of control and possibly an accident. Therefore, check and if necessary, bleed the brake system.
ECA13490
CAUTION:
After adjusting the brake lever position, make sure there is no brake drag.
CHASSIS
EAS21190
ADJUSTING THE REAR DISC BRAKE
1. Adjust:
• Brake pedal position
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Loosen the locknut “1”.
b. Turn the adjusting bolt “2” in direction “a” or
“b” until the specified brake pedal position is obtained.
Direction “a”
Brake pedal is raised.
Direction “b”
Brake pedal is lowered.
EWA13070
WARNING
After adjusting the brake pedal position, check that the end of the adjusting bolt “c” is visible through the hole “d”.
c. Tighten the locknut “1” to specification.
Locknut
18 Nm (1.8 m·kg, 13 ft·lb)
EWA13050
WARNING
A soft or spongy feeling in the brake pedal can indicate the presence of air in the brake system. Before the vehicle is operated, the air must be removed by bleeding the brake system. Air in the brake system will considerably reduce braking performance.
ECA13510
CAUTION:
After adjusting the brake pedal position, make sure there is no brake drag.
3-22
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Adjust:
• Rear brake light switch
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE REAR BRAKE
LIGHT SWITCH» on page 3-24.
EAS21240
CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
NOTE:
• Place the vehicle on a suitable stand.
• Make sure the vehicle is upright.
2. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
Recommended brake fluid
DOT4
CHASSIS the brake fluid and could cause vapor lock.
ECA13540
CAUTION:
Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
NOTE:
In order to ensure a correct reading of the brake fluid level, make sure the top of the brake fluid reservoir is horizontal.
EAS21250
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE PADS
The following procedure applies to all of the brake pads.
1. Operate the brake.
2. Check:
• Front brake pad
Wear indicators “a” almost touch the brake disc
→
Replace the brake pads as a set.
Refer to «FRONT BRAKE» on page 4-20.
A. Front brake
B. Rear brake
EWA13090
WARNING
• Use only the designated brake fluid.
Other brake fluids may cause the rubber seals to deteriorate, causing leakage and poor brake performance.
• Refill with the same type of brake fluid that is already in the system. Mixing brake fluids may result in a harmful chemical reaction, leading to poor brake performance.
• When refilling, be careful that water does not enter the brake fluid reservoir. Water will significantly lower the boiling point of
3-23
EAS21260
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE PADS
The following procedure applies to all of the brake pads.
1. Operate the brake.
2. Check:
• Rear brake pad
Wear indicators “b” almost touch the brake disc
→
Replace the brake pads as a set.
Refer to «REAR BRAKE» on page 4-32.
CHASSIS
EAS21280
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE HOSES
The following procedure applies to all of the brake hoses and brake hose clamps.
1. Check:
• Brake hose “1”
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
2. Check:
• Brake hose clamp “2”
Loose Connection
→
Tighten the clamp bolt.
2. Check:
• Brake hose clamp “2”
Loose
→
Tighten the clamp bolt.
3. Hold the vehicle upright and apply the front brake several times.
4. Check:
• Brake hose
Brake fluid leakage
→
Replace the damaged hose.
Refer to «FRONT BRAKE» on page 4-20.
EAS21290
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE HOSE
1. Check:
• Brake hose “1”
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
3. Hold the vehicle upright and apply the rear brake several times.
4. Check:
• Brake hose
Brake fluid leakage
→
Replace the damaged hose.
Refer to «REAR BRAKE» on page 4-32.
EAS21330
ADJUSTING THE REAR BRAKE LIGHT
SWITCH
NOTE:
The rear brake light switch is operated by movement of the brake pedal. The rear brake light switch is properly adjusted when the brake light comes on just before the braking effect starts.
1. Check:
• Rear brake light operation timing
Incorrect
→
Adjust.
2. Adjust:
• Rear brake light operation timing
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Lifting the brake light switch, hold the main body “1” of the rear brake light switch so that it does not rotate and turn the adjusting
3-24
nut “2” in direction “a” or “b” until the rear brake light comes on at the proper time.
Direction “a”
Brake light comes on sooner.
Direction “b”
Brake light comes on later.
CHASSIS
c. Connect a clear plastic hose “1” tightly to the bleed screw “2”.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS21350
BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYS-
TEM
EWA13100
WARNING
Bleed the hydraulic brake system whenever:
• The system is disassembled.
• A brake hose is loosened, disconnected or replaced.
• The brake fluid level is very low.
• Brake operation is faulty.
NOTE:
• Be careful not to spill any brake fluid or allow the brake master cylinder reservoir or brake fluid reservoir to overflow.
• When bleeding the hydraulic brake system, make sure there is always enough brake fluid before applying the brake. Ignoring this precaution could allow air to enter the hydraulic brake system, considerably lengthening the bleeding procedure.
• If bleeding is difficult, it may be necessary to let the brake fluid settle for a few hours.
Repeat the bleeding procedure when the tiny bubbles in the hose have disappeared.
1. Bleed:
• Hydraulic brake system
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Fill the brake fluid reservoir to the proper level with the recommended brake fluid.
b. Install the diaphragm (brake master cylinder reservoir or brake fluid reservoir).
3-25
A. Front brake caliper
B. Rear brake caliper d. Place the other end of the hose into a container.
e. Slowly apply the brake several times.
f.
Fully pull the brake lever or fully press down the brake pedal and hold it in position.
g. Loosen the bleed screw.
NOTE:
Loosening the bleed screw will release the pressure and cause the brake lever to contact the throttle grip or the brake pedal to fully extend.
h. Tighten the bleed screw and then release the brake lever or brake pedal.
i.
Repeat steps (e) to (h) until all of the air bubbles have disappeared from the brake fluid in the plastic hose.
j.
Tighten the bleed screw to specification.
Bleed screw
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
k. Fill the brake fluid reservoir to the proper level with the recommended brake fluid.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
EWA13110
WARNING
After bleeding the hydraulic brake system, check the brake operation.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1006
ADJUSTING THE SHIFT PEDAL
1. Adjust:
• Shift pedal position
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Loosen both locknuts “1”.
b. Turn the shift rod “2” in direction “a” or “b” to obtain the correct shift pedal position.
Direction “a”
Shift pedal is raised.
Direction “b”
Shift pedal is lowered.
CHASSIS
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the rear wheel is elevated.
2. Spin the rear wheel several times and find the tightest position of drive chain.
3. Check:
• Drive chain slack “a”
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Drive chain slack
25–35 mm (0.98–1.38 in)
c. Tighten both locknuts.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1007
ADJUSTING THE DRIVE CHAIN SLACK
NOTE:
The drive chain slack must be checked at the tightest point on the chain.
ECA13550
CAUTION:
A drive chain that is too tight will overload the engine and other vital parts, and one that is too loose can skip and damage the swingarm or cause an accident. Therefore, keep the drive chain slack within the specified limits.
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EW2D1005
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
3-26
4. Adjust:
• Drive chain slack
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Loosen the wheel axle nut “1” b. Loosen both locknuts “2” c. Turn both adjusting bolts “3” in direction “a” or “b” until the specified drive chain slack is obtained.
Direction “a”
Drive chain is tightened.
Direction “b”
Drive chain is loosened.
NOTE:
To maintain the proper wheel alignment, adjust both sides evenly.
d. Tighten both locknuts to specification.
Locknut
16 Nm (1.6 m·kg, 12 ft·lb)
e. Tighten the wheel axle nut to specification.
Wheel axle nut
150 Nm (15 m·kg, 108 ft·lb)
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1008
LUBRICATING THE DRIVE CHAIN
The drive chain consists of many interacting parts. If the drive chain is not maintained properly, it will wear out quickly. Therefore, the drive chain should be serviced, especially when the vehicle is used in dusty areas.
This vehicle has a drive chain with small rubber O-rings between each side plate. Steam cleaning, high-pressure washing, certain solvents, and the use of a coarse brush can damage these O-rings. Therefore, use only kerosene to clean the drive chain. Wipe the drive chain dry and thoroughly lubricate it with engine oil or chain lubricant that is suitable for
O-ring chains. Do not use any other lubricants on the drive chain since they may contain solvents that could damage the O-rings.
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil or chain lubricant suitable for O-ring chains
EAS21510
CHECKING AND ADJUSTING THE STEER-
ING HEAD
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the front wheel is elevated.
2. Check:
• Steering head
Grasp the bottom of the front fork legs and gently rock the front fork.
Binding/looseness
→
Adjust the steering head.
3. Remove:
• Upper bracket
3-27
CHASSIS
Refer to «STEERING HEAD» on page 4-57.
4. Adjust:
• Steering head
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the lock washer “1”, the upper ring nut “2”, and the rubber washer “3”.
b. Loosen the lower ring nut “4” and then tighten it to specification with a steering nut wrench “5”.
NOTE:
Set the torque wrench at a right angle to the steering nut wrench.
Steering nut wrench
90890-01403
Spanner wrench
YU-33975
Lower ring nut (initial tightening torque)
52 Nm (5.2 m·kg, 38 ft·lb)
c. Loosen the lower ring nut “4” completely, and then tighten it to specification.
EWA13140
WARNING
Do not overtighten the lower ring nut.
Lower ring nut (final tightening torque)
18 Nm (1.8 m·kg, 13 ft·lb)
CHASSIS
d. Check the steering head for looseness or binding by turning the front fork all the way in both directions. If any binding is felt, remove the lower bracket and check the upper and lower bearings.
Refer to «STEERING HEAD» on page 4-57.
e. Install the rubber washer “3”.
f.
Install the upper ring nut “2”.
g. Finger tighten the upper ring nut “2”, then align the slots of both ring nuts. If necessary, hold the lower ring nut and tighten the upper ring nut until their slots are aligned.
h. Install the lock washer “1”.
NOTE:
Make sure the lock washer tabs “a” sit correctly in the ring nut slots “b”.
d. Hold the spring gauge at a 90
°
angle from the handlebar, pull the spring gauge, and then record the measurement when the handlebar starts to run.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Install:
• Upper bracket
Refer to «STEERING HEAD» on page 4-57.
6. Measure:
• Steering head tension
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
NOTE:
Make sure all of the cables and wires are properly routed.
a. Point the front wheel straight ahead.
b. Install a plastic locking tie “1” loosely around the end of the handlebar as shown.
c. Hook a spring gauge “2” onto the plastic locking tie.
Steering head tension
200–500 g
e. Repeat the above procedure on the opposite handlebar.
f.
If the steering head tension is out of specification (both handlebars should be within specification), remove the upper bracket and loosen or tighten the upper ring nut.
g. Reinstall the upper bracket and measure the steering head tension again as described above.
h. Repeat the above procedure until the steering head tension is within specification.
i.
Grasp the bottom of the front fork legs and gently rock the front fork.
Binding/looseness
→
Adjust the steering head.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS21530
CHECKING THE FRONT FORK
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
3-28
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
2. Check:
• Inner tube “1”
Damage/scratches
→
Replace.
• Oil seal “2”
Oil leakage
→
Replace.
3. Hold the vehicle upright and apply the front brake.
4. Check:
• Front fork operation
Push down hard on the handlebar several times and check if the front fork rebounds smoothly.
Rough movement
→
Repair.
Refer to «FRONT FORK» on page 4-48.
CHASSIS
EWA13150
WARNING
• Always adjust both front fork legs evenly.
Uneven adjustment can result in poor handling and loss of stability.
• Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
Spring preload
ECA13570
CAUTION:
• Grooves are provided to indicate the adjustment position.
• Never go beyond the maximum or minimum adjustment positions.
1. Adjust:
• Spring preload
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the adjusting bolt “1” in direction “a” or
“b”.
Direction “a”
Spring preload is increased
(suspension is harder).
Direction “b”
Spring preload is decreased
(suspension is softer).
Spring preload adjusting positions
Minimum
8
Standard
6
Maximum
0
EAS21580
ADJUSTING THE FRONT FORK LEGS
The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs.
NOTE:
Each front fork leg is equipped with a spring preload adjusting bolt, the right front fork leg is equipped with a reboumd damping force adjusting screw and left front fork leg with a compression damping force adjusting screw.
3-29
CHASSIS
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
Rebound damping (Right side front fork)
EC2D1006
CAUTION:
• Never go beyond the maximum or minimum adjustment positions.
• When assembling the front forks, be careful not to assemble them to the opposite position because there are two kinds of forks (for the rebound side and for the compression side).
1. Adjust:
• Rebound damping
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the adjusting screw “1” in direction “a” or “b”.
Direction “a” (turn in)
Rebound damping is increased
(suspension is harder).
Direction “b” (turn out)
Rebound damping is decreased
(suspension is softer).
Rebound damping adjusting positions
Minimum
26 clicks in direction: “b”*
Standard
15 clicks in direction: “b”*
Maximum
1 clicks in direction: “b”*
* With the adjusting screw fully turned-in direction “a”
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
Compression damping (Left side front fork)
ECA13590
CAUTION:
• Never go beyond the maximum or minimum adjustment positions.
• When assembling the front forks, be careful not to assemble them to the opposite position because there are two kinds of forks (for the rebound side and for the compression side).
1. Adjust:
• Compression damping
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the adjusting screw “1” in direction “a” or “b”.
Direction “a” (turn in)
Compression damping is increased
(suspension is harder).
Direction “b” (turn out)
Compression damping is decreased
(suspension is softer).
Compression damping adjusting positions
Minimum
26 clicks in direction: “b”*
Standard
5 clicks in direction: “b”*
Maximum
1 clicks in direction: “b”*
* With the adjusting screw fully turned-in direction “a”
3-30
CHASSIS
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS21620
ADJUSTING THE REAR SHOCK
ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
Spring preload
ECA13590
CAUTION:
Never go beyond the maximum or minimum adjustment positions.
1. Adjust:
• Spring preload
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Adjust the spring preload with the special wrench and extension bar included in the owner’s tool kit.
b. Turn the adjusting ring “1” in direction “a” or
“b”.
c. Align the desired position on the adjusting ring with the stopper “2”
Direction “a”
Spring preload is increased
(suspension is harder).
Direction “b”
Spring preload is decreased
(suspension is softer).
Spring preload adjusting positions
Minimum
1
Standard
3
Maximum
7
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
Rebound damping
ECA13590
CAUTION:
Never go beyond the maximum or minimum adjustment positions.
1. Adjust:
• Rebound damping
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the adjusting screw “1” in direction “a” or “b”.
Direction “a”
Rebound damping is increased
(suspension is harder).
Direction “b”
Rebound damping is decreased
(suspension is softer).
Rebound damping adjusting position
Minimum
12 clicks in direction: “b”*
Standard
6 clicks in direction: “b”*
Maximum
1 clicks in direction: “b”*
* With the adjusting screw fully turned-in direction “a”
3-31
CHASSIS
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS21650
CHECKING THE TIRES
The following procedure applies to both of the tires.
1. Check:
• Tire pressure
Out of specification
→
Regulate.
EWA13180
WARNING
• The tire pressure should only be checked and regulated when the tire temperature equals the ambient air temperature.
• The tire pressure and the suspension must be adjusted according to the total weight (including cargo, rider, passenger and accessories) and the anticipated riding speed.
• Operation of an overloaded vehicle could cause tire damage, an accident or an injury.
NEVER OVERLOAD THE VEHICLE.
3-32
Tire air pressure (measured on cold tires):
Basic weight (with oil and a full fuel tank)
FZ1-N
214kg (472lb)
FZ1-S
220kg (485lb)
Loading condition*
0–90 kg (0–198 lb)
Front
250 kPa (2.5 kg/cm
2,
2.5 bar, 36 psi)
Rear
290 kPa (2.9 kg/cm
2,
2.9 bar, 42 psi)
Loading condition*
FZ1-N
90–196 kg (198–432 lb)
FZ1-S
90–190 kg (198–419 lb)
Front
250 kPa (2.5 kg/cm
2,
2.5 bar, 36 psi)
Rear
290 kPa (2.9 kg/cm
2,
2.9 bar, 42 psi)
High speed riding:
Front
250 kPa (2.5 kg/cm
2,
2.5 bar, 36 psi)
Rear
290 kPa (2.9 kg/cm
2,
2.9 bar, 42 psi)
Maximum load*
FZ1-N
196 kg (432 lb)
FZ1-S
190 kg (419 lb)
* Total weight of rider, passenger, cargo and accessories.
EWA13190
WARNING
It is dangerous to ride with a worn-out tire.
When the tire tread reaches the wear limit, replace the tire immediately.
2. Check:
• Tire surfaces
Damage/wear
→
Replace the tire.
1. Tire tread depth
2. Side wall
3. Wear indicator
Minimum tire tread depth
1.6 mm (0.06 in)
EWA14080
WARNING
• Do not use a tubeless tire on a wheel designed only for tube tires to avoid tire failure and personal injury from sudden deflation.
• When using a tube tire, be sure to install the correct tube.
• Always replace a new tube tire and a new tube as a set.
• To avoid pinching the tube, make sure the wheel rim band and tube are centered in the wheel groove.
• Patching a punctured tube is not recommended. If it is absolutely necessary to do so, use great care and replace the tube as soon as possible with a good quality replacement.
CHASSIS
EWA14090
WARNING
After extensive tests, the tires listed below have been approved by Yamaha Motor Co.,
Ltd. for this model. The front and rear tires should always be by the same manufacturer and of the same design. No guarantee concerning handling characteristics can be given if a tire combination other than one approved by Yamaha is used on this vehicle.
Front tire
Size
120/70 ZR17 M/C (58W)
Manufacturer/model
DUNLOP/D221FA
MICHELIN/PILOT ROAD S
Rear tire
Size
190/50 ZR17 M/C (73W)
Manufacturer/model
DUNLOP/D221G
MICHELIN/PILOT ROAD D
EWA13210
WARNING
New tires have a relatively low grip on the road surface until they have been slightly worn. Therefore, approximately 100 km should be traveled at normal speed before any high-speed riding is done.
NOTE:
For tires with a direction of rotation mark “1”:
• Install the tire with the mark pointing in the direction of wheel rotation.
• Align the mark “2” with the valve installation point.
A. Tire
B. Wheel
Tube wheel
Tubeless wheel
Tube tire only
Tube or tubeless tire
3-33
EAS21670
CHECKING THE WHEELS
The following procedure applies to both of the wheels.
1. Check:
• Wheel
Damage/out-of-round
→
Replace.
EWA13260
WARNING
Never attempt to make any repairs to the wheel.
NOTE:
After a tire or wheel has been changed or replaced, always balance the wheel.
EAS21690
CHECKING AND LUBRICATING THE
CABLES
The following procedure applies to all of the inner and outer cables.
EWA13270
WARNING
Damaged outer cable may cause the cable to corrode and interfere with its movement.
Replace damaged outer cable and inner cables as soon as possible.
1. Check:
• Outer cable
Damage
→
Replace.
2. Check:
• Cable operation
Rough movement
→
Lubricate.
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil or a suitable cable lubricant
NOTE:
Hold the cable end upright and pour a few drops of lubricant into the cable sheath or use a suitable lubricating device.
EAS21700
LUBRICATING THE LEVERS
Lubricate the pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts of the levers.
Recommended lubricant
Lithium — soap — based grease
CHASSIS
EAS21710
LUBRICATING THE PEDAL
Lubricate the pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts of the pedal.
Recommended lubricant
Lithium — soap — based grease
EAS21720
LUBRICATING THE SIDESTAND
Lubricate the pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts of the sidestand.
Recommended lubricant
Lithium — soap — based grease
EAS21730
LUBRICATING THE CENTERSTAND (FZ1-S)
Lubricate the pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts of the centerstand.
Recommended lubricant
Lithium — soap — based grease
EAS21740
LUBRICATING THE REAR SUSPENSION
Lubricate the pivoting point and metal-to-metal moving parts of the rear suspension.
Recommended lubricant
Molybdenum disulfide grease
3-34
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
EAS21750
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
EAS21760
CHECKING AND CHARGING THE BATTERY
Refer to «ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS» on page 8-89.
EAS21770
CHECKING THE FUSES
Refer to «ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS» on page 8-89.
EAS21780
REPLACING THE HEADLIGHT BULBS
1. Remove:
• Headlight side cover bolts “1” (FZ1-N)
A. FZ1-N
B. FZ1-S
4. Remove:
• Headlight bulb cover “1” (FZ1-S)
2. Disconnect:
• Headlight sub-wire harness coupler “2”
(FZ1-N)
5. Remove:
• Headlight bulb holder “1”
3. Disconnect:
• Headlight coupler “1”
3-35
A. FZ1-N
B. FZ1-S
6. Remove:
• Headlight bulb “1”
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
EAS21800
ADJUSTING THE HEADLIGHT BEAM
1. Adjust:
• Headlight beam (vertically)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the adjusting screw “1” in direction “a” or “b”.
Direction “a”
Headlight beam is raised.
Direction “b”
Headlight beam is lowered.
A. FZ1-N
B. FZ1-S
EWA13320
WARNING
Since the headlight bulb gets extremely hot, keep flammable products and your hands away from the bulb until it has cooled down.
7. Install:
• Headlight bulb
Secure the new headlight bulb with the headlight bulb holder.
ECA13690
CAUTION:
Avoid touching the glass part of the headlight bulb to keep it free from oil, otherwise the transparency of the glass, the life of the bulb and the luminous flux will be adversely affected. If the headlight bulb gets soiled, thoroughly clean it with a cloth moistened with alcohol or lacquer thinner.
8. Install:
• Headlight bulb holder
9. Install:
• Headlight bulb cover
10. Connect:
• Headlight coupler
11. Connect:
• Headlight assembly coupler
12. Install:
• Headlight assembly bolts
3-36
A. FZ1-N
B. FZ1-S
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Adjust:
• Headlight beam (horizontally)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the adjusting screw “1” in direction “a” or “b”.
Direction “a”
Headlight beam moves to the left.
Direction “b”
Headlight beam moves to the right.
A. FZ1-N
B. FZ1-S
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3-37
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
CHASSIS
GENERAL CHASSIS
………………………………………………………………………… 4-1
REMOVING THE COVER…………………………………………………………….. 4-7
INSTALLING THE COVER …………………………………………………………… 4-7
FRONT WHEEL
……………………………………………………………………………….. 4-8
REMOVING THE FRONT WHEEL ………………………………………………. 4-10
CHECKING THE FRONT WHEEL……………………………………………….. 4-10
ADJUSTING THE FRONT WHEEL STATIC BALANCE ………………….. 4-11
INSTALLING THE FRONT WHEEL (DISC) …………………………………… 4-12
REAR WHEEL
……………………………………………………………………………….. 4-14
REMOVING THE REAR WHEEL (DISC) ……………………………………… 4-17
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL…………………………………………………. 4-17
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL DRIVE HUB ………………………………. 4-17
CHECKING AND REPLACING THE REAR WHEEL SPROCKET ……. 4-18
ADJUSTING THE REAR WHEEL STATIC BALANCE…………………….. 4-18
INSTALLING THE REAR WHEEL (DISC) …………………………………….. 4-18
FRONT BRAKE
……………………………………………………………………………… 4-20
INTRODUCTION ………………………………………………………………………. 4-25
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE DISCS …………………………………….. 4-25
REPLACING THE FRONT BRAKE PADS …………………………………….. 4-26
REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS ………………………………. 4-27
DISASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS ……………………… 4-27
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS ………………………………. 4-28
ASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS …………………………… 4-28
INSTALLING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS……………………………… 4-28
REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER………………… 4-29
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER ………………… 4-30
ASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER…………….. 4-30
INSTALLING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER ………………. 4-30
REAR BRAKE
……………………………………………………………………………….. 4-32
INTRODUCTION ………………………………………………………………………. 4-37
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE DISC…………………………………………. 4-37
REPLACING THE REAR BRAKE PADS ………………………………………. 4-37
REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER…………………………………… 4-38
DISASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER………………………….. 4-38
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER …………………………………… 4-39
ASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER……………………………….. 4-39
INSTALLING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER …………………………………. 4-40
REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER………………….. 4-41
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER ………………….. 4-41
ASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER ………………. 4-41
INSTALLING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER…………………. 4-41
HANDLEBAR
…………………………………………………………………………………. 4-43
4
REMOVING THE HANDLEBAR ………………………………………………….. 4-45
CHECKING THE HANDLEBAR…………………………………………………… 4-45
INSTALLING THE HANDLEBAR …………………………………………………. 4-45
FRONT FORK
………………………………………………………………………………… 4-48
REMOVING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ……………………………………….. 4-50
DISASSEMBLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ………………………………. 4-50
CHECKING THE FRONT FORK LEGS………………………………………… 4-51
ASSEMBLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ……………………………………. 4-52
INSTALLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS ………………………………………. 4-56
STEERING HEAD
…………………………………………………………………………… 4-57
REMOVING THE LOWER BRACKET ………………………………………….. 4-59
CHECKING THE STEERING HEAD ……………………………………………. 4-59
INSTALLING THE STEERING HEAD…………………………………………… 4-60
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
………………………………………….. 4-61
HANDLING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ………………………………. 4-63
DISPOSING OF A REAR SHOCK ABSORBER…………………………….. 4-63
REMOVING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY…………….. 4-63
CHECKING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY …………….. 4-63
CHECKING THE CONNECTING ARM AND RELAY ARM ……………… 4-64
INSTALLING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY …………… 4-64
SWINGARM
…………………………………………………………………………………… 4-65
REMOVING THE SWINGARM ……………………………………………………. 4-67
CHECKING THE SWINGARM ……………………………………………………. 4-67
INSTALLING THE SWINGARM …………………………………………………… 4-68
CHAIN DRIVE
………………………………………………………………………………… 4-69
REMOVING THE DRIVE CHAIN …………………………………………………. 4-70
CHECKING THE DRIVE CHAIN …………………………………………………. 4-70
CHECKING THE DRIVE SPROCKET ………………………………………….. 4-71
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL SPROCKET ………………………………. 4-71
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL DRIVE HUB ………………………………. 4-71
INSTALLING THE DRIVE CHAIN ………………………………………………… 4-71
EAS21830
GENERAL CHASSIS
Removing the seat and battery
GENERAL CHASSIS
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
Job/Parts to remove
Passenger seat
Rider seat
Battery band
Battery cover
Battery negative lead
Battery positive lead
Battery
Battery seat
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-1
Removing the headlight and meter assembly (FZ1-N)
GENERAL CHASSIS
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
9
10
Job/Parts to remove
Headlight side cover bolt (left and right)
Headlight coupler
Headlight sub-wire harness coupler
Headlight assembly
Headlight bracket
Headlight side cover (left and right)
Meter cover
Meter coupler
Meter assembly
Headlight and meter stay
2
1
1
2
Q’ty
4
1
1
1
1
1
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-2
Removing the front cowling (FZ1-S)
GENERAL CHASSIS
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
Job/Parts to remove
Inner panel
Headlight assembly coupler
Meter coupler
Front cowling assembly
Rear view mirror
Cowling stay
Meter assembly
Headlight unit
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty
2
1
1
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-3
Removing the rear fender (FZ1-N)
GENERAL CHASSIS
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
6
7
4
5
8
1
2
3
Licence plate light lead coupler
Turn signal light lead coupler
Mud guard assembly
Rear fender
Tail/brake light lead coupler
Tail cover
Rear fender bracket
Tail/brake light
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-4
Removing the rear fender (FZ1-S)
GENERAL CHASSIS
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
9
10
Licence plate light lead coupler
Turn signal light lead coupler
Mud guard assembly
Rear fender
Tail/brake light lead coupler
Tail/brake light cover
Rear fender side cover (left and right)
Rear fender bracket
Tail/brake light
Tail cover
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
2
1
1 Disconnect.
1
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-5
Removing the air filter case
GENERAL CHASSIS
7
8
5
6
2
3
4
Order
1
Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Fuel tank
Intake air temperature sensor lead coupler
Intake air temperature sensor
Air filter case cover
Air filter
Funnel
Air filter case
Air induction system hose
Crankcase breather hose
Q’ty
1
Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Disconnect.
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-6
EAS21840
REMOVING THE COVER
1. Remove:
• Tail cover
• Rear fender
NOTE:
To remove the quick fastener, push its center with a screwdriver, then pull the fastener out.
GENERAL CHASSIS
EAS21850
INSTALLING THE COVER
1. Install:
• Rear fender
• Tail cover
NOTE:
To install the quick fastener, push its pin so that it protrudes from the fastener head, then insert the fastener into the cover and push the pin “a” in with screwdriver. Make sure that the pin is flush with the fastener’s head.
4-7
EAS21870
FRONT WHEEL
Removing the front wheel and brake discs
FRONT WHEEL
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
7
8
Job/Parts to remove
Brake hose holder (left and right)
Front brake caliper (left and right)
Front wheel axle pinch bolt
Front wheel axle
Collar (left and right)
Dust cover
Front wheel
Front brake disc (left and right)
Q’ty
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
2
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-8
Disassembling the front wheel
FRONT WHEEL
Order
1
2
3
Job/Parts to remove
Oil seal (left and right)
Wheel bearing (left and right)
Spacer
Q’ty
2
2
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
4-9
EAS21900
REMOVING THE FRONT WHEEL
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the front wheel is elevated.
2. Remove:
• Left brake caliper
• Right brake caliper
Refer to «FRONT BRAKE» on page 4-20.
NOTE:
Do not apply the brake lever when removing the brake calipers.
3. Elevate:
• Front wheel
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the front wheel is elevated.
4. Loosen:
• Front wheel axle pinch bolt
5. Remove:
• Front wheel axle
• Front wheel
EAS21920
CHECKING THE FRONT WHEEL
1. Check:
• Wheel axle
Roll the wheel axle on a flat surface.
Bends
→
Replace.
EWA13460
WARNING
Do not attempt to straighten a bent wheel axle.
2. Check:
• Tire
• Front wheel
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
FRONT WHEEL
Refer to «CHECKING THE TIRES» on page
3-32 and «CHECKING THE WHEELS» on page 3-34.
3. Measure:
• Radial wheel runout “1”
• Lateral wheel runout “2”
Over the specified limits
→
Replace.
Radial wheel runout limit
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
Lateral wheel runout limit
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
4. Check:
• Wheel bearings
Front wheel turns roughly or is loose
→
Replace the wheel bearings.
• Oil seals
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
5. Replace:
• Wheel bearings
• Oil seals
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Clean the outside of the front wheel hub.
b. Remove the oil seals “1” with a flat-head screwdriver.
NOTE:
To prevent damaging the wheel, place a rag “2” between the screwdriver and the wheel surface.
4-10
c. Remove the wheel bearings “3” with a general bearing puller.
FRONT WHEEL
• Adjust the front wheel static balance with the brake disc installed.
1. Remove:
• Balancing weight(s)
2. Find:
• Front wheel’s heavy spot
NOTE:
Place the front wheel on a suitable balancing stand.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Spin the front wheel.
b. When the front wheel stops, put an “X
1
” mark at the bottom of the wheel.
d. Install the new wheel bearings and oil seals in the reverse order of disassembly.
ECA14130
CAUTION:
Do not contact the wheel bearing inner race
“1” or balls “2”. Contact should be made only with the outer race “3”.
NOTE:
Use a socket “4” that matches the diameter of the wheel bearing outer race and oil seal.
c. Turn the front wheel 90
°
so that the “X
1
” mark is positioned as shown.
d. Release the front wheel.
e. When the wheel stops, put an “X
2
” mark at the bottom of the wheel.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS21970
ADJUSTING THE FRONT WHEEL STATIC
BALANCE
NOTE:
• After replacing the tire, wheel or both, the front wheel static balance should be adjusted.
4-11
f.
Repeat steps (c) through (e) several times until all the marks come to rest at the same spot.
g. The spot where all the marks come to rest is the front wheel’s heavy spot “X”.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Adjust:
• Front wheel static balance
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
a. Install a balancing weight “1” onto the rim exactly opposite the heavy spot “X”.
NOTE:
Start with the lightest weight.
b. Turn the front wheel 90
°
so that the heavy spot is positioned as shown.
FRONT WHEEL
EAS22000
INSTALLING THE FRONT WHEEL (DISC)
The following procedure applies to both of the brake discs.
1. Lubricate:
• Wheel axle
• Oil seal lips
Recommended lubricant
Lithium-soap-based grease
2. Lift the wheel up between the fork legs.
3. Insert the wheel axle.
NOTE:
Install the tire and wheel with the mark “1” pointing in the direction of wheel rotation.
c. If the heavy spot does not stay in that position, install a heavier weight.
d. Repeat steps (b) and (c) until the front wheel is balanced.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Check:
• Front wheel static balance
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the front wheel and make sure it stays at each position shown.
4. Lower the front wheel so that it is on the ground.
5. Tighten:
• Wheel axle
Wheel axle nut
72 Nm (7.2 m·kg, 52 ft·lb)
• Wheel axle pinch bolt
Wheel axle pinch bolt
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
ECA14140
CAUTION:
Before tightening the front wheel axle, push down hard on the handlebar several times and check if the front fork rebounds smoothly.
6. Install:
• Brake caliper
Brake caliper bolt
40 Nm (4.0 m·kg, 29 ft·lb)
b. If the front wheel does not remain stationary at all of the positions, rebalance it.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4-12
EWA13490
WARNING
Make sure the brake cable is routed properly.
NOTE:
Make sure that there is enough space between the brake pads before installing the brake calipers onto the brake discs.
FRONT WHEEL
4-13
EAS22020
REAR WHEEL
Removing the rear wheel
REAR WHEEL
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
9
10
Job/Parts to remove
Rear brake caliper
Locknut (left and right)
Adjusting bolt (left and right)
Wheel axle nut
Washer
Rear wheel axle
Adjusting block (left)
Adjusting block (right)
Rear wheel
Brake caliper bracket
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
2
2
1
1
1
Loosen.
Loosen.
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-14
Removing the brake disc and rear wheel sprocket
REAR WHEEL
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
9
Job/Parts to remove
Rear brake disc
Rear wheel sprocket
Coller (left and right)
Dust cover
Oil seal
Bearing
Rear wheel drive hub
Rear wheel drive hub damper
Rear wheel
1
1
2
1
Q’ty
1
1
2
6
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-15
Disassembling the rear wheel
REAR WHEEL
Order
1
2
3
4
5
6
Coller
Bearing
Spacer
Oil seal
Circlip
Bearing
Job/Parts to remove Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
4-16
REAR WHEEL
EAS22040
REMOVING THE REAR WHEEL (DISC)
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the rear wheel is elevated.
2. Remove:
• Brake caliper “1”
NOTE:
Do not depress the brake pedal when removing the brake caliper.
5. Remove:
• Left collar “1”
• Rear wheel drive hub “2”
• Rear wheel drive hub damper
• Right collar
3. Loosen:
• Locknut “1”
• Adjusting bolt “2”
4. Remove:
• Wheel axle nut “1”
• Wheel axle “2”
• Rear wheel
NOTE:
Push the rear wheel forward and remove the drive chain from the rear wheel sprocket.
4-17
EAS22090
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL
1. Check:
• Wheel axle
• Rear wheel
• Wheel bearings
• Oil seals
Refer to «FRONT WHEEL» on page 4-8.
2. Check:
• Tire
• Rear wheel
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
Refer to «CHECKING THE TIRES» on page
3-32 and «CHECKING THE WHEELS» on page 3-34.
3. Measure:
• Radial wheel runout
• Lateral wheel runout
Refer to «FRONT WHEEL» on page 4-8.
EAS22110
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL DRIVE HUB
1. Check:
• Rear wheel drive hub “1”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Rear wheel drive hub dampers “2”
REAR WHEEL
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS22120
CHECKING AND REPLACING THE REAR
WHEEL SPROCKET
1. Check:
• Rear wheel sprocket
More than 1/4 tooth “a” wear
→
Replace the rear wheel sprocket.
Bent teeth
→
Replace the rear wheel sprocket.
b. Correct
1. Drive chain roller
2. Rear wheel sprocket
2. Replace:
• Rear wheel sprocket
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the self-locking nuts and the rear wheel sprocket.
b. Clean the rear wheel drive hub with a clean cloth, especially the surfaces that contact the sprocket.
c. Install the new rear wheel sprocket.
Rear wheel sprocket self-locking nut
100 Nm (10 m·kg, 72 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Tighten the self-locking nuts in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS22150
ADJUSTING THE REAR WHEEL STATIC
BALANCE
NOTE:
• After replacing the tire, wheel or both, the rear wheel static balance should be adjusted.
• Adjust the rear wheel static balance with the brake disc and rear wheel drive hub installed.
1. Adjust:
• Rear wheel static balance
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE FRONT
WHEEL STATIC BALANCE» on page 4-11.
EAS22160
INSTALLING THE REAR WHEEL (DISC)
1. Lubricate:
• Wheel axle
• Wheel bearings
• Oil seal lips
Recommended lubricant
Lithium-soap-based grease
2. Adjust:
• Drive chain slack
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE DRIVE CHAIN
SLACK» on page 3-26.
Drive chain slack
25–35 mm (0.98–1.38 in)
3. Tighten:
• Wheel axle nut
• Brake caliper bolts
Wheel axle nut
150 Nm (15 m·kg, 108 ft·lb)
Brake caliper bolt (front)
27 Nm (2.7 m·kg, 20 ft·lb)
Brake caliper bolt (rear)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
4-18
EWA13500
WARNING
Make sure the brake hose is routed properly.
REAR WHEEL
4-19
EAS22210
FRONT BRAKE
Removing the front brake pads
FRONT BRAKE
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
Job/Parts to remove
Brake hose holder
Front brake caliper
Brake pad clip
Brake pad pin
Brake pad spring
Brake pad
Bleed screw
2
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
2
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-20
Removing the front brake master cylinder
FRONT BRAKE
Order Job/Parts to remove
Brake fluid
7
8
9
10
11
4
5
6
1
2
3
Right rearview mirror (FZ1-N)
Brake master cylinder reservoir cap
Brake master cylinder reservoir diaphragm holder
Brake master cylinder diaphragm
Brake lever
Front brake light switch lead coupler
Front brake light switch
Union bolt
Copper washer
Master cylinder bracket
Master cylinder assembly
4-21
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Drain.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAU-
LIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-
25.
1
1
1
Disconnect.
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Disassembling the front brake master cylinder
FRONT BRAKE
Order
1
2
Job/Parts to remove
Brake master cylinder kit
Brake master cylinder body
Q’ty
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
4-22
Removing the front brake calipers
FRONT BRAKE
Order Job/Parts to remove
Brake fluid
3
4
1
2
Union bolt
Copper washer
Brake hose
Brake caliper
1
1
1
2
Q’ty Remarks
Drain.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAU-
LIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-
25.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-23
Disassembling the front brake calipers
FRONT BRAKE
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
7
Job/Parts to remove
Brake pad clip
Brake pad pin
Brake pad spring
Brake pad
Brake caliper piston
Brake caliper piston seal
Bleed screw
Q’ty
2
1
4
8
1
2
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
4-24
FRONT BRAKE
EAS22220
INTRODUCTION
EWA14100
WARNING
Disc brake components rarely require disassembly. Therefore, always follow these preventive measures:
• Never disassemble brake components unless absolutely necessary.
• If any connection on the hydraulic brake system is disconnected, the entire brake system must be disassembled, drained, cleaned, properly filled, and bled after reassembly.
• Never use solvents on internal brake components.
• Use only clean or new brake fluid for cleaning brake components.
• Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
• Avoid brake fluid coming into contact with the eyes as it can cause serious injury.
• FIRST AID FOR BRAKE FLUID ENTERING
THE EYES:
• Flush with water for 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention.
EAS22240
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE DISCS
The following procedure applies to both brake discs.
1. Remove:
• Front wheel
Refer to «FRONT WHEEL» on page 4-8.
2. Check:
• Brake disc
Damage/galling
→
Replace.
3. Measure:
• Brake disc deflection
Out of specification
→
Correct the brake disc deflection or replace the brake disc.
Brake disc deflection limit
0.1 mm (0.004 in)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the front wheel is elevated.
b. Before measuring the front brake disc deflection, turn the handlebar to the left or right to ensure that the front wheel is stationary.
c. Remove the brake caliper.
d. Hold the dial gauge at a right angle against the brake disc surface.
e. Measure the deflection 1.5 mm (0.06 in) below the edge of the brake disc.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Measure:
• Brake disc thickness
Measure the brake disc thickness at a few different locations.
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Brake disc thickness limit
4.0 mm (0.16 in)
5. Adjust:
• Brake disc deflection
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the brake disc.
b. Rotate the brake disc by one bolt hole.
c. Install the brake disc.
4-25
NOTE:
Tighten the brake disc bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
Brake disc bolt
18 Nm (1.8 m·kg, 13 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
FRONT BRAKE
Brake pad lining thickness
(inner)
4.5 mm (0.18 in)
Limit
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
Brake pad lining thickness
(outer)
4.5 mm (0.18 in)
Limit
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
d. Measure the brake disc deflection.
e. If out of specification, repeat the adjustment steps until the brake disc deflection is within specification.
f.
If the brake disc deflection cannot be brought within specification, replace the brake disc.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
6. Install:
• Front wheel
Refer to «FRONT WHEEL» on page 4-8.
EAS22270
REPLACING THE FRONT BRAKE PADS
The following procedure applies to both brake calipers.
NOTE:
When replacing the brake pads, it is not necessary to disconnect the brake hose or disassemble the brake caliper.
1. Measure:
• Brake pad wear limit “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the brake pads as a set.
2. Install:
• Brake pads
• Brake pad spring
NOTE:
Always install new brake pads and a brake pad spring as a set.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect a clear plastic hose “1” tightly to the bleed screw “2”. Put the other end of the hose into an open container.
4-26
b. Loosen the bleed screw and push the brake caliper pistons into the brake caliper with your finger.
c. Tighten the bleed screw.
Bleed screw
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
d. Install new brake pads and a new brake pad spring.
NOTE:
The arrow mark “a” on the brake pad spring must point in the direction of disc rotation.
FRONT BRAKE
NOTE:
Before removing the brake caliper, drain the brake fluid from the entire brake system.
1. Remove:
• Union bolt “1”
• Copper washers “2”
• Brake hose “3”
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Install:
• Brake pad pins
• Brake pad clips
• Brake caliper
Brake caliper bolt
40 Nm (4.0 m·kg, 29 ft·lb)
4. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
NOTE:
Put the end of the brake hose into a container and pump out the brake fluid carefully.
EAS22360
DISASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE
CALIPERS
The following procedure applies to both of the brake calipers.
1. Remove:
• Brake caliper pistons “1”
• Brake caliper piston seals “2”
5. Check:
• Brake lever operation
Soft or spongy feeling
→
Bleed the brake system.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
EAS22300
REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS
The following procedure applies to both of the brake calipers.
4-27
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Secure the brake caliper pistons with a piece of wood “a”.
b. Blow compressed air into the brake hose joint opening “b” to force out the left side pistons from the brake caliper.
EWA13570
WARNING
• Never try to pry out the brake caliper pistons.
• Do not loosen the bolts “3”.
FRONT BRAKE
c. Remove the brake caliper piston seals.
d. Repeat the previous steps to force out the right side pistons from the brake caliper.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS22390
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE CALIPERS
Recommended brake component replacement schedule
Brake pads
Piston seals
If necessary
Every two years
Brake hoses
Brake fluid
Every four years
Every two years and whenever the brake is disassembled
1. Check:
• Brake caliper pistons “1”
Rust/scratches/wear
→
Replace the brake caliper pistons.
• Brake caliper cylinders “2”
Scratches/wear
→
Replace the brake caliper assembly.
• Brake caliper body “3”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace the brake caliper assembly.
• Brake fluid delivery passages
(brake caliper body)
Obstruction
→
Blow out with compressed air.
EWA13600
WARNING
Whenever a brake caliper is disassembled, replace the piston seals.
4-28
EAS22410
ASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE CALI-
PERS
EWA13620
WARNING
• Before installation, all internal brake components should be cleaned and lubricated with clean or new brake fluid.
• Never use solvents on internal brake components as they will cause the piston seals to swell and distort.
• Whenever a brake caliper is disassembled, replace the brake caliper piston seals.
Recommended brake fluid
DOT4
EAS22440
INSTALLING THE FRONT BRAKE CALI-
PERS
The following procedure applies to both of the brake calipers.
1. Install:
• Brake caliper “1”
(temporarily)
• Copper washers
• Brake hose “2”
• Union bolt “3”
Brake hose union bolt
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
EWA13530
WARNING
Proper brake hose routing is essential to insure safe vehicle operation. Refer to
«CABLE ROUTING» on page 2-39.
ECA14170
CAUTION:
When installing the brake hose onto the brake caliper “1”, make sure the brake pipe
“a” touches the projection “b” on the brake caliper.
FRONT BRAKE
ECA13540
CAUTION:
Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
5. Bleed:
• Brake system
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
6. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
2. Remove:
• Brake caliper
3. Install:
• Brake pads
• Brake pad spring
• Brake pad pin
• Brake pad clips
• Brake caliper
• Brake hose holder
Brake caliper bolt
40 Nm (4.0 m·kg, 29 ft·lb)
Brake hose holder bolt
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
Refer to «REPLACING THE FRONT
BRAKE PADS» on page 4-26.
4. Fill:
• Brake master cylinder reservoir
(with the specified amount of the recommended brake fluid)
Recommended fluid
DOT4
EWA13090
WARNING
• Use only the designated brake fluid.
Other brake fluids may cause the rubber seals to deteriorate, causing leakage and poor brake performance.
• Refill with the same type of brake fluid that is already in the system. Mixing brake fluids may result in a harmful chemical reaction, leading to poor brake performance.
• When refilling, be careful that water does not enter the brake fluid reservoir. Water will significantly lower the boiling point of the brake fluid and could cause vapor lock.
4-29
7. Check:
• Brake lever operation
Soft or spongy feeling
→
Bleed the brake system.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
EAS22490
REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
NOTE:
Before removing the front brake master cylinder, drain the brake fluid from the entire brake system.
1. Disconnect:
• Brake switch couplers “1”
(from the brake switch)
2. Remove:
• Union bolt “1”
• Copper washers “2”
• Brake hose “3”
NOTE:
To collect any remaining brake fluid, place a container under the master cylinder and the end of the brake hose.
FRONT BRAKE
EAS22520
ASSEMBLING THE FRONT BRAKE MAS-
TER CYLINDER
EWA13520
WARNING
• Before installation, all internal brake components should be cleaned and lubricated with clean or new brake fluid.
• Never use solvents on internal brake components.
Recommended fluid
DOT4
EAS22530
INSTALLING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
1. Install:
• Brake master cylinder “1”
• Brake master cylinder bracket “2”
Brake master cylinder bracket bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• Install the brake master cylinder holder with the “UP” mark “a” facing up.
• Align the end of the brake master cylinder holder with the punch mark “b” on the handlebar.
• First, tighten the upper bolt, then the lower bolt.
• There should be more than 11 mm (0.43 in) for clearance between the right handlebar switch and the brake master cylinder bracket.
Also, the punch mark should be seen.
EAS22500
CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
1. Check:
• Brake master cylinder
Damage/scratches/wear
→
Replace.
• Brake fluid delivery passages
(brake master cylinder body)
Obstruction
→
Blow out with compressed air.
2. Check:
• Brake master cylinder kit
Damage/scratches/wear
→
Replace.
3. Check:
• Brake master cylinder reservoir
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Brake master cylinder reservoir diaphragm
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
4. Check:
• Brake hoses
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
4-30
2. Install:
• Copper washers
• Brake hose
• Union bolt
Brake hose union bolt
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
EWA13530
WARNING
Proper brake hose routing is essential to insure safe vehicle operation. Refer to
«CABLE ROUTING» on page 2-39.
NOTE:
• While holding the brake hose, tighten the union bolt as shown.
• Turn the handlebar to the left and right to make sure the brake hose does not touch other parts (e.g., wire harness, cables, leads). Correct if necessary.
EC2D1004
CAUTION:
Attach the brake hose so that its angle is
23
°
to 33
°
against the straight line in parallel with the ceiling plane of the master cylinder.
FRONT BRAKE
• When refilling, be careful that water does not enter the brake master cylinder reservoir. Water will significantly lower the boiling point of the brake fluid and could cause vapor lock.
ECA13540
CAUTION:
Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
4. Bleed:
• Brake system
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
5. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
3. Fill:
• Brake master cylinder reservoir
(with the specified amount of the recommended brake fluid)
Recommended fluid
DOT4
EWA13540
WARNING
• Use only the designated brake fluid.
Other brake fluids may cause the rubber seals to deteriorate, causing leakage and poor brake performance.
• Refill with the same type of brake fluid that is already in the system. Mixing brake fluids may result in a harmful chemical reaction, leading to poor brake performance.
4-31
6. Check:
• Brake lever operation
Soft or spongy feeling
→
Bleed the brake system.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
EAS22550
REAR BRAKE
Removing the rear brake pads
REAR BRAKE
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
Job/Parts to remove
Screw plug
Brake pad pin
Rear brake caliper
Brake pad shim
Brake pad
Bleed screw
Brake pad spring
1
1
4
2
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-32
Removing the rear brake master cylinder
REAR BRAKE
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
8
9
10
11
Order Job/Parts to remove
Brake fluid
Brake fluid reservoir cap
Brake fluid reservoir diaphragm holder
Brake fluid reservoir diaphragm
Brake fluid reservoir tank
Brake fluid reservoir hose
Hose joint
Bushing
Union bolt
Copper washer
Brake hose
Brake master cylinder
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
Q’ty Remarks
Drain.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAU-
LIC BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-
25.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-33
Disassembling the rear brake master cylinder
REAR BRAKE
Order
1
2
3
4
Job/Parts to remove
Brake master cylinder kit
Hose joint
Bushing
Brake master cylinder body
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
4-34
Removing the rear brake caliper
REAR BRAKE
Order
1
2
3
4
Job/Parts to remove
Union bolt
Copper washer
Brake hose
Barke caliper
Q’ty
1
2
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-35
Disassembling the rear brake caliper
REAR BRAKE
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
7
8
Job/Parts to remove
Screw plug
Brake pad pin
Brake pad
Brake pad shim
Brake pad spring
Brake caliper piston
Brake caliper piston seal
Bleed screw
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
2
4
2
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
4-36
REAR BRAKE
EAS22560
INTRODUCTION
EWA14100
WARNING
Disc brake components rarely require disassembly. Therefore, always follow these preventive measures:
• Never disassemble brake components unless absolutely necessary.
• If any connection on the hydraulic brake system is disconnected, the entire brake system must be disassembled, drained, cleaned, properly filled, and bled after reassembly.
• Never use solvents on internal brake components.
• Use only clean or new brake fluid for cleaning brake components.
• Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
• Avoid brake fluid coming into contact with the eyes as it can cause serious injury.
• FIRST AID FOR BRAKE FLUID ENTERING
THE EYES:
• Flush with water for 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention.
EAS22570
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE DISC
1. Remove:
• Rear wheel
Refer to «REAR WHEEL» on page 4-14.
2. Check:
• Brake disc
Damage/galling
→
Replace.
3. Measure:
• Brake disc deflection
Out of specification
→
Correct the brake disc deflection or replace the brake disc.
Refer to «CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE
DISCS» on page 4-25.
Brake disc deflection limit
0.15 mm (0.0059 in)
4. Measure:
• Brake disc thickness
Measure the brake disc thickness at a few different locations.
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Refer to «CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE
DISCS» on page 4-25.
4-37
Brake disc thickness limit
4.5 mm (0.18 in)
5. Adjust:
• Brake disc deflection
Refer to «CHECKING THE FRONT BRAKE
DISCS» on page 4-25.
Brake disc bolt
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
6. Install:
• Rear wheel
Refer to «REAR WHEEL» on page 4-14.
EAS22580
REPLACING THE REAR BRAKE PADS
NOTE:
When replacing the brake pads, it is not necessary to disconnect the brake hose or disassemble the brake caliper.
1. Measure:
• Brake pad wear limit “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the brake pads as a set.
Brake pad lining thickness
(inner)
6.0 mm (0.24 in)
Limit
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
Brake pad lining thickness
(outer)
6.0 mm (0.24 in)
Limit
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
2. Install:
• Brake pad shims
(onto the brake pads)
• Brake pads
• Brake pad spring
NOTE:
Always install new brake pads, brake pad shims, and a brake pad spring as a set.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
a. Connect a clear plastic hose “1” tightly to the bleed screw “2”. Put the other end of the hose into an open container.
REAR BRAKE
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
b. Loosen the bleed screw and push the brake caliper pistons into the brake caliper with your finger.
c. Tighten the bleed screw.
Bleed screw
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
d. Install a new brake pad shim “3” onto each new brake pad “4”.
e. Install new brake pads and a new brake pad spring “5”.
5. Check:
• Brake pedal operation
Soft or spongy feeling
→
Bleed the brake system.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
EAS22590
REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER
NOTE:
Before disassembling the brake caliper, drain the brake fluid from the entire brake system.
1. Remove:
• Union bolt “1”
• Copper washers “2”
• Brake hose “3”
NOTE:
Put the end of the brake hose into a container and pump out the brake fluid carefully.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Install:
• Brake caliper
• Brake pad pin
• Screw plug
Brake caliper bolt (front)
27 Nm (2.7 m·kg, 20 ft·lb)
Brake caliper bolt (rear)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
4. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
EAS22600
DISASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE CALI-
PER
1. Remove:
• Brake caliper piston “1”
• Brake caliper piston seals “2”
4-38
REAR BRAKE
Scratches/wear
→
Replace the brake caliper assembly.
• Brake caliper body “3”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace the brake caliper assembly.
• Brake fluid delivery passages
(brake caliper body)
Obstruction
→
Blow out with compressed air.
EWA13610
WARNING
Whenever a brake caliper is disassembled, replace the brake caliper piston seals.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Secure the brake caliper pistons with a piece of wood “a”.
b. Blow compressed air into the brake hose joint opening “b” to force out the piston from the brake caliper.
EWA13550
WARNING
• Cover the brake caliper piston with a rag.
Be careful not to get injured when the piston is expelled from the brake caliper.
• Never try to pry out the brake caliper piston.
2. Check:
• Brake caliper bracket “1”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
c. Remove the brake caliper piston seals.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS22640
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER
Recommended brake component replacement schedule
Brake pads If necessary
Piston seals
Brake hoses
Brake fluid
Every two years
Every four years
Every two years and whenever the brake is disassembled
1. Check:
• Brake caliper pistons “1”
Rust/scratches/wear
→
Replace the brake caliper pistons.
• Brake caliper cylinders “2”
4-39
EAS22650
ASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER
EWA13620
WARNING
• Before installation, all internal brake components should be cleaned and lubricated with clean or new brake fluid.
• Never use solvents on internal brake components as they will cause the piston seals to swell and distort.
• Whenever a brake caliper is disassembled, replace the brake caliper piston seals.
Recommended fluid
DOT4
EAS22670
INSTALLING THE REAR BRAKE CALIPER
1. Install:
• Brake caliper “1”
(temporarily)
• Copper washers “2”
• Brake hose “3”
• Union bolt “4”
Brake hose union bolt
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
EWA13530
WARNING
Proper brake hose routing is essential to insure safe vehicle operation. Refer to
«CABLE ROUTING» on page 2-39.
EC2D1010
CAUTION:
When installing the brake hose onto the brake caliper, make sure the brake pipe “a” touches the projection “b” on the brake caliper.
2. Remove:
• Brake caliper
3. Install:
• Brake pad shims
• Brake pads
• Brake pad spring
• Brake pad pin
• Screw plug
REAR BRAKE
• Brake caliper
Refer to «REPLACING THE REAR BRAKE
PADS» on page 4-37.
Brake caliper bolt (front)
27 Nm (2.7 m·kg, 20 ft·lb)
Brake caliper bolt (rear)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
4. Fill:
• Brake fluid reservoir
(with the specified amount of the recommended brake fluid)
Recommended fluid
DOT4
EWA13090
WARNING
• Use only the designated brake fluid.
Other brake fluids may cause the rubber seals to deteriorate, causing leakage and poor brake performance.
• Refill with the same type of brake fluid that is already in the system. Mixing brake fluids may result in a harmful chemical reaction, leading to poor brake performance.
• When refilling, be careful that water does not enter the brake fluid reservoir. Water will significantly lower the boiling point of the brake fluid and could cause vapor lock.
ECA13540
CAUTION:
Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
5. Bleed:
• Brake system
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
6. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
4-40
7. Check:
• Brake pedal operation
Soft or spongy feeling
→
Bleed the brake system.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
EAS22700
REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
1. Remove:
• Union bolt “1”
• Copper washers “2”
• Brake hose “3”
NOTE:
To collect any remaining brake fluid, place a container under the master cylinder and the end of the brake hose.
EAS22720
CHECKING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
1. Check:
• Brake master cylinder
Damage/scratches/wear
→
Replace.
• Brake fluid delivery passages
(brake master cylinder body)
Obstruction
→
Blow out with compressed air.
2. Check:
• Brake master cylinder kit
Damage/scratches/wear
→
Replace.
4-41
REAR BRAKE
3. Check:
• Brake fluid reservoir
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Brake fluid reservoir diaphragm
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
4. Check:
• Brake hose
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS22730
ASSEMBLING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
EWA13520
WARNING
• Before installation, all internal brake components should be cleaned and lubricated with clean or new brake fluid.
• Never use solvents on internal brake components.
Recommended fluid
DOT4
ET2D1022
INSTALLING THE REAR BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER
1. Install:
• Copper washers
• Brake hose “1”
• Union bolt “2”
Brake hose union bolt
30 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 22 ft·lb)
EW2D1004
WARNING
Proper brake hose routing is essential to insure safe vehicle operation.
Refer to «CABLE ROUTING» on page 2-39.
EC2D1005
CAUTION:
When installing the brake hose onto the brake master cylinder, make sure the brake pipe touches the projection “a” as shown.
REAR BRAKE
2. Fill:
• Brake fluid reservoir
(with the specified amount of the recommended brake fluid)
Recommended fluid
DOT4
EW2D1005
WARNING
• Use only the designated brake fluid.
Other brake fluids may cause the rubber seals to deteriorate, causing leakage and poor brake performance.
• Refill with the same type of brake fluid that is already in the system. Mixing brake fluids may result in a harmful chemical reaction, leading to poor brake performance.
• When refilling, be careful that water does not enter the brake fluid reservoir. Water will significantly lower the boiling point of the brake fluid and could cause vapor lock.
EC2D1010
CAUTION:
Brake fluid may damage painted surfaces and plastic parts. Therefore, always clean up any spilt brake fluid immediately.
3. Bleed:
• Brake system
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
4. Check:
• Brake fluid level
Below the minimum level mark “a”
→
Add the recommended brake fluid to the proper level.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL» on page 3-23.
5. Check:
• Brake pedal operation
Soft or spongy feeling
→
Bleed the brake system.
Refer to «BLEEDING THE HYDRAULIC
BRAKE SYSTEM» on page 3-25.
6. Adjust:
• Brake pedal position
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE REAR DISC
BRAKE» on page 3-22.
7. Adjust:
• Rear brake light operation timing
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE REAR BRAKE
LIGHT SWITCH» on page 3-24.
4-42
EAS22840
HANDLEBAR
Removing the handlebar
HANDLEBAR
Order Job/Parts to remove
Front cowling (FZ1-S)
9
10
11
12
13
14
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
Rear view mirror (FZ1-N)
Front brake light switch connector
Front master cylinder bracket
Front brake master cylinder assembly
Right handlebar switch
Throttle cable housing
Throttle cable
Grip end
Throttle grip
Clutch cable
Handlebar grip
Left handlebar switch
Clutch lever holder
Upper handlebar holder
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
2
2 Disconnect.
4-43
Removing the handlebar
HANDLEBAR
Order
15
16
Job/Parts to remove
Handlebar
Lower handlebar holder
Q’ty
1
2
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-44
EAS22860
REMOVING THE HANDLEBAR
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
2. Remove:
• Handlebar grip “1”
NOTE:
Blow compressed air between the handlebar and the handlebar grip, and gradually push the grip off the handlebar.
HANDLEBAR
EAS22930
INSTALLING THE HANDLEBAR
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
2. Install:
• Lower handlebar holders “1”
NOTE:
Temporarily tighten the nuts “2”.
3. Remove:
• Throttle cable housing “1”
• Throttle grip “2”
NOTE:
While removing the throttle cable housing, pull back the rubber cover “3”.
3. Install:
• Handlebar “1”
• Upper handlebar holder “2”
Upper handlebar holder bolt
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
ECA14250
CAUTION:
• First, tighten the bolts on the front side of the handlebar holder, and then on the rear side.
• Turn the handlebar all the way to the left and right. If there is any contact with the fuel tank, adjust the handlebar position.
NOTE:
• The upper handlebar holder should be installed with the punch mark “a” facing forward.
• Align the match marks “b” on the handlebar with the upper surface of the lower handlebar holders.
EAS22880
CHECKING THE HANDLEBAR
1. Check:
• Handlebar
Bends/cracks/damage
→
Replace.
EWA13690
WARNING
Do not attempt to straighten a bent handlebar as this may dangerously weaken it.
4-45
4. Tighten:
• Lower handlebar holder nuts
Lower handlebar holder nut
32 Nm (3.2 m·kg, 23 ft·lb)
5. Install:
• Clutch lever holder “1”
• Clutch cable
NOTE:
Align the slit in the clutch lever holder with the punch mark «a» in the handlebar.
HANDLEBAR
Grip end
26 Nm (2.6 m·kg, 19 ft·lb)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Apply a thin coat of rubber adhesive onto the left end of the handlebar.
b. Side the handlebar grip over the left end of the handlebar.
c. Wipe off any excess rubber adhesive with a clean rag.
EW2D1007
WARNING
Do not touch the handlebar grip until the rubber adhesive has fully dried.
NOTE:
There should be 1–3 mm (0.04–0.12 in) of clearance “a” between the handlebar grip and the grip end.
6. Install:
• Left handlebar switch
NOTE:
Align the projections “a” on the left handlebar switch with the hole “b” in the handlebar.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
8. Install:
• Throttle grip “1”
• Throttle cable hoousing “2”
• Throttle cables
• Grip end “3”
NOTE:
Align the projections “a” on the throttle cable housing with the hole “b” in the handlebar.
7. Install:
• Handlebar grip “1”
• Grip end “2”
4-46
9. Install:
• Right handlebar switch
NOTE:
• Align the projections «a» on the handlebar switch with the holes «b» in the handlebar.
• Threre should be 1–3 mm (0.04–0.12 in) of clearance “c” between the handlebar grip and the grip end.
10. Install:
• Front brake master cylinder assembly
• Front brake master cylinder holder “1”
Front brake master cylinder bracket bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
ECS2D1010
CAUTION:
• Install the brake master cylinder bracket with the “UP” mark facing up.
• First, tighten the upper bolt, then the lower bolt.
NOTE:
Align the end of the brake master cylinder holder with the punch mark “a” on the handlebar.
11. Adjust:
• Throttle cable free play
4-47
HANDLEBAR
EAS22950
FRONT FORK
Removing the front fork legs
FRONT FORK
Order Job/Parts to remove
Front wheel
Front brake calipers
1
2
3
4
5
Front fender
Cap bolt
Upper bracket pinch bolt
Lower bracket pinch bolt
Front fork leg
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «CHECKING THE TIRES» on page 3-32 and «CHECKING THE
WHEELS» on page 3-34.
Loosen.
Loosen.
Loosen.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-48
Disassembling the front fork legs
FRONT FORK
11
12
13
14
7
8
9
10
15
16
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
Job/Parts to remove
Cap bolt
O-ring
Damper adjusting rod
Nut
Washer
Spacer
Fork spring
Dust seal
Oil seal clip
Oil seal
Washer
Damper rod assembly bolt
Copper washer
Damper rod assembly
Inner tube
Outer tube
4-49
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
EAS22970
REMOVING THE FRONT FORK LEGS
The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs.
NOTE:
Each front fork leg is eqipped with a spring preload adjusting bolt, the right fork leg is equipped with a rebound damping force adjusting screan and left front fprk is equipped with a compression damping force adjusting screw. Pay attention not to mistake the right and left.
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the front wheel is elevated.
2. Loosen:
• Upper bracket pinch bolts “1”
• Cap bolt “2”
• Lower bracket pinch bolts “3”
EWA13640
WARNING
Before loosening the upper and lower bracket pinch bolts, support the front fork leg.
FRONT FORK
• Nut “3”
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Press down on the spacer with the fork spring compressor “4”.
b. Install the rod holder “5” between the nut
“3” and the spacer “2”.
Fork spring compressor
90890-01441
YM-01441
Rod holder
90890-01434
Damper rod holder double ended
YM-01434
NOTE:
Use the side of the rod holder that is marked
“B”.
c. Hold the spring preload adjusting bolt “6” and loosen the nut “3”.
d. Remove the cap bolt.
e. Remove the rod holder and fork spring compressor.
f.
Remove the spacer and nut.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Drain:
• Fork oil
NOTE:
Stroke the damper rod “1” several times while draining the fork oil.
3. Remove:
• Front fork leg
EAS22990
DISASSEMBLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS
The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs.
1. Remove:
• Cap bolt “1”
(from the damper adjusting rod)
• Spacers “2”
4-50
FRONT FORK
A. Compression side
B. Rebound side
NOTE:
While holding the damper rod with the damper rod holder “1”, loosen the damper rod assembly bolt.
Damper rod holder
90890-01423
Damping rod holder
YM-01423
3. Remove:
• Oil seal clip “1”
(with a flat-head screwdriver)
ECA14180
CAUTION:
Do not scratch the inner tube.
4. Remove:
• Damper rod assembly bolt
• Damper rod assembly
EC2D1080
CAUTION:
For the damper rod assembly, the right side is used for the rebound operation and left side for the compression. Pay attention not to mistake the right and left.
NOTE:
The left side (for the compression) damper rod assembly has the four holes of oil path, unlike the right side.
EAS23010
CHECKING THE FRONT FORK LEGS
The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs.
1. Check:
• Inner tube “1”
• Outer tube “2”
Bends/damage/scratches
→
Replace.
EWA13650
WARNING
Do not attempt to straighten a bent inner tube as this may dangerously weaken it.
4-51
2. Measure:
• Spring free length “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Spring free length
243.5 mm (9.59 in)
Limit
238.6 mm (9.39 in)
3. Check:
• Damper rod “1”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
Obstruction
→
Blow out all of the oil passages with compressed air.
• Damper adjusting rod
Bends/damage
→
Replace.
ECA14200
CAUTION:
• The front fork leg has a built-in damper adjusting rod and a very sophisticated internal construction, which are particularly sensitive to foreign material.
• When disassembling and assembling the front fork leg, do not allow any foreign material to enter the front fork.
FRONT FORK
• Damper rod assembly bolt
• Copper washer
EC2D1080
CAUTION:
For the damper rod assembly, the right side is used for the rebound operation and left side for the compression. Pay attention not to mistake the right and left.
NOTE:
The left side (for the compression) damper rod assembly has the four holes of oil path, unlike the right side.
ECA14210
CAUTION:
Allow the damper rod assembly to slide slowly down the inner tube “2” until it protrudes from the bottom of the inner tube.
Be careful not to damage the inner tube.
EAS23030
ASSEMBLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS
The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs.
EWA13660
WARNING
• Make sure the oil levels in both front fork legs are equal.
• Uneven oil levels can result in poor handling and a loss of stability.
NOTE:
• When assembling the front fork leg, be sure to replace the following parts:
— Oil seal
— Dust seal
• Before assembling the front fork leg, make sure all of the components are clean.
1. Install:
• Damper rod assembly “1”
• Inner tube “2”
4-52
2. Lubricate:
• Inner tube’s outer surface
Recommended oil
Suspension oil 01 or equivalent
3. Tighten:
• Damper rod assembly bolt “1”
Damper rod assembly bolt
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
NOTE:
While holding the damper rod assembly with the damper rod holder “2”, tighten the damper rod assembly bolt.
Damper rod holder
90890-01423
Damping rod holder
YM-01423
FRONT FORK
4. Install:
• Dust seal “1”
• Oil seal clip “2”
• Oil seal “3”
• Washer “4”
ECA14220
CAUTION:
Make sure the numbered side of the oil seal faces up.
NOTE:
• Before installing the oil seal, lubricate its lips with lithium-soap-based grease.
• Lubricate the outer surface of the inner tube with fork oil.
• Before installing the oil seal, cover the top of the front fork leg with a plastic bag to protect the oil seal during installation.
6. Install:
• Oil seal clip “1”
NOTE:
Adjust the oil seal clip so that it fits into the outer tube’s groove.
7. Install:
• Dust seal “1”
(with the fork seal driver weight “2”)
Fork seal driver
90890-01442
Adjustable fork seal driver (36–
46 mm)
YM-01442
5. Install:
• Oil seal “1”
(with the fork seal driver “2”)
Fork seal driver
90890-01442
Adjustable fork seal driver (36–
46 mm)
YM-01442
4-53
8. Install:
• Rod puller “1”
• Rod puller attachment (M 10) “2”
(onto the damper rod “3”)
FRONT FORK
Rod puller
90890-01437
Rod puller attachment (M10)
90890-01436
9. Fill:
• Front fork leg
(with the specified amount of the recommended fork oil)
Quantity
545.0 cm
3
(18.43 US oz) (19.18 lmp.oz)
Recommended oil
Suspension oil 01 or equivalent
ECA14230
CAUTION:
• Be sure to use the recommended fork oil.
Other oils may have an adverse effect on front fork performance.
• When disassembling and assembling the front fork leg, do not allow any foreign material to enter the front fork.
NOTE:
Be sure to bleed the front fork.
10. After filling the front fork leg, slowly stroke the damper rod “1” up and down (at least ten times) to distribute the fork oil.
NOTE:
Be sure to stroke the damper rod slowly because the fork oil may spurt out.
11. Before measuring the fork oil level, wait ten minutes until the oil has settled and the air bubbles have dispersed.
NOTE:
Be sure to bleed the front fork leg of any residual air.
12. Measure:
• Front fork leg oil level “a”
(from the top of the outer tube, with the outer tube fully compressed and without the fork spring)
Out of specification
→
Correct.
Front fork leg oil level
91 mm (3.58 in)
13. Install:
• Nut “1”
• Fork spring “2”
• Spacer “3”
• Damper adjusting rod “4”
• Cap bolt “5”
4-54
FRONT FORK
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the rod puller and adapter.
b. Install the nut.
c. Install the fork spring and spacer.
NOTE:
Install the spring with the smaller pitch “a” facing up “A”.
f.
Remove the rod puller and the rod puller attachment.
g. Install the nut “1” and position it as specified “b”.
Distance “b”
12 mm (0.47 in)
d. Press down in the spacer with the fork spring compressor “1” e. Pull up the rod puller and install the rod holder “2” between the damper adjusting rod locknut “3” and the spacer “4”.
NOTE:
Use the side of the rod holder that is marked
“B”.
Fork spring compressor
90890-01441
YM-01441
Rod holder
90890-01434
Damper rod holder double ended
YM-01434
h. Set the cap bolt distance “c” to specification.
Distance “c”
13 mm (0.51 in)
i.
Inatall the damper adjusting rod and cap bolt, and then finger tighten the cap bolt.
j.
Hold the cap bolt and tighten the damper adjusting rod locknut to specification.
Damper adjusting rod locknut
15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb)
k. Remove the rod holder and fork spring compressor.
4-55
FRONT FORK
EW2D1003
WARNING
• The fork spring is compressed.
• Always use a new cap bolt O-ring.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS23050
INSTALLING THE FRONT FORK LEGS
The following procedure applies to both of the front fork legs.
NOTE:
Each front fork leg is eqipped with a spring preload adjusting bolt, the right fork leg is equipped with a rebound damping force adjusting screw and left front fork is equipped with a compression damping force adjusting screw. Pay attension not to mistake the right and left.
1. Install:
• Front fork leg
Temporarily tighten the upper and lower bracket pinch bolts.
NOTE:
Make sure the inner fork tube is flush with the top of the handlebar holder.
2. Tighten:
• Lower bracket pinch bolt “1”
Lower bracket pinch bolt
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
• Cap bolt “2”
Cap bolt
23 Nm (2.3 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
• Upper bracket pinch bolt “3”
Upper bracket pinch bolt
26 Nm (2.6 m·kg, 19 ft·lb)
EWA13680
WARNING
Make sure the brake hoses are routed properly.
3. Adjust:
• Spring preload
• Rebound damping
• Compression damping
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE FRONT FORK
LEGS» on page 3-29.
4-56
EAS23090
STEERING HEAD
Removing the lower bracket
STEERING HEAD
Order
1
2
3
4
Job/Parts to remove
Front wheel
Front brake calipers
Front cowling (FZ1-S)
Headlight and meter assembly (FZ1-N)
Handlebar
Front fork legs
Main switch connector
Steering stem nut
Upper bracket
Front brake hose joint
1
1
2
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «FRONT WHEEL» on page
4-8.
Refer to «FRONT BRAKE» on page
4-20.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «HANDLEBAR» on page 4-
43.
Refer to «FRONT FORK» on page 4-
48.
Disconnect.
4-57
Removing the lower bracket
STEERING HEAD
15
16
17
18
19
11
12
13
14
Order
5
6
7
8
9
10
Job/Parts to remove
Front brake hose joint bracket
Horn
Horn bracket
Lock washer
Upper ring nut
Rubber washer
Lower ring nut
Lower bracket
Lower bearing
Lower bearing dust seal
Lower bearing inner race
Bearing cover
Upper bearing inner race
Upper bearing
Bearing outer race
4-58
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
STEERING HEAD
Damage/pitting
→
Replace.
EAS23110
REMOVING THE LOWER BRACKET
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
2. Remove:
• Upper ring nut “1”
• Rubber washer
• Lower ring nut “2”
• Lower bracket
NOTE:
Hold the lower ring nut with the ring nut wrench
“3”, and then remove the upper ring nut with the steering nut wrench “4”.
Ring nut wrench
90890-01268
Spanner wrench
YU-01268
Steering nut wrench
90890-01403
Spanner wrench
YU-33975
EWA13730
WARNING
Securely support the lower bracket so that there is no danger of it falling.
3. Replace:
• Bearings
• Bearing races
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the bearing races from the steering head pipe with a long rod “1” and hammer.
b. Remove the bearing race from the lower bracket with a floor chisel “2” and hammer.
c. Install a new rubber seal and new bearing races.
ECA14270
CAUTION:
If the bearing race is not installed properly, the steering head pipe could be damaged.
NOTE:
• Always replace the bearings and bearing races as a set.
• Whenever the steering head is disassembled, replace the rubber seal.
EAS23120
CHECKING THE STEERING HEAD
1. Wash:
• Bearings
• Bearing races
Recommended cleaning solvent
Kerosene
2. Check:
• Bearings “1”
• Bearing races “2”
4-59
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Check:
• Upper bracket
• Lower bracket
(along with the steering stem)
Bends/cracks/damage
→
Replace.
EAS23140
INSTALLING THE STEERING HEAD
1. Lubricate:
• Upper bearing
• Lower bearing
• Bearing races
Recommended lubricant
Lithium-soap-based grease
2. Install:
• Lower ring nut “1”
• Rubber washer “2”
• Upper ring nut “3”
• Lock washer “4”
Refer to «INSTALLING THE STEERING
HEAD» on page 4-60.
STEERING HEAD
Steering stem nut
113 Nm (11.3 m·kg, 82 ft·lb)
3. Install:
• Front brake hose joint bracket
• Front brake hose joint
4. Install:
• Upper bracket
• Steering stem nut
NOTE:
Temporarily tighten the steering stem nut.
5. Install:
• Front fork legs
Refer to «FRONT FORK» on page 4-48.
NOTE:
Temporarily tighten the upper and lower bracket pinch bolts.
6. Tighten:
• Steering stem nut
4-60
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
EAS23160
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
Removing the rear shock absorber assembly
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
8
9
10
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Side cover (left and right)
Brake fluid reservoir tank bolt
Self-locking nut/bolt
Self-locking nut/bolt
Self-locking nut/bolt
Self-locking nut/bolt/collar
Rear shock absorber assembly
Oil seal/bearing/collar
Collar/self-locking nut/bolt
Connecting arm
Oil seal/bearing/collar
Relay arm
4-61
1/1
1/1
1/1
1/1/1
1
6/3/3
1/1/1
2
2/1/1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «REAR BRAKE» on page 4-
32.
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
Removing the rear shock absorber assembly
Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-62
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
EAS23180
HANDLING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
EWA13740
WARNING
This rear shock absorber contains highly compressed nitrogen gas. Before handling the rear shock absorber, read and make sure you understand the following information. The manufacturer cannot be held responsible for property damage or personal injury that may result from improper handling of the rear shock absorber.
• Do not tamper or attempt to open the rear shock absorber.
• Do not subject the rear shock absorber to an open flame or any other source of high heat. High heat can cause an explosion due to excessive gas pressure.
• Do not deform or damage the rear shock absorber in any way. Rear shock absorber damage will result in poor damping performance.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the rear wheel is elevated.
2. Remove:
• Rear shock absorber assembly lower bolt
“1”
• Relay arm-to-swingarm bolt “2”
• Connecting arm-to-relay arm bolt “3”
NOTE:
While removing the rear shock absorber assembly lower bolt, hold the swigarm so that it does not drop down.
EAS23190
DISPOSING OF A REAR SHOCK
ABSORBER
1. Gas pressure must be released before disposing of a rear shock absorber. To release the gas pressure, drill a 2–3mm (0.079–
0.118 in) hole through the rear shock absorber at a point 15–20 mm (0.59–0.79 in) from its end as shown.
EWA13760
WARNING
Wear eye protection to prevent eye damage from released gas or metal chips.
3. Remove:
• Rear shock absorber assembly upper bolt
“1”
• Rear shock absorber assembly
NOTE:
Raise the swigarm and then remove the rear shock absorber assembly from between the swingarm.
EAS23210
REMOVING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
4-63
EAS23240
CHECKING THE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY
1. Check:
• Rear shock absorber rod
Bends/damage
→
Replace the rear shock absorber assembly.
• Rear shock absorber
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
Gas leaks/oil leaks
→
Replace the rear shock absorber assembly.
• Spring
Damage/wear
→
Replace the rear shock absorber assembly.
• Bushings
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
• Dust seals
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
• Bolts
Bends/damage/wear
→
Replace.
3. Tighten:
• Rear shock absorber assembly upper nut
Rear shock absorber assembly upper nut
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
• Rear shock absorber assembly lower nut
Rear shock absorber assembly lower nut
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
• Relay-arm-to-swingarm nut
EAS23260
CHECKING THE CONNECTING ARM AND
RELAY ARM
1. Check:
• Connecting arms “1”
• Relay arm “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
Relay-arm-to-swingarm nut
44 Nm (4.4 m·kg, 32 ft·lb)
2. Check:
• Bearings
• Oil seals
Damage/pitting
→
Replace.
3. Check:
• Coller
Damage/scratches
→
Replace.
EAS23300
INSTALLING THE REAR SHOCK
ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
1. Lubricate:
• Spacers
• Bearings
Recommended lubricant
Lithium-soap-based grease
2. Install:
• Rear shock absorber assembly
NOTE:
When installing the rear shock absorber assembly, lift up the swingarm.
4-64
EAS23330
SWINGARM
Removing the swingarm
SWINGARM
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rear wheel
Rear brake caliper
Rear shock absorber
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
Drive sprocket
Rear fender cover
Drive chain guard
Brake hose holder
Drive chain adjusting bolt/locknut
Pivot shaft nut/washer
Pivot shaft
Swingarm
4-65
2/2
1/1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «REAR WHEEL» on page 4-
14.
Refer to «REAR BRAKE» on page 4-
32.
Refer to «REAR SHOCK
ABSORBER ASSEMBLY» on page
4-61.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Removing the swingarm
SWINGARM
Order
8
9
10
11
12
Job/Parts to remove
Drive chain
Dust cover
Drive chain guide
Spacer
Bearing
Q’ty
1
2
1
1
2
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-66
EAS23350
REMOVING THE SWINGARM
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the rear wheel is elevated.
2. Remove:
• Relay arm-to-swingarm bolt “1”
• Connecting arm bolt “2”
• Rear shock absorber assembly lower bolt
“3”
NOTE:
When removing the rear shock absorber assembly lower bolt, hold the swingarm so that it does not drop down.
SWINGARM
If swingarm vertical movement is not smooth or if there is binding, check the spacers, bearings, washers, and dust covers.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS23360
CHECKING THE SWINGARM
1. Check:
• Swingarm
Bends/cracks/damage
→
Replace.
2. Check:
• Pivot shaft
Roll the pivot shaft on a flat surface.
Bends
→
Replace.
EWA13770
WARNING
Do not attempt to straighten a bent pivot shaft.
3. Measure:
• Swingarm side play
• Swingarm vertical movement
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Measure the tightening torque of the pivot shaft nut.
Pivot shaft nut
105 Nm (10.5 m·kg, 76 ft·lb)
b. Measure the swingarm side play “A” by moving the swingarm from side to side.
c. If the swingarm side play is out of specification, check the spacers, bearings, washers, and dust covers.
Swingarm side play (at the end of the swingarm)
1.0 mm (0.04 in)
d. Check the swingarm vertical movement “B” by moving the swingarm up and down.
4-67
3. Wash:
• Pivot shaft
• Dust covers
• Spacer
• Washers
• Bearings
Recommended cleaning solvent
Kerosene
4. Check:
• Dust covers “1”
• Spacer “2”
• Bearings “3”
Damage/pitting
→
Replace.
SWINGARM
5. Check:
• Connecting arms “1”
• Relay arm “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
6. Check:
• Bearings “3”
• Oil seals “4”
Damage/pitting
→
Replace.
7. Check:
• Collars “5”
Damage/scratches
→
Replace.
3. Install:
• Rear shock absorber assembly
• Rear wheel
Refer to «INSTALLING THE REAR SHOCK
ABSORBER ASSEMBLY» on page 4-64 and «INSTALLING THE REAR WHEEL
(DISC)» on page 4-18.
4. Adjust:
• Drive chain slack
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE DRIVE CHAIN
SLACK» on page 3-26.
Drive chain slack
25–35 mm (0.98–1.38 in)
EAS23380
INSTALLING THE SWINGARM
1. Lubricate:
• Bearings
• Spacers
• Dust covers
• Pivot shaft
Recommended lubricant
Lithium-soap-based grease
2. Install:
• Swingarm
• Pivot shaft “1”
• Pivot shaft nut “2”
4-68
EAS23400
CHAIN DRIVE
Removing the drive chain
CHAIN DRIVE
Order Job/Parts to remove
Drive sprocket
1
2
Drive chain guard
Drive chain
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
1
1
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
4-69
CHAIN DRIVE
EAS23410
REMOVING THE DRIVE CHAIN
1. Stand the vehicle on a level surface.
EWA13120
WARNING
Securely support the vehicle so that there is no danger of it falling over.
NOTE:
Place the vehicle on a suitable stand so that the rear wheel is elevated.
2. Remove:
• Drive chain
(with the drive chain cutter)
NOTE:
Only cut the drive chain if it or the swingarm is to be replaced.
EAS23440
CHECKING THE DRIVE CHAIN
1. Measure:
• Measure the dimension between 15-links on the inner side “a” and outer side “b” of the roller and calculate the dimension between pin centers.
• Dimension “c” between pin centers = (Inner dimension “a” + Outer dimension “b”)/2
• 15-link section “c” of the drive chain
Out of specification
→
Replace the drive chain, front drive sprocket and rear drive sprocket as a set.
15-link drive chain section limit
(maximum)
239.3 mm (9.42 in)
NOTE:
• While measuring the 15-link section, push down on the drive chain to increase its tension.
• Perform this measurement at two or three different places.
2. Check:
• Drive chain
Stiffness
→
Clean and lubricate or replace.
3. Clean:
• Drive chain
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Wipe the drive chain with a clean cloth.
b. Put the drive chain in kerosene and remove any remaining dirt.
c. Remove the drive chain from the kerosene and completely dry it.
ECA14290
CAUTION:
• This vehicle has a drive chain with small rubber O-rings “1” between the drive chain side plates. Never use high-pressure water or air, steam, gasoline, certain solvents (e.g., benzine), or a coarse brush to clean the drive chain. High-pressure methods could force dirt or water into the drive chain’s internals, and solvents will deteriorate the O-rings. A coarse brush can also damage the O-rings. Therefore, use only kerosene to clean the drive chain.
• Do not soak the drive chain in kerosene for more than ten minutes, otherwise the
O-rings can be damaged.
4-70
CHAIN DRIVE
• Drive sprocket
More than 1/4 tooth “a” wear
→
Replace the drive chain sprockets as a set.
Bent teeth
→
Replace the drive chain sprockets as a set.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Check:
• O-rings “1”
Damage
→
Replace the drive chain.
• Drive chain rollers “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the drive chain.
• Drive chain side plates “3”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the drive chain.
Cracks
→
Replace the drive chain and make sure the battery breather hose is properly routed away from the drive chain and below the swingarm.
b. Correct
1. Drive chain roller
2. Drive chain sprocket
EAS23470
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL SPROCKET
Refer to «CHECKING AND REPLACING THE
REAR WHEEL SPROCKET» on page 4-18.
ET2D1031
CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL DRIVE HUB
Refer to «CHECKING THE REAR WHEEL
DRIVE HUB» on page 4-17.
EAS28800
INSTALLING THE DRIVE CHAIN
1. Lubricate:
• Drive chain
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil or chain lubricant suitable for O-ring chains
2. Install:
• Drive sprocket
• Lock washer
• Drive sprocket nut
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-
2.
Drive sprocket nut
85 Nm (8.5 m·kg, 61 ft·lb)
5. Lubricate:
• Drive chain
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil or chain lubricant suitable for O-ring chains
EAS23460
CHECKING THE DRIVE SPROCKET
1. Check:
4-71
ENGINE
ENGINE REMOVAL
………………………………………………………………………….. 5-2
INSTALLING THE ENGINE ………………………………………………………….. 5-8
CAMSHAFTS
…………………………………………………………………………………. 5-10
REMOVING THE CAMSHAFTS ………………………………………………….. 5-12
CHECKING THE CAMSHAFTS ………………………………………………….. 5-13
CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN AND CAMSHAFT SPROCKET……. 5-14
CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN GUIDES …………………………………… 5-14
CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN TENSIONER …………………………….. 5-14
INSTALLING THE CAMSHAFTS …………………………………………………. 5-16
CYLINDER HEAD
…………………………………………………………………………… 5-19
REMOVING THE CYLINDER HEAD ……………………………………………. 5-20
CHECKING THE CYLINDER HEAD ……………………………………………. 5-20
INSTALLING THE CYLINDER HEAD …………………………………………… 5-20
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
………………………………………………………. 5-22
REMOVING THE VALVES ………………………………………………………….. 5-24
CHECKING THE VALVES AND VALVE GUIDES …………………………… 5-25
CHECKING THE VALVE SEATS …………………………………………………. 5-26
CHECKING THE VALVE SPRINGS……………………………………………… 5-28
CHECKING THE VALVE LIFTERS ………………………………………………. 5-29
INSTALLING THE VALVES…………………………………………………………. 5-29
GENERATOR
…………………………………………………………………………………. 5-31
REMOVING THE GENERATOR ………………………………………………….. 5-33
INSTALLING THE GENERATOR …………………………………………………. 5-33
STARTER CLUTCH
………………………………………………………………………… 5-35
REMOVING THE STARTER CLUTCH …………………………………………. 5-36
CHECKING THE DAMPER ………………………………………………………… 5-36
CHECKING THE STARTER CLUTCH………………………………………….. 5-36
INSTALLING THE STARTER CLUTCH ………………………………………… 5-37
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
………………………………………………… 5-38
REMOVING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR …………………. 5-39
INSTALLING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ………………… 5-39
ELECTRIC STARTER
……………………………………………………………………… 5-40
CHECKING THE STARTER MOTOR …………………………………………… 5-42
ASSEMBLING THE STARTER MOTOR ……………………………………….. 5-43
INSTALLING THE STARTER MOTOR………………………………………….. 5-43
CLUTCH
………………………………………………………………………………………… 5-44
REMOVING THE CLUTCH…………………………………………………………. 5-48
5
CHECKING THE FRICTION PLATES ………………………………………….. 5-49
CHECKING THE CLUTCH PLATES…………………………………………….. 5-49
CHECKING THE CLUTCH SPRINGS ………………………………………….. 5-50
CHECKING THE CLUTCH HOUSING …………………………………………. 5-50
CHECKING THE CLUTCH BOSS ……………………………………………….. 5-50
CHECKING THE PRESSURE PLATE ………………………………………….. 5-50
CHECKING THE PULL LEVER SHAFT AND PULL ROD……………….. 5-50
INSTALLING THE CLUTCH ……………………………………………………….. 5-51
SHIFT SHAFT
………………………………………………………………………………… 5-54
REMOVING THE SHIFT SHAFT …………………………………………………. 5-56
CHECKING THE SHIFT SHAFT …………………………………………………. 5-56
CHECKING THE STOPPER LEVER……………………………………………. 5-56
INSTALLING THE SHIFT SHAFT ………………………………………………… 5-56
OIL PUMP
……………………………………………………………………………………… 5-58
REMOVING THE OIL PAN …………………………………………………………. 5-62
CHECKING THE SPROCKET AND CHAIN ………………………………….. 5-62
CHECKING THE OIL PUMP ………………………………………………………. 5-62
CHECKING THE RELIEF VALVE ………………………………………………… 5-63
CHECKING THE OIL DELIVERY PIPES………………………………………. 5-63
CHECKING THE OIL STRAINER………………………………………………… 5-63
CHECKING THE OIL NOZZLES …………………………………………………. 5-63
ASSEMBLING THE OIL PUMP …………………………………………………… 5-63
INSTALLING THE OIL/WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY………………………… 5-64
INSTALLING THE OIL PAN ………………………………………………………… 5-65
CRANKCASE
………………………………………………………………………………… 5-66
DISASSEMBLING THE CRANKCASE …………………………………………. 5-68
CHECKING THE CRANKCASE ………………………………………………….. 5-68
CHECKING THE BEARING AND OIL SEALS ………………………………. 5-68
ASSEMBLING THE CRANKCASE………………………………………………. 5-68
CRANKSHAFT
………………………………………………………………………………. 5-70
REMOVING THE CONNECTING RODS AND PISTONS ……………….. 5-72
REMOVING THE CRANKSHAFT ASSEMBLY ………………………………. 5-72
CHECKING THE CYLINDER AND PISTON………………………………….. 5-73
CHECKING THE PISTON RINGS ……………………………………………….. 5-73
CHECKING THE PISTON PINS ………………………………………………….. 5-74
CHECKING THE BIG END BEARINGS ……………………………………….. 5-75
INSTALLING THE CONNECTING ROD AND PISTON …………………… 5-78
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT ………………………………………………… 5-81
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT DRIVE SPROCKET……………………. 5-81
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT JOURNAL BEARINGS ……………….. 5-81
INSTALLING THE CRANKSHAFT……………………………………………….. 5-83
TRANSMISSION
…………………………………………………………………………….. 5-85
REMOVING THE TRANSMISSION……………………………………………… 5-90
CHECKING THE SHIFT FORKS …………………………………………………. 5-90
CHECKING THE SHIFT DRUM ASSEMBLY…………………………………. 5-91
CHECKING THE TRANSMISSION ……………………………………………… 5-91
INSTALLING THE TRANSMISSION…………………………………………….. 5-92
EAS23710
ENGINE REMOVAL
Removing the drive sprocket
ENGINE REMOVAL
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
7
8
Job/Parts to remove
Locknut
Shift rod
Shift arm
Drive sprocket cover
Drive sprocket nut
Lock washer
Drive sprocket
Plate
Q’ty
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-2
Removing the exhaust pipe
ENGINE REMOVAL
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
8
9
6
7
10
11
1
2
3
4
5
EXUP pulley cover
EXUP servo motor cover
EXUP cables
EXUP servo motor
O
2
sensor
Exhaust pipe assembly
Exhaust pipe gasket
Muffler
Muffler gasket
Muffler cover
Muffler end cover
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-3
Disassembling the exhaust valve pipe
ENGINE REMOVAL
Order
1
2
3
4
Job/Parts to remove
Nut
Pulley
Spring
Spring seat
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
5-4
Disconnecting the leads and hoses
ENGINE REMOVAL
Order
Fuel tank
Job/Parts to remove
Air filter case
Throttle body assembly
Engine oil
1
2
3
4
5
Oil cooler
Air cut-off valve
Starter motor
Battery negative lead
Battery positive lead
Clutch cable
Ground lead
Stator coil assembly coupler
5-5
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4.
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE
OIL» on page 3-12.
Refer to «OIL COOLER» on page 6-
4.
Refer to «AIR INDUCTION SYS-
TEM» on page 7-13.
Refer to «ELECTRIC STARTER» on page 5-40.
Disconnect.
Disconnecting the leads and hoses
ENGINE REMOVAL
Order
6
7
8
9
10
Job/Parts to remove Q’ty
Crankshaft position sensor lead coupler 1
Oil level switch connector 1
Neutral switch connector
Cylinder identification sensor coupler
Speed sensor coupler
1
1
1
Remarks
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-6
Removing the engine
ENGINE REMOVAL
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
Job/Parts to remove
Right front engine mounting bolt 1
Left front engine mounting bolt
Upper self-locking nut
Upper engine mounting bolt
Lower self-locking nut
Lower engine mounting bolt
Engine mounting adjust bolt
Engine
1
2
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-7
EAS23720
INSTALLING THE ENGINE
1. Install:
• Right front engine mounting bolt 2 “1”
Refer to «CYLINDER HEAD» on page 5-19.
ENGINE REMOVAL
2. Tighten:
• Right front engine mounting bolt 2
Right front engine mounting bolt 2
50 Nm (5.0 m·kg, 36 ft·lb)
3. Install:
• Engine mounting adjust bolts
(temporarily tighten)
4. Install:
• Engine
5. Install:
• Lower engine mounting bolt “1”
• Upper engine mounting bolt “2”
• Self-locking nuts
NOTE:
Do not fully tighten the bolts and nuts.
7. Tighten:
• Engine mounting adjust bolts
Engine mounting adjust bolt
7 Nm (0.7 m·kg, 5.1 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Use the pivot shaft wrench “1” and pivot shaft wrench adapter “2” to tighten the engine mounting adjust bolts.
Pivot shaft wrench
90890-01518
Frame spanner socket
YM-01518
Pivot shaft wrench adapter
90890-01476
6. Install:
• Left front engine mounting bolt “1”
(temporarily tighten)
• Right front engine mounting bolt 1 “2”
(temporarily tighten)
5-8
8. Tighten:
• Lower self-locking nut “1”
• Upper self-locking nut “2”
Upper self-locking nut
51 Nm (5.1 m·kg, 37 ft·lb)
Lower self-locking nut
51 Nm (5.1 m·kg, 37 ft·lb)
NOTE:
First tighten the lower self-locking nut, and then tighten the upper self-locking nut.
ENGINE REMOVAL
Left front engine mounting bolt
45 Nm (4.5 m·kg, 33 ft·lb)
Right front engine mounting bolt 1
45 Nm (4.5 m·kg, 33 ft·lb)
9. Tighten:
• Left front engine mounting bolt ”1”
• Right front engine mounting bolt 1 ”2”
5-9
EAS23760
CAMSHAFTS
Removing the cylinder head cover
CAMSHAFTS
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
Order
Fuel tank
Job/Parts to remove
Throttle body assembly
Radiator assembly
Air cut-off valve
Ignition coil
Spark plug
Cylinder head cover
Cylinder head cover gasket
Timing chain guide (top side)
Cylinder identification sensor
O-ring
1
1
1
1
4
4
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4.
Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1.
Refer to «AIR INDUCTION SYS-
TEM» on page 7-13.
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-10
Removing the camshafts
CAMSHAFTS
Order Job/Parts to remove
Pickup rotor cover
3
4
1
2
5
6
7
8
9
10
Camshaft sprocket bolt
Timing chain tensioner
Timing chain tensioner gasket
Intake camshaft cap
Dowel pin
Exhaust camshaft cap
Dowel pin
Intake camshaft
Exhaust camshaft
Camshaft sprocket
1
3
4
1
6
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR» on page 5-38.
Loosen.
Refer to «REMOVING THE CAM-
SHAFTS» on page 5-12.
3
6 Refer to «REMOVING THE CAM-
SHAFTS» on page 5-12.
1
1
2
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-11
CAMSHAFTS
EAS23810
REMOVING THE CAMSHAFTS
1. Remove:
• Pickup rotor cover
Refer to «CRANKSHAFT POSITION SEN-
SOR» on page 5-38.
2. Align:
• “T” mark “a” on the pickup rotor
(with the crankcase mating surface “b”)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the crankshaft clockwise.
b. When piston #1 is at TDC on the compression stroke, align the “T” mark “a” on the pickup rotor with the crankcase mating surface “b”.
NOTE:
TDC on the compression stroke can be found when the camshaft lobes are turned away from each other.
5. Remove:
• Camshaft caps “1”
• Dowel pins
ECA13720
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to the cylinder head, camshafts or camshaft caps, loosen the camshaft cap bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern, working from the outside in.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Loosen:
• Camshaft sprocket bolts “1”
Camshaft wrench
90890-04143
6. Remove:
• Intake camshaft “1”
• Exhaust camshaft “2”
NOTE:
To prevent the timing chain from falling into the crankcase, fasten it with a wire “3”.
4. Remove:
• Timing chain tensioner “1”
• Gasket
5-12
CAMSHAFTS
EAS23850
CHECKING THE CAMSHAFTS
1. Check:
• Camshaft lobes
Blue discoloration/pitting/scratches
→
Replace the camshaft.
2. Measure:
• Camshaft lobe dimensions “a” and “b”
Out of specification
→
Replace the camshaft.
Camshaft lobe dimension limit
Intake camshaft “a”
32.50–32.60 mm
(1.280–1.284 in)
Limit
32.40 mm (1.276 in)
Intake camshaft “b”
24.95–25.05 mm
(0.982–0.986 in)
Limit
24.85 mm (0.978 in)
Exhaust camshaft “a”
30.70–30.80 mm
(1.209–1.213 in)
Limit
30.60 mm (1.205 in)
Exhaust camshaft “b”
22.95–23.05 mm
(0.904–0.908 in)
Limit
22.85 mm (0.900 in)
3. Measure:
• Camshaft runout
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Camshaft runout limit
0.03 mm (0.0012 in)
4. Measure:
• Camshaft-journal-to-camshaft-cap clearance
Out of specification
→
Measure the camshaft journal diameter.
Camshaft-journal-to-camshaftcap-clearance
0.028–0.062 mm
(0.0011–0.0024 in)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Install the camshaft into the cylinder head
(without the dowel pins and camshaft caps).
b. Position strip of Plastigauge® “1” onto the camshaft journal as shown.
c. Install the dowel pins and camshaft caps.
NOTE:
• Tighten the camshaft cap bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern, working from the inner caps out.
• Do not turn the camshaft when measuring the camshaft journal-to-camshaft cap clearance with the Plastigauge®.
5-13
Camshaft cap bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
d. Remove the camshaft caps and then measure the width of the Plastigauge® “2”.
CAMSHAFTS
2. Check:
• Camshaft sprocket
More than 1/4 tooth wear “a”
→
Replace the camshaft sprockets and the timing chain as a set.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Measure:
• Camshaft journal diameter “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the camshaft.
Within specification
→
Replace the cylinder head and the camshaft caps as a set.
Camshaft journal diameter
22.459–22.472 mm
(0.8842–0.8847 in)
a. 1/4 tooth b. Correct
1. Timing chain roller
2. Camshaft sprocket
EAS23950
CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN GUIDES
The following procedure applies to all of the camshaft sprockets and timing chain guides.
1. Check:
• Timing chain guide (exhaust side) “1”
• Timing chain guide (intake side) “2”
• Timing chain guide (top side) “3”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the defective part(s).
EAS23870
CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN AND CAM-
SHAFT SPROCKET
1. Check:
• Timing chain “1”
Damage/stiffness
→
Replace the timing chain and camshaft and camshaft sprocket as a set.
5-14
EAS23960
CHECKING THE TIMING CHAIN TEN-
SIONER
1. Remove:
• Timing chain tensioner housing “1”
• Timing chain tensioner rod “2”
• Timing chain tensioner spring “3”
NOTE:
Squeeze the timing chain tensioner clip, and then remove the timing chain tensioner spring and timing chain tensioner rod.
CAMSHAFTS
b. Squeeze the timing chain tensioner clip “2” and push the timing chain tensioner rod “3”.
NOTE:
When the timing chain tensioner rod “3” is pushed while holding the grip of the timing chain tensioner clip “2”, make sure not to release the timing chain tensioner rod “3” before releasing the timing chain tensioner clip
“2”. (Otherwise, the timing chain tensioner rod
“3” may run off.)
2. Check:
• Timing chain tensioner housing
• Timing chain tensioner rod
• Timing chain tensioner spring
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
3. Install:
• Timing chain tensioner spring
• Timing chain tensioner rod “1”
NOTE:
Prior to installing the timing chain tensioner rod, drain the engine oil from the timing chain tensioner housing.
c. Hook the clip “4” to the timing chain tensioner rod “3”.
NOTE:
Hook the timing chain tensioner rod pin “5” to the center of the clip “4”. After the installation, check that the clip “4” can come off by its own weight by pushing the timing chain tensioner rod “3” at the position of installation.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Install the timing chain tensioner spring and timing chain tensioner rod “1”.
5-15
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
CAMSHAFTS
EAS24000
INSTALLING THE CAMSHAFTS
1. Align:
• “T” mark “a” on the pickup rotor
(with the crankcase mating surface “b”)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the crankshaft clockwise.
b. When position #1 is at TDC, align the “T” mark “a” with the crankcase mating surface
“b”.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Install:
• Intake camshaft sprocket “1”
• Exhaust camshaft sprocket “2”
(with the camshaft sprockets temporarily tightened)
NOTE:
Install the camshaft sprockets as a illustration.
4. Install:
• Dowel pins
• Intake camshaft caps
• Exhaust camshaft caps
NOTE:
• Make sure each camshaft cap is installed in its original place. Refer to the identification marks as follows:
“I”: Intake side camshaft cap mark
“E”: Exhaust side camshaft cap mark
“L”: Left side camshaft cap mark
“R”: Right side camshaft cap mark
• Make sure the arrow mark “a” on each camshaft points towards the right side of the engine.
3. Install:
• Exhaust camshaft “1”
• Intake camshafts “2”
(with the camshaft sprockets temporarily tightened)
NOTE:
Make sure the punch mark “a” on each camshaft faces up.
5-16
5. Install:
• Camshaft cap bolts
Camshaft cap bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Tighten the camshaft cap bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern, working from the inner caps out.
EC2D1001
CAUTION:
• Lubricate the camshaft cap bolts with the engine oil.
• The camshaft cap bolts must be tightened evenly or damage to the cylinder head, camshaft caps, and camshafts will result.
• Do not turn the crankshaft when installing the camshaft to avoid damage or improper valve timing.
6. Tighten:
• Camshaft sprocket bolts “1”
Camshaft sprocket bolt
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
Camshaft wrench
90890-04143
EC2D1002
CAUTION:
Be sure to tighten the camshaft sprocket bolts to the specified torque to avoid the possibility of the bolts coming loose and damaging the engine.
CAMSHAFTS
• Timing chain tensioner “1”
• Timing chain tensioner bolts “2”
Timing chain tensioner bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
EC2D1003
CAUTION:
The arrow mark “a” on the timing chain tensioner should face up.
EW2D1006
WARNING
Always use a new gasket.
7. Align:
• Camshaft punch mark “a”
Align the camshaft punch mark “a” and the camshaft cap arrow mark “b”.
Camshaft wrench
90890-04143
9. Turn:
• Crankshaft
(several turns clockwise)
10. Check:
• “T” mark “a”
Make sure the “T” mark on the pickup rotor is aligned with the crankcase mating surface “b”.
• Camshaft punch mark “c”
Make sure the punch mark “c” on the camshaft is aligned with the camshaft cap arrow mark “d”.
Out of alignment
→
Adjust.
Refer to the installation steps above.
8. Install:
• Gasket
5-17
11. Measure:
• Valve clearance
Out of specification
→
Adjust.
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE VALVE
CLEARANCE» on page 3-4.
12. Install:
• Pickup coil rotor cover
«CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR» on page 5-38.
CAMSHAFTS
5-18
EAS24100
CYLINDER HEAD
Removing the cylinder head
CYLINDER HEAD
5
6
7
3
4
1
2
Order
Engine
Job/Parts to remove
Intake camshaft
Exhaust camshaft
Cylinder head
Cylinder head gasket
Dowel pin
Coolant pipe
O-ring
Thermo wax outlet hose
Right front engine mounting bolt 2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to
«ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Refer to
«CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10.
Refer to
«CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-10.
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-19
CYLINDER HEAD
EAS24120
REMOVING THE CYLINDER HEAD
1. Remove:
• Intake camshaft
• Exhaust camshaft
Refer to «REMOVING THE CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-12.
2. Remove:
• Cylinder head nuts
• Cylinder head bolts
NOTE:
• Loosen the nuts in the proper sequence as shown.
• Loosen each nut 1/2 of a turn at a time. After all of the nuts are fully loosened, remove them.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Place a straightedge “1” and a thickness gauge “2” across the cylinder head.
EAS24160
CHECKING THE CYLINDER HEAD
1. Eliminate:
• Combustion chamber carbon deposits
(with a rounded scraper)
NOTE:
Do not use a sharp instrument to avoid damaging or scratching:
• Spark plug bore threads
• Valve seats
2. Check:
• Cylinder head
Damage/scratches
→
Replace.
• Cylinder head water jacket
Mineral deposits/rust
→
Eliminate.
3. Measure:
• Cylinder head warpage
Out of specification
→
Resurface the cylinder head.
Maximum cylinder head warpage
0.10 mm (0.0039 in)
5-20
2. Install: b. Measure the warpage.
c. If the limit is exceeded, resurface the cylinder head as follows.
d. Place a 400–600 grit wet sandpaper on the surface plate and resurface the cylinder head using a figure-eight sanding pattern.
NOTE:
To ensure an even surface, rotate the cylinder head several times.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS24240
INSTALLING THE CYLINDER HEAD
1. Check:
• Cylinder head bolts “1”
Cylinder head bolt
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Retighten the cylinder head bolts to specification, before installing the cylinder head.
• Gasket “1”
• Dowel pins
3. Install:
• Cylinder head
NOTE:
Pass the timing chain through the timing chain cavity.
4. Tighten:
• Cylinder head nuts “1” – “10”
Cylinder head nut (1st)
19 Nm (1.9 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
Cylinder head nut (2nd)
67 Nm (6.7 m·kg, 48 ft·lb)
• Cylinder head bolts “11” “12”
Cylinder head bolt
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• First, tighten the nuts “1” – “10” to approximately 19 Nm (1.9 m·kg, 14 ft·lb) with a torque wrench, and then tighten the 67 Nm
(6.7 m·kg, 48 ft·lb).
• Lubricate the cylinder head nuts with engine oil.
• Tighten the cylinder head nuts in the proper tightening sequence as shown and torque them in two stages.
CYLINDER HEAD
5. Install:
• Exhaust camshaft
• Intake camshaft
Refer to «INSTALLING THE CAMSHAFTS» on page 5-16.
5-21
EAS24270
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
Removing the valves and valve springs
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
Order Job/Parts to remove
Cylinder head
13
14
15
9
10
11
12
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
Intake valve lifter
Intake valve pad
Intake valve cotter
Intake valve upper spring seat
Intake valve spring
Intake valve stem seal
Intake valve lower spring seat
Intake valve
Intake valve guide
Exhaust valve lifter
Exhaust valve pad
Exhaust valve cotter
Exhaust valve upper spring seat
Exhaust valve spring
Exhaust valve stem seal
5-22
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «CYLINDER HEAD» on page 5-19.
8
8
8
12
8
8
16
12
12
12
12
12
12
24
12
Removing the valves and valve springs
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
Order
16
17
18
Job/Parts to remove
Exhaust valve lower spring seat
Exhaust valve
Exhaust valve guide
Q’ty
8
8
8
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-23
EAS24280
REMOVING THE VALVES
The following procedure applies to all of the valves and related components.
NOTE:
Before removing the internal parts of the cylinder head (e.g., valves, valve springs, valve seats), make sure the valves properly seal.
1. Remove:
• Valve lifter “1”
• Valve pad “2”
NOTE:
Make a note of the position of each valve lifter and valve pad so that they can be reinstalled in their original place.
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
NOTE:
Remove the valve cotters by compressing the valve spring with the valve spring compressor
“2” and the valve spring compressor attachment “3”.
Valve spring compressor
90890-04019
YM-04019
Valve spring compressor attachment
90890-04108
Valve spring compressor adapter 22 mm
YM-04108
Valve spring compressor attachment
90890-04114
Valve spring compressor adapter 19.5 mm
YM-04114
2. Check:
• Valve sealing
Leakage at the valve seat
→
Check the valve face, valve seat, and valve seat width.
Refer to «CHECKING THE VALVE SEATS» on page 5-26.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Pour a clean solvent “a” into the intake and exhaust ports.
b. Check that the valves properly seal.
NOTE:
There should be no leakage at the valve seat
“1”.
4. Remove:
• Upper spring seat “1”
• Valve spring “2”
• Valve stem seal “3”
• Lower spring seat “4”
• Valve “5”
NOTE:
Identify the position of each part very carefully so that it can be reinstalled in its original place.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Remove:
• Valve cotters “1”
5-24
EAS24290
CHECKING THE VALVES AND VALVE
GUIDES
The following procedure applies to all of the valves and valve guides.
1. Measure:
• Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance
Out of specification
→
Replace the valve guide.
• Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance =
Valve guide inside diameter “a” —
Valve stem diameter “b”
Valve-stem-to-valve-guide clearance
Intake
0.010 – 0.037 mm
(0.0004 – 0.0015)
Limit
0.08 mm (0.0032 in)
Exhaust
0.025 – 0.052 mm
(0.0010 – 0.0020 in)
Limit
0.10 mm (0.0039 in)
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
NOTE:
To ease valve guide removal and installation, and to maintain the correct fit, heat the cylinder head to 100
°
C (212
°
F) in an oven.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the valve guide with the valve guide remover “1”.
b. Install the new valve guide with the valve guide installer “2” and valve guide remover
“1”.
c. After installing the valve guide, bore the valve guide with the valve guide reamer “3” to obtain the proper valve-stem-to-valveguide clearance.
2. Replace:
• Valve guide
5-25
NOTE:
After replacing the valve guide, reface the valve seat.
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
Intake
Valve guide remover (ø4)
90890-04111
YM-04111
Exhaust
Valve guide remover (ø4.5)
90890-04116
YM-04116
Intake
Valve guide installer (ø4)
90890-04112
YM-04112
Exhaust
Valve guide installer (ø4.5)
90890-04117
YM-04117
Intake
Valve guide reamer (ø4)
90890-04113
YM-04113
Exhaust
Valve guide reamer (ø4.5)
90890-04118
YM-04118
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Eliminate:
• Carbon deposits
(from the valve face and valve seat)
4. Check:
• Valve face
Pitting/wear
→
Grind the valve face.
• Valve stem end
Mushroom shape or diameter larger than the body of the valve stem
→
Replace the valve.
5. Measure:
• Valve margin thickness “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the valve.
Valve margin thickness
0.5–0.9 mm (0.0197–0.0354 in)
Limit
0.5 mm (0.02 in)
6. Measure:
• Valve stem runout
Out of specification
→
Replace the valve.
NOTE:
• When installing a new valve, always replace the valve guide.
• If the valve is removed or replaced, always replace the oil seal.
Valve stem runout
0.01 mm (0.0004 in)
EAS24300
CHECKING THE VALVE SEATS
The following procedure applies to all of the valves and valve seats.
1. Eliminate:
• Carbon deposits
(from the valve face and valve seat)
2. Check:
• Valve seat
Pitting/wear
→
Replace the cylinder head.
3. Measure:
• Valve seat width “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the cylinder head.
5-26
Valve seat width
Intake
0.90–1.10 mm
(0.0354–0.0433 in)
Exhaust
0.90–1.10 mm
(0.0354–0.0433 in)
Limit
1.6 mm (0.063 in)
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
NOTE:
After replacing the cylinder head or replacing the valve and valve guide, the valve seat and valve face should be lapped.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Apply a coarse lapping compound “a” to the valve face.
ECA13790
CAUTION:
Do not let the lapping compound enter the gap between the valve stem and the valve guide.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Apply Mechanic’s blueing dye (Dykem) “b” onto the valve face.
b. Apply molybdenum disulfide oil onto the valve stem.
c. Install the valve into the cylinder head.
d. Turn the valve until the valve face and valve seat are evenly polished, then clean off all of the lapping compound.
NOTE:
For the best lapping results, lightly tap the valve seat while rotating the valve back and forth between your hands.
b. Install the valve into the cylinder head.
c. Press the valve through the valve guide and onto the valve seat to make a clear impression.
d. Measure the valve seat width.
NOTE:
Where the valve seat and valve face contacted one another, the blueing will have been removed.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Lap:
• Valve face
• Valve seat e. Apply a fine lapping compound to the valve face and repeat the above steps.
f.
After every lapping procedure, be sure to clean off all of the lapping compound from the valve face and valve seat.
g. Apply Mechanic’s blueing dye (Dykem) “b” onto the valve face.
5-27
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
h. Install the valve into the cylinder head.
i.
j.
Press the valve through the valve guide and onto the valve seat to make a clear impression.
Measure the valve seat width “c” again. If the valve seat width is out of specification, reface and lap the valve seat.
2. Measure:
• Compressed valve spring force “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the valve spring.
Compressed valve spring force
(installed)
Intake valve spring
127.4–144.6 N
(12.99–14.74 kg, 28.64–32.51 lb) at 32.65 mm (1.285 in)
Exhaust valve spring
133.0–153.0 N
(13.56–15.60 kg, 29.90–34.39 lb) at 32.82 mm (1.292 in)
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS24310
CHECKING THE VALVE SPRINGS
The following procedure applies to all of the valve springs.
1. Measure:
• Valve spring free length “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the valve spring.
Valve spring free length
Intake valve spring
40.5 mm (1.60 in)
Limit
38.5 mm (1.47 in)
Exhaust valve spring
40.5 mm (1.60 in)
Limit
38.5 mm (1.47 in)
b. Installed length
3. Measure:
• Valve spring tilt “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the valve spring.
Spring tilt limit
Intake valve spring
1.8 mm (0.07 in)
Exhaust valve spring
1.8 mm (0.07 in)
5-28
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
EAS24320
CHECKING THE VALVE LIFTERS
The following procedure applies to all of the valve lifters.
1. Check:
• Valve lifter
Damage/scratches
→
Replace the valve lifters and cylinder head.
3. Install:
• Valve “1”
• Lower spring seat “2”
• Valve stem seal “3”
• Valve spring “4”
• Upper spring seat “5”
(into the cylinder head)
NOTE:
• Make sure each valve is installed in its original place. Refer to the following embossed marks.
Right and left intake valve (-s): “5VY:”
Middle intake valve (-s): “5VY.”
Exhaust valve (-s): “5VY”.
• Install the valve springs with the larger pitch
“a” facing up.
EAS24330
INSTALLING THE VALVES
The following procedure applies to all of the valves and related components.
1. Deburr:
• Valve stem end
(with an oil stone) b. Smaller pitch
4. Install:
• Valve cotters “1”
NOTE:
Install the valve cotters by compressing the valve springs with the valve spring compressor
“2” and the valve spring compressor attachment “3”.
2. Lubricate:
• Valve stem “1”
• Valve stem seal “2”
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Molybdenum disulfide oil
5-29
Valve spring compressor
90890-04019
YM-04019
Intake
Valve spring compressor attachment
90890-04114
YM-04114
Exhaust
Valve spring compressor attachment
90890-04108
YM-04108
VALVES AND VALVE SPRINGS
• Each valve lifter and valve pad must be reinstalled in its original position.
5. To secure the valve cotters onto the valve stem, lightly tap the valve tip with a softface hammer.
ECA13800
CAUTION:
Hitting the valve tip with excessive force could damage the valve.
6. Install:
• Valve pad “1”
• Valve lifter “2”
NOTE:
• Lubricate the valve lifter and valve pad with molybdenum disulfide oil.
• The valve lifter must move smoothly when rotated with a finger.
5-30
EAS24480
GENERATOR
Removing the generator
GENERATOR
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Fuel tank
Engine oil
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
8
9
10
Stator coil assembly lead coupler
Plug
Generator rotor cover
Gasket
Dowel pin
Generator rotor assembly
Stator coil assembly
Dowel pin
Bearing housing
Collar
5-31
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE
OIL» on page 3-12.
Disconnect.
Removing the generator
GENERATOR
Order
11
12
13
14
15
16
Job/Parts to remove
Bearing
Stator coil assembly lead holder
Idler gear
Idler gear shaft
Washer
Bearing
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-32
GENERATOR
EAS24490
REMOVING THE GENERATOR
1. Remove:
• Plug
• Generator rotor cover “1”
NOTE:
• While pushing generator rotor, remove the generator rotor cover.
• Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
• After all of the bolts are fully loosened, remove them.
EAS24500
INSTALLING THE GENERATOR
1. Install:
• Idle gear shaft
• Idle gear “1”
• Washer
• Idle gear shaft bolt “2”
Idle gear shaft bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
2. Remove:
• Generator rotor and starter clutch assembly “1”
2. Install
• Generator rotor and starter clutch assembly “1”
3. Remove:
• Idle gear shaft bolt “1”
• Idle shaft
• Idle gear “2”
5-33
3. Install:
• Generator rotor cover gasket
• Generator rotor cover “1”
Generator rotor cover bolt (M6)
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
Generator rotor cover bolt (M8)
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
GENERATOR
NOTE:
• First tighten the M8 bolts and then tighten the
M6 bolts.
• Tighten the generator rotor cover bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
5-34
EAS24550
STARTER CLUTCH
Removing the starter clutch
STARTER CLUTCH
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
9
Job/Parts to remove
Generator rotor
Damper
Driven gear
Washer
Starter clutch drive gear
Collar
Washer
Spacer
O-ring
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
3
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-35
STARTER CLUTCH
EAS24560
REMOVING THE STARTER CLUTCH
1. Remove:
• Spacer “1”
• O-ring “2”
• Washer “3”
EAS24570
CHECKING THE STARTER CLUTCH
1. Check:
• Starter clutch rollers “1”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
2. Remove:
• Starter clutch drive gear “1”
• Collar “2”
• Washer “3”
2. Check:
• Starter clutch idle gear “1”
• Starter clutch drive gear “2”
Burrs/chips/roughness/wear
→
Replace the defective part(s).
3. Remove:
• Driven gear “1”
• Dampers “2”
• Generator rotor “3”
ET2D1009
CHECKING THE DAMPER
1. Check:
• Dampers “1”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
5-36
3. Check:
• Starter clutch gear’s contacting surfaces
Damage/pitting/wear
→
Replace the starter clutch gear.
4. Check:
• Starter clutch operation
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Install the starter clutch drive gear “1” onto the starter clutch “2” and hold the starter clutch.
b. When turning the starter clutch drive gear counterclockwise “A”, the starter clutch and the starter clutch drive gear should engage,
otherwise the starter clutch is faulty and must be replaced.
c. When turning the starter clutch drive gear clockwise “B”, it should turn freely, otherwise the starter clutch is faulty and must be replaced.
STARTER CLUTCH
3. Install:
• Washer “1”
• O-ring “2”
• Spacer “3”
NOTE:
Lubricate the engine oil to O-ring.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS24600
INSTALLING THE STARTER CLUTCH
1. Install:
• Generator rotor “1”
• Damper “2”
• Driven gear “3”
NOTE:
• The hole side of the damper is installed to the generator side.
• Lubricate the engine oil “4”.
2. Install
• Starter clutch drive gear “1”
• Collar “2”
• Washer “3”
Refer to «CHECKING THE STARTER
CLUTCH» on page 5-36.
5-37
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
EAS24520
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Removing the crankshaft position sensor
3
4
1
2
5
6
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Fuel tank
Engine oil
Crankshaft position sensor lead coupler 1
Crankshaft position sensor 1
O-ring
Pickup rotor cover
1
1
Gasket
Cover
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE
OIL» on page 3-12.
Disconnect.
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-38
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
EAS24530
REMOVING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
1. Disconnect:
• Crankshaft position sensor lead coupler
2. Remove:
• Crankshaft position sensor
• O-ring
• Pickup coil rotor cover “1”
NOTE:
Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn at a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
After all of the bolts are fully loosened, remove them.
2. Connect
• Crankshaft position sensor lead coupler
EAS24540
INSTALLING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
1. Install:
• Gasket
• Pickup rotor cover “1”
Pickup rotor cover
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
• O-ring
• Crankshaft posision sensor
Crankshaft position sensor bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
5-39
EAS24780
ELECTRIC STARTER
Removing the starter motor
ELECTRIC STARTER
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
1
2
Fuel tank
Throttle body assembly
Starter motor lead
Starter motor
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4.
1
1
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-40
Disassembling the starter motor
ELECTRIC STARTER
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
9
10
Job/Parts to remove
O-ring
Front cover
Lock washer
Washer
Starter motor yoke
Armature assembly
O-ring
Starter motor lead
Brush holder
Rear cover
1
2
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
2
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
5-41
EAS24790
CHECKING THE STARTER MOTOR
1. Check:
• Commutator
Dirt
→
Clean with 600 grit sandpaper.
2. Measure:
• Commutator diameter “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the starter motor.
Commutator wear limit
27.0 mm (1.06 in)
ELECTRIC STARTER
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
Armature coil
Commutator resistance “1”
0.0250–0.0350
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
Insulation resistance “2”
Above 1 M
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
b. If any resistance is out of specification, replace the starter motor.
3. Measure:
• Mica undercut “a”
Out of specification
→
Scrape the mica to the proper measurement with a hacksaw blade that has been grounded to fit the commutator.
Mica undercut
0.7 mm (0.03 in)
NOTE:
The mica of the commutator must be undercut to ensure proper operation of the commutator.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Measure:
• Brush length “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the brushes as a set.
Brush length wear limit
5.0 mm (0.20 in)
4. Measure:
• Armature assembly resistances (commutator and insulation)
Out of specification
→
Replace the starter motor.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Measure the armature assembly resistances with the pocket tester.
6. Measure:
• Brush spring force
Out of specification
→
Replace the brush springs as a set.
Brush spring force
7.65–10.0 N
(780–1021 gf, 27.54–36.03 oz)
5-42
ELECTRIC STARTER
NOTE:
Align the match marks “a” on the starter motor yoke with the match marks “b” on the front and starter motor rear covers.
7. Check:
• Gear teeth
Damage/wear
→
Replace the gear.
EAS24800
ASSEMBLING THE STARTER MOTOR
1. Install:
• Brush seat “1”
NOTE:
Align the tab “a” on the brush seat with the tab
“b” in the starter motor rear cover.
EAS24810
INSTALLING THE STARTER MOTOR
1. Install:
• Starter motor “1”
• Starter motor bolts “2”
Starter motor bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
2. Connect:
• Starter motor lead “3”
2. Install:
• Armature “1”
3. Install:
• Starter motor yoke “1”
• O-rings “2”
• Starter motor rear cover “3”
• Starter motor assembling bolts
Starter motor assembling bolt
5 Nm (0.5 m·kg, 3.6 ft·lb)
5-43
EAS25060
CLUTCH
Removing the clutch cover
CLUTCH
Order Job/Parts to remove
Engine oil
1
2
3
4
5
Clutch cable
Clutch cover
Clutch cover gasket
Dowel pin
Oil filler cap
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty Remarks
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE
OIL» on page 3-12.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-44
Removing the pull lever shaft
CLUTCH
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
Circlip
Pull lever
Job/Parts to remove
Pull lever spring
Pull lever shaft
Oil seal
Bearing
Q’ty
2
1
1
2
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-45
Removing the clutch
CLUTCH
11
12
13
14
7
8
9
10
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
15
16
17
18
Job/Parts to remove
Compression spring
Pressure plate
Pull rod
Bearing
Friction plate 1
Clutch plate 1
Friction plate 2
Wire circlip
Clutch plate 2
Friction plate 3
Clutch damper spring
Clutch damper spring seat
Clutch boss nut
Washer
Clutch boss assembly
Thrust plate
Clutch housing
Bearing
5-46
1
1
1
1
1
1
7
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
6
1
1
7
1
1
Remarks
Removing the clutch
CLUTCH
Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-47
CLUTCH
EAS25080
REMOVING THE CLUTCH
1. Remove:
• Clutch cover “1”
• Gasket
NOTE:
Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn at a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
After all of the bolts are fully loosened, remove them.
4. Remove:
• Clutch plate 1 “1”
• Friction plate 2
5. Straighten the clutch boss nut rib “1”.
2. Remove:
• Compression spring bolts “1”
• Compression springs
• Pressure plate “2”
• Pull rod “3”
6. Loosen:
• Clutch boss nut “1”
NOTE:
While holding the clutch boss “2” with the universal clutch holder “3”, loosen the clutch boss nut.
Universal clutch holder
90890-04086
YM-91042
3. Remove:
• Friction plate 1 “1”
5-48
7. Remove:
• Clutch boss nut
• Washer
• Clutch boss assembly
• Thrust plate
8. Remove:
• Wire circlip “1”
NOTE:
There is a built-in damper between the clutch boss and the clutch plate. It is not necessary to remove the wire circlip “1” and disassemble the built-in damper unless there is serious clutch chattering.
CLUTCH
1. Check:
• Friction plate
Damage/wear
→
Replace the friction plates as a set.
2. Measure:
• Friction plate thickness
Out of specification
→
Replace the friction plates as a set.
NOTE:
Measure the friction plate at four places.
Friction plate thickness
2.9 — 3.1 mm (0.114 — 0.122 in)
Limit
2.8 mm (0.110 in)
9. Remove:
• Clutch plate 2 “1”
• Friction plate 3 “2”
10. Remove:
• Clutch damper spring “1”
• Clutch damper spring seat “2”
EAS25110
CHECKING THE CLUTCH PLATES
The following procedure applies to all of the clutch plates.
1. Check:
• Clutch plate
Damage
→
Replace the clutch plates as a set.
2. Measure:
• Clutch plate warpage
(with a surface plate and thickness gauge
“1”)
Out of specification
→
Replace the clutch plates as a set.
Clutch plate warpage limit
0.1 mm (0.0039 in)
ET2D1010
CHECKING THE FRICTION PLATES
The following procedure applies to all of the friction plates.
5-49
CLUTCH
EAS25140
CHECKING THE CLUTCH SPRINGS
The following procedure applies to all of the clutch springs.
1. Check:
• Clutch spring
Damage
→
Replace the clutch springs as a set.
2. Measure:
• Clutch spring free length “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the clutch springs as a set.
Clutch spring free length
52.5 mm (2.07 in)
Limit
49.9 mm (1.96 in)
2. Check:
• Bearing
Damage/wear
→
Replace the bearing and clutch housing.
EAS25160
CHECKING THE CLUTCH BOSS
1. Check:
• Clutch boss splines
Damage/pitting/wear
→
Replace the clutch boss.
NOTE:
Pitting on the clutch boss splines will cause erratic clutch operation.
EAS25170
CHECKING THE PRESSURE PLATE
1. Check:
• Pressure plate “1”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Bearing “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS25150
CHECKING THE CLUTCH HOUSING
1. Check:
• Clutch housing dogs
Damage/pitting/wear
→
Deburr the clutch housing dogs or replace the clutch housing.
NOTE:
Pitting on the clutch housing dogs will cause erratic clutch operation.
5-50
EAS25220
CHECKING THE PULL LEVER SHAFT AND
PULL ROD
1. Check:
CLUTCH
• Pull lever shaft pinion gear teeth “1”
• Pull rod teeth “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the pull rod and pull lever shaft pinion gear as a set.
3. Install:
• Wire circlip “1”
2. Check:
• Pull rod bearing
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS25240
INSTALLING THE CLUTCH
1. Install:
• Clutch damper spring seat “1”
• Clutch damper spring “2”
4. Install:
• Clutch housing “1”
NOTE:
Align the projection of clutch housing “a” and hollow of the oil pump drive gear “b”.
2. Install:
• Friction plate 3 “1”
• Clutch plate 2 “2”
NOTE:
Lubricate the engine oil.
5-51
5. Install:
• Thrust plate
• Clutch boss assembly “1”
• Washer
• Clutch boss nut “2”
Clutch boss nut
95 Nm (9.5 m·kg, 69 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• Install the washer on the main axle with the
“OUT” mark facing away from the vehicle.
CLUTCH
• Lock the threads on the clutch boss nut by staking them with a drift punch at the point aligned with the groove in the axle.
• While holding the clutch boss assembly “1” with the clutch holding tool “3”, tighten the clutch boss nut.
Universal clutch holder
90890-04086
YM-91042
8. Install:
• Friction plate 1 “1”
NOTE:
Install the last friction plate shifting half phase.
6. Lubricate
• Friction plates
• Clutch plates
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil
7. Install:
• Friction plate 2
• Clutch plate 1 “1”
9. Install:
• Bearing
• Pull rod “1”
• Pressure plate “2”
• Clutch springs
• Clutch spring bolts “3”
Clutch spring bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Tighten the clutch spring bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
5-52
CLUTCH
10. Install:
• Pull lever
NOTE:
Install the pull lever with the “O“ mark facing toward lower side.
12. Tighten
• Clutch cover bolts “1”
Clutch cover bolt
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
• Clutch cover bolt “2”
Clutch cover bolt
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
NOTE:
Tighten the clutch cover bolts in a stages and in a crisscross pattern.
11. Install:
• Clutch cover
• Clutch cover gasket
NOTE:
• Install the pull rod so that the teeth a face towards the rear of the vehicle. Then, install the clutch cover.
• Apply oil onto the bearing.
• Apply molybdenum disulfide grease onto the pull rod.
• When installing the clutch cover, push the pull lever and check that the punch mark “a” on the pull lever aligns with the mark “b” on the clutch cover. Make sure that the pull rod teeth and pull lever shaft pinion gear are engaged.
• Tighten the clutch cover bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
13. Adjust:
• Clutch cable free play
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE CLUTCH
CABLE FREE PLAY» on page 3-14.
5-53
EAS25410
SHIFT SHAFT
Removing the shift shaft and stopper lever
SHIFT SHAFT
Order Job/Parts to remove
Clutch assembly
Shift arm and shift rod
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
9
10
11
12
13
Circlip
Washer
Shift shaft
Collar
Shift shaft spring
Washer
Stopper screw
Stopper lever
Washer
Oil seal
Bearing
Bearing
Stopper lever spring
5-54
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Removing the shift shaft and stopper lever
SHIFT SHAFT
Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-55
SHIFT SHAFT
ET2D1011
REMOVING THE SHIFT SHAFT
1. Remove:
• Clutch assembly
Refetr to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44
2. Remove:
• Shift arm
• Shift rod
Refetr to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-
2
3. Remove:
• Circlip “1”
• Washer “2”
(left side of the engine)
EAS25420
CHECKING THE SHIFT SHAFT
1. Check:
• Shift shaft “1”
Bends/damage/wear
→
Replace.
• Shift shaft spring “2”
• Collar “3”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
4. Remove
• Shift shaft “1”
• Shift shaft spring “2”
• Collar
• Washer
EAS25430
CHECKING THE STOPPER LEVER
1. Check:
• Stopper lever “1”
Bends/damage
→
Replace.
Roller turns roughly
→
Replace the stopper lever.
5. Remove:
• Stopper lever spring “1”
• Stopper screw “2”
• Stopper lever “3”
• Washer
5-56
EAS25450
INSTALLING THE SHIFT SHAFT
1. Install:
• Washer
• Stopper lever “1”
• Stopper screw “2”
Stopper screw
22 Nm (2.2 m·kg, 16 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
• Stopper lever spring “3”
2. Install:
• Washer
• Collar
• Shift shaft spring “1”
• Shift shaft “2”
NOTE:
• Mesh the stopper lever with the shift drum segment assembly.
• Lubricate the oil seal lips with lithium soap base grease.
• Install the end of the shift shaft spring onto the shift shaft spring stopper.
SHIFT SHAFT
• Shift rod
• Shift arm
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-
2.
5. Install:
• Clutch assembly
Refer to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44.
3. Install:
• Washer “1”
• Circlip “2”
4. Install:
5-57
EAS24920
OIL PUMP
Removing the oil pan and oil pump
OIL PUMP
Order Job/Parts to remove
Engine oil
1
EXUP cables
O
2
sensor
Muffler
Exhaust pipe assembly
Clutch assembly
Water pump inlet pipe
Water pump outlet pipe
Oil level switch lead coupler
5-58
Q’ty
1
Remarks
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE
OIL» on page 3-12.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Refer to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44.
Refer to «OIL COOLER» on page 6-
4.
Refer to «OIL COOLER» on page 6-
4.
Disconnect.
Removing the oil pan and oil pump
OIL PUMP
7
8
9
10
11
12
Order
2
5
6
3
4
13
14
15
16
17
Job/Parts to remove
Oil level switch
Oil level switch lead holder
Oil pan
Oil pan gasket
Dowel pin
Drain pipe
Oil strainer
Oil pipe
Oil delivery pipe
Relief valve assembly
Oil/water pump assembly drive chain guide
Collar
Oil/water pump assembly drive sprocket
Washer
Oil/water pump assembly drive chain
Dowel pin
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
2
1
1
5-59
Remarks
Removing the oil pan and oil pump
OIL PUMP
Order
18
Job/Parts to remove
Oil/water pump assembly
Q’ty
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-60
Disassembling the oil pump
OIL PUMP
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
8
Job/Parts to remove
Oil/water pump driven sprocket
Collar
Oil pump housing
Bearing
Pin
Oil pump outer roter
Oil pump inner roter
Pin
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
5-61
EAS24930
REMOVING THE OIL PAN
1. Remove:
• Oil level switch “1”
• Oil pan “2”
• Oil pan gasket
• Dowel pins
NOTE:
Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn at a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern. After all of the bolts are fully loosened, remove them.
OIL PUMP
EAS24960
CHECKING THE OIL PUMP
1. Check:
• Oil pump driven gear “1”
• Oil pump rotor housing “2”
• Oil pump cover
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace the defective part(s).
ET2D1012
CHECKING THE SPROCKET AND CHAIN
1. Check:
• Oil/water pump assembly drive sprocket “1”
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace the defective part(-s).
2. Measure:
• Inner-rotor-to-outer-rotor-tip clearance “a”
• Outer-rotor-to-oil-pump-housing clearance
“b”
Inner-rotor-to-outer-roter-tipclearance
0.01–0.10 mm
(0.0004–0.0039 in)
Limit
0.18 mm (0.0071 in)
Outer-rotor-to-oil-pump-housingclearance
0.09–0.15 mm
(0.0035–0.0059 in)
Limit
0.22 mm (0.0087 in)
2. Check:
• Oil/water pump assembly drive chain “1”
Damag/stiffness
→
Replace the oil/water pump assembly drive chain and oil/water pump assembly drive sprocket as a set.
1. Oil pump inner rotor
2. Oil pump outer rotor
3. Oil pump housing
3. Check:
• Oil pump operation
Rough movement
→
Repeat steps (1) and
(2) or replace the defective part(s).
5-62
OIL PUMP
EAS24970
CHECKING THE RELIEF VALVE
1. Check:
• Relief valve body “1”
• Relief valve “2”
• Spring “3”
• O-ring “4”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the defective part(s).
ET2D1013
CHECKING THE OIL NOZZLES
The following procedure applies to all of the oil nozzles.
1. Check:
• Oil nozzle “1”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the oil nozzles.
• O-ring “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
• Oil nozzle passage
Obstruction
→
Blow out with compressed air.
EAS24980
CHECKING THE OIL DELIVERY PIPES
1. Check:
• Oil delivery pipe “1”
• Oil pipe “2”
Damage
→
Replace.
Obstruction
→
Wash and blow out with compressed air.
EAS24990
CHECKING THE OIL STRAINER
1. Check:
• Oil strainer “1”
Damage
→
Replace.
Contaminants
→
Clean with solvent.
EAS25010
ASSEMBLING THE OIL PUMP
1. Lubricate:
• Inner rotor
• Outer rotor
• Oil pump shaft
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil
2. Install:
• Pin “1”
• Inner rotor “2”
• Outer rotor “3”
• Oil pump housing “4”
5-63
OIL PUMP
NOTE:
When installing the inner rotor, align the pin “1” in the oil pump shaft with the groove in the inner rotor “2”.
3. Install:
• Oil/water pump driven sprocket “1”
Oil/water pump driven sprocket bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
NOTE:
5VY mark of the oil/water pump driven gear is installed at oil pump side.
2. Install:
• Washer
• Oil/water pump assembly drive chain “1”
• Oil/water pump assembly drive sprocket “2”
• Collar
NOTE:
Install the oil/water pump assembly drive chain
“1” onto the oil/water pump assembly drive sprocket “2”.
EC2D1008
CAUTION:
After installing the oil/water pump assembly drive chain and drive sprocket, make sure the oil/water pump turns smoothly.
4. Check:
• Oil pump operation
Refer to «CHECKING THE OIL PUMP» on page 5-62.
EAS25030
INSTALLING THE OIL/WATER PUMP
ASSEMBLY
1. Install:
• Oil ring
• Oil/water pump assembly “1”
• Dowel pin
• Bolts “2”
Oil/water pump assembly bolt
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
5-64
3. Install:
• Oil/water pump assembly drive chain guide
“1”
Oil/water pump assembly drive chain guide bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
NOTE:
“UP” mark of the oil/water pump assembly drive chain guide is upward.
OIL PUMP
4. Install:
• Oil delivery pipe “1”
Oil delivery pipe bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
5. Install:
• Relief valve “1”
• O-ring
• Oil strainer “2”
Oil strainer bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
• O-ring
• Oil pipe “3”
• O-ring
• Drain pipe “4”
• O-ring
EAS25050
INSTALLING THE OIL PAN
1. Install:
• Dowel pins
• Gasket
• Oil pan “1”
Oil pan bolt
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
• Oil level switch “2”
Oil level switch bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
• Engine oil drain bolt “3”
Engine oil drain bolt
43 Nm (4.3 m·kg, 31 ft·lb)
EWA12820
WARNING
Always use new copper washers.
NOTE:
• Tighten the oil pan bolts in stages and in a crisscross pattern.
• Lubricate the oil level switch O-ring with engine oil.
5-65
EAS25540
CRANKCASE
Separating the crankcase
CRANKCASE
Order Job/Parts to remove
Air filter case
Throttle body assembly
Engine
Cylinder head
Generator
Starter clutch
Shift shaft
Crankshaft position sensor
Clutch
5-66
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4.
Refer to «ENGINE REMOVAL» on page 5-2.
Refer to «CYLINDER HEAD» on page 5-19.
Refer to «GENERATOR» on page 5-
31.
Refer to «STARTER CLUTCH» on page 5-35.
Refer to «SHIFT SHAFT» on page 5-
54.
Refer to «CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR» on page 5-38.
Refer to «CLUTCH» on page 5-44.
Separating the crankcase
CRANKCASE
Order Job/Parts to remove
Oil pump
Starter motor
6
7
4
5
8
9
1
2
3
Timing chain
Timing chain guide (intake side)
Pin
Timing chain guide (exhaust side)
Left side cover
O-ring
Lower crankcase
Dowel pin
Damper
1
1
1
1
3
1
1
1
2
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «OIL PUMP» on page 5-58.
Refer to «ELECTRIC STARTER» on page 5-40.
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
5-67
EAS25550
DISASSEMBLING THE CRANKCASE
1. Place the engine upside down.
2. Remove:
• Crankcase bolts
NOTE:
• Loosen each bolt 1/4 of a turn at a time, in stages and in a crisscross pattern. After all of the bolts are fully loosened, remove them.
• Loosen the bolts in decreasing numerical order (refer to the numbers in the illustration).
• The numbers embossed on the crankcase indicate the crankcase tightening sequence.
M9 x 105 mm (4.1 in) bolts: “1” – “10”
M8 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolt: “11” LOCTITE®
M8 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolts: “12”, “16”
M6 x 70 mm (2.8 in) bolts: “19”, “21”, “23”
M6 x 65 mm (2.5 in) bolts: “17”, “18”
M6 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolt and washer: “22”
M6 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolts: “24”, “25”
M6 x 50 mm (2.0 in) bolts: “20”, “26”
M8 x 50 mm (2.0 in) bolts: “13” – “15”
3. Remove:
• Lower crankcase
ECA13900
CAUTION:
Tap on one side of the crankcase with a soft-face hammer. Tap only on reinforced portions of the crankcase, not on the crankcase mating surfaces. Work slowly and carefully and make sure the crankcase halves separate evenly.
4. Remove:
• Dowel pins
5. Remove:
• Crankshaft journal lower bearing
(from the lower crankcase)
5-68
CRANKCASE
NOTE:
Identify the position of each crankshaft journal lower bearing so that it can be reinstalled in its original place.
EAS25580
CHECKING THE CRANKCASE
1. Thoroughly wash the crankcase halves in a mild solvent.
2. Thoroughly clean all the gasket surfaces and crankcase mating surfaces.
3. Check:
• Crankcase
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Oil delivery passages
Obstruction
→
Blow out with compressed air.
ET2D1014
CHECKING THE BEARING AND OIL SEALS
1. Check:
• Bearings
Clean and lubricate the bearings, then rotate the inner race with your finger.
Rough movement
→
Replace.
2. Check:
• Oil seals
Damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS25650
ASSEMBLING THE CRANKCASE
1. Lubricate:
• Crankshaft journal bearings
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil
2. Apply:
• Sealant
Yamaha bond No. 1215
(Three Bond No.1215®)
90890-85505
NOTE:
Do not allow any sealant to come into contact with the oil gallery or crankshaft journal bearings. Do not apply sealant to within 2–3 mm
(0.08–0.12 in) of the crankshaft journal bearings.
3. Install:
• Dowel pin
4. Set the shift drum assembly and transmission gears in the neutral position.
5. Install:
• Lower crankcase “1”
(onto the upper crankcase “2”)
ECA13980
CAUTION:
Before tightening the crankcase bolts, make sure the transmission gears shift correctly when the shift drum assembly is turned by hand.
CRANKCASE
Crankcase bolt
Bolt “1”–“10”
1st: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
2nd*: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
3rd: +60
°
Bolt “11”–“16”
24 Nm (2.4 m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
Bolt “17”–“26”
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
*Following the tightening order, loosen the bolt one by one and then retighten it to the specific torque.
6. Install:
• Crankcase bolts
NOTE:
• Lubricate the bolt threads with engine oil.
• Install a washer on bolts “1” – “10” and “22”.
• Seal bolt “18”
• Tighten the bolts in the tightening sequence cast on the crankcase.
M9 x 105 mm (4.1 in) bolts: “1” – “10”
M8 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolt: “11” LOCTITE®
M8 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolts: “12”, “16”
M6 x 70 mm (2.8 in) bolts: “19”, “21”, “23”
M6 x 65 mm (2.5 in) bolts: “17”, “18”
M6 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolt and washer: “22”
M6 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolts: “24”, “25”
M6 x 50 mm (2.0 in) bolts: “20”, “26”
M8 x 50 mm (2.0 in) bolts: “13” – “15”
5-69
EAS25950
CRANKSHAFT
Removing the connecting rods and pistons
CRANKSHAFT
Order Job/Parts to remove
Lower crankcase
6
7
4
5
1
2
3
8
9
10
11
12
Connecting rod cap
Big end lower bearing
Big end upper bearing
Piston pin clip
Piston pin
Piston
Connecting rod
Top ring
2nd ring
Oil ring
Cylinder
Cylinder gasket
5-70
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5-
66.
4
4
8
4
4
4
4
4
1
4
4
1
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
Removing the crankshaft
CRANKSHAFT
Order Job/Parts to remove
Crankcase
5
6
7
3
4
1
2
Connecting rod and connecting rod caps
Crankshaft
Crankshaft journal lower bearing
Crankshaft journal upper bearing
Washer
Crankshaft drive gear
Pin
Pickup rotor
1
1
1
5
1
1
5
Q’ty Remarks
Separate.
Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5-
66.
Refer to «REMOVING THE CON-
NECTING RODS AND PISTONS» on page 5-72.
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
5-71
EAS26030
REMOVING THE CONNECTING RODS AND
PISTONS
The following procedure applies to all of the connecting rods and pistons.
1. Remove:
• Connecting rod cap “1”
• Big end bearings
NOTE:
• Idetify the position of each big end bearing so that it can be reinstalled in its original place.
• After removing the connecting rods and connecting rod caps, care should be taken not to damage the mating surfaces of the connecting rods and connecting rod caps.
CRANKSHAFT
Piston pin puller set
90890-01304
Piston pin puller
YU-01304
2. Remove:
• Cylinder
• Cylinder gasket
• Cylinder stud bolts
3. Remove:
• Piston pin clips “1”
• Piston pin “2”
• Piston “3”
EC2D1006
CAUTION:
Do not use a hammer to drive the piston pin out.
NOTE:
• For reference during installation, put identification marks on the piston crown.
• Before removing the piston pin, deburr the piston pin clip groove and the piston pin bore area. If both areas are debarred and the piston pin is still difficult to remove, remove it with the piston pin puller set “4”.
4. Remove:
• Top ring
• 2nd ring
• Oil ring
NOTE:
When removing a piston ring, open the end gap with your fingers and lift the other side of the ring over the piston crown.
EAS25980
REMOVING THE CRANKSHAFT ASSEMBLY
1. Remove:
• Crankshaft assembly
• Crankshaft journal upper bearings
(from the upper crankcase)
Refer to «CRANKSHAFT» on page 5-70.
5-72
NOTE:
Identify the position of each crankshaft journal upper bearing so that it can be reinstalled in its original place.
ET2D1032
CHECKING THE CYLINDER AND PISTON
1. Check:
• Piston wall
• Cylinder wall
Vertical scratches
→
Replace the cylinder, and the piston and piston rings as a set.
2. Measure:
• Piston-to-cylinder clearance
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Measure cylinder bore “C” with the cylinder bore gauge.
NOTE:
Measure cylinder bore “C” by taking side-toside and front-to-back measurements of the cylinder. Then, find the average of the measurements.
Cylinder bore “C”
Wear limit
Taper limit “T”
Out of round “R”
77.00 – 77.01 mm
(3.0315 – 3.0319 in)
77.06 mm (3.03 in)
0.005 mm (0.0002 in)
0.005 mm (0.0002 in)
“C” = maximum of D
1
– D
6
“T” = maximum of D
1
or D
2
– maximum of D
5
or D
6
“R” = maximum of D
1
D
3
or D
5
– minimum of D
2
D
4
or D
6
CRANKSHAFT
4 mm (0.16 in) “a” from the bottom edge of the piston
Piston size “P”
76.975 — 76.990 mm
(3.0305 — 3.0311 in)
d. If out of specification, replace the piston and piston rings as a set.
e. Calculate the piston-to-cylinder clearance with the following formula.
Piston-to-cylinder clearance =
Cylinder bore “C” –
Piston skirt diameter “P”
Piston-to-cylinder clearance
0.010–0.035 mm
(0.0004–0.0014 in)
Limit: 0.120 mm (0.0047 in)
f.
If out of specification, replace the cylinder, and the piston and piston rings as a set.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1015
CHECKING THE PISTON RINGS
1. Measure:
• Piston ring side clearance
Out of specification
→
Replace the piston and piston rings as a set.
NOTE:
Before measuring the piston ring side clearance, eliminate any carbon deposits from the piston ring grooves and piston rings.
b. If out of specification, replace the cylinder, and the pistons and piston rings as a set.
c. Measure piston skirt diameter “P” with the micrometer.
5-73
Piston ring side clearance
Top ring
0.030–0.065 mm
(0.0012–0.0026 in)
Limit
0.115 mm (0.0045 in)
2nd ring
0.020–0.055 mm
(0.0008–0.0022 in)
Limit
0.115 mm (0.0045 in)
2. Install:
• Piston ring
(into the cylinder)
NOTE:
Level the piston ring into the cylinder with the piston crown.
5 mm (0.20 in) “a”
CRANKSHAFT
Piston ring end gap
Top ring
0.15–0.25 mm
(0.0059–0.0098 in)
Limit
0.50 mm (0.0197 in)
2nd ring
0.30–0.45 mm
(0.0118–0.0177 in)
Limit
0.80 mm (0.0315 in)
Oil ring
0.10–0.40 mm
(0.0039–0.0157 in)
ET2D1016
CHECKING THE PISTON PINS
The following procedure applies to all of the piston pins.
1. Check:
• Piston pin
Blue discoloration/grooves
→
Replace the piston pin and then check the lubrication system.
2. Measure:
• Piston pin outside diameter “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the piston pin.
Piston pin bore outside diameter
16.991–17.000 mm
(0.6689–0.6693 in)
Limit
16.971 mm (0.6682 in)
3. Measure:
• Piston ring end gap
Out of specification
→
Replace the piston ring.
NOTE:
The oil ring expander spacer’s end gap cannot be measured. If the oil ring rail’s gap is excessive, replace all three piston rings.
3. Measure:
• Piston pin bore inside diameter “b”
Out of specification
→
Replace the piston.
5-74
Piston pin bore inside diameter
17.002–17.013 mm
(0.6694–0.6698 in)
Limit
17.043 mm (0.6710 in)
CRANKSHAFT end bearings must be installed in their original positions.
a. Clean the big end bearings, crankshaft pins, and the inside of the connecting rods halves.
b. Install the big end upper bearing into the connecting rod and the big end lower bearing into the connecting rod cap.
NOTE:
Align the projections “a” on the big end bearings with the notches “b” in the connecting rod and connecting rod cap.
4. Calculate:
• Piston-pin-to-position clearance
Out of specification
→
Replace the position pin and piston as a set.
Piston-pin-to-pistonclearance =
Piston pin bore size —
Piston pin outside diameter
Piston-pin-to-piston clearance
0.002–0.022 mm
(0.0001–0.009 in)
Limit
0.072 mm (0.0028 in)
ET2D1017
CHECKING THE BIG END BEARINGS
1. Measure:
• Crankshaft-pin-to-big-end-bearing crearance
Out of specification
→
Replace the big end bearings.
Crankshaft-pin-to-big-end-bearing clearance
0.034–0.058 mm
(0.0013–0.0023 in)
Limit
0.09 mm (0.0035 in)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
The following procedure applies to all of the connecting rods.
ECA14900
CAUTION:
Do not interchange the big end bearings and connecting rods. To obtain the correct creankshaft-pin-to-big-end-bearing clearance and prevent engine damage, the big
5-75
c. Put a piece of Pleastigauge® “1” on the crankshaft pin.
d. Assemble the connecting rod halves.
NOTE:
• Do not move the connecting rod or crankshaft until the clearance measurement has been completed.
• Lubricate the bolt threads with molybdenum disulfide grease.
• Make sure that the “Y” mark “c” on the connecting rod faces towards the left side of the crankshaft.
• Make sure that the characters “d” on both the connecting rod and connecting rod cap are aligned.
CRANKSHAFT
e. Tighten the connecting rod bolts.
NOTE:
Install by carrying out the following procedures in order to assemble in the most suitable condition.
Connecting rod bolt
29.4 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 21 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• First, tighten the bolts to 15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb).
• Retighten the bolts to 29.4 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 21 ft·lb).
f.
Replace the connecting rod bolts with new ones.
g. Clean the connecting rod bolts.
h. After installing big end bearing, assemble the connecting rod and connecting rod cap once using a single unit of the connecting rod.
i.
Tighten the connecting rod bolt while checking that the sections shown “a” and
“b” are flush with each other by touching the surface.
• Side machined face “a”
• Thrusting faces (4 places at front and rear)
“b”
NOTE:
To install the big end bearing, care should be taken not to install it at an angle and the position should not be out of alignment.
j.
Loosen the connecting rod bolt, remove the connecting rod and connecting rod cap and install these parts to the crankshaft with the big end bearing kept in the current condition.
k. Tighten the connecting rod bolts.
Connecting rod bolt
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
+150
°
EC2D1014
CAUTION:
Tighten the connecting rod bolts using the plastic-region tightening angle method.
l.
Clean the connecting rod bolts.
m. Tighten the connecting rod bolts.
n. Put a mark “1” on the corner of the connecting rod bolt “2” and the connecting rod
“3”.
o. Tighten the bolt further to reach the specified angle (150
°
).
5-76
p. After the installation, check that the section shown “a” is flush with each other by touching the surface.
• Side machined face “a”
EWA13120
WARNING
• When the bolt is tightened more than the specified angle, do not loosen the bolt and then retighten it.
Replace the bolt with a new one and perform the procedure again.
• If they are not flush with each other, remove the connecting rod bolt and big end bearing and restart from step “e”. In this case, make sure to replace the connecting rod bolt.
EC2D1015
CAUTION:
• Do not use a torque wrench to tighten the nut to the specified angle.
• Tighten the bolt until it is at the specified angles.
CRANKSHAFT
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Select:
• Big end bearings (P1 – P4)
NOTE:
• The numbers “A” stamped into the crankshaft wed and the numbers “1” on the connecting rods are used to determine the replacement big end bearings sizes.
• “P1” — ”P4” refer to the bearings shown in the crankshaft illustration.
For example, if the connecting rod “P
1
” and the crankshaft web “P
1
” numbers are “5” and “2” respectively, then the bearing size for “P
1
” is:
“P
1
” (connecting rod) – “P
1
”
(crankshaft) =
5 – 2 = 3 (brown)
BIG END BEARING COLOR CODE
1 Blue
2
3
4
Black
Brown
Green q. Remove the connecting rod and big end bearings.
Refer to «REMOVING THE CONNECTING
RODS AND PISTONS» on page 5-72.
r.
Measure the compressed Plastigauge® width on the crankshaft pin.
If the crankshaft-pin-to-big-end-bearing clearance is out of specification, select replacement big end bearings.
5-77
EAS26190
INSTALLING THE CONNECTING ROD AND
PISTON
The following procedure applies to all of the connecting rods and pistons.
1. Install:
• Top ring “1”
• 2nd ring “2”
• Upper oil ring rail “3”
• Oil ring expander “4”
• Lower oil ring rail “5”
NOTE:
Be sure to install the piston rings so that the manufacturer’s marks or numbers “a” face up.
CRANKSHAFT
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil
4. Offset:
• Piston ring end gaps
2. Install:
• Piston “1”
(onto the respective connecting rod “2”)
• Piston pin “3”
• Piston pin clip “4”
NOTE:
• Apply engine oil onto the piston pin.
• Make sure that the “Y” mark “a” on the connecting rod faces left when the arrow mark
“b” on the piston is pointing up as shown.
• Reinstall each piston into its original cylinder
(numbering order starting from the left: #1 to
#4).
a. Top ring b. Lower oil ring rail c. Upper oil ring rail d. 2nd ring e. Oil ring expander
5. Lubricate:
• Crankshaft pins
• Big end bearings
• Connecting rod big end inner surface
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil
6. Check:
• Cylinder stud bolts “1”
Cylinder stud bolt
8 Nm (0.8 m·kg, 5.8 ft·lb)
3. Lubricate:
• Piston
• Piston rings
• Cylinder
5-78
7. Install:
• Cylinder gasket “2”
8. Install:
• Big end bearings
(onto the connecting rods and connecting rod caps)
NOTE:
• Align the projections “a” on the big end bearings with the notches “b” in the connecting rods and connecting rod caps.
• Be sure to reinstall each big end bearing in its original place.
• Make sure that the characters “c” a on both the connecting rod and connecting rod cap are aligned.
CRANKSHAFT
NOTE:
• Install by carrying out the following procedures in order to assemble in the most suitable condition.
• First tighten the bolts to 15 Nm (1.5 m·kg, 11 ft·lb)
• Retighten the bolts to 29.4 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 21 ft·lb)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Replace the connecting rod bolts with new ones.
b. Clean the connecting rod bolts.
c. After installing the big end bearing, assemble the connecting rod and connecting rod cap once using a single unit of the connecting rod.
d. Tighten the connecting rod bolt while checking that the sections shown “a” and
“b” are flush with each other by touching the surface.
NOTE:
To install the big end bearing, care should be taken not to install it at an angle and the position should not be out of alignment.
9. Tighten:
• Connecting rod bolts
Connecting rod bolt
29.4 Nm (3.0 m·kg, 21 ft·lb)
5-79
a. Side machined face b. Thrusting faces (4 places at front and rear) e. Loosen the connecting rod bolt, remove the connecting rod and connecting rod cap and install these parts to the crankshaft with the big end bearing kept in the current condition.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
10. Install:
• Piston assemblies “1”
(into the cylinder)
NOTE:
While compressing the piston rings with one hand, install the connecting rod assembly into the cylinder with the other hand.
CRANKSHAFT
ECA14980
CAUTION:
Tighten the connecting rod bolts using the plastic-region tightening angle method.
a. Clean the connecting rod bolts.
b. Tighten the connecting rod bolts.
c. Put a mark “1” on the connecting rod bolt
“2” and the connecting rod cap “3”.
11. Install:
• Cylinder assembly “1”
• Connecting rod caps “2”
NOTE:
• Make sure that the “Y” marks “a” on the connecting rods face towards the left side of the crankshaft.
• Make sure that the characters on both the connecting rod and connecting rod cap are aligned.
d. Tighten the bolt further to reach the specified angle (150
°
).
e. After the installation, check that the section shown “a” is flush with each other by touching the surface.
12. Tighten:
• Connecting rod bolts
Connecting rod bolt
20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)+150
°
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Side machined face
EWA13990
WARNING
• When the bolt is tightened more than the specified angle, do not loosen the bolt and then retighten it. Replace the bolt with a new one and perform the procedure again.
5-80
CRANKSHAFT
• If they are not flush with each other, remove the connecting rod bolt and big end bearing and restart from step “9”. In this case, make sure to replace the connecting rod bolt.
ECA14680
CAUTION:
• Do not use a torque wrench to tighten the bolt to the specified angle.
• Tighten the bolt until it is at the specified angles.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1018
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT
1. Measure:
• Crankshaft runout
Out of specification
→
Replace the crankshaft.
Crankshaft runout
Less than 0.03 mm (0.0012 in)
2. Check:
• Crankshaft journal surfaces
• Crankshaft pin surfaces
• Bearing surfaces
Scratches/wear
→
Replace the crankshaft.
ET2D1019
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT DRIVE
SPROCKET
1. Check:
• Crankshaft drive sprocket “1”
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace the defective part(s).
ET2D1020
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT JOURNAL
BEARINGS
1. Measure:
• Crankshaft-journal-to-crankshaft-journalbearing clearance
Out of specification
→
Replace the crankshaft journal bearings.
Crankshaft-journal-to-crankshaft-journal-bearing clearance
0.014–0.037 mm
(0.0006–0.0015 in)
Limit
0.10 mm (0.0039 in)
EC2D1008
CAUTION:
Do not interchange the crankshaft journal bearings. To obtain the correct crankshaftjournal-to-crankshaft-journal-bearing clearance and prevent engine damage, the crankshaft journal bearings must be installed in their original positions.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Clean the crankshaft journal bearings, cranshaft journals, and bearing portions of the crankcase.
b. Place the upper crankcase upside down on a bench.
c. Install the crankshaft journal upper bearings “1” and the crankshaft into the upper crankcase.
NOTE:
Align the projections “a” on the crankshaft journal upper bearings with the notches “b” in the upper crankcase.
5-81
d. Put a piece of Plastigauge® “2” on each crankshaft journal.
NOTE:
Do not put the Plastigauge® over the oil hole in the crankshaft journal.
CRANKSHAFT
Crankcase bolt
Bolt “1”–“10”
1st: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
2nd: 20 Nm (2.0 m·kg, 14 ft·lb)
3rd: +60
°
Bolt “11”–“16”
24 Nm (2.4m·kg, 17 ft·lb)
Bolt “17”–“26”
12 Nm (1.2m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
M9 x 105 mm (4.1 in) bolts: “1”–“10”
M8 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolt: “11” LOCTITE®
M8 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolts: “12”, “16”
M6 x 70 mm (2.8 in) bolts: “19”, “21”, “23”
M6 x 65 mm (2.5 in) bolts: “17”, “18”
M6 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolt and washer: “22”
M6 x 60 mm (2.4 in) bolts: “24”, “25”
M6 x 50 mm (2.0 in) bolts: “20”, “26”
M8 x 50 mm (2.0 in) bolts: “13”–“15”
* Following the tightening order, loosen the bolt one by one and then retighten it to the specific torque.
NOTE:
Lubricate the crankcase bolt threads with engine oil.
Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5-66.
e. Install the crankshaft journal lower bearings “1” into the lower crankcase and assemble the crankcase halves.
NOTE:
• Align the projections “a” of the crankshaft journal lower bearings with the notches “b” in the lower crankcase.
• Do not move the crankshaft until the clearance measurement has been completed.
f.
Tighten the bolts to specification in the tightening sequence cast on the crankcase.
g. Remove the lower crankcase and the crankshaft journal lower bearings.
h. Measure the compressed Plastigauge® width “c” on each crankshaft journal.
If the crankshaft-journal-to-crankshaft-journal-bearing clearance is out of specification, select replacement crankshaft journal bearings.
5-82
CRANKSHAFT
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Select:
• Crankshaft journal bearings (J1–J5)
NOTE:
• The numbers “A” stamped into the crankshaft web and the numbers “1” stamped into the lower crankcase are used to determine the replacement crankshaft journal bearing sizes.
• “J1–J5” refer to the bearings shown in the crankshaft illustration.
• If “J1–J5” are the same, use the same size for all of the bearings.
• If the size is the same for all “J
1
to J
5
” one digit for that size is indicated. (Crankcase side only)
For example, if the crankcase “J
1
” and crankshaft web “J
1
” numbers are “6” and
“2” respectively, then the bearing size for
“J
1
” is:
“J
1
” (crankcase) – “J
1
”
(crankshaft web) – 1 =
6 – 2 – 1 = 3 (brown)
CRANKSHAFT JOURNAL BEARING
COLOR CODE
0 White
3
4
1
2
Blue
Black
Brown
Green
ET2D1021
INSTALLING THE CRANKSHAFT
1. Install:
• Crankshaft journal upper bearings “1”
(into the upper crankcase)
2. Lubricate:
• Crankshaft journal upper bearings
(with the recommended lubricant)
Recommended lubricant
Engine oil
5-83
NOTE:
• Align the projections “a” on the crankshaft journal upper bearings with the notches “b” in the upper crankcase.
• Be sure to install each crankshaft journal upper bearing in its original place.
3. Install:
• Crankshaft
4. Install:
• Crankcase (lower)
Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5-66.
5. Install:
• Pin
• Pickup rotor “1”
• Drive sprocket “2”
Drive sprocket bolt
60 Nm (6.0 m·kg, 43 ft·lb)
CRANKSHAFT
5-84
EAS26240
TRANSMISSION
Removing the transmission, shift drum assembly, and shift forks
TRANSMISSION
Order Job/Parts to remove
Crankcase lower
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
9
10
11
12
13
Drive axle assembly
Circlip
Oil seal
Bearing
Washer
Shift fork guide bar retainer
Spring
Shift fork guide bar
Shift fork “L”
Shift fork “R”
Shift drum assembly
Shift fork “C”
Main axle retainer
5-85
2
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Separate.
Refer to «CRANKCASE» on page 5-
66.
Removing the transmission, shift drum assembly, and shift forks
TRANSMISSION
Order
14
15
16
17
Job/Parts to remove
Main axle assembly
Oil pipe
O-ring
Oil baffle plate
Q’ty
1
1
2
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
5-86
Disassembling the main axle assenbly
TRANSMISSION
12
13
14
15
8
9
10
11
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
Job/Parts to remove
2nd pinion gear
Toothed lock washer
Toothed lock washer retainer
6th pinion gear
Collar
Washer
Circlip
3rd pinion gear
Circlip
Washer
5th pinion gear
Collar
Main axle
Bearing housing
Bearing
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
5-87
Disassembling the drive axle assenbly
TRANSMISSION
12
13
14
15
8
9
10
11
16
17
18
19
20
Order
1
2
3
6
7
4
5
Job/Parts to remove
Washer
1st wheel gear
Collar
5th wheel gear
Circlip
Washer
3rd wheel gear
Collar
Toothed lock washer
Toothed lock washer retainer
4th wheel gear
Collar
Washer
Circlip
6th wheel gear
Circlip
Washer
Collar
2nd wheel gear
Collar
5-88
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
Disassembling the drive axle assenbly
TRANSMISSION
Order
21
22
23
Job/Parts to remove
Oil seal
Bearing
Drive axle
Q’ty
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
5-89
TRANSMISSION
EAS26250
REMOVING THE TRANSMISSION
1. Remove:
• Drive axle asseembly “1”
• Shift drum retainers “2”
• Shift fork guide bars
• Shift fork “L” and “R”
• Shift drum assembly
• Shift fork “C”
2. Remove:
• Bearing housing “1”
• Main axle assembly “2”
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Insert two bolts “3” of the proper size, as shown in the illustration, into the main axle assembly bearing housing.
EAS26260
CHECKING THE SHIFT FORKS
The following procedure applies to all of the shift forks.
1. Check:
• Shift fork cam follower “1”
• Shift fork pawl “2”
Bends/damage/scoring/wear
→
Replace the shift fork.
b. Tighten the bolts until they contact the crankcase surface.
c. Continue tightening the bolts until the main axle assembly comes free from the upper crankcase.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Remove:
• Oil pipe “1”
• Bearing “2”
2. Check:
• Shift fork guide bar
Roll the shift fork guide bar on a flat surface.
Bends
→
Replace.
EWA12840
WARNING
Do not attempt to straighten a bent shift fork guide bar.
5-90
TRANSMISSION
Out of specification
→
Replace the main axle.
Main axle runout limit
0.08 mm (0.0032 in)
3. Check:
• Shift fork movement
(along the shift fork guide bar)
Rough movement
→
Replace the shift forks and shift fork guide bar as a set.
2. Measure:
• Drive axle runout
(with a centering device and dial gauge “1”)
Out of specification
→
Replace the drive axle.
Drive axle runout limit
0.08 mm (0.0032 in)
EAS26270
CHECKING THE SHIFT DRUM ASSEMBLY
1. Check:
• Shift drum grooves “1”
Damage/scratches/wear
→
Replace the shift drum assembly.
• Shift drum segment “2”
Damage/wear
→
Replace the shift drum assembly.
• Shift drum bearing “3”
Damage/pitting
→
Replace the shift drum assembly.
3. Check:
• Transmission gears
Blue discoloration/pitting/wear
→
Replace the defective gear(s).
• Transmission gear dogs
Cracks/damage/rounded edges
→
Replace the defective gear(s).
EAS26280
CHECKING THE TRANSMISSION
1. Measure:
• Main axle runout
(with a centering device and dial gauge “1”)
5-91
TRANSMISSION
ET2D1022
INSTALLING THE TRANSMISSION
1. Install:
• Bearing “1”
NOTE:
Make the seal side of bearing face to the outside and install it close to the right end face of the crankcase.
• Oil pipe “2”
2. Install:
• Main axle assembly “1”
• Bearing housing “2”
Bearing housing bolt
12 Nm (1.2 m·kg, 8.7 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
• Shift fork “C”
• Shift drum assembly
• Shift fork guide bar
• Shift fork guide bar retainer
Shift fork guide bar retainer bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
NOTE:
• The embossed marks on the shift forks should face towards the right side of the engine and be in the following sequence: “R”,
“C”, “L”.
• Carefully position the shift forks so that they are installed correctly into the transmission gears.
• Install shift fork “C” into the groove in the 3rd and 4th pinion gear on the main axle.
3. Install:
• Shift fork “L” “1” and “R” “2”
• Drive axle assembly “3”
• Shift fork guide bar
• Shift fork guide bar retainer “4”
Shift fork guide bar retainer bolt
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
LOCTITE®
NOTE:
• Install shift fork “L” into the groove in the 6th wheel gear and shift fork “R” into the groove in the 5th wheel gear on the drive axle.
• Make sure that the drive axle bearing circlip
“a” is inserted into the grooves in the upper crankcase.
5-92
4. Check:
• Transmission
Rough movement
→
Repair.
NOTE:
Oil each gear, shaft, and bearing thoroughly.
5-93
TRANSMISSION
COOLING SYSTEM
RADIATOR
………………………………………………………………………………………. 6-1
CHECKING THE RADIATOR………………………………………………………… 6-3
INSTALLING THE RADIATOR ………………………………………………………. 6-3
OIL COOLER
…………………………………………………………………………………… 6-4
CHECKING THE OIL COOLER…………………………………………………….. 6-5
INSTALLING THE OIL COOLER …………………………………………………… 6-5
THERMOSTAT
…………………………………………………………………………………. 6-6
CHECKING THE THERMOSTAT…………………………………………………… 6-8
ASSEMBLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEMBLY …………………………….. 6-8
INSTALLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEMBLY ……………………………….. 6-8
WATER PUMP
……………………………………………………………………………….. 6-10
DISASSEMBLING THE WATER PUMP ……………………………………….. 6-11
CHECKING THE WATER PUMP …………………………………………………. 6-11
ASSEMBLING THE WATER PUMP …………………………………………….. 6-11
6
EAS26380
RADIATOR
Removing the radiator
RADIATOR
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Fuel tank
Air filter case
Coolant
7
8
5
6
9
3
4
1
2
Radiator side covers
Coolant reservoir hose
Radiator front cover
Radiator
Radiator fan motor
Radiator inlet hose
Oil cooler outlet hose
Water pump breather hose
Radiator outlet hose
6-1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE COOL-
ANT» on page 3-19.
Removing the radiator
RADIATOR
Order
10
11
Job/Parts to remove
Water pump inlet pipe
O-ring
Q’ty
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
6-2
RADIATOR
EAS26390
CHECKING THE RADIATOR
1. Check:
• Radiator fins
Obstruction
→
Clean.
Apply compressed air to the rear of the radiator.
Damage
→
Repair or replace.
NOTE:
Straighten any flattened fins with a thin, flathead screwdriver.
2. Check:
• Radiator hoses
• Radiator pipes
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
3. Measure:
• Radiator cap opening pressure
Below the specified pressure
→
Replace the radiator cap.
Radiator cap opening pressure
93.3 — 122.7 kPa
(0.93 — 1.23 kg/cm
2
, 0.9 — 1.2 bar, 13.5 — 17.8 psi)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Install the radiator cap tester “1” and radiator cap tester adapter “2” to the radiator cap “3”.
Radiator cap tester
90890-01325
Radiator pressure tester
YU-24460-01
Radiator cap tester adapter
90890-01352
Radiator pressure tester adapter
YU-33984
b. Apply the specified pressure for ten seconds and make sure there is no drop in pressure.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Check:
• Radiator fan
Damage
→
Replace.
Malfunction
→
Check and repair.
Refer to «RADIATOR» on page 6-1.
EAS26400
INSTALLING THE RADIATOR
1. Fill:
• Cooling system
(with the specified amount of the recommended coolant)
Refer to «CHANGING THE COOLANT» on page 3-19.
2. Check:
• Cooling system
Leaks
→
Repair or replace any faulty part.
3. Measure:
• Radiator cap opening pressure
Below the specified pressure
→
Replace the radiator cap.
Refer to «CHECKING THE RADIATOR» on page 6-3.
6-3
EAS26410
OIL COOLER
Removing the oil cooler
OIL COOLER
Order Job/Parts to remove
Engine oil
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
9
10
11
12
Oil cooler inlet hose
Oil cooler bolt
Washer
Oil cooler
O-ring
Water pump outlet pipe
O-ring
Water jacket joint inlet hose
O-ring
Water jacket joint
Stay
O-ring
6-4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE
OIL» on page 3-12.
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
EAS26420
CHECKING THE OIL COOLER
1. Check:
• Oil cooler
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
2. Check:
• Oil cooler inlet hose
• Oil cooler outlet hose
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS26430
INSTALLING THE OIL COOLER
1. Clean:
• Mating surfaces of the oil cooler and the crankcase
(with a cloth dampened with lacquer thinner)
2. Install:
• O-ring
• Oil cooler “1”
• Washer “2”
• Oil cooler bolt “3”
Oil cooler bolt
63 Nm (6.3 m·kg, 46 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• Before installing the oil cooler, lubricate the oil cooler bolt and O-ring with a thin coat of engine oil.
• Make sure the O-ring is positioned properly.
• Align the projection “a” on the oil cooler with the slot “b” in the crankcase.
OIL COOLER
3. Fill:
• Cooling system
(with the specified amount of the recommended coolant)
Refer to «CHANGING THE COOLANT» on page 3-19.
• Crankcase
(with the specified amount of the recommended engine oil)
Refer to «CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL» on page 3-12.
4. Check:
• Cooling system
Leaks
→
Repair or replace any faulty part.
5. Measure:
• Radiator cap opening pressure
Below the specified pressure
→
Replace the radiator cap.
Refer to «CHECKING THE RADIATOR» on page 6-3.
6-5
EAS26440
THERMOSTAT
Removing the thermostat assembly
THERMOSTAT
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Fuel tank
Air filter case
Coolant
3
4
1
2
Thermostat assembly outlet hose
Thermostat assembly
Thermostat assembly inlet hose
Band
1
2
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Drain.
Refer to «CHANGING THE COOL-
ANT» on page 3-19.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
6-6
Disassembling the thermostat assembly
THERMOSTAT
Order
1
2
3
4
Job/Parts to remove
Thermostat housing cover
Thermostat
Thermostat housing
O-ring
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the disassembly procedure.
6-7
EAS26450
CHECKING THE THERMOSTAT
1. Check:
• Thermostat
Does not open at 71 – 85
°
C (160 – 185
°
F)
→
Replace.
THERMOSTAT
• Thermostat housing “2”
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Suspend the thermostat “3” in a container
“4” filled with water.
b. Slowly heat the water “2”.
c. Place a thermometer “1” in the water.
d. While stirring the water, observe the thermostat and thermometer’s indicated temperature.
EAS26460
ASSEMBLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEM-
BLY
1. Install:
• Thermostat housing “1”
• Thermostat “2”
• O-ring “3”
• Thermostat housing cover “4”
Thermostat housing cover nut
10 Nm (1.0 m·kg, 7.2 ft·lb)
NOTE:
Install the thermostat with its breather hole “a” facing up.
A. Fully closed
B. Fully open
NOTE:
If the accuracy of the thermostat is in doubt, replace it. A faulty thermostat could cause serious overheating or overcooling.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Check:
• Thermostat housing cover “1”
6-8
EAS26480
INSTALLING THE THERMOSTAT ASSEM-
BLY
1. Fill:
• Cooling system
(with the specified amount of the recommended coolant)
Refer to «CHANGING THE COOLANT» on page 3-19.
2. Check:
• Cooling system
Leaks
→
Repair or replace any faulty part.
3. Measure:
• Radiator cap opening pressure
Below the specified pressure
→
Replace the radiator cap.
Refer to «CHECKING THE RADIATOR» on page 6-3.
THERMOSTAT
6-9
EAS26500
WATER PUMP
Removing the impeller shaft
WATER PUMP
6
7
4
5
8
1
2
3
Order Job/Parts to remove
Oil/water pump assembly
Oil pump roter
Water pump cover
O-ring
Pin
Impeller shaft (along with the impeller)
Water pump seal
Oil seal
Bearing
O-ring
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «OIL PUMP» on page 5-58.
Refer to «OIL PUMP» on page 5-58.
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
6-10
WATER PUMP
EAS26520
DISASSEMBLING THE WATER PUMP
1. Remove:
• Water pump seal “1”
• Water pump housing “2”
NOTE:
Tap out the water pump seal from the inside of the water pump housing.
2. Remove:
• Oil seal “1”
• Bearing “2”
• Water pump housing “3”
NOTE:
Tap out the bearing and oil seal from the outside of the water pump housing.
EAS26540
CHECKING THE WATER PUMP
1. Check:
• Water pump housing cover “1”
• Water pump housing “2”
• Impeller “3”
• Rubber damper “4”
• Rubber damper holder “5”
• Water pump seals
• Oil seal
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
3. Remove:
• Rubber damper holder “1”
• Rubber damper “2”
(from the impeller, with a thin, flat-head screwdriver)
NOTE:
Do not scratch the impeller shaft.
2. Check:
• Bearing
Rough movement
→
Replace.
3. Check:
• Water pump outlet pipe
Cracks/damage/wear
→
Replace.
EAS26560
ASSEMBLING THE WATER PUMP
1. Install:
• Oil seal “1”
(into the water pump housing “2”)
NOTE:
• Before installing the oil seal, apply tap water or coolant onto its out surface.
• Install the oil seal with a socket that matches its outside diameter.
6-11
WATER PUMP
NOTE:
Before installing the rubber damper, apply tap water or coolant onto its outer surface.
2. Install:
• Water pump seal “1”
ECA14080
CAUTION:
Never lubricate the water pump seal surface with oil or grease.
NOTE:
• Install the water pump seal with the special tools.
• Before installing the water pump seal, apply
Yamaha bond No.1215 (Three Bond
No.1215® ) “2” to the water pump housing
“3”.
Mechanical seal installer “4”
90890-04078
Water pump seal installer
YM-33221-A
Middle driven shaft bearing driver “5”
90890-04058
Bearing driver 40 mm
YM-04058
Yamaha bond No. 1215 (Three
Bond No.1215®)
90890-85505
4. Measure:
• Impeller shaft tilt
Out of specification
→
Repeat steps (3) and (4).
ECA14090
CAUTION:
Make sure the rubber damper and rubber damper holder are flush with the impeller.
Impeller shaft tilt limit
0.15 mm (0.006 in)
1. Straightedge
2. Impeller
A. Push down.
3. Install:
• Rubber damper holder “1”
• Rubber damper “2”
6-12
6-13
WATER PUMP
FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL TANK
…………………………………………………………………………………….. 7-1
REMOVING THE FUEL TANK ………………………………………………………. 7-2
REMOVING THE FUEL PUMP……………………………………………………… 7-2
CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP BODY ……………………………………………. 7-2
CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP OPERATION ………………………………….. 7-2
INSTALLING THE FUEL PUMP ……………………………………………………. 7-2
INSTALLING THE FUEL TANK……………………………………………………… 7-3
THROTTLE BODIES
…………………………………………………………………………. 7-4
CHECKING THE INJECTORS ……………………………………………………… 7-8
CHECKING THE THROTTLE BODIES ………………………………………….. 7-8
CHECKING THE FUEL PRESSURE……………………………………………… 7-8
ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ……………………….. 7-8
ADJUSTING THE SUB-THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ……………….. 7-9
CHECKING THE SUB-THROTTLE SERVO MOTOR ……………………… 7-10
CHECKING THE THERMO WAX ………………………………………………… 7-11
ADJUSTING THE THERMO WAX……………………………………………….. 7-11
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
………………………………………………………………. 7-13
CHECKING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM ………………………………… 7-14
INSTALLING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM ………………………………. 7-15
7
EAS26620
FUEL TANK
Removing the fuel tank
FUEL TANK
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
6
7
4
5
8
1
2
3
Fuel hose
Fuel sender coupler
Fuel pump coupler
Fuel tank drain hose
Fuel tank breather hose
Fuel tank
Fuel tank cover
Fuel pump
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
7-1
EAS26630
REMOVING THE FUEL TANK
1. Extract the fuel in the fuel tank through the fuel tank cap with a pump.
2. Remove:
• Fuel hose connector cover
• Fuel hose
• Fuel sender coupler
• Fuel pump coupler
• Fuel tank breather hose
• Fuel tank drain hose
EC2D1009
CAUTION:
• Be sure to disconnect the fuel hose by hand. Do not forcefully disconnect the hose with tools.
• Although the fuel has been removed from the fuel tank be careful when removing the fuel hoses, since there may be fuel remaining in it.
NOTE:
• To remove the fuel hose from the fuel injection pipe, slide the cover “a” on the end of the hose in the direction of the arrow shown and then remove the hose.
• Before removing the hoses, place a few rags in the area under where it will be removed.
3. Remove:
• Fuel tank
NOTE:
Do not set the fuel tank down so that the installation surface of the fuel pump is directly under the tank. Be sure to lean the fuel tank in an upright position.
EAS26640
REMOVING THE FUEL PUMP
1. Remove:
• Fuel pump
FUEL TANK
ECA14720
CAUTION:
• Do not drop the fuel pump or give it a strong shock.
• Do not touch the base section of the fuel sender.
EAS26670
CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP BODY
1. Check:
• Fuel pump body
Obstruction
→
Clean.
Cracks/damage
→
Replace fuel pump assembly.
2. Check:
• Diaphragms and gaskets
Turn/fatigue/cracks
→
Replace fuel pump assembly.
3. Check:
• Valves
Cracks/damage
→
Replace fuel pump assembly.
EAS26690
CHECKING THE FUEL PUMP OPERATION
1. Check:
• Fuel pump operation
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUEL PRES-
SURE» on page 7-8.
EAS26710
INSTALLING THE FUEL PUMP
1. Install:
• Fuel pump
Fuel pump bolt
4 Nm (0.4 m·kg, 2.9 ft·lb)
NOTE:
• Do not damage the installation surface of the fuel tank when installing the fuel pump.
• Always use a new fuel pump gasket.
• Install the fuel pump as shown in the illustration.
• Align the projection “a” on the fuel pump with the slot in the fuel pump bracket.
• Tighten the fuel pump bolts in stages in a crisscross pattern and to the specified torque.
7-2
ET2D1023
INSTALLING THE FUEL TANK
1. Install:
• Fuel hose
• Fuel hose connector cover
ECA14740
CAUTION:
When installing the fuel hose, make sure that it is securely connected, and that the fuel hose holders are in the correct position, otherwise the fuel hose will not be properly installed.
NOTE:
Install the fuel hose connector securely onto the fuel tank until a distinct “click” is heard, and then make sure that it does not come loose.
To install the fuel hose from the fuel injection hose, slide the cover “a” on the end of the hose in the direction of arrow shown.
2. Install:
• Fuel sender coupler
• Fuel pump coupler
• Fuel tank breather hose
• Fuel tank drain hose
NOTE:
There is white paint mark on the fuel tank breather hose.
Refer to «CABLE ROUTING» on page 2-39.
7-3
FUEL TANK
EAS26970
THROTTLE BODIES
Removing the throttle bodies
THROTTLE BODIES
7
8
5
6
3
4
1
2
9
10
Order Job/Parts to remove
Rider and passenger seat
Fuel tank
Air filter case
Sub-wire harness coupler
Coolant temperature sensor coupler
Thermo wax inret hose
Thermo wax outlet hose
Idle adjust screw wire
Throttle body joint clamp
Throttle bodies
Throttle cables
Throttle body joint
Fuel hose
1
2
1
4
4
1
1
1
2
1
Q’ty Remarks
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Refer to «FUEL TANK» on page 7-1.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-1.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Loosen.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
7-4
Removing the throttle bodies
THROTTLE BODIES
Order Job/Parts to remove Q’ty Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
7-5
Removing the injectors
THROTTLE BODIES
11
12
13
14
7
8
9
10
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
15
16
17
18
Job/Parts to remove
Throttle position sensor coupler
Sub-throttle position sensor coupler
Sub-throttle motor assembly coupler
Intake air pressure sensor coupler
Cylinder #1-injector coupler
Cylinder #2-injector coupler
Cylinder #3-injector coupler
Cylinder #4-injector coupler
Sub-wire harness
Negative pressure hose
Intake air pressure sensor
Fuel distributor
Injector
Spring
Thermo wax assembly
Idle adjust screw wire
Link cover
Cotter pin
7-6
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
Q’ty
1
1
1
1
1
1
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Loosen.
Remarks
Removing the injectors
THROTTLE BODIES
Order
19
20
21
22
23
Job/Parts to remove
Washer
Link
Sub-throttle servo motor assembly
Throttle position sensor
Throttle body assembly
Q’ty
2
1
1
1
1
Remarks
For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
7-7
THROTTLE BODIES
EAS26980
CHECKING THE INJECTORS
1. Check:
• Injectors
Damage
→
Replace.
EAS26990
CHECKING THE THROTTLE BODIES
1. Check:
• Throttle bodies
Cracks/damage
→
Replace the throttle bodies as a set.
2. Check:
• Fuel passages
Obstructions
→
Clean.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Wash the throttle bodies in a petroleum- based solvent.
Do not use any caustic carburetor cleaning solution.
b. Blow out all of the passages with compressed air.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1033
CHECKING THE FUEL PRESSURE
1. Check:
• Fuel pressure
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the rider and passenger seat.
Refer to «GENERAL CHASSIS» on page 4-
1.
b. Disconnect the fuel hose (fuel tank to primary injector fuel rail) “1” from the primary injector fuel rail.
EW2C01008
WARNING
Cover fuel hose connections with a cloth when disconnecting them. Residual pressure in the fuel lines could cause fuel to spurt out when removing the hoses.
c. Connect the pressure gauge “2” and adapter “3” to the fuel hose (fuel tank to primary injector fuel rail).
Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set
90890-06756
Pressure gauge
90890-03153
YU-03153
Fuel pressure adapter
90890-03176
YM-03176
d. Start the engine.
e. Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure
324 kPa (46.1 psi) (3.24 kg/ cm²)
Faulty
→
Replace the fuel pump.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS27020
ADJUSTING THE THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
NOTE:
Before adjusting the throttle position sensor, the engine idling speed should be properly adjusted.
7-8
1. Check:
• Throttle position sensor
Refer to «CHECKING THE THROTTLE
POSITION SENSOR» on page 8-109.
2. Adjust:
• Throttle position sensor angle
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the throttle position sensor coupler to the wire harness.
b. Connect the digital circuit tester to the throttle position sensor.
• Positive tester probe yellow terminal “1”
• Negative tester probe black/blue terminal “2”
Digital circuit tester
90890-03174
c. Measure the throttle position sensor voltage.
d. Adjust the throttle position sensor angle so the measured voltage is within the specified range.
Throttle position sensor voltage
0.63–0.73 V
THROTTLE BODIES
ET2D1024
ADJUSTING THE SUB-THROTTLE POSI-
TION SENSOR
1. Check:
• Sub-throttle position sensor
Refer to «CHECKING THE SUB-THROT-
TLE POSITION SENSOR» on page 8-110.
2. Adjust:
• Sub-throttle position sensor full open angle
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Turn the nut “1” of the worm shaft of the sub-throttle counterclockwise until it contacts with the full open stopper.
b. When the dimension of “a” sections of the throttle bodies #3 and #4 is measured with a micrometer caliper, adjust with the adjuster “2” of the output shaft section of the sub-throttle servo motor so that the dimension is in a range from 24.2 to 24.6 mm (0.95 to 0.97 in.)
Sub-throttle dimension “a”
24.2–24.6 mm (0.95–0.97 in)
c. After adjusting the dimension of “a” sections of the throttle bodies #3 and #4, measure the dimension of “a” sections of #1 and #2.
d. If the dimension of “a” sections of the throttle bodies #1 and #2 is different from the dimension of “a” sections of the throttle bodies #3 and #4, adjust it to the same dimension as the measurement value adjusted for the throttle bodies #3 and #4, using the tuning screw “3” located between the throttle bodies #2 and #3.
e. After adjusting the throttle position sensor angle, tighten the throttle position sensor screws.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
7-9
THROTTLE BODIES
4. Adjust:
• Sub-throttle position sensor voltage
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the sub-throttle position sensor coupler to the wire harness.
b. Connect the digital circuit tester to the subthrottle position sensor.
• Positive tester probe
Green/Yellow terminal “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue terminal “2”
Digital circuit tester
90890-03174
A. Front side
B. Rear side
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Adjust:
• Primary opening
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. After performing the full open angle of the sub-throttle position sensor, turn the nut of the worm shaft clockwise, measure the dimension of “b” section with a micrometer caliper or other device and adjust so that the dimension is in a range from 8.1 to 8.5 mm (0.32 to 0.33 in).
Sub-throttle dimension “b”
8.1–8.5 mm (0.32–0.33 in)
A. Front side
B. Rear side
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
7-10
c. Move the sub-throttle position sensor to adjust to be in the specified range.
Sub-throttle position sensor voltage
0.97–1.07 V
d. After adjusting the sub-throttle position sensor voltage, tighten the sub-throttle position sensor screws.
NOTE:
• After setting up the sub-throttle position sensor, check that the sub-throttle position sensor output voltage is 0.4 V or more with the nut of worm shaft turned to the full close side until it stops.
• When the sub-throttle position sensor output voltage is 0.4 V or more, check that the subthrottle position sensor output voltage is 4.6
V or less with the nut of worm shaft turned to the full open side until it stops.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Connect
• Sub-throttle motor assembly coupler
EAS2D1011
CHECKING THE SUB-THROTTLE SERVO
MOTOR
1. Check:
• Sub-throttle servo motor operation
Out of specification
→
Replace.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Check whether or not the sub-throttle valve is seized.
1 Turn the nut of worm shaft of the sub-throttle servo motor by hand to check that the sub-throttle valve is moved smoothly by hand.
2 If it is not moved smoothly, disconnect the link between the sub-throttle servo motor and sub-throttle valve, and then check whether or not the sub-throttle valve is moved smoothly by hand.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-
4.
3 When the sub-throttle valve is not moved smoothly, repair or replace it since the cause is the seizure of sub-throttle valve body itself.
When it moved smoothly at Step (1) and
(2), replace the sub-throttle servo motor.
b. Perform the self-diagnosis mode and check the operation of sub-throttle valve by visual inspection (Code No: 56).
The operation should be carried out as 5second drive in the full open direction, 2second stop and 5-second drive in the full close direction.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAT2D1004
CHECKING THE THERMO WAX
1. Check:
• Thermo wax “1”
Damage
→
Replace the thermo wax assembly.
THROTTLE BODIES
a. Before adjusting the distance, push the rod
“b” in order to be fitted in several times by hand.
b. Measure the outside air temperature, and adjust the distance “a” by turning the adjusting screw “2”. Refer to the thermo wax tolerance table based on the measured outside air temperature for correct adjustment.
ET2D1025
ADJUSTING THE THERMO WAX
1. Adjust:
• Thermo wax the end face distance “a”
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
NOTE:
• Setup tolerance of the longitudinal axis should be ± 0.2 mm ( ± 0.008 in).
• After adjusting the thermo wax, check that the first idling is released at the coolant temperature around 60
°
C (140
°
F) by idling.
• If the first idling is not released around 60
°
C
(140
°
F), make sure to set it again. (When the coolant temperature is low, adjust the distance between the end faces longer or adjust
7-11
it shorter when the coolant temperature is high.)
• In case of turning the adjusting bolt two-third turn, the temperature varies about 10
°
C
(50
°
F).
THROTTLE BODIES
7-12
EAS27040
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Removing the air cut-off valve assembly and hoses
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Order
1
2
5
6
3
4
7
8
Job/Parts to remove
Air cut-off valve coupler
Air cut-off valve hose 1
Air cut-off valve hose 2
Air cut-off valve hose 3
Air cut-off valve
Reed valve cap
Reed valve assembly
Plate
Q’ty
1
1
1
2
1
1
2
4
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Remarks
For assembly, reverse the removal procedure.
7-13
EAS27060
CHECKING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
Air injection
The air induction system burns unburned exhaust gases by injecting fresh air (secondary air) into the exhaust port, reducing the emission of hydrocarbons. When there is negative pressure at the exhaust port, the reed valve opens, allowing secondary air to flow into the exhaust port. The required temperature for burning the unburned exhaust gases is approximately 600 to 700
°
C.
Air cut-off valve
The air cut-off valve is controlled by the signals from the ECU in accordance with the combustion conditions. Ordinarily, the air cut-off valve opens to allow the air to flow during idle and closes to cut-off the flow when the vehicle is being driven. However, if the coolant temperature is below the specified value, the air cut-off valve remains open and allows the air to flow into the exhaust pipe until the temperature becomes higher than the specified value.
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
A. From the air cleaner
B. To the cylinder head
1. Check:
• Hoses
Loose connections
→
Connect properly.
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
• Pipes
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
2. Check:
• Reed valve “1”
• Reed valve stopper
• Reed valve seat
Cracks/damage
→
Replace the reed valve.
7-14
3. Measure:
• Reed valve bending limit “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace the reed valve.
Reed valve bending limit
0.4 mm (0.016 in)
AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
• Plate
• Reed valve assembly
• Reed valve cap
2. Install:
• Air cut-off valve
• Air cut-off valve hose 1
• Air cut-off valve hose 2
• Air cut-off valve hose 3
• Air cut-off valve coupler
4. Check:
• Air cut-off valve
Cracks/damage
→
Replace.
5. Check
• Air induction system solenoid
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the air induction system solenoid coupler from the wire harness.
b. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1) to the air induction system solenoid terminals as shown.
• Positive tester probe
Brown terminal “1”
• Negative tester probe
Brown/Red terminal “2” c. Measure the air induction system solenoid resistance.
Air induction system solenoid resistance
18–22
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
d. Out of specification
→
Replace.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS27070
INSTALLING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
1. Install:
7-15
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
IGNITION SYSTEM
…………………………………………………………………………… 8-1
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………….. 8-1
TROUBLESHOOTING …………………………………………………………………. 8-3
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
………………………………………………………… 8-5
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………….. 8-5
STARTING CIRCUIT CUT-OFF SYSTEM OPERATION……………………. 8-7
TROUBLESHOOTING …………………………………………………………………. 8-9
CHARGING SYSTEM
……………………………………………………………………… 8-11
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………… 8-11
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-13
LIGHTING SYSTEM
……………………………………………………………………….. 8-15
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-N) ………………………………………………………. 8-15
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-S) ………………………………………………………. 8-17
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-19
SIGNALING SYSTEM
……………………………………………………………………… 8-21
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………… 8-21
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-23
COOLING SYSTEM
………………………………………………………………………… 8-27
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………… 8-27
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-29
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
…………………………………………………………….. 8-31
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………… 8-31
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-33
ECU SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION …………………………………………. 8-37
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION TABLE………………………………………. 8-38
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD ………………………………………………… 8-41
DIAGNOSTIC MODE…………………………………………………………………. 8-42
TROUBLESHOOTING DETAILS …………………………………………………. 8-50
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM
…………………………………………………………………….. 8-75
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………… 8-75
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-77
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
………………………………………………………………….. 8-79
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM…………………………………………………………………… 8-79
GENERAL INFORMATION …………………………………………………………. 8-81
KEY CODES REGISTRATION METHOD……………………………………… 8-81
TROUBLESHOOTING ……………………………………………………………….. 8-85
SELF-DIAGNOSIS ERROR CODE INDICATION …………………………… 8-85
8
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
…………………………………………………………. 8-89
CHECKING THE SWITCHES……………………………………………………… 8-93
CHECKING THE BULBS AND BULB SOCKETS…………………………… 8-96
CHECKING THE FUSES……………………………………………………………. 8-97
CHECKING AND CHARGING THE BATTERY………………………………. 8-97
CHECKING THE RELAYS………………………………………………………… 8-100
CHECKING THE TURN SIGNAL/HAZARD RELAY ……………………… 8-102
CHECKING THE RELAY UNIT (DIODE) …………………………………….. 8-102
CHECKING THE IGNITION COILS ……………………………………………. 8-103
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ………………… 8-104
CHECKING THE LEAN ANGLE SENSOR………………………………….. 8-105
CHECKING THE STARTOR MOTOR OPERATION ……………………… 8-105
CHECKING THE STARTOR COIL……………………………………………… 8-106
CHECKING THE RECTIFIER/REGULATOR……………………………….. 8-106
CHECKING THE HORN …………………………………………………………… 8-106
CHECKING THE FUEL SENDER ……………………………………………… 8-107
CHECKING THE SPEED SENSOR …………………………………………… 8-107
CHECKING THE RADIATOR FAN MOTOR…………………………………. 8-108
CHECKING THE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR ……………… 8-108
CHECKING THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR …………………….. 8-109
CHECKING THE SUB-THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ……………… 8-110
CHECKING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM SOLENOID …………….. 8-110
CHECKING THE ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE SENSOR…………….. 8-111
CHECKING THE CYLINDER IDENTIFICATION SENSOR ……………. 8-111
CHECKING THE INTAKE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR ………………….. 8-112
CHECKING THE INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR ……………. 8-112
EAS27090
IGNITION SYSTEM
EAS27110
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
IGNITION SYSTEM
8-1
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
11.Relay unit
12.Starting circuit cut-off relay
14.Neutral switch
15.Sidestand switch
17.Crankshaft position sensor
21.Lean angle sensor
23.ECU
24.Ignition coil #1
25.Ignition coil #2
26.Ignition coil #3
27.Ignition coil #4
28.Spark plug
56.Engine stop switch
60.Clutch switch
78.Fuse (ignition)
IGNITION SYSTEM
8-2
IGNITION SYSTEM
EAS27150
TROUBLESHOOTING
The ignition system fails to operate (no spark or intermittent spark).
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main and ignition)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the spark plugs.
Refer to «CHECKING THE SPARK
PLUGS» on page 3-10.
OK
↓
4 Check the ignition spark gap.
Refer to «CHECKING THE IGNI-
TION COILS» on page 8-103.
NG
↓
5 Check the ignition coils.
Refer to «CHECKING THE IGNI-
TION COILS» on page 8-103.
NG
↓
6 Check the crankshaft position sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SEN-
SOR» on page 8-104.
OK
↓
7 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
NG
NG
OK
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
→
→
→
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Re-gap or replace the spark plugs.
Ignition system is OK.
Replace the ignition coils.
Replace the crankshaft position sensor
Replace the immobilizer kit.
8-3
8 Check the engine stop switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
9 Check the neutral switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
10 Check the sidestand switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
11 Check the clutch switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
12 Check the starting circuit cut-off relay.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
13 Check the lean angle sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE LEAN
ANGLE SENSOR» on page 8-105.
OK
↓
14 Check the entire ignition system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-1.
OK
↓
Replace the ECU
IGNITION SYSTEM
NG
→
Replace the right handlebar switch.
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
NG
→
NG
NG
→
→
Replace the neutral switch.
Replace the sidestand switch.
Replace the clutch switch.
Replace the relay unit.
Replace the lean angle sensor.
Properly connect or repair the ignition system’s wiring
8-4
EAS27160
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
EAS27170
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
8-5
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
9. Starter relay
10.Starter motor
11.Relay unit
12.Starting circuit cut-off relay
14.Neutral switch
15.Sidestand switch
56.Engine stop switch
57.Start switch
60.Clutch switch
78.Fuse (ignition)
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
8-6
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
EAS27180
STARTING CIRCUIT CUT-OFF SYSTEM OPERATION
If the engine stop switch is set to “ ” and the main switch is set to “ON” (both switches are closed), the starter motor can only operate if at least one of the following conditions is met:
• The transmission is in neutral (the neutral switch is closed).
• The clutch lever is pulled to the handlebar (the clutch switch is closed) and the sidestand is up (the sidestand switch is closed).
The starting circuit cut-off relay prevents the starter motor from operating when neither of these conditions has been met. In this instance, the starting circuit cut-off relay is open so current cannot reach the starter motor. When at least one of the above conditions has been met the starting circuit cut-off relay is closed and the engine can be started by pressing the starter switch.
8-7
a. WHEN THE TRANSMISSION IS IN NEU-
TRAL b. WHEN THE SIDESTAND IS UP AND THE
CLUTCH LEVER IS PULLED TO THE
HANDLEBAR
1. Battery
2. Main fuse
3. Main switch
4. Ignition fuse
5. Engine stop switch
6. Starting circuit cut-off relay
7. Diode
8. Clutch switch
9. Sidestand switch
10.Neutral switch
11.Start switch
12.Starter relay
13.Starter motor
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
8-8
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
EAS27190
TROUBLESHOOTING
The starter motor fails to turn.
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
3 Air filter case
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main and ignition)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the starter motor operation.
Refer to «CHECKING THE STAR-
TOR MOTOR OPERATION» on page 8-105.
OK
↓
4 Check the starter motor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
STARTER MOTOR» on page 5-42.
OK
↓
5 Check the relay unit (starting circuit cut-off relay).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
6 Check the relay unit (diode).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
7 Check the starter relay.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Replace the starter motor.
Repair or replace the starter motor.
Replace the relay unit.
Replace the relay unit.
Replace the starter relay.
8-9
8 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
9 Check the engine stop switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
10 Check the neutral switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
11 Check the sidestand switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
12 Check the clutch switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
13 Check the start switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
14 Check the entire starting system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-5.
OK
↓
The starting system circuit is OK.
ELECTRIC STARTING SYSTEM
NG
→
Replace the immobilizer kit.
NG
→
Replace the right handlebar switch.
NG
NG
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
→
→
Replace the neutral switch.
Replace the sidestand switch.
Replace the clutch switch.
Replace the right handlebar switch.
Properly connect or repair the starting system’s wiring
8-10
EAS27200
CHARGING SYSTEM
EAS27210
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
CHARGING SYSTEM
8-11
2. Rectifier/regulator
3. A.C.magneto
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
CHARGING SYSTEM
8-12
CHARGING SYSTEM
EAS27230
TROUBLESHOOTING
The battery is not being charged.
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
NG
→
1 Check the fuse.
(Main)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the stator coil.
Refer to «CHECKING THE STATOR
COIL» on page 8-106.
OK
↓
4 Check the rectifier/regulator.
Refer to «CHECKING THE RECTI-
FIER/REGULATOR» on page 8-
106.
OK
↓
5 Check the entire charging system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-11.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
NG
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
→
Replace the fuse.
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
• Replace the startor assembly.
Replace the rectifier/regulator.
Properly connect or repair the charging system’s wiring.
8-13
8-14
CHARGING SYSTEM
EAS27240
LIGHTING SYSTEM
EAS27250
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-N)
LIGHTING SYSTEM
8-15
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
23.ECU
49.High beam indicator light
52.Meter light
61.Pass switch
62.Dimmer switch
72.Auxiliary light
73.Headlight
74.License plate light
75.Tail/brake light
76.Headlight relay (on/off)
77.Fuse (tail light))
81.Fuse (headlight)
LIGHTING SYSTEM
8-16
ET2D1026
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM (FZ1-S)
LIGHTING SYSTEM
8-17
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
23.ECU
49.High beam indicator light
52.Meter light
61.Pass switch
62.Dimmer switch
72.Auxiliary light
73.Headlight
74.License plate light
75.Tail/brake light
76.Headlight relay (on/off)
77.Headlight relay (dimmer)
78.Fuse (tail light)
82.Fuse (headlight)
LIGHTING SYSTEM
8-18
LIGHTING SYSTEM
EAS27260
TROUBLESHOOTING
Any of the following fail to light: headlight, high beam indicator light, taillight, license light or meter light.
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
3 Air filter case
NG
→
1 Check the each bulbs and bulb sockets condition.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BULBS
AND BULB SOCKETS» on page 8-
96.
OK
↓
2 Check the fuses.
(Main, headlight and tail/beake light)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
4 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
5 Check the dimmer switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
6 Check the pass switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
7 Check the rear brake light switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the bulb(s) and bulb socket(s).
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Replace the immobilizer kit.
The dimmer switch is faulty. Replace the left handlebar switch.
The pass switch is faulty. Replace the left handlebar switch.
The rear brake light switch is faulty.
Replace the rear brake light switch.
8-19
LIGHTING SYSTEM
8 Check the headlight relay (on/off).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
9 Check the headlight relay (dimmer)
(FZ1-S).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
10 Check the entire lighting system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
(FZ1-N)» on page 8-15.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the headlight relay.
Replace the headlight relay.
Properly connect or repair the lighting system’s wiring.
8-20
EAS27270
SIGNALING SYSTEM
EAS27280
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
SIGNALING SYSTEM
8-21
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
11.Relay unit
14.Neutral switch
16.Fuel pump
19.Speed sensor
23.ECU
42.Fuel level warning light
43.Oil level warning light
44.Neutral indicator light
45.Tacho meter
46.Multi function meter
48.Coolant temperature indicator light
50.Turn signal indicator light (left)
51.Turn signal indicator light (right)
53.Oil level switch
55.Front brake light switch
58.Rear brake light switch
63.Hazard switch
64.Turn signal switch
65.Horn switch
66.Horn
67.Turn signal/hazard relay
68.Front turn signal light (left)
69.Front turn signal light (right)
70.Rear turn signal light (left)
71.Rear turn signal light (right)
75.Tail/brake light
77.Fuse (tail/brake light)
78.Fuse (ignition)
80.Fuse (signal)
SIGNALING SYSTEM
8-22
SIGNALING SYSTEM
EAS27290
TROUBLESHOOTING
• Any of the following fail to light: turn signal light, brake light or an indicator light.
• The horn fails to sound.
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
3 Air filter case
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main, ignition, signal and tail/brake light)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
4 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
Check the signaling system
The horn fails to sound.
1 Check the horn switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
2 Check the horn.
Refer to «CHECKING THE HORN» on page 8-106.
OK
↓
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Replace the immobilizer kit.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
Replace the left handlebar switch.
Replace the horn.
8-23
SIGNALING SYSTEM
3 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
The tail/brake light fails to come on.
1 Check the tail/brake light bulb and socket.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BULBS
AND BULB SOCKETS» on page 8-
96.
OK
↓
2 Check the front brake light switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
3 Check the rear brake light switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
4 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
NG
NG
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
→
→
Properly connect or repair the signaling system wiring.
Replace the tail/brake light bulb, socket or both.
Replace the front brake light switch.
Replace the rear brake light switch.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
This circuit is OK.
The turn signal light, turn signal indicator light or both fail to blink.
1 Check the turn signal bulb.
Refer to «CHECKING THE BULBS
AND BULB SOCKETS» on page 8-
96.
OK
↓
NG
→
Replace the turn signal bulb.
NG
→
2 Check the turn signal switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
Replace the left handlebar switch.
8-24
SIGNALING SYSTEM
3 Check the hazard switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
4 Check the turn signal/hazard relay.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
5 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
The neutral indicator light fails to come on.
1 Check the neutral switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
2 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
The oil level warning light fails to come on.
1 Check the oil level switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
2 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
The fuel level warning light fails to come on.
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the left handlebar switch.
Replace the turn signal/hazard relay.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
Replace the neutral switch.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
Replace the oil level switch.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
8-25
SIGNALING SYSTEM
1 Check the fuel sender.
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUEL
SENDER» on page 8-107.
OK
↓
2 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
The speedometer fails to operate.
1 Check the speed sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE SPEED
SENSOR» on page 8-107.
OK
↓
2 Check the entire signaling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-21.
OK
↓
Replace the meter assembly.
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the fuel pump assembly.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
Replace the speed sensor.
Properly connect or repair the signaling system’s wiring.
8-26
EAS27300
COOLING SYSTEM
EAS27310
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
COOLING SYSTEM
8-27
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
23.ECU
38.Coolant temperature sensor
78.Fuse (ignition)
82.Radiator fan motor relay
83.Fuse (radiator fan motor left)
84.Fuse (radiator fan motor right)
85.Radiator fan motor (left)
86.Radiator fan motor (right)
COOLING SYSTEM
8-28
COOLING SYSTEM
EAS27320
TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
3 Air filter case
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main, ignition and radiator fan motor)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
4 Check the radiator fan motor (left and right).
Refer to «CHECKING THE RADIA-
TOR FAN MOTOR» on page 8-108.
OK
↓
5 Check the radiator fan motor relay.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
6 Check the coolant temperature.
Refer to «CHECKING THE COOL-
ANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR» on page 8-108.
OK
↓
7 Check the entire cooling system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-27.
OK
↓
This circuit is OK.
NG
NG
NG
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
→
→
→
8-29
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Replace the immobilizer kit.
The radiator fan motor is faulty and must be replaced.
Replace the radiator fan motor relay.
Replace the coolant temperature sensor.
Properly connect or repair the cooling system’s wiring.
8-30
COOLING SYSTEM
EAS27330
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
EAS27340
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
8-31
1. Main switch
4. Fuse (backup)
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
8. Fuse (fuel injection)
11.Relay unit
12.Starting circuit cut-off relay
13.Fuel pump relay
14.Neutral switch
15.Sidestand switch
16.Fuel pump
17.Crankshaft position sensor
18.Cylinder identification sensor
19.Speed sensor
20.Atmospheric pressure sensor
21.Lean angle sensor
22.O
2
sensor
23.ECU
24.Ignition coil #1
25.Ignition coil #2
26.Ignition coil #3
27.Ignition coil #4
28.Spark plug
29.Injector #1
30.Injector #2
31.Injector #3
32.Injector #4
34.Sub-throttle position sensor
35.EXUP servo motor
36.Intake air pressure sensor
37.Throttle position sensor
38.Coolant temperature sensor
39.Air temperature sensor
46.Multi function meter
56.Engine stop switch
78.Fuse (ignition)
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
8-32
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
EAS27370
TROUBLESHOOTING
The ignition system fails to operate (no spark or intermittent spark).
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
3 Air filter case
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main, backup, fuel injection and ignition)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the spark plugs.
Refer to «CHECKING THE SPARK
PLUGS» on page 3-10.
OK
↓
4 Check the ignition coils.
Refer to «CHECKING THE IGNI-
TION COILS» on page 8-103.
OK
↓
5 Check the crankshaft position sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SEN-
SOR» on page 8-104.
OK
↓
6 Check the relay unit (fuel pump relay).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
7 Check the fuel pump.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Re-gap or replace the spark plugs.
Replace the ignition coils.
Replace the crankshaft position sensor.
Replace the relay unit.
Replace the fuel pump.
8-33
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
8 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
9 Check the engine stop switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
10 Check the neutral switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
11 Check the sidestand switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
12 Check the clutch switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
13 Check the relay unit (starting circuit cut-off relay).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
14 Check the lean angle sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE LEAN
ANGLE SENSOR» on page 8-105.
OK
↓
15 Check the cylinder identificatin sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE CYLIN-
DER IDENTIFICATION SENSOR» on page 8-111.
OK
↓
16 Check the speed sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE SPEED
SENSOR» on page 8-107.
OK
↓
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the immobilizer kit.
Replace the right handlebar switch.
Replace the neutral switch.
Replace the sidestand switch.
Replace the clutch switch.
Replace the relay unit.
Replace the lean angle sensor.
Reeplace the cylinder identification sensor.
Replace the spped sensor.
8-34
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
17 Checking the aomospheric pressure sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE ATMO-
SPHERIC PRESSURE SENSOR» on page 8-111.
OK
↓
18 Check the injector.
Refer to «CHECKING THE INJEC-
TORS» on page 7-8.
OK
↓
19 Check the throttle position sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE THROT-
TLE POSITION SENSOR» on page
8-109.
OK
↓
20 Check the sub-throttle position sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE SUB-
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR» on page 8-110.
OK
↓
21 Check the intake air pressure sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE INTAKE
AIR PRESSURE SENSOR» on page 8-112.
OK
↓
22 Check the coolant temperature sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE COOL-
ANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR» on page 8-108.
OK
↓
23 Check the inatke air temperature sensor.
Refer to «CHECKING THE INTAKE
AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR» on page 8-112.
OK
↓
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
NG
→
Replace the atomospheric pressure sensor.
Replace the injector.
Replace the throttle position sensor.
Replace the sub-throttle position sensor.
Replace the intake air pressure sensor
Replace the coolant temperature sensor.
Replace the intake air temperature sensor.
8-35
24 Check the entire ignition system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-1.
OK
↓
Replace the ECU.
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
NG
→
Properly connect or repair the ignition system’s wiring
8-36
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
EAS27350
ECU SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
The ECU is equipped with a self-diagnostic function in order to ensure that the fuel injection system is operating normally. If this function detects a malfunction in the system, it immediately operates the engine under substitute characteristics and illuminates the engine trouble warning light to alert the rider that a malfunction has occurred in the system. Once a malfunction has been detected, a fault code is stored in the memory of the ECU.
• To inform the rider that the fuel injection system is not functioning, the engine trouble warning light flashes when the start switch is being pushed to start the engine.
• If a malfunction is detected in the system by the self-diagnostic function, the ECU provides an appropriate substitute characteristic operation, and alerts the rider of the detected malfunction by illuminating the engine trouble warning light.
• After the engine has been stopped, the lowest fault code number appears on the odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter LCD. Once a fault code has been displayed, it remains stored in the memory of the ECU until it is deleted.
Engine trouble warning light indication and FI system operation
Warning light indication
Flashing*
Remains on
ECU operation FI operation
Warning provided when unable to start engine
Operation stopped
Malfunction detected Operated with substitute characteristics in accordance with the description of the malfunction
Vehicle operation
Cannot be operated
Can or cannot be operated depending on the fault code
* The warning light flashes when any one of the conditions listed below is present and the start switch is pushed:
11: Cylinder identification sensor 30: Lean angle sensor
(latch up detected)
12: Crankshaft position sensor 41:
19: Sidestand switch
(open circuit in the wire to the ECU)
50:
Lean angle sensor
(open or short-circuit)
ECU internal malfunction
(faulty ECU memory)
Checking the engine trouble warning light
The engine trouble warning light comes on for 1.4 seconds after the main switch has been turned to
“ON” and it comes on while the start switch is being pushed. If the warning light does not come on under these conditions, the warning light (LED) may be defective.
8-37
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
a. Main switch “OFF” b. Main switch “ON” c. Engine trouble warning light off d. Engine trouble warning light on for 1.4 seconds
ET2D1027
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION TABLE
If the ECU detects an abnormal signal from a sensor while the vehicle is being driven, the ECU illuminates the engine trouble warning light and provides the engine with alternate operating instructions that are appropriate for the type of malfunction.
When an abnormal signal is received from a sensor, the ECU processes the specified values that are programmed for each sensor in order to provide the engine with alternate operating instructions that enable the engine to continue to operate or stop operating, depending on the conditions.
Self-Diagnostic Function table
Fault code No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Item Symptom
Able/ unable to start
Able/ unable to drive
Cylinder identification sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
Intake air pressure sensor
(open or short circuit)
Intake air pressure sensor hose line
(piping system)
Throttle position sensor
(open or short circuit)
Throttle position sensor
(stuck)
EXUP servo motor potention circuit
(open or short circuit)
EXUP servo motor
(stuck)
Sidestand switch
(open circuit in the wire to the ECU)
Intake air pressure sensor or atmospheric pressure sensor
No normal signals are received from the cylinder identification sensor when the engine is started or while the vehicle is being driven.
No normal signals are received from the crankshaft position sensor.
Intake air pressure sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Intake air pressure sensor: faulty intake air pressure sensor system.
Throttle position sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Throttle position sensor is stuck.
EXUP servo motor potension circuit: open or short circuit detected.
EXUP servo motor is stuck.
Open circuit in the input line of ECU No.24 terminal is detected when start switch is pressed from the sidestand switch to the
ECU.
When the main switch is turned to “ON”, the atmospheric pressure sensor voltage and intake air pressure sensor voltage differ greatly.
Unable
Unable Unable
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Unable Unable
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
8-38
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
21
22
23
24
30
33
34
35
36
Item Symptom
Able/ unable to start
Able/ unable to drive
Coolant temperature sensor
(open or short circuit)
Intake air temperature sensor
(open or short circuit)
Atmospheric pressure sensor
(open or short circuit)
O
2
sensor
Lean angle sensor
(latch up detected)
Cylinder-#1 ignition coil
(open circuit)
Coolant temperature sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Intake air temperature sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Atmospheric pressure sensor: open or short circuit detected.
No normal signal is received from the O
2 sensor.
No normal signal is received from the lean angle sensor.
Primary lead of the cylinder-#1 ignition coil: open circuit detected.
Cylinder-#2 ignition coil
(open circuit)
Cylinder-#3 ignition coil
(open circuit)
Cylinder-#4 ignition coil
(open circuit)
Primary lead of the cylinder-#2 ignition coil: open circuit detected.
Primary lead of the cylinder-#3 ignition coil: open circuit detected.
Primary lead of the cylinder-#4 ignition coil: open circuit detected.
Able
Able
Able
Able
Unable
Able
Able
Able
Able
Unable
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
8-39
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
39
41
42
43
44
46
47
Injector
Item
(open circuit)
Injector:
Symptom
open circuit detected.
Able/ unable to start
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Able/ unable to drive
Able
(depending on the number of faulty cylinders)
Lean angle sensor
(open or short-circuit)
Speed sensor
Neutral switch
Fuel system voltage
(monitoring voltage)
Error in writing the amount of CO adjustment on EEPROM
Vehicle system power supply
(monitoring voltage)
Sub-throttle servo motor potention (open or short circuit)
Lean angle sensor: open or short circuit detected.
No normal signals are received from the speed sensor.
Neutral switch: open or short circuit detected.
Power supply to the injectors and the fuel pump is not normal.
An error is detected while reading or writing on EEPROM (CO adjustment value).
Power supply to the fuel injection system is not normal.
sub-throttle servo motor potention:open or short circuit detected.
Unable Unable
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
Able
48
50
–
Sub-throttle servo motor (lock)
ECU internal malfunction
(memory check error)
A lock of the sub-throttle servo motor is detected.
ECU memory is faulty. (When this malfunction is detected in the ECU, the fault code number might not appear on the meter.)
Start unable warning Relay is not turned ON even if the crank signal is input while the start switch is turned ON.
When the start switch is turned ON while an error is detected with the fault code of
No.11, 12, 19, 30, 41 or 50.
Communication error with the meter
Fault code No.
Item Symptom
Able
Unable Unable
Unable Unable
Able/ unable to start
Able
Able/ unable to drive
Er-1
ECU internal malfunction
(output signal error)
No signals are received from the ECU.
Unable Unable
8-40
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
Item Symptom
Able/ unable to start
Able/ unable to drive
Er-2
Er-3
Er-4
ECU internal malfunction
(output signal error)
ECU internal malfunction
(output signal error)
ECU internal malfunction
(input signal error)
No signals are received from the ECU within the specified duration.
Data from the ECU cannot be received correctly.
Non-registered data has been received from the meter.
EAS27400
TROUBLESHOOTING METHOD
The engine operation is not normal and the engine trouble warning light comes on.
1. Check:
• Fault code number
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Check the fault code number displayed on the meter.
b. Identify the faulty system with the fault code. Refer to “Self-Diagnostic Function table”.
c. Identify the probable cause of malfunction.
Refer to “Diagnostic code table”.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Checking and repair the probable cause of malfunction.
Fault code No.
Check and repair.
Refer to «TROUBLE-
SHOOTING
DETAILS» on page 8-
50.
Monitor the operation of the sensors and actuators in the diagnostic mode. Refer to
“Sensor operation table” and “Actuator operation table”.
Fault code No.
Check and repair.
Refer to Self-Diagnostic Function table.
3. Perform ECU reinstatement action.
Refer to “Reinstatement method” of table in
“TROUBLESHOOTING DETAILS”.
4. Turn the main switch to “OFF” and back to
“ON”, then check that no fault code number is displayed.
NOTE:
If fault codes are displayed, repeat steps (1) to
(4) until no fault code number is displayed.
5. Erase the malfunction history in the diagnostic mode. Refer to “Sensor operation table (Diagnostic code No.62)”.
NOTE:
Turning the main switch to “OFF” will not erase the malfunction history.
Unable
Unable
Unable
Unable
Unable
Unable
The engine operation is not normal but the engine trouble warning light does not come on.
1. Check the operation of following sensors and actuators in the Diagnostic mode.
Refer to “Sensor operation table” and
“Actuator operation table”.
01: Throttle position sensor (throttle angle)
02: Atmospheric pressure sensor
05: Intake air pressure sensor
06: Coolant temperature sensor
07: Vehicle speed pulse
09: Fuel system voltage (battery bolt)
21: Neutral switch
30: Ignition coil #1
31: Ignition coil #2
32: Ignition coil #3
33: Ignition coil #4
36: Injector #1
37: Injector #2
38: Injector #3
39: Injector #4
48: AI system solenoid
53: EXUP servo motor
56: Sub-throttle servo motor
8-41
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
If a malfunction is detected in the sensors or actuators, repair or replace all faulty parts.
If no malfunction is detected in the sensors and actuators, check and repair inner parts of the engine.
EAS27420
DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Setting the diagnostic mode
1. Turn the main switch to “OFF” and set the engine stop switch to “ ”.
2. Disconnect the wire harness coupler from the fuel pump.
3. Press and hold the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons, turn the main switch to “ON”, and continue to press the buttons for 8 seconds or more.
NOTE:
• All displays on the meter disappear except the odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter display.
• “dI” appears on the odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter LCD.
4. Press the “SELECT” button to select the diagnostic mode “dI”.
5. After selecting “dI”, simultaneously press the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons for 2 seconds or more to activate the diagnostic mode. The diagnostic code number “d01” appears on the clock
LCD.
6. Set the engine stop switch to “ ”.
7. Select the diagnostic code number corresponding to the fault code number by pressing the
“SELECT” and “RESET” buttons.
NOTE:
• The diagnostic code number appears on the LCD meter (d01–70).
• To decrease the selected diagnostic code number, press the “RESET” button. Press the “RESET” button for 1 second or longer to automatically decrease the diagnostic code numbers.
• To increase the selected diagnostic code number, press the “SELECT” button. Press the
“SELECT” button for 1 second or longer to automatically increase the diagnostic code numbers.
8. Verify the operation of the sensor or actuator.
• Sensor operation
8-42
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
The data representing the operating conditions of the sensor appears on the odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter LCD.
• Actuator operation
Set the engine stop switch to “ ” to operate the actuator.
NOTE:
If the engine stop switch is set to “ ”, set it to “ ”, and then set it to “ ” again.
9. Turn the main switch to “OFF” to cancel the diagnostic mode.
Fault code table
Fault code
No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
Symptom Probable cause of malfunction
• No normal signals are received from the cylinder identification sensor when the engine is started or while the vehicle is being driven.
No normal signals are received from the crankshaft position sensor.
Intake air pressure sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Intake air pressure sensor: faulty intake air pressure sensor system.
Throttle position sensor: open or short circuit detected.
• Open or short circuit in sub wire harness.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Defective cylinder identification sensor.
• Improperly installed sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Defective crankshaft position sensor.
• Malfunction in pickup rotor.
• Improperly installed sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Open or short circuit in sub wire harness.
• Defective intake air pressure sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Intake air pressure sensor hose is detached, clogged, kinked, or pinched.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Open or short circuit in sub wire harness.
• Defective throttle position sensor.
• Improperly installed throttle position sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
Throttle position sensor: stuck
• Stuck throttle position sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
EXUP servo motor potention circuit: open or short circuit detected.
• Open or short circuit in sub wire harness.
• Detective EXUP servo motor (potention circuit).
EXUP servo motor is stuck. • Open or short circuit in sub wire harness.
• Stuck EXUP servo motor (mechanism).
• Stuck EXUP servo motor (motor).
Open circuit is detected in the input line of ECU No.24 terminal is detected when the start switch is pressed.
• Open circuit in wire harness (ECU Coupler).
• Malfunction in ECU.
Diagnostic code No.
—
—
03
03
01
01
53
53
20
8-43
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code
No.
20
21
22
23
24
30
33
34
35
Symptom Probable cause of malfunction
When the main switch is turned to “ON”, the atmospheric pressure sensor voltage and intake air pressure sensor voltage differ greatly.
Coolant temperature sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Intake air temperature sensor: open or short circuit detected.
Atmospheric pressure sensor: open or short circuit detected.
No normal signal is received from the O
2
sensor.
No normal signal is received from the lean angle sensor.
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#1 ignition coil.
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#2 ignition coil.
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#3 ignition coil.
• Atmospheric pressure sensor hose is clogged.
• Intake air pressure sensor hose is clogged, kinked, or pinched.
• Malfunction of the atmospheric pressure sensor in the intermediate electrical potential.
• Malfunction of the intake air pressure sensor in the intermediate electrical potential.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Defective coolant temperature sensor.
• Improperly installed coolant temperature sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Defective intake air temperature sensor.
• Improperly installed intake air temperature sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in sub wire harness.
• Defective atmospheric pressure sensor.
• Improperly installed atmospheric pressure sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Defective O
2
sensor.
• Improperly installed O
2
sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Vehicle has overturned.
• Defective lean angle sensor.
• Improperly installed lean angle sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in ignition coil.
• Malfunction in a component of ignition cutoff circuit system.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in ignition coil.
• Malfunction in a component of ignition cutoff circuit system.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in ignition coil.
• Malfunction in a component of ignition cutoff circuit system.
• Malfunction in ECU.
Diagnostic code No.
02
03
06
05
02
—
08
30
31
32
8-44
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code
No.
36
39
41
42
43
44
46
47
48
50
Er-1
Symptom Probable cause of malfunction
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#4 ignition coil.
Open circuit detected in a injector.
Lean angle sensor: open or short circuit detected.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in ignition coil.
• Malfunction in a component of ignition cutoff circuit system.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit sub-wire- harness.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Improperly installed injector.
• Defective injector.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Defective lean angle sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
No normal signals are recieved from the speed sensor.
Neutral switch: open or short circuit detected.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in speed sensor.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire haraness.
• Malfunction in neutral switch.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Open circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in ECU.
Power supply to the injectors and the fuel pump is not normal.
An error is detected while reading or writing on
EEPROM (CO adjustment value).
Power supply to the fuel injection system relay is not normal.
• Malfunction in ECU. (The CO adjustment value is not properly written on or read from the internal memory).
Sub-throttle servo motor potention circuit: open or short circuit detected.
Sub-throttle servo motor is stuck.
• Malfunction in the charging system.
Refer to «CHARGING SYSTEM» on page 8-
11.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Detective Sub-throttle servo motor (potention circuit).
Faulty ECU memory. (When this malfunction is detected in the ECU, the fault code number might not appear on the meter.)
No signals are received from the ECU.
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Stuck Sub-throttle servo motor (mechanism).
• Stuck Sub-throttle servo motor (motor).
• Malfunction in ECU. (The program and data are not properly written on or read from the internal memory.)
• Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Malfunction in meter.
• Defective wire connection of the ECU coupler.
• Malfunction in ECU.
Diagnostic code No.
33
36
37
38
39
08
07
21
09
60
—
56
56
—
—
8-45
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code
No.
Er-2
Er-3
Er-4
Symptom Probable cause of malfunction
No signals are received from the ECU within the specified duration.
Data from the ECU cannot be received correctly.
Non-registered data has been received from the meter.
• Improper connection in wire harness.
• Malfunction in meter.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Improper connection in wire harness.
• Malfunction in meter.
• Malfunction in ECU.
• Improper connection in wire harness.
• Malfunction in meter.
• Malfunction in ECU.
Diagnostic code No.
—
—
—
Sensor operation table
Diagnostic code
No.
Item
01
02
03
05
06
07
08
Meter display Checking method
Throttle position sensor signal
• Fully closed position 15–18
• Fully opened position
Atmospheric pressure
Intake air pressure
Intake air temperature
Coolant temperature
Vehicle speed pulse
Lean angle sensor
• Upright
• Overturned
95–100
Displays the atmospheric pressure.
Displays the cylinder-#1 intake air pressure.
Displays the intake air temperature.
Displays the coolant temperature.
0–999
0.4–1.4
3.7–4.4
Check with throttle valve fully closed.
Check with throttle valve fully opened.
Compare the actually measured atmospheric pressure with the meter display value.
Set the engine stop switch to “ ” then operate the throttle while pushing the start switch “ ”. (If the display value changes, the performance is OK.)
Compare the actually measured air temperature with the meter display value.
Compare the actually measured coolant temperature with the meter diaplay value.
Check that the number increases when the rear wheel is rotated. The number is cumulative and does not reset each time the wheel is stopped.
Remove the lean angle sensor and incline it more than 65 degrees.
8-46
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Diagnostic code
No.
09
20
21
60
61
Item
Fuel system voltage
(battery voltage)
Malfunction history code
• No history
• History exists
Meter display
Approximately 12.0
Sidestand switch
• Stand retracted
• Stand extended
Neutral switch
• Neutral
• In gear
EEPROM fault cylinder No
• No fault
• Fault detected
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
00
01–04 (fault cylinder No.)
• (If more than one cylinder is defective, the display changes every two seconds to show all the detected cylinder numbers. When all cylinder numbers are shown, the display repeats.)
00
Fault codes 11–50
• (If more than one code number is detected, the display changes every two seconds to show all the detected code numbers.
When all code numbers are shown, the display repeats.)
Checking method
Set the engine stop switch to “ ” and then compare with the actually measured battery voltage. (If the battery voltage is lower, recharge the battery.)
Set ON/OFF the sidestand switch (with the transmission in gear).
Set ON/OFF the neutral switch (shift the transmission).
—
—
Malfunction history code erasure
• No history
• History exists
62
00
Fault codes 01-28
• (If more than one code number is detected, the display alternates every two seconds to show all the detected code numbers.
When all code numbers are shown, the display repeats the same process.)
—
To erase the history, set the engine stop switch to “ “ .
8-47
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Diagnostic code
No.
63
70
Item Meter display Checking method
Malfunction code reinstate
• No mulfunction code 00
• Malfunction code exists Fault code 24
• (If more than one code number is detected, the display changes every two seconds to show all the detected code numbers.
When all code numbers are shown, the display repeats.)
Control number 0–255
—
To reinstate, set the engine stop switch to “ “ .
—
Actuator operation table
Diagnostic code
No.
Item
Cylinder-#1 ignition coil
Actuation Checking method
30
31
32
33
36
37
Cylinder-#2 ignition coil
Cylinder-#3 ignition coil
Cylinder-#4 ignition coil
Injector #1
Injector #2
Actuates the cylinder-#1 ignition coil five times at one second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the cylinder-#2 ignition coil five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the cylinder-#3 ignition coil five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the cylinder-#4 ignition coil five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the injector #1 five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the injector #2 five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Check the spark five times.
• Connect an ignition checker.
Check the spark five times.
• Connect an ignition checker.
Check the spark five times.
• Connect an ignition checker.
Check the spark five times.
• Connect an ignition checker.
Check the operating sound of the injector #1 five times.
Check the operating sound of the injector #2 five times.
8-48
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Diagnostic code
No.
38
39
48
50
51
52
53
Item Actuation Checking method
Injector #3
Injector #4
Air induction system solenoid
Actuates the injector #3 five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the injector #4 five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuates the Air induction system solenoid five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Fuel injection system relay Actuates the fuel injection system relay five times at one-second intervals.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
(The engine trouble warning light is OFF when the relay is
ON, and the engine trouble warning light is ON when the relay is OFF).
Radiator fan motor relay Actuates the radiator fan motor relay five times at onesecond intervals. (ON 2 seconds, OFF 3 seconds)
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Headlight relay
Exup servo motor
Actuates the headlight relay for five times every five-second. (ON 2 seconds, OFF 3 seconds)
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light.
Actuate the servo motor turns to close side and to open side.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light only while the motor is runnning.
Check the operating sound of the injector #3 five times.
Check the operating sound of the injector #4 five times.
Check the operating sound of the Air induction system solenoid five times.
Check the operating sound of the fuel injection system relay five times.
Check the operating sound of the Radiator fan motor relay five times.
Check the operating sound of the headlight relay five times.
Check the operating sound of the EXUP servo motor.
8-49
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Diagnostic code
No.
Item
Sub-throttle servo motor
Actuation Checking method
56
Actuate the servo motor turns to close side and to open side.
Illuminates the engine trouble warning light only while the motor is runnning.
Check the operating sound of the Sub-throttle servo motor.
EAS27460
TROUBLESHOOTING DETAILS
This section describes the measures per fault code number displayed on the meter. Check and service the items or components that are the probable cause of the malfunction following the order given.
After the check and service of the malfunctioning part has been completed, reset the meter display according to the reinstatement method.
Fault code No.:
Code number displayed on the meter when the engine failed to work normally. Refer to Self-Diagnostic Function table.
Diagnostic code No.:
Diagnostic code number to be used when the diagnostic mode is operated. Refer to «DIAGNOSTIC
MODE» on page 8-42.
Fault code No.
11 Symptom
No normal signals are received from the cylinder identification sensor when the engine is started or while the vehicle is being driven.
Diagnostic code No.
Orde r
—
Item/components and probable cause
1
2
Installed condition of cylinder identification sensor.
Connections
• Cylinder identification sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
—
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
Check for looseness or pinching.
Starting the
• Check the coupler for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of engine and operate it at idle.
the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
3
4
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between the cylinder identification sensor coupler and ECU coupler
(Blue–Blue)
(White/Black–White/Black)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
Defective cylinder identification sensor.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
CYLINDER IDENTIFICATION
SENSOR» on page 8-111.
8-50
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
12 Symptom
No normal signals are received from the crankshaft position sensor.
— Diagnostic code No.
Orde r
1 Installed condition of crankshaft position sensor
—
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Check for looseness or pinching.
Reinstatement method
Cranking the engine.
2
3
4
Connections
• Crankshaft position sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Check the couplers for any pins that may have pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between the crankshaft position sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Gray–Gray)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
Defective crankshaft position sensor.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR» on page 8-104.
8-51
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
13 Symptom Intake air pressure sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Diagnostic code No.
Orde r
1
03
Item/components and probable cause
Connections
• Intake air pressure sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Intake air pressure sensor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may have pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turn the main switch to ON.
2
3
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between intake air pressure sensor coupler and ECU coupler
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
(Pink/White–Pink/White)
(Blue–Blue)
Defective intake air pressure sensor • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.03)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
INTAKE AIR PRESSURE SEN-
SOR» on page 8-112.
Fault code No.
14 Symptom
Intake air pressure sensor: faulty intake air pressure sensor system.
Intake air pressure sensor Diagnostic code No.
Orde r
03
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Intake air pressure sensor hose • Check the intake air pressure sensor hose condition.
• Repair or replace the sensor hose.
Connections
• Intake air pressure sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Defective intake air pressure sensor • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.03)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
INTAKE AIR PRESSURE SEN-
SOR» on page 8-112.
Starting the engine and operate it at idle.
8-52
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
15 Symptom Throttle position sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Diagnostic code No.
Order
1
2
Item/components and probable cause
Installed condition of throttle position sensor.
Connections
01
• Throttle position sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Throttle position sensor
Check or maintenance job
• Check for looseness or pinching.
• Check that is installed in the specified position.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
3
4
5
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between throttle position sensor coupler and ECU coupler
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
(Yellow–Yellow)
(Blue–Blue)
Throttle position sensor lead wire open circuit output voltage check.
• Check for open circuit and replace the throttle position sensor.
(Black/Blue–Yellow)
Output voltage Open circuit item
Ground wire open circuit
5 V
Defective throttle position sensor.
Output wire open circuit
Power supply wire open circuit
0 V
0 V
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.01)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
THROTTLE POSITION SEN-
SOR» on page 8-109.
8-53
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
16 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
01
Item/components and probable cause
Installed condition of throttle position sensor.
1
2
Defective throttle position sensor.
Stuck throttle position sensor detected.
Throttle position sensor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the installed area for looseness or pinching.
• Check that is installed in the specified position.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4 section.
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.01)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4 section.
Reinstatement method
Reinstated by starting the engine, operating it at idle, and then racing it.
Fault code No.
17 Symptom EXUP servo motor circuit:open or short circuit detected.
Diagnostic code No.
Order
1
53
Item/components and probable cause
Connections
• EXUP servo motor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
EXUP servo motor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
3
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between EXUP servo motor coupler and ECU coupler
(Blue–Blue)
(White/Red–White/Red)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
Defective EXUP servo motor (potention circuit).
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.53)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
EXUP SERVO MOTOR» on page 3-18.
8-54
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
2
3
4
18 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
53
Item/components and probable cause
Connections
• EXUP servo motor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
1
EXUP servo motor is stuck.
EXUP servo motor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the coupler.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between EXUP servo motor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Black/Green–Black/Green)
(Black/Red–Black/Red)
Defective EXUP servo motor • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.53)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
EXUP SERVO MOTOR» on page 3-18.
Defective EXUP valve, pulley, and cables
Replace if defective.
Fault code No.
19 Symptom
Open circuit is detected in the input line of ECU No.24 terminal is difected when the start switch is pressed.
Sidestand switch Diagnostic code No.
Order
20
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness or sub lead.
Defective sidestand switch
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.20)
• Check the coupler for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the coupler.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between sidestand switch coupler and ECU coupler
(Black–Black)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
If the transmission is in gear, retracting the sidestand.
If the transmission is in neutral, reconnecting the wiring.
8-55
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
Diagnostic code No.
Orde r
02
03
Item/components and probable cause
1
20 Symptom
When the main switch is turned to “ON”, the atmospheric pressure sensor voltage and intake air pressure sensor voltage differ greatly.
Defective intake air pressure sensor or atmospheric pressure sensor.
Atmospheric pressure sensor
Intake air pressure sensor
Check or maintenance job
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code Nos. 02, 03)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
INTAKE AIR PRESSURE SEN-
SOR» on page 8-112 or
«CHECKING THE ATMO-
SPHERIC PRESSURE SEN-
SOR» on page 8-111.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
Fault code No.
21 Symptom
Coolant temperature sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Diagnostic code No.
Order
06
Item/components and probable cause
1
Connections
• Coolant temperature sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Coolant temperature sensor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the coupler for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
3
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between coolant temperature sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Green/White–Green/White)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
Defective coolant temperature sensor. • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.06)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR» on page 8-108.
8-56
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
22 Symptom
Intake air temperature sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Intake air temperature sensor Diagnostic code No.
Order
05
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Intake air temperature sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between intake air temperature sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Brown/White–Brown/White)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
Defective intake air temperature sensor.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.05)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
SENSOR» on page 8-112.
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
8-57
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
23 Symptom
Atmospheric pressure sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Atmospheric pressure sensor Diagnostic code No.
Order
02
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Atmospheric pressure sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub wire harness 2.
Defective atmospheric pressure sensor.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between atmospheric pressure sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
(Pink–Pink)
(Blue–Blue)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.02)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE
SENSOR» on page 8-111.
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
8-58
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
24 Symptom
No normal signal is received from the O
2
sensor.
Diagnostic code No.
Order
—
Item/components and probable cause
—
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Installed state of O
Connections
• O
2
2
sensor coupler
sensor.
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
Check for looseness or pinching.
Start and warm
• Check the couplers for any pins up the engine until the coolthat may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler ant temperature rises over
60
°
C.
when acceleratsecurely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between O
2
sensor coupler and
ECU coupler.
(Gray/Green–Gray/Green) ing the throttle, the waring light is turned off, or it is reset by the
No.63).
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue) diagnostic mode (Code
(Pink/Black–Pink/Black)
(Red/White–Red/White)
4
Check fuel pressure.
• Refer to «THROTTLE BODIES» on page 7-4.
5
Defective O
2
sensor.
• Replace if defective.
Fault code No.
30 Symptom No normal signal is received from the lean angle sensor.
Diagnostic code No.
08 Lean angle sensor
Order
2
3
Item/components and probable cause
1 The vehicle has overturned.
Installed state of the lean angle sensor
Connections
• Lean angle sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Check or maintenance job
Raise the vehicle upright.
Check the installed direction and condition of the sensor.
• Check the coupler for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the coupler.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
”ON” (however, the engine cannot be restarted unless the main switch is first turned to
“OFF”).
4
Defective lean angle sensor • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.08)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
LEAN ANGLE SENSOR» on page 8-105.
8-59
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
33 Symptom
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#1 ignition coil.
Cylinder-#1 ignition coil Diagnostic code No.
Order
30
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Cylinder-#1 ignition coil coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness 1 coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub-wire harness 1.
Defective cylinder-#1 ignition coil
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between cylinder-#1 ignition coil coupler and ECU coupler.
(Red/Black–Red/Black)
(Orange–Orange)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.30)
• Test the primary and secondary coils for continuity.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
IGNITION COILS» on page 8-
103.
Starting the engine and operating it at idle.
8-60
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
34 Symptom
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#2 ignition coil
Cylinder-#2 ignition coil Diagnostic code No.
Order
31
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Cylinder-#2 ignition coil coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness 1 coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub-wire harness 1.
Defective cylinder-#2 ignition coil.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between cylinder-#2 ignition coil coupler and ECU coupler.
(Red/Black–Red/Black)
(Gray/Red–Gray/Red)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.31)
• Test the primary and secondary coils for continuity.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
IGNITION COILS» on page 8-
103.
Starting the engine and operating it at idle.
8-61
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
35 Symptom
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#3 ignition coil
Cylinder-#3 ignition coil Diagnostic code No.
Order
32
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Cylinder-#3 ignition coil coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness 1 coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub-wire harness 1.
Defective cylinder-#3 ignition coil.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between cylinder-#3 ignition coil coupler and ECU coupler.
(Red/Black–Red/Black)
(Orange/Green–Orange/Green)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.32)
• Test the primary and secondary coils for continuity.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
IGNITION COILS» on page 8-
103.
Starting the engine and operating it at idle.
8-62
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
36 Symptom
Open circuit detected in the primary lead of the cylinder-
#4 ignition coil
Cylinder-#4 ignition coil Diagnostic code No.
Order
33
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Cylinder-#4 ignition coil coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness 1 coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub-wire harness 1.
Defective cylinder-#4 ignition coil.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between cylinder-#4 ignition coil coupler and ECU coupler.
(Red/Black–Red/Black)
(Gray/Green–Gray/Green)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.33)
• Test the primary and secondary coils for continuity.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
IGNITION COILS» on page 8-
103.
Starting the engine and operating it at idle.
8-63
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
39 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
1
2
3
Item/components and probable
Connections
36
37
38
39 cause
• Injector coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness and/or sub-wire harness.
Defective primary injector.
Open circuit detected in a injector.
Injector #1
Injector #2
Injector #3
Injector #4
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
Start the engine and operating it at idle.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the copler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between primary injector coupler and ECU coupler.
(Red/Blue-Red/Blue)
#1: (Red/Black–Red/Black)
#2: (Green/Black–Green/Black)
#3: (Blue/Black–Blue/Black)
#4: (Orange/Black–Orange/
Black)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code Nos.36, 37, 38, 39)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
INJECTORS» on page 7-8.
8-64
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
41 Symptom Lean angle sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Diagnostic code No.
Order
08
Item/components and probable cause
1
Connections
• Lean angle sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Lean angle sensor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
3
Open or short circuit in lead.
Defective lean angle sensor.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between lean angle sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Blue–Blue)
(Yellow/Green–Yellow/Green)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.08)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
LEAN ANGLE SENSOR» on page 8-105.
8-65
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
A-1
A-2
A-3
A-4
Connections
42 Symptom
• Speed sensor coupler
Open or short circuit in lead.
Defective speed sensor
A. No normal signals are received from the speed sensor.
B. Open circuit is detected in the neutral switch.
Diagnostic code No.
Order
A 07
B 21
Item/components and probable cause
Installed state of speed sensor.
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Speed sensor
Neutral switch
Check or maintenance job
• Check for looseness or pinching.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between speed sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Blue–Blue)
(White/Yellow–White/Yellow)
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.07)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SPEED SENSOR» on page 8-
107.
Reinstatement method
Starting the engine, and activating the speed sensor by operating the vehicle at 20 to
30 km/h.
8-66
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
B-5
Faulty shift drum (neutral detection area).
42 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
B-1
A 07
B 21
Item/components and probable cause
Installed state of neutral switch.
B-2
B-3
B-4
Connections
• Neutral switch coupler
Defective neutral switch.
A. No normal signals are received from the speed sensor.
B. Open circuit is detected in the neutral switch.
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Open circuit in neutral switch lead.
Speed sensor
Neutral switch
Check or maintenance job
• Check for looseness or pinching.
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between neutral switch coupler and relay unit coupler
(Sky blue–Sky blue)
• Between relay unit coupler and
ECU coupler.
(Blue/Yellow–Blue/Yellow)
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No.21)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «TRANSMISSION» on page 5-85.
Reinstatement method
Starting the engine, and activating the speed sensor by operating the vehicle at 20 to
30 km/h.
8-67
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
43 Symptom
Power supply to the injectors and fuel pump is not normal.
Fuel system voltage (battery voltage) Diagnostic code No.
Order
09
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
Connections
• Relay unit coupler (fuel pump relay)
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between relay unit coupler and
ECU coupler.
(Blue/Yellow–Blue/Yellow)
(Red/Blue–Red/Blue)
• Between relay unit coupler and battery terminal.
(Red–Red)
• Between relay unit coupler and engine stop switch coupler.
(Red/Black–Red/Black)
Malfunction or open circuit in fuel pump relay
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect it securely.
• Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No. 09)
• Replace if defective.
• If there is no malfunction with the fuel pump relay, replace the
ECU.
Starting the engine and operating it at idle.
8-68
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
44 Symptom
An error is detected while reading or writing on EEPROM
(CO adjustment value).
EEPROM fault cylinder No.
Diagnostic code No.
Orde r
60
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
Malfunction in ECU • Set the faulty cylinder’s exhaust gas volume.
1 Execute the diagnostic mode
(Code No. 60) to check the faulty cylinder number. (If multiple cylinders are defective, the numbers of the faulty cylinders are displayed alternately at 2-second intervals.)
2 Execute the CO adjustment mode and set the exhaust gas volume of the faulty cylinder to
“0”.
If “0” is displayed, set the numerical value other than
“0”. When the malfunction is recovered, reset “0”.
Refer to «ADJUSTING THE
EXHAUST GAS VOLUME» on page 3-8.
• Replace ECU if it does not recover from the malfunction.
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
(Readjust the exhaust gas volume after it is reinstated.)
8-69
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
46 Symptom
Power supply to the fuel injection system relay is not normal.
— Diagnostic code No.
Order
—
Item/components and probable cause
Check or maintenance job
Reinstatement method
1
2
3
4
Connections.
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
Faulty battery
Malfunction in rectifier/regulator
• Check the coupler for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the coupler.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
• Replace or change the battery
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHARGING SYS-
TEM» on page 8-11.
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between battery and main switch
(Red–Red)
• Between main switch and ignition fuse
(Brown/Blue–Brown/Blue)
• Between ignition fuse and ECU
(Red/White–Red/White)
Starting the engine and operating it at idle.
8-70
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
Diagnostic monitoring code No.
Order
56
Item/components and probable cause
1
47 Symptom
Sub-throttle position sensor:open or short circuit detected.
Installed state of sub-throttle position sensor.
ing.
Sub-throttle servo motor
Check or maintenance job
• Check for looseness or pinch-
• Check that the sensor is installed in the specified position.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
3
4
Connections
• Sub-throttle position sensor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between sub-throttle position sensor coupler and ECU coupler.
(Black/Blue–Black/Blue)
(Green/Yellow–Green/Yellow)
(Blue–Blue)
Defective sub-throttle position sensor. • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No. 56)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SUB-THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR» on page 8-110.
8-71
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
2
3
48 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
56
Item/components and probable cause
Connections
• Sub-throttle servo motor coupler
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
1
Sub-throttle servo motor:stuck.
Sub-throttle servo motor
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between sub-throttle servo motor coupler and ECU coupler
(Yellow/Red–Yellow/Red)
(Yellow/White–Yellow/White)
Defective sub-throttle servo motor • Execute the diagnostic mode.
(Code No. 56)
• Replace if defective.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SUB-THROTTLE SERVO
MOTOR» on page 7-10.
Fault code No.
50 Symptom
Faulty ECU memory. (When this malfunction is detected in the ECU, the fault code number might not appear on the meter.)
— Diagnostic code No.
Order
—
Item/components and probable cause
Malfunction in ECU.
Check or maintenance job
Replace the ECU.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”
1
NOTE:
Do not perform this procedure with the main switch turned to
“ON”.
8-72
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
Er-1 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
—
Item/components and probable cause
1
Connections
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Main wire harness meter assembly coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
No signals are received from the ECU.
—
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between meter assembly coupler and ECU coupler.
(Yellow/Blue–Yellow/Blue)
3 Malfunction in meter assembly.
Replace the meter assembly.
4 Malfunction in ECU.
Replace the ECU.
Fault code No.
Er-2 Symptom
No signals are received from the ECU within the specified duration.
— Diagnostic code No.
Order
—
Item/components and probable cause
1
Connections
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Main wire harness meter assembly coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between meter assembly coupler and ECU coupler.
(Yellow/Blue–Yellow/Blue)
3 Malfunction in meter assembly.
Replace the meter assembly.
4 Malfunction in ECU.
Replace the ECU.
8-73
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
Fault code No.
Er-3 Symptom
Diagnostic code No.
Order
1
—
Data from the ECU cannot be received correctly.
—
Item/components and probable cause
Connections
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Main wire harness meter assembly coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
2
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between meter assembly coupler and ECU coupler.
(Yellow/Blue–Yellow/Blue)
3 Malfunction in meter assembly.
Replace the meter assembly.
4 Malfunction in ECU.
Replace the ECU.
Fault code No.
Er-4 Symptom Non-registered data has been received from the meter.
Diagnostic code No.
— —
Order
1
Item/components and probable cause
Connections
• Main wire harness ECU coupler
• Main wire harness meter assembly coupler
• Sub-wire harness coupler
Check or maintenance job
• Check the couplers for any pins that may be pulled out.
• Check the locking condition of the couplers.
• If there is a malfunction, repair it and connect the coupler securely.
2
Open or short circuit in wire harness.
• Repair or replace if there is an open or short circuit.
• Between meter assembly coupler and ECU coupler.
(Yellow/Blue–Yellow/Blue)
3 Malfunction in meter assembly.
Replace the meter assembly.
4 Malfunction in ECU.
Replace the ECU.
Reinstatement method
Turning the main switch to
“ON”.
8-74
EAS27550
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM
EAS27560
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM
8-75
1. Main switch
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
8. Fuse (fuel injection)
13.Fuel pump relay
16.Fuel pump
23.ECU
46.Multi function meter
56.Engine stop switch
78.Fuse (ignition)
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM
8-76
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM
EAS27570
TROUBLESHOOTING
If the fuel pump fails to operate.
NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting, remove the following part(s):
1 Rider and passenger seat
2 Fuel tank
3 Air filter case
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main, ignition and fuel injection system)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
3 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
4 Check the engine stop switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
5 Check the relay unit (fuel pump relay).
Refer to «CHECKING THE
RELAYS» on page 8-100.
OK
↓
6 Check the fuel pump.
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUEL
PRESSURE» on page 7-8.
OK
↓
7 Check the entire fuel pump system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-75.
OK
↓
Replace the ECU.
NG
NG
NG
NG
NG
NG
→
→
→
→
→
→
8-77
Replace the fuse(s).
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
Replace the immobilizer kit.
Replace the right handlebar switch.
Replace the relay unit.
Replace the fuel pump.
Properly connect or repair the fuel pump system’s wiring.
8-78
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM
EAS27640
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
EAS27650
CIRCUIT DIAGRAM
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
8-79
1. Main switch
4. Fuse (backup)
5. Immobilizer unit
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
23.ECU
41.Immobilizer indicator
46.Multi function meter
78.Fuse (ignition)
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
8-80
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
EAS27670
GENERAL INFORMATION
This vehicle is equipped with an immobilizer system to help prevent theft by re-registering codes in the standard keys. This system consists of the following.
• A code re-registering key (with a red bow)
• Two standard keys (with a black bow) that can be re-registered with new codes
• A transponder (which is installed in each key bow)
• An immobilizer unit
• The ECU
• An immobilizer system indicator light
The key with the red bow is used to register codes in each standard key. Do not use the key with the red bow for driving. It should only be used for re-registering new codes in the standard keys. The immobilizer system cannot be operated with a new key until the key registered with a code. If you lose the code re-registering key, the ECU and main switch (included with an immobilizer unit) needs to be replaced.
Therefore, always use a standard key for driving. (See caution below.)
NOTE:
Each standard key is registered during production, therefore re-registering at purchase is not necessary.
ECA14970
CAUTION:
• DO NOT LOSE THE CODE RE-REGISTERING KEY! If the code re-registering key is lost, registering new codes in the standard keys is impossible. The standard keys can still be used to start the vehicle, however if code re-registering is required (i.e., if a new standard key is made or all keys are lost) the entire immobilizer system must be replaced. Therefore, it is highly recommended to use either standard key after any code re-registering and keep the code re-registering key in a safe place.
• Do not submerse either of the keys in water.
• Do not expose the keys to excessively high temperatures.
• Do not place either of the keys close to magnets (this includes, but not limited to, products such as speakers, etc.).
• Do not place heavy items on either key.
• Do not grind either key or alter their shape.
• Do not disassemble the plastic part of either key.
• Keep other immobilizer keys away for this unit’s code re-registering key and main switch.
EAS27691
PART REPLACEMENT AND KEY CODE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS
In the course of use, you may encounter the following cases where replacement of parts and registration of code re-registering/standard keys are required.
NOTE:
Each standard key is registered during production, therefore re-registering at purchase is not necessary.
Standard key is lost
Main switch/immobilizer unit
Main switch
Parts to be replaced
Immobilizer unit
Standard key
ECU
✓
Accessory lock* and key
Key registration requirement
New standard key
8-81
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
All keys have been lost (including code re-registering key)
ECU is defective
Immobilizer unit is defective
Main switch is defective
Accessory lock* is defective
Main switch/immobilizer unit
Main switch
Parts to be replaced
Immobilizer unit
Standard key
ECU
Accessory lock* and key
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
Key registration requirement
Code re-registering key and standard keys
Code re-registering key and standard keys
Code re-registering key and standard keys
Code re-registering key and standard keys
No required
* Accessory locks mean the seat lock, fuel tank cap or the helmet holder.
Code re-registering key registration:
When the immobilizer unit or ECU is replaced, the code re-registering key must be registered to the unit.
To register a code re-registering key:
1. Turn the main switch to “ON” with the code re-registering key.
NOTE:
Check that the immobilizer system indicator light comes on for one second, then goes off. When the immobilizer system indicator light goes off, the code re-registering key has been registered.
2. Check that the engine can be started.
3. Register the standard key, following the instructions in the section below.
Standby mode:
To enable the immobilizer system, turn the ignition key to “OFF”. 30 seconds later, the indicator light will start flashing continuously in the standby flashing mode pattern for up to 24 hours. After that time, the indicator light will stop flashing, but the immobilizer system is still enabled.
8-82
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Standby mode
a. Main switch “ON” b. Main switch “OFF” c. LED on d. LED off e. Standby mode on f. Standby mode off
Standard key registration:
Standard key registration is required when a standard key is lost and needs to be replaced, or when the code re-registering key is re-registered after the immobilizer unit or ECU are replaced.
NOTE:
Do not start the engine with a standard key that has not been registered. If the main switch is turned
“ON” with a standared key that has not been registered, the immobilizer system indicator light flashes to indicate fault code “52”. (Refer to «SELF-DIAGNOSIS FAULT CODE INDICATION» on page 8-85).
1. Check that the immobilizer system indicator light signals the standby mode.
2. Using the code re-registering key, turn the main switch “ON”, then “OFF”, and then remove the key within 5 seconds.
3. Insert the first standard key to be registered into the main switch, then turn the key to “ON” within
5 seconds to activate the key registration mode.
NOTE:
The existing standard key code is erased from the memory when the key registration mode is activated. When the key registration mode is activated, the immobilizer system indicator light flashes rapidly.
4. While the indicator light is flashing, turn the main switch to “OFF”, remove the key, and within 5 seconds, insert the second standard key to be registered into the main switch.
NOTE:
If the immobilizer system indicator light stops flashing 5 seconds after the first standard key is registered, the registration mode is deactivated. If this occurs, the second standard key cannot be registered, and steps 2 to 4 need to be repeated to register both standard keys.
5. Turn the main switch to “ON”.
NOTE:
When the indicator light goes off, the registration is complete.
6. Check that the engine can be started with the two registered standard keys.
8-83
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Standard key registration
a. Main switch “ON” b. Main switch “OFF” c. LED on d. LED off e. Less than 5.0 s f. Code re-registering key g. First standard key h. Second standard key i. Registration mode
A. Registration of the second standard key is complete.
B. Immobilizer system indicator light stops flashing when the registration of the second standard key is complete.
Voiding the standard key code:
If a standard key has been lost, it is possible to disable its use by re-registering the remaining standard key. Standard key registration erases the stored standard key code from the memory, thus disabling the lost standard key. To re-register, refer to “Standard key registration”.
Standard key code voiding method
a. Main switch “ON” b. Main switch “OFF” c. LED on d. LED off e. Less than 5.0 s f. Code re-registering key g. Remaining standard key h. Registration mode
A. If the immobilizer system indicator light stops flashing 5 seconds after the first standard key is registered, the second standard key cannnot be registered.
8-84
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
EAS27700
TROUBLESHOOTING
When the main switch is turn “ON”, the indicator light does not come on or flashing.
NG
→
1 Check the fuses.
(Main, ignition and backup)
Refer to «CHECKING THE FUSES» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
Replace the fuse(s).
NG
→
2 Check the battery.
Refer to «CHECKING AND
CHARGING THE BATTERY» on page 8-97.
OK
↓
• Clean the battery terminals.
• Recharge or replace the battery.
NG
→
3 Check the main switch.
Refer to «CHECKING THE
SWITCHES» on page 8-93.
OK
↓
Replace the immobilizer kit.
NG
→
4 Check the entire immobilizer system’s wiring.
Refer to «CIRCUIT DIAGRAM» on page 8-79.
OK
↓
Properly connect or repair the immobilizer system’s wiring.
• Check the condition of the each immobilizer system’s circuits.
• Refer to «SELF-DIAGNOSIS FAULT
CODE INDICATION» on page 8-85.
EAS27720
SELF-DIAGNOSIS FAULT CODE INDICATION
When the system failure occurred, the error code number is indicated in the immobilizer system indicator light blinks at the same time. The pattern of blinking also shows the error code.
Error code
Detection Symptoms Trouble Measures
51
IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
Cannot transmit code between the key and immobilizer unit.
1 Objects that may keep off radio waves exist around the keys and antennas.
2 Immobilizer unit failure.
3 Key failure.
1 Keep clear of magnets, metals and other keys form the surroundings of keys and antennas.
2 Replace the immobilizer unit.
3 Replace the key.
8-85
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
Error code
Detection Symptoms Trouble Measures
52
53
54
55
56
IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
ECU
Codes do not match between the key and immobilizer unit.
Cannot transmit code between the
ECU and immobilizer unit.
Codes do not match between ECU and immobilizer unit.
Key code registration error.
Undefinition code is received.
1 Disturbed by other transponder.
Failed to verify continually for ten times.
2 Unregistered sub key was used.
Noise interference or disconnected lead/cable.
1 Obstruction due to radio wave noise.
2 Error by disconnection of the communication harness.
3 Immobilizer unit failure.
4 ECU failure.
Noise interference or disconnected lead/cable.
1 Obstruction due to radio wave noise.
2 Error by disconnection of the communication harness.
3 Immobilizer unit failure.
4 ECU failure.
(When the used parts form other vehicles are used, the code re-registering key ID is not registered to the ECU.)
1 Place the immobilizer unit away more than 50 mm from the transponder of other vehicle.
2 Register the standard key.
1 Check the wire harness and connector.
2 Replace the immobilizer unit.
3 Replace the ECU.
1 Register the code re-registering key
ID.
2 Check the wire harness and connector.
3 Replace the immobilizer unit.
4 Replace the ECU.
Same standard key was attempted to continuously two times register.
Noise interference or disconnected lead/cable.
1 Obstruction due to radio wave noise.
2 Error by disconnection of the communication harness.
3 Immobilizer unit failure
4 ECU failure
Prepare the new standard key and register it.
1 Check the wire harness and connector.
2 Replace the immobilizer unit.
3 Replace the ECU.
Immobilizer system indicator light error code indication
Digit of 10 : Cycles of 1 sec. ON and 1.5 sec. OFF.
Digit of 1 : Cycles of 0.5 sec. ON and 0.5 sec. OFF.
8-86
a. Light on b. Light off
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
8-87
8-88
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM
EAS27970
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
8-89
1. Main switch (immobilizer unit)
2. Front brake light switch
3. Starter relay
4. Battery
5. Fuse box
6. Rear brake light switch
7. Neutral switch
8. Sidestand switch
9. Oil level switch
10.Radiator fan motor
11.Horn
12.Ignition coil
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
8-90
8-91
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
1. Coolant temperature sensor
2. Intake air temperature sensor
3. Intake air pressure sensor
4. Fuel pump
5. ECU
6. Lean angle sensor
7. Starting circuit cut-off relay
8. Headlight relay (on/off)
9. Radiator fan motor relay
10.Turn signal relay
11.Recifier/regulator
12.Throttle position sensor
13.Sub-throttle position sensor
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
8-92
EAS27980
CHECKING THE SWITCHES
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
8-93
1. Main switch
2. Horn switch
3. Dimmer switch
4. Pass switch
5. Turn signal switch
6. Hazard switch
7. Clutch switch
8. Sidestand switch
9. Engine stop switch
10.Front brake light switch
11.Start switch
12.Oil level switch
13.Neutral switch
14.Rear brake light switch
15.Fuse box
16.O
2
sensor
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
8-94
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
Check each switch for continuity with the pocket tester. If the continuity reading is incorrect, check the wiring connections and if necessary, replace the switch.
ECA14370
CAUTION:
Never insert the tester probes into the coupler terminal slots “1”. Always insert the probes from the opposite end of the coupler, taking care not to loosen or damage the leads.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
NOTE:
• Before checking for continuity, set the pocket tester to “0” and to the “
Ω ×
1” range.
• When checking for continuity, switch back and forth between the switch positions a few times.
The switches and their terminal connections are illustrated as in the following example of the main switch.
The switch positions “a” are shown in the far left column and the switch lead colors “b” are shown in the top row.
The continuity (i. e., a closed circuit) between switch terminals at a given switch position is indication by “ ” There is continuity between red, brown/blue, and brown/red when the switch is set to
“ON” and between red and brown/red when the switch is set to “ ”.
8-95
EAS27990
CHECKING THE BULBS AND BULB SOCK-
ETS
Check each bulb and bulb socket for damage or wear, proper connections, and also for continuity between the terminals.
Damage/wear
→
Repair or replace the bulb, bulb socket or both.
Improperly connected
→
Properly connect.
No continuity
→
Repair or replace the bulb, bulb socket or both.
Types of bulbs
The bulbs used on this vehicle are shown in the following illustration.
• Bulbs “a” and “b” are used for the headlights and usually use a bulb holder that must be detached before removing the bulb. The majority of these types of bulbs can be removed from their respective socket by turning them counterclockwise.
• Bulbs “c” is used for turn signal and tail/brake lights and can be removed from the socket by pushing and turning the bulb counterclockwise.
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS hands away from the bulb until it has cooled down.
ECA14380
CAUTION:
• Be sure to hold the socket firmly when removing the bulb. Never pull the lead, otherwise it may be pulled out of the terminal in the coupler.
• Avoid touching the glass part of the headlight bulb to keep it free from oil, otherwise the transparency of the glass, the life of the bulb, and the luminous flux will be adversely affected. If the headlight bulb gets soiled, thoroughly it with a cloth moistened with alcohol or lacquer thinner.
2. Check:
• Bulb (for continuity)
(with the pocket tester)
No continuity
→
Replace.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
NOTE:
Before checking for continuity, set the pocket tester to “0” and to the “
Ω ×
1” range.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the positive tester probe to terminal “1” and the negative tester probe to terminal “2”, and check the continuity.
b. Connect the positive tester probe to terminal “1” and the negative tester probe to terminal “3”, and check the continuity.
c. If either of the readings indicate no continuity, replace the bulb.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
Checking the condition of the bulbs
The following procedure applies to all of the bulbs.
1. Remove:
• Bulb
EWA13320
WARNING
Since the headlight bulb gets extremely hot, keep flammable products and your
8-96
Checking the condition of the bulb sockets
The following procedure applies to all of the bulb sockets.
1. Check:
• Bulb socket (for continuity)
(with the pocket tester)
No continuity
→
Replace.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
NOTE:
Check each bulb socket for continuity in the same manner as described in the bulb section; however, note the following.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Install a good bulb into the bulb socket.
b. Connect the pocket tester probes to the respective leads of the bulb socket.
c. Check the bulb socket for continuity. If any of the readings indicate no continuity, replace the bulb socket.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28000
CHECKING THE FUSES
The following procedure applies to all of the fuses.
ECA13680
CAUTION:
To avoid a short circuit, always set the main switch to “OFF” when checking or replacing a fuse.
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
2. Check:
• Fuse
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester to the fuse and check the continuity.
NOTE:
Set the pocket tester selector to “
Ω ×
1”.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
b. If the pocket tester indicates “
∞
”, replace the fuse.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
8-97
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
3. Replace:
• Blown fuse
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Set the main switch to “OFF”.
b. Install a new fuse of the correct amperage rating.
c. Set on the switches to verify if the electrical circuit is operational.
d. If the fuse immediately blows again, check the electrical circuit.
Fuses Q’ty
Main
Headlight (FZ1-N)
Headlight (FZ1-S)
Signaling system
Tail/brake light
Ignition
Buckup
Radiator fan motor
Reserve
Reserve (FZ1-N)
Reserve (FZ1-S)
Amperage rating
50 A
15 A
25 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
25 A
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
EWA13310
WARNING
Never use a fuse with an amperage rating other than that specified. Improvising or using a fuse with the wrong amperage rating may cause extensive damage to the electrical system, cause the lighting and ignition systems to malfunction and could possibly cause a fire.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
4. Install:
• Rider and passenger seat
EAS28030
CHECKING AND CHARGING THE BATTERY
EWA13290
WARNING
Batteries generate explosive hydrogen gas and contain electrolyte which is made of poisonous and highly caustic sulfuric acid.
Therefore, always follow these preventive measures:
• Wear protective eye gear when handling or working near batteries.
• Charge batteries in a well-ventilated area.
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
• Keep batteries away from fire, sparks or open flames (e.g., welding equipment, lighted cigarettes).
• DO NOT SMOKE when charging or handling batteries.
• KEEP BATTERIES AND ELECTROLYTE
OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN.
• Avoid bodily contact with electrolyte as it can cause severe burns or permanent eye injury.
FIRST AID IN CASE OF BODILY CONTACT:
EXTERNAL
• Skin — Wash with water.
• Eyes — Flush with water for 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention.
INTERNAL
• Drink large quantities of water or milk followed with milk of magnesia, beaten egg or vegetable oil. Get immediate medical attention.
ECA13660
CAUTION:
• This is a sealed battery. Never remove the sealing caps because the balance between cells will not be maintained and battery performance will deteriorate.
• Charging time, charging amperage and charging voltage for an MF battery are different from those of conventional batteries. The MF battery should be charged as explained in the charging method illustrations. If the battery is overcharged, the electrolyte level will drop considerably.
Therefore, take special care when charging the battery.
NOTE:
Since MF batteries are sealed, it is not possible to check the charge state of the battery by measuring the specific gravity of the electrolyte. Therefore, the charge of the battery has to be checked by measuring the voltage at the battery terminals.
1. Remove:
• Rider and passenger seat
2. Disconnect:
• Battery leads
(from the battery terminals)
ECA13640
CAUTION:
First, disconnect the negative battery lead
“1”, and then positive battery lead “2”.
3. Remove:
• Battery
4. Check:
• Battery charge
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect a pocket tester to the battery terminals.
• Positive tester probe
→ positive battery terminal
• Negative tester probe
→ negative battery terminal
8-98
NOTE:
• The charge state of an MF battery can be checked by measuring its open-circuit voltage (i.e., the voltage when the positive battery terminal is disconnected).
• No charging is necessary when the open-circuit voltage equals or exceeds 12.8 V.
b. Check the charge of the battery, as shown in the charts and the following example.
Example
Open-circuit voltage = 12.0 V
Charging time = 6.5 hours
Charge of the battery = 20–30%
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
5. Charge:
• Battery
(refer to the appropriate charging method illustration)
EWA13300
WARNING
Do not quick charge a battery.
ECA13670
CAUTION:
• Never remove the MF battery sealing caps.
• Do not use a high-rate battery charger since it forces a high-amperage current
into the battery quickly and can cause battery overheating and battery plate damage.
• If it is impossible to regulate the charging current on the battery charger, be careful not to overcharge the battery.
• When charging a battery, be sure to remove it from the vehicle. (If charging has to be done with the battery mounted on the vehicle, disconnect the negative battery lead from the battery terminal.)
• To reduce the chance of sparks, do not plug in the battery charger until the battery charger leads are connected to the battery.
• Before removing the battery charger lead clips from the battery terminals, be sure to turn off the battery charger.
• Make sure the battery charger lead clips are in full contact with the battery terminal and that they are not shorted. A corroded battery charger lead clip may generate heat in the contact area and a weak clip spring may cause sparks.
• If the battery becomes hot to the touch at any time during the charging process, disconnect the battery charger and let the battery cool before reconnecting it. Hot batteries can explode!
• As shown in the following illustration, the open-circuit voltage of an MF battery stabilizes about 30 minutes after charging has been completed. Therefore, wait 30 minutes after charging is completed before measuring the open-circuit voltage.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
Charging method using a variable-current
(voltage) charger
a. Measure the open-circuit voltage prior to charging.
NOTE:
Voltage should be measured 30 minutes after the machine is stopped.
b. Connect a charged and AMP meter to the battery and start charging.
NOTE:
Set the charging voltage at 16–17 V.If the setting is lower, charging will be insufficient. If too high, the battery will be over-charged.
8-99
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
c. Make sure that the current is higher than the standard charging current written on the battery.
NOTE:
If the current is lower than the standard charging current written on the battery, set the charging voltage adjust dial at 20–24 V and monitor the amperage for 3–5 minutes to check the battery.
• Reach the standard charging current
Battery is good.
• Does not reach the standard charging current
Replace the battery.
d. Adjust the voltage so that the current is at the standard charging level.
e. Set the time according to the charging time suitable for the open-circuit voltage.
Refer to “Battery condition checking steps”.
f.
If charging requires more than 5 hours, it is advisable to check the charging current after a lapse of 5 hours. If there is any change in the amperage, readjust the voltage to obtain the standard charging current.
g. Measure the battery open-circuit voltage after leaving the battery unused for more than 30 minutes.
12.8 V or more — Charging is complete.
12.7 V or less — Recharging is required.
Under 12.0 V — Replace the battery.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
Charging method using a constant voltage charger
a. Measure the open-circuit voltage prior to charging.
NOTE:
Voltage should be measured 30 minutes after the machine is stopped.
b. Connect a charger and AMP meter to the battery and start charging.
c. Make sure that the current is higher than the standard charging current written on the battery.
NOTE:
If the current is lower than the standard charging current written on the battery, this type of battery charger cannot charge the MF battery.
A variable voltage charger is recommended.
d. Charge the battery until the battery’s charging voltage is 15 V.
NOTE:
Set the charging time at 20 hours (maximum).
e. Measure the battery open-circuit voltage after leaving the battery unused for more than 30 minutes.
12.8 V or more — Charging is complete.
12.7 V or less — Recharging is required.
Under 12.0 V — Replace the battery.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
6. Install:
• Battery
7. Connect:
• Battery leads
(to the battery terminals)
ECA13630
CAUTION:
First, connect the positive battery lead “1”, and then the negative battery lead “2”.
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
EAS28040
CHECKING THE RELAYS
Check each switch for continuity with the pocket tester. If the continuity reading is incorrect, replace the relay.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
1. Disconnect the relay from the wire harness.
2. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1) and battery (12 V) to the relay terminal as shown.
Check the relay operation.
Out of specification
→
Replace.
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
4. Negative tester probe
Relay operation
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
Relay unit (starting circuit cut-off relay)
FZ1-N
8. Check:
• Battery terminals
Dirt
→
Clean with a wire brush.
Loose connection
→
Connect properly.
9. Lubricate:
• Battery terminals
Recommended lubricant
Dielectric grease
10. Install:
• Rider and passenger seat
FZ1-S
8-100
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
4. Negative tester probe
Result
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
Relay unit (fuel pump relay)
FZ1-N
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
4. Negative tester probe
Result
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
Headlight relay (on/off)
(FZ1-S)
FZ1-S
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
4. Negative tester probe
Result
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
Headlight relay (dimmer)
(FZ1-S)
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
4. Negative tester probe
Result
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
Headlight relay (on/off)
(FZ1-N)
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
8-101
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
4. Negative tester probe
Result
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
(between “3” to “5”)
Radiator fan motor relay
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
1. Positive battery terminal
2. Negative battery terminal
3. Positive tester probe
4. Negative tester probe
Result
Continuity/No continuity
(between “3” to “4”)
ET2D1030
CHECKING THE TURN SIGNAL/HAZARD
RELAY
1. Check:
• Turn signal/hazard relay input voltage
Out of specification
→
The wiring circuit from the main switch to the turn signal/hazard relay coupler is faulty and must be repaired.
Turn signal/hazard relay input voltage
DC 12 V
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the turn signal/hazard relay terminal as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
→
Blue/Red “1”
• Negative tester probe
→
Ground b. Turn the main switch to “ON”.
c. Measure the turn signal/hazard relay input voltage.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Check:
• Turn signal/hazard relay output voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Turn signal/hazard relay output voltage
DC 12 V
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the turn signal/hazard relay terminal as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
→
Brown/White “1”
• Negative tester probe
→
Ground b. Turn the main switch to “ON”.
c. Measure the turn signal/hazard relay output voltage.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1021
CHECKING THE RELAY UNIT (DIODE)
1. Check:
• Relay unit (diode)
Out of specification
→
Replace.
8-102
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
FZ1-N
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
NOTE:
The pocket tester and the analog pocket tester readings are shown in the following table.
Continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Sky blue “1”
Negative tester probe
→
Yellow/Black “2” (FZ1-N) Black/
Yellow “2” (FZ1-S)
No continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Yellow/Black “2” (FZ1-N) Black/
Yellow “2” (FZ1-S)
Negative tester probe
→
Sky blue “1”
Continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Sky blue “1”
Negative tester probe
→
Blue/
Yellow “3”
No continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Blue/
Yellow “3”
Negative tester probe
→
Sky blue “1”
Continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Sky blue “1”
Negative tester probe
→
Sky blue/White “4”
No continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Sky blue/White “4”
Negative tester probe
→
Sky blue “1”
Continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Blue/
Black “5”
Negative tester probe
→
Blue/
Yellow “3”
No continuity
Positive tester probe
→
Blue/
Yellow “3”
Negative tester probe
→
Blue/
Black “5”
FZ1-S
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the relay unit coupler from the wire harness.
b. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω×
1) to the relay unit terminal as shown.
c. Check the relay unit (diode) for continuity.
d. Check the relay unit (diode) for no continuity.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28100
CHECKING THE IGNITION COILS
The following procedure applies to all of the ignition coils.
1. Check:
• Primary coil resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Primary coil resistance
1.19–1.61
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the ignition coil leads from the wire harness.
b. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1) to the ignition coil as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
8-103
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
• Positive tester probe
Ignition coil terminal
• Negative tester probe
Ignition coil terminal
3. Check:
• Ignition spark gap “a”
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Minimum ignition spark gap
6.0 mm (0.24 in)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the spark plug cap from the spark plug.
b. Connect the ignition checker/dynamic spark tester “2” as shown.
Ignition checker
90890-06754
Opama pet-4000 spark checker
YM-34487
c. Measure the primary coil resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Check:
• Secondary coil resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Secondary coil resistance
8.5–11.5 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the ignition coil leads from the wire harness.
b. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1k) to the ignition coil as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Negative tester probe
Ignition coil terminal “1”
• Positive tester probe
Spark plug terminal “2” c. Measure the secondary coil resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
8-104
1. Spark plug cap c. Set the main switch to “ON”.
d. Measure the ignition spark gap “a”.
e. Crank the engine by pushing the starter switch and gradually increase the spark gap until a misfire occurs.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28120
CHECKING THE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
1. Disconnect:
• Crankshaft position sensor coupler
(from the wire harness)
2. Check:
• Crankshaft position sensor resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace the crankshaft position sensor.
Crankshaft position sensor resistance
336–504
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
a. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
100) to the crankshaft position sensor coupler as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Gray “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black “2” b. Measure the crankshaft position sensor resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28130
CHECKING THE LEAN ANGLE SENSOR
1. Remove:
• Lean angle sensor
2. Check:
• Lean angle sensor out put voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Lean angle sensor output voltage
Less than 65
°
: 0.4–1.4 V
More than 65
°
: 3.7–4.4 V
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the lean angle sensor coupler to the wire harness.
b. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the lean angle sensor coupler as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Yellow/Green “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue “2” c. When turn the lean angle sensor to 65
°
.
d. Measure the lean angle sensor output voltage.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
ET2D1034
CHECKING THE STARTOR MOTOR OPERA-
TION
1. Check:
• Starter motor operation
Does not operate
→
Perform the electric starting system troubleshooting, starting with step5.
Refer to «TROUBLESHOOTING» on page
8-9.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the positive battery terminal “1” and starter motor lead “2” with a jumper lead “3”.
EWA13810
WARNING
• A wire that is used as a jumper lead must have at least the same capacity of the battery, otherwise the jumper lead may burn.
• This check is likely to produce sparks, therefore, make sure no flammable gas or fluid is in the vicinity.
8-105
b. Check the starter motor operation.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Check:
• Startor coil resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace the startor coil.
EAS28150
CHECKING THE STATOR COIL
1. Disconnect:
• Stator coil coupler
(from the wire harness)
2. Check:
• Stator coil resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace the startor coil.
Stator coil resistance
0.14–0.18
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1) to the startor coil coupler as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
White “1”
• Negative tester probe
White “2”
• Positive tester probe
White “1”
• Negative tester probe
White “3”
• Positive tester probe
White “2”
• Negative tester probe
White “3”
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
• Charging voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace the rectifier/ regulator.
Charging voltage
14 V at 5000 r/min
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Set the engine tachometer to the ignition coil of cylinder #1.
b. Connect the pocket tester (AC 20 V) to the rectifier/regulator coupler as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Red “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black “2” b. Measure the stator coil resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28170
CHECKING THE RECTIFIER/REGULATOR
1. Check:
8-106
c. Start the engine and let it run at approximately 5000 r/min.
d. Measure the charging voltage.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28180
CHECKING THE HORN
1. Check:
• Horn resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Horn resistance
1.15–1.25
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the horn leads from the horn terminals.
b. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1) to the horn terminals.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Horn terminal “1”
• Negative tester probe
Horn terminal “2”
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
(from the fuel tank)
4. Check:
• Fuel sender resistance
Fuel sender resistance
Full position of the float
19–21
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
Empty position of the float
139–141
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
10) to the fuel sender terminal as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Green/white “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black “2” c. Measure the horn resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
2. Check:
• Horn sound
Faulty sound
→
Adjust or replace.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect a battery (12 V) to the horn.
b. Turn the adjusting screw in direction “a” or
“b” until the specified horn sound is obtained.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28230
CHECKING THE FUEL SENDER
1. Remove:
• Fuel tank
2. Disconnect:
• Fuel pump coupler
• Fuel sender coupler
(from the wire harness)
3. Remove:
• Fuel pump
8-107
b. Measure the fuel sender resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28240
CHECKING THE SPEED SENSOR
1. Check:
• Speed sensor output voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Output voltage reading cycle
0.6 V to 4.8 V to 0.6 V to 4.8 V
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the speed sensor coupler (wire harness side) as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
White/Yellow “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue “2” b. Set the main switch to “ON”.
c. Elevate the rear wheel and slowly rotate it.
d. Measure the voltage (DC 5 V) of White/Yellow and Blue. With each full rotation of the rear wheel, the voltage reading should cycle from 0.6 V to 4.8 V to 0.6 V to 4.8 V.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28250
CHECKING THE RADIATOR FAN MOTOR
1. Check:
• Radiator fan motor
Faulty/rough movement
→
Replace.
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the radiator fan motor coupler from the wire harness.
b. Connect the battery (DC 12 V) as shown.
• Positive tester probe
Blue “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black “2”
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
EWA14130
WARNING
• Handle the coolant temperature sensor with special care.
• Never subject the coolant temperature sensor to strong shocks. If the coolant temperature sensor is dropped, replace it.
2. Check:
• Coolant temperature sensor resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Coolant temperature sensor resistance
0
°
C (32
°
F) : 5.21–6.37 k
Ω
80
°
C (176
°
F) : 0.29–0.35 k
Ω
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1k) to the coolant temperature sensor “1” as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Coolant temperature sensor terminal
• Negative tester probe
Coolant temperature sensor terminal b. Immerse the coolant temperature sensor in a container filled with coolant “2”.
NOTE:
Make sure the coolant temperature sensor terminals do not get wet.
c. Place a thermometer “3” in the coolant.
c. Measure the radiator fan motor movement.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28260
CHECKING THE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
1. Remove:
• Coolant temperature sensor
8-108
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
• Tester positive lead
→
Blue “1”
• Tester negative lead
→
Black/Blue “2” b. Check the throttle position sensor maximum resistance.
Out of specification
→
Replace the throttle position sensor.
Maximum throttle position sensor resistance
4–6 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
c. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1k) to the throttle position sensor as shown.
• Tester positive lead
→
Yellow “3”
• Tester negative lead
→
Black/Blue “2” d. Slowly heat the coolant, and then let it cool to the specified temperature indicated in the table.
e. Check the coolant temperature sensor for continuity at the temperatures indicated in the table.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28300
CHECKING THE THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
1. Remove:
• Throttle position sensor
(from the throttle body)
2. Check:
• Throttle position sensor
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1k) to the throttle position sensor as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
d. While slowly opening the throttle, check that the throttle position sensor resistance is within the specified range.
The resistance does not change or it changes abruptly
→
Replace the throttle position sensor.
Throttle position sensor resistance
0–6 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Install:
• Throttle position sensor
8-109
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
NOTE:
When installing the throttle position sensor, adjust its angle properly. Refer to «ADJUST-
ING THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR» on page 7-8.
EAS2D1010
CHECKING THE SUB-THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR
1. Remove:
• Sub-throttle position sensor
(from the throttle body)
2. Check:
• Sub-throttle position sensor
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Disconnect the sub-throttle motor coupler.
b. Disconnect the sub-throttle position sensor coupler.
c. Remove the sub-throttle position sensor from the sub-throttle servo motor.
d. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1k) to the sub-throttle position sensor as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Tester positive lead
→
Blue “1”
• Tester negative lead
→
Black/Blue “2” e. Check the throttle position sensor maximum resistance.
Out of specification
→
Replace the throttle position sensor.
Maximum sub-throttle position sensor resistance
4–6 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
f.
Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1k) to the throttle position sensor as shown.
• Tester positive lead
→
Green/Yellow “3”
• Tester negative lead
→
Black/Blue “2” g. While slowly opening the sub-throttle worm nut, check that the sub-throttle position sensor resistance is within the specified range.
The resistance does not change or it changes abruptly
→
Replace the sub-throttle position sensor.
NOTE:
Check mainly that the resistance changes gradually when turning the sub-throttle worm nut, since the readings (from closed to wideopen sub-throttle) may differ slightly from those specified.
Throttle position sensor resistance
0–6 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Install:
• Sub-throttle position sensor
NOTE:
When installing the throttle position sensor, adjust its angle properly. Refer to «CHECKING
THE SUB-THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR» on page 8-110.
EA2D1012
CHECKING THE AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
SOLENOID
1. Check:
• Air induction system solenoid resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace.
8-110
Air induction system solenoid resistance
18–22
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Remove the Air induction system solenoid coupler from the wire harness.
b. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
1) to the Air induction system solenoid terminal as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Brown “1”
• Negative tester probe
Brown/Red “2” c. Measure the Air induction system solenoid resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28380
CHECKING THE ATMOSPHERIC PRES-
SURE SENSOR
1. Check:
• Atmospheric pressure sensor output voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Atmospheric pressure sensor output voltage
3.75–4.25 V
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the atmospheric pressure sensor coupler (wire harness side) as shown.
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Pink “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue “2” b. Set the main switch to “ON”.
c. Measure the atmospheric pressure sensor output voltage.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28390
CHECKING THE CYLINDER IDENTIFICA-
TION SENSOR
1. Check:
• Cylinder identification sensor output voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Cylinder identification sensor output voltage
When sensor is on
4.8 V or more
When sensor is off
0.8 V or less
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the cylinder identification sensor coupler (wire harness side) as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
White/Black “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue “2”
8-111
b. Set the main switch to “ON”.
c. Rotate the crankshaft.
d. Measure the voltage (DC 20 V) of White/
Black and Black/Blue. With each full rotation of the crankshaft, the voltage reading should cycle from 0.8 V to 4.8 V to 0.8 V to
4.8 V.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
EAS28410
CHECKING THE INTAKE AIR PRESSURE
SENSOR
1. Check:
• Intake air pressure sensor output voltage
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Intake air pressure sensor output voltage
3.75–4.25 V
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (DC 20 V) to the intake air pressure sensor coupler (wire harness side) as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Pink/White “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue “2”
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
EAS28420
CHECKING THE INTAKE AIR TEMPERA-
TURE SENSOR
1. Remove:
• Intake air temperature sensor
(from the air filter case.)
EWA14110
WARNING
• Handle the intake air temperature sensor with special care.
• Never subject the intake air temperature sensor to strong shocks. If the intake air temperature sensor is dropped, replace it.
2. Check:
• Intake air temperature sensor resistance
Out of specification
→
Replace.
Intake air temperature sensor resistance
2.21–2.69 k
Ω
at 20
°
C (68
°
F)
▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼▼ a. Connect the pocket tester (
Ω ×
100) to the intake air temperature sensor terminal as shown.
Pocket tester
90890-03112
Analog pocket tester
YU-03112-C
• Positive tester probe
Brown/White “1”
• Negative tester probe
Black/Blue “2” b. Set the main switch to “ON”.
c. Measure the intake air pressure sensor output voltage.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
8-112
b. Measure the intake air temperature sensor resistance.
▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲▲
3. Install:
• Intake air temperature sensor
Intake air temperature sensor bolt
1.2 Nm (0.12 m·kg, 0.87 ft·lb)
8-113
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
TROUBLESHOOTING
TROUBLESHOOTING
………………………………………………………………………. 9-1
GENERAL INFORMATION …………………………………………………………… 9-1
STARTING FAILURES …………………………………………………………………. 9-1
INCORRECT ENGINE IDLING SPEED …………………………………………. 9-1
POOR MEDIUM-AND-HIGH-SPEED PERFORMANCE …………………… 9-2
FAULTY GEAR SHIFTING ……………………………………………………………. 9-2
SHIFT PEDAL DOES NOT MOVE…………………………………………………. 9-2
JUMPS OUT OF GEAR……………………………………………………………….. 9-2
FAULTY CLUTCH ……………………………………………………………………….. 9-2
OVERHEATING ………………………………………………………………………….. 9-2
OVERCOOLING …………………………………………………………………………. 9-3
POOR BRAKING PERFORMANCE ………………………………………………. 9-3
FAULTY FRONT FORK LEGS ………………………………………………………. 9-3
UNSTABLE HANDLING……………………………………………………………….. 9-3
FAULTY LIGHTING OR SIGNALING SYSTEM ……………………………….. 9-4
9
EAS28450
TROUBLESHOOTING
EAS28460
GENERAL INFORMATION
NOTE:
The following guide for troubleshooting does not cover all the possible causes of trouble. It should be helpful, however, as a guide to basic troubleshooting. Refer to the relative procedure in this manual for checks, adjustments, and replacement of parts.
EAS28470
STARTING FAILURES
Engine
1. Cylinder(s) and cylinder head(s)
• Loose spark plug
• Loose cylinder head or cylinder
• Damaged cylinder head gasket
• Damaged cylinder gasket
• Worn or damaged cylinder
• Incorrect valve clearance
• Improperly sealed valve
• Incorrect valve-to-valve-seat contact
• Incorrect valve timing
• Faulty valve spring
• Seized valve
2. Piston(s) and piston ring(s)
• Improperly installed piston ring
• Damaged, worn or fatigued piston ring
• Seized piston ring
• Seized or damaged piston
3. Air filter
• Improperly installed air filter
• Clogged air filter element
4. Crankcase and crankshaft
• Improperly assembled crankcase
• Seized crankshaft
Fuel system
1. Fuel tank
• Empty fuel tank
• Clogged fuel filter
• Clogged fuel strainer
• Clogged fuel tank drain hose
• Clogged rollover valve hose
• Deteriorated or contaminated fuel
2. Fuel pump
• Faulty fuel pump
• Faulty fuel pump relay
3. Throttle body (-ies)
• Deteriorated or contaminated fuel
9-1
TROUBLESHOOTING
• Sucked-in air
Electrical system
1. Battery
• Discharged battery
• Faulty battery
2. Fuse(s)
• Blown, damaged or incorrect fuse
• Improperly installed fuse
3. Spark plug(s)
• Incorrect spark plug gap
• Incorrect spark plug heat range
• Fouled spark plug
• Worn or damaged electrode
• Worn or damaged insulator
4. Ignition coil(s)
• Cracked or broken ignition coil body
• Broken or shorted primary or secondary coils
5. Ignition system
• Faulty ECU
• Faulty crankshaft position sensor
6. Switches and wiring
• Faulty main switch
• Faulty engine stop switch
• Broken or shorted wiring
• Faulty neutral switch
• Faulty start switch
• Faulty sidestand switch
• Faulty clutch switch
• Improperly grounded circuit
• Loose connections
7. Starting system
• Faulty starter motor
• Faulty starter relay
• Faulty starting circuit cut-off relay
• Faulty starter clutch
EAS28490
INCORRECT ENGINE IDLING SPEED
Engine
1. Cylinder(s) and cylinder head(s)
• Incorrect valve clearance
• Damaged valve train components
2. Air filter
• Clogged air filter element
Fuel system
1. Throttle body (-ies)
• Damaged or loose throttle body joint
• Improperly synchronized throttle bodies
• Improperly adjusted engine idling speed
(idle adjusting screw)
• Improper throttle cable free play
• Flooded throttle body
• Faulty air induction system
Electrical system
1. Battery
• Discharged battery
• Faulty battery
2. Spark plug(s)
• Incorrect spark plug gap
• Incorrect spark plug heat range
• Fouled spark plug
• Worn or damaged electrode
• Worn or damaged insulator
3. Ignition coil(s)
• Broken or shorted primary or secondary coils
• Cracked or broken ignition coil
4. Ignition system
• Faulty ECU
• Faulty crankshaft position sensor
EAS28510
POOR MEDIUM-AND-HIGH-SPEED PER-
FORMANCE
Refer to «STARTING FAILURES» on page 9-1.
Engine
1. Air filter
• Clogged air filter element
Fuel system
1. Fuel pump
• Faulty fuel pump
EAS28530
FAULTY GEAR SHIFTING
Shifting is difficult
Refer to Clutch drags.
EAS28540
SHIFT PEDAL DOES NOT MOVE
Shift shaft
• Improperly adjusted shift rod
• Bent shift shaft
Shift drum and shift forks
• Foreign object in a shift drum groove
• Seized shift fork
• Bent shift fork guide bar
Transmission
• Seized transmission gear
• Foreign object between transmission gears
9-2
TROUBLESHOOTING
• Improperly assembled transmission
EAS28550
JUMPS OUT OF GEAR
Shift shaft
• Incorrect shift pedal position
• Improperly returned stopper lever
Shift forks
• Worn shift fork
Shift drum
• Incorrect axial play
• Worn shift drum groove
Transmission
• Worn gear dog
EAS28560
FAULTY CLUTCH
Clutch slips
1. Clutch
• Improperly assembled clutch
• Improperly adjusted clutch cable
• Loose or fatigued clutch spring
• Worn friction plate
• Worn clutch plate
2. Engine oil
• Incorrect oil level
• Incorrect oil viscosity (low)
• Deteriorated oil
Clutch drags
1. Clutch
• Unevenly tensioned clutch springs
• Warped pressure plate
• Bent clutch plate
• Swollen friction plate
• Bent clutch push rod
• Broken clutch boss
• Burnt primary driven gear bushing
• Match marks not aligned
2. Engine oil
• Incorrect oil level
• Incorrect oil viscosity (high)
• Deteriorated oil
EAS28600
OVERHEATING
Engine
1. Clogged coolant passages
• Cylinder head(s) and piston(s)
• Heavy carbon buildup
2. Engine oil
• Incorrect oil level
• Incorrect oil viscosity
• Inferior oil quality
Cooling system
1. Coolant
• Low coolant level
2. Radiator
• Damaged or leaking radiator
• Faulty radiator cap
• Bent or damaged radiator fin
3. Water pump
• Damaged or faulty water pump
• Thermostat
• Thermostat stays closed
• Oil cooler
• Clogged or damaged oil cooler
• Hose(s) and pipe(s)
• Damaged hose
• Improperly connected hose
• Damaged pipe
• Improperly connected pipe
Fuel system
1. Throttle body (-ies)
• Damaged or loose throttle body joint
2. Air filter
• Clogged air filter element
Chassis
1. Brake(s)
• Dragging brake
Electrical system
1. Spark plug(s)
• Incorrect spark plug gap
• Incorrect spark plug heat range
2. Ignition system
• Faulty ECU
EAS28610
OVERCOOLING
Cooling system
1. Thermostat
• Thermostat stays open
EAS28620
POOR BRAKING PERFORMANCE
• Worn brake pad
• Worn brake disc
• Air in hydraulic brake system
• Leaking brake fluid
• Faulty brake caliper kit
9-3
TROUBLESHOOTING
• Faulty brake caliper seal
• Loose union bolt
• Damaged brake hose
• Oil or grease on the brake disc
• Oil or grease on the brake pad
• Incorrect brake fluid level
EAS28660
FAULTY FRONT FORK LEGS
Leaking oil
• Bent, damaged or rusty inner tube
• Cracked or damaged outer tube
• Improperly installed oil seal
• Damaged oil seal lip
• Incorrect oil level (high)
• Loose damper rod assembly bolt
• Damaged damper rod assembly bolt copper washer
• Cracked or damaged cap bolt O-ring
Malfunction
• Bent or damaged inner tube
• Bent or damaged outer tube
• Damaged fork spring
• Worn or damaged outer tube bushing
• Bent or damaged damper rod
• Incorrect oil viscosity
• Incorrect oil level
EAS28670
UNSTABLE HANDLING
1. Handlebar
• Bent or improperly installed handlebar
2. Steering head components
• Improperly installed upper bracket
• Improperly installed lower bracket
(improperly tightened ring nut)
• Bent steering stem
• Damaged ball bearing or bearing race
3. Front fork leg(s)
• Uneven oil levels (both front fork legs)
• Unevenly tensioned fork spring (both front fork legs)
• Broken fork spring
• Bent or damaged inner tube
• Bent or damaged outer tube
4. Swingarm
• Worn bearing or bushing
• Bent or damaged swingarm
5. Rear shock absorber assembly(-ies)
• Faulty rear shock absorber spring
• Leaking oil or gas
6. Tire(s)
• Uneven tire pressures (front and rear)
• Incorrect tire pressure
• Uneven tire wear
7. Wheel(s)
• Incorrect wheel balance
• Deformed cast wheel
• Damaged wheel bearing
• Bent or loose wheel axle
• Excessive wheel runout
8. Frame
• Bent frame
• Damaged steering head pipe
• Improperly installed bearing race
EAS28710
FAULTY LIGHTING OR SIGNALING SYS-
TEM
Headlight does not come on
• Wrong headlight bulb
• Too many electrical accessories
• Hard charging
• Incorrect connection
• Improperly grounded circuit
• Poor contacts (main or light switch)
• Burnt-out headlight bulb
Headlight bulb burnt out
• Wrong headlight bulb
• Faulty battery
• Faulty rectifier/regulator
• Improperly grounded circuit
• Faulty main switch
• Faulty light switch
• Headlight bulb life expired
Tail/brake light does not come on
• Wrong tail/brake light bulb
• Too many electrical accessories
• Incorrect connection
• Burnt-out tail/brake light bulb
Tail/brake light bulb burnt out
• Wrong tail/brake light bulb
• Faulty battery
• Incorrectly adjusted rear brake light switch
• Tail/brake light bulb life expired
Turn signal does not come on
• Faulty turn signal switch
• Faulty turn signal relay
• Burnt-out turn signal bulb
• Incorrect connection
• Damaged or faulty wire harness
TROUBLESHOOTING
• Improperly grounded circuit
• Faulty battery
• Blown, damaged or incorrect fuse
Turn signal blinks slowly
• Faulty turn signal relay
• Faulty main switch
• Faulty turn signal switch
• Incorrect turn signal bulb
Turn signal remains lit
• Faulty turn signal relay
• Burnt-out turn signal bulb
Turn signal blinks quickly
• Incorrect turn signal bulb
• Faulty turn signal relay
• Burnt-out turn signal bulb
Horn does not sound
• Improperly adjusted horn
• Damaged or faulty horn
• Faulty main switch
• Faulty horn switch
• Faulty battery
• Blown, damaged or incorrect fuse
• Faulty wire harness
9-4
EAS28740
WIRING DIAGRAM
FZ1-N (V) 2006
1. Main switch
2. Rectifier/regulator
3. A.C.magneto
4. Fuse (backup)
5. Immobilizer unit
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
8. Fuse (fuel injection)
9. Starter relay
10. Starter motor
11. Relay unit
12. Starting circuit cut-off relay
13. Fuel pump relay
14. Neutral switch
15. Sidestand switch
16. Fuel pump
17. Crankshaft position sensor
18. Cylinder identification sensor
19. Speed sensor
20. Atmospheric pressure sensor
21. Lean angle sensor
22. O2 sensor
23. E.C.U.
24. Ignition coil #1
25. Ignition coil #2
26. Ignition coil #3
27. Ignition coil #4
28. Spark plug
29. Injector #1
30. Injector #2
31. Injector #3
32. Injector #4
33. Air induction system solenoid
34. Sub-throttle position sensor
35. EXUP servo motor
36. Intake air pressure sensor
37. Throttle position sensor
38. Coolant temperature sensor
39. Air temperature sensor
40. Meter assembly
41. Immobilizer indicator light
42. Fuel level warning light
43. Oil level warning light
44. Neutral indicator light
45. Tacho meter
46. Multi function meter
47. Engine trouble warning light
48. Coolant temperature indicator light
49. Hi beam indicator light
50. Turn signal indicator light (left)
51. Turn signal indicator light
(right)
52. Meter light
53. Oil level switch
54. Right handlebar switch
55. Front brake light switch
56. Engine stop switch
57. Start switch
58. Rear brake light switch
59. Left handlebar switch
60. Clutch switch
61. Pass switch
62. Dimmer switch
63. Hazard switch
64. Turn signal switch
65. Horn switch
66. Horn
67. Turn signal relay
68. Front turn signal light (left)
69. Front turn signal light (right)
70. Rear turn signal light (left)
71. Rear turn signal light (right)
72. Auxiliary light
73. Headlight
74. License plate light
75. Tail/brake light
76. Headlight relay (on/off)
77. Fuse (tail light)
78. Fuse (ingition)
79. Anti safety alarm (option)
80. Fuse (signal)
81. Fuse (headlight)
82. Radiator fan motor relay
83. Fuse (radiator fan motor left)
84. Fuse (radiator fan motor right)
85. Radiator fan motor (left)
86. Radiator fan motor (right)
87. Ground
EAS28750
COLOR CODE
Lg
O
P
R
Sb
W
Y
B/G
B
Br
Ch
Dg
G
Gy
L
B/L
B/R
B/W
B/Y
Br/G
Br/L
Br/R
Black
Brown
Chocolate
Dark green
Green
Gray
Blue
Light green
Orange
Pink
Red
Sky blue
White
Yellow
Black/Green
Black/Blue
Black/Red
Black/White
Black/Yellow
Brown/Green
Brown/Blue
Brown/Red
Brown/White
Brown/Yellow
Green/Black
Green/Red
Green/White
Green/Yellow
Gray/Green
Gray/Red
Blue/Black
Blue/Red
Blue/White
Blue/Yellow
Orange/Black
Orange/Green
Orange/Yellow
Pink/Black
Pink/White
Red/Black
Red/Green
Red/Blue
Red/White
Red/Yellow
Sky blue/White
White/Black
White/Red
White/Yellow
Yellow/Black
Yellow/Green
Yellow/Blue
Yellow/Red
Yellow/White
W/R
W/Y
Y/B
Y/G
Y/L
Y/R
Y/W
P/W
R/B
R/G
R/L
R/W
R/Y
Sb/W
W/B
L/B
L/R
L/W
L/Y
O/B
O/G
O/Y
P/B
Br/W
Br/Y
G/B
G/R
G/W
G/Y
Gy/G
Gy/R
FZ1-S (V) 2006
1. Main switch
2. Rectifier/regulator
3. A.C.magneto
4. Fuse (backup)
5. Immobilizer unit
6. Fuse (main)
7. Battery
8. Fuse (fuel injection)
9. Starter relay
10. Starter motor
11. Relay unit
12. Starting circuit cut-off relay
13. Fuel pump relay
14. Neutral switch
15. Sidestand switch
16. Fuel pump
17. Crankshaft position sensor
18. Cylinder identification sensor
19. Speed sensor
20. Atmospheric pressure sensor
21. Lean angle sensor
22. O2 sensor
23. E.C.U.
24. Ignition coil #1
25. Ignition coil #2
26. Ignition coil #3
27. Ignition coil #4
28. Spark plug
29. Injector #1
30. Injector #2
31. Injector #3
32. Injector #4
33. Air induction system solenoid
34. Sub-throttle position sensor
35. EXUP servo motor
36. Intake air pressure sensor
37. Throttle position sensor
38. Coolant temperature sensor
39. Air temperature sensor
40. Meter assembly
41. Immobilizer indicator light
42. Fuel level warning light
43. Oil level warning light
44. Neutral indicator light
45. Tacho meter
46. Multi function meter
47. Engine trouble warning light
48. Coolant temperature indicator light
49. Hi beam indicator light
50. Turn signal indicator light (left)
51. Turn signal indicator light
(right)
52. Meter light
53. Oil level switch
54. Right handlebar switch
55. Front brake light switch
56. Engine stop switch
57. Start switch
58. Rear brake light switch
59. Left handlebar switch
60. Clutch switch
61. Pass switch
62. Dimmer switch
63. Hazard switch
64. Turn signal switch
65. Horn switch
66. Horn
67. Turn signal relay
68. Front turn signal light (left)
69. Front turn signal light (right)
70. Rear turn signal light (left)
71. Rear turn signal light (right)
72. Auxiliary light
73. Headlight
74. License plate light
75. Tail/brake light
76. Headlight relay (on/off)
77. Headlight relay (dimmer)
78. Fuse (tail light)
79. Fuse (ingition)
80. Anti safety alarm (option)
81. Fuse (signal)
82. Fuse (headlight)
83. Radiator fan motor relay
84. Fuse (radiator fan motor left)
85. Fuse (radiator fan motor right)
86. Radiator fan motor (left)
87. Radiator fan motor (right)
88. Ground
EAS28750
COLOR CODE
Y
B/G
B/L
B/R
B/W
B/Y
Br/G
Br/L
Br/R
Br/W
Br/Y
P
R
Sb
W
Gy
L
Lg
O
B
Br
Ch
Dg
G
Black
Brown
Chocolate
Dark green
Green
Gray
Blue
Light green
Orange
Pink
Red
Sky blue
White
Yellow
Black/Green
Black/Blue
Black/Red
Black/White
Black/Yellow
Brown/Green
Brown/Blue
Brown/Red
Brown/White
Brown/Yellow
Green/Black
Green/Red
Green/White
Green/Yellow
Gray/Green
Gray/Red
Blue/Black
Blue/Red
Blue/White
Blue/Yellow
Orange/Black
Orange/Green
Orange/Yellow
Pink/Black
Pink/White
Red/Black
Red/Green
Red/Blue
Red/White
Red/Yellow
Sky blue/White
White/Black
White/Red
White/Yellow
Yellow/Black
Yellow/Green
Yellow/Blue
Yellow/Red
Yellow/White
R/G
R/L
R/W
R/Y
Sb/W
W/B
W/R
W/Y
Y/B
Y/G
Y/L
Y/R
Y/W
L/W
L/Y
O/B
O/G
O/Y
P/B
P/W
R/B
G/B
G/R
G/W
G/Y
Gy/G
Gy/R
L/B
L/R
YAMAHA MOTOR CO., LTD.
2500 SHINGAI IWATA SHIZUOKA JAPAN
FZ1-N (V) 2006
WIRING DIAGRAM
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHEMA DE CABLAGE
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHALTPLAN
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHEMA ELETTRICO
DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES
DE FZ1-N (V) 2006
FZ1-S (V) 2006
WIRING DIAGRAM
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHEMA DE CABLAGE
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHALTPLAN
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHEMA ELETTRICO
DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES
DE FZ1-S (V) 2006
FZ1-N (V) 2006
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
ON
OFF
P
81
80
82
77
78
79
75
76
2
3
4
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHEMA DE CABLAGE
5
6
85
7
10
8
9
74
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHALTPLAN
C
11
B
WIRE HARNESS
HEADLIGHT
SUB-WIRE HARNESS
WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHEMA ELETTRICO
A
WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1
12
13
14
56
52
53
54
OFF
RUN
55
FREE
PUSH
57
58
OFF
ON
59 60
HI
LO
OFF
ON
61
62
L
N
R
OFF
ON
63
65
64
51
Ch
Dg
38
40
41
42
43
39
44
47
48
45
46
49
50
50
16
18
19
17
15
37
36
35
20
34
83 84
73
72
70 70
71
66 67
Dg
B
B
Dg
68 69
21
DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES
DE FZ1-N (V) 2006
29
30
31
26
27
22
26
23
26
24
26
25
28
33
32
FZ1-S (V) 2006
WIRING DIAGRAM
1
ON
OFF
P
82
81
83
79
80
78
76
77
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHEMA DE CABLAGE
5
D
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHALTPLAN
C B
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHEMA ELETTRICO
WIRE HARNESS
HEADLIGHT
SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2
WIRE HARNESS HEADLIGHT SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2
A
WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1
4
6
2
3
86
7
10
8
9
11
12
13 14
16
18
17
19
15
52
53
54
OFF
RUN
55
FREE
PUSH
74
75
56
B B
57
58
59
OFF
ON
60
HI
LO
61
ON
OFF
62
R
N
L
63
OFF
ON
65
64
51
38
40
41
42
43
39
44
50
50
48
49
45
46
47
37
36
35
34
20
84 85
66 67 68 69
70 71 71 70
73
72
21
DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES
DE FZ1-S (V) 2006
29
30
31
26
27
22
26
23
26
24
26
25
28
33
32
FZ1-N (V) 2006
WIRING DIAGRAM
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHEMA DE CABLAGE
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHALTPLAN
FZ1-N (V) 2006
SCHEMA ELETTRICO
DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES
DE FZ1-N (V) 2006
FZ1-S (V) 2006
WIRING DIAGRAM
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHEMA DE CABLAGE
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHALTPLAN
C B
FZ1-S (V) 2006
SCHEMA ELETTRICO
A D
WIRE HARNESS
HEADLIGHT
SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2
WIRE HARNESS HEADLIGHT SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 2 WIRE HARNESS SUB-WIRE HARNESS 1
DIAGRAMA DE CONEXIONES
DE FZ1-S (V) 2006
ON
OFF
P
B B
OFF
RUN
FREE
PUSH
OFF
ON
HI
LO
ON
OFF
R
N
L
OFF
ON
- Manuals
- Brands
- Yamaha Manuals
- Motorcycle
- 2006 FZ1-S
Manuals and User Guides for Yamaha 2006 FZ1-S. We have 1 Yamaha 2006 FZ1-S manual available for free PDF download: Service Manual
Руководство по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ1-N и FZ1-NA.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2010
- Страниц: 104
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 3,7 Mb
Руководство по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ1-S и FZ1-SA.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2010
- Страниц: 106
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 4,3 Mb
Руководство по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha FZ6-S Fazer.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2002
- Страниц: 104
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 2,8 Mb
Руководство по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ8-S и FZ8-SA Fazer.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2010
- Страниц: 101
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 4,1 Mb
Руководство по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha FZ8-N.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2010
- Страниц: 97
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 3,7 Mb
Сборник руководств на английском языке по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ1-N, FZ1-NA, FZ1-S и FZ1-SA Fazer.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2005-2011
- Страниц: —
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 27,6 Mb
Сборник руководств на английском языке по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha FZ6 Fazer различных моделей.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2003-2011
- Страниц: —
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 46,7 Mb
Сборник руководств на английском языке по эксплуатации и техническому обслуживанию мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ8-N, FZ8-NA, FZ8-NAC, FZ8-S, FZ8-SA Fazer.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2010-2012
- Страниц: —
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 13,0 Mb
Руководство на английском языке по техническому обслуживанию и ремонту мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FJ600, FZ600, XJ600 и YX600 Radian.
- Издательство: Haynes Publishing
- Год издания: —
- Страниц: 200
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 89,6 Mb
Сборник руководств на английском языке по ремонту мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ1-N, FZ1-NA, FZ1-NV, FZ1-NX, FZ1-S, FZ1-SA, FZ1-SV, FZ1-SX Fazer 2006-2008 годов выпуска.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2005/2008
- Страниц: 451/546
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 45,5 Mb
Руководство на английском языке по ремонту мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ6RY и FZ6RYC 2009 года выпуска.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2008
- Страниц: 420
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 19,4 Mb
Руководство на английском языке по ремонту мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ6-SS и FZ6-SSC.
- Издательство: Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
- Год издания: 2003
- Страниц: 432
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 13,1 Mb
Сборник руководств на английском, французском, немецком, испанском и итальянском языках по ремонту мотоциклов Yamaha моделей FZ-6N, FZ-6S и др.
- Издательство: Yamaha
- Год издания: —
- Страниц: —
- Формат: ISO
- Размер: 1,7 Gb
Руководство на немецком языке по техническому обслуживанию и ремонту мотоциклов Yamaha FZ750 с 1984 года выпуска.
- Издательство: —
- Год издания: —
- Страниц: 98
- Формат: PDF
- Размер: 4,4 Mb
OWNER’S MANUAL
FZS10W
FZS10WC
LIT-11626-20-54 |
3C3-28199-11 |
EAU10041
INTRODUCTION
EAU10080
Congratulations on your purchase of the Yamaha FZS10W/FZS10WC. This model is the result of Yamaha’s vast experience in the production of fine sporting, touring, and pacesetting racing machines. It represents the high degree of craftsmanship and reliability that have made Yamaha a leader in these fields.
This manual will give you an understanding of the operation, inspection, and basic maintenance of this motorcycle. If you have any questions concerning the operation or maintenance of your motorcycle, please consult a Yamaha dealer.
The design and manufacture of this Yamaha motorcycle fully comply with the emissions standards for clean air applicable at the date of manufacture. Yamaha has met these standards without reducing the performance or economy of operation of the motorcycle. To maintain these high standards, it is important that you and your Yamaha dealer pay close attention to the recommended maintenance schedules and operating instructions contained within this manual.
IMPORTANT MANUAL INFORMATION
EAU10131
Particularly important information is distinguished in this manual by the following notations:
The Safety Alert Symbol means ATTENTION! BECOME ALERT! YOUR SAFETY IS
INVOLVED!
Failure to follow WARNING instructions could result in severe injury or death to the |
||||
WARNING |
motorcycle operator, a bystander or a person inspecting or repairing the motor- |
|||
cycle. |
||||
A CAUTION indicates special precautions that must be taken to avoid damage to |
||||
CAUTION: |
||||
the motorcycle. |
||||
NOTE: |
A NOTE provides key information to make procedures easier or clearer. |
|||
NOTE:
●This manual should be considered a permanent part of this motorcycle and should remain with it even if the motorcycle is subsequently sold.
●Yamaha continually seeks advancements in product design and quality. Therefore, while this manual contains the most current product information available at the time of printing, there may be minor discrepancies between your motorcycle and this manual. If you have any questions concerning this manual, please consult your Yamaha dealer.
EWA10010
WARNING
PLEASE READ THIS MANUAL AND THE “YOU AND YOUR MOTORCYCLE: RIDING TIPS” BOOKLET CAREFULLY AND COMPLETELY BEFORE OPERATING THIS MOTORCYCLE. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO OPERATE THIS MOTORCYCLE UNTIL YOU HAVE ATTAINED ADEQUATE KNOWLEDGE OF ITS CONTROLS AND OPERATING FEATURES
IMPORTANT MANUAL INFORMATION
AND UNTIL YOU HAVE BEEN TRAINED IN SAFE AND PROPER RIDING TECHNIQUES. REGULAR INSPECTIONS AND CAREFUL MAINTENANCE, ALONG WITH GOOD RIDING SKILLS, WILL ENSURE THAT YOU SAFELY ENJOY THE CAPABILITIES AND THE RELIABILITY OF THIS MOTORCYCLE.
*Product and specifications are subject to change without notice.
IMPORTANT MANUAL INFORMATION
EAU10192
AFFIX DEALER
LABEL HERE
FZS10W/FZS10WC
OWNER’S MANUAL
©2006 by Yamaha Motor Corporation, U.S.A. 1st edition, September 2006
All rights reserved.
Any reprinting or unauthorized use without the written permission of Yamaha Motor Corporation, U.S.A. is expressly prohibited.
Printed in Japan.
P/N LIT-11626-20-54
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SAFETY INFORMATION ……………… |
1-1 |
Location of important labels ……….. |
1-5 |
DESCRIPTION ……………………………. |
2-1 |
Left view …………………………………… |
2-1 |
Right view …………………………………. |
2-2 |
Controls and instruments ……………. |
2-3 |
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL |
|
FUNCTIONS ………………………………… |
3-1 |
Main switch/steering lock ……………. |
3-1 |
Indicator and warning lights ………… |
3-2 |
Multi-function meter unit …………….. |
3-4 |
Handlebar switches …………………… |
3-8 |
Clutch lever ……………………………… |
3-9 |
Shift pedal ……………………………….. |
3-9 |
Brake lever …………………………….. |
3-10 |
Brake pedal ……………………………. |
3-10 |
Fuel tank cap ………………………….. |
3-10 |
Fuel ………………………………………. |
3-11 |
Catalytic converter …………………… |
3-12 |
Seats …………………………………….. |
3-12 |
Storage compartment ………………. |
3-14 |
Adjusting the front fork …………….. |
3-14 |
Adjusting the shock absorber |
|
assembly …………………………….. |
3-16 |
Luggage strap holders ……………… |
3-18 |
EXUP system …………………………. |
3-18 |
Sidestand ………………………………. |
3-18 |
Ignition circuit cut-off system …….. |
3-19 |
PRE-OPERATION CHECKS …………. |
4-1 |
Pre-operation check list …………….. |
4-2 |
OPERATION AND IMPORTANT |
|
RIDING POINTS ………………………….. |
5-1 |
Starting the engine ……………………. |
5-1 |
Shifting ……………………………………. |
5-2 |
Engine break-in ………………………… |
5-4 |
Parking ……………………………………. |
5-4 |
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND |
|
MINOR REPAIR…………………………… |
6-1 |
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE ………. |
6-1 |
Owner’s tool kit ………………………… |
6-1 |
Periodic maintenance chart for the |
|
emission control system …………. |
6-3 |
General maintenance and |
|
lubrication chart …………………….. |
6-4 |
Removing and installing panels ….. |
6-8 |
Checking the spark plugs ………….. |
6-9 |
Canister (for California only) …….. |
6-10 |
Engine oil and oil filter cartridge … |
6-10 |
Coolant …………………………………. |
6-13 |
Replacing the air filter element …. |
6-15 |
Checking the throttle cable free |
|
play ……………………………………. |
6-17 |
Valve clearance ……………………… |
6-17 |
Tires ……………………………………… |
6-17 |
Cast wheels …………………………… |
6-20 |
Accessories and replacement |
|
parts ………………………………….. |
6-20 |
Adjusting the clutch lever free |
|
play ……………………………………. |
6-21 |
Adjusting the rear brake light |
|
switch …………………………………. |
6-22 |
Checking the front and rear |
|
brake pads ………………………….. |
6-22 |
Checking the brake fluid level …… |
6-23 |
Changing the brake fluid ………….. |
6-24 |
Drive chain slack …………………….. |
6-24 |
Cleaning and lubricating the |
|
drive chain ………………………….. |
6-25 |
Checking and lubricating the |
|
cables ………………………………… |
6-26 |
Checking and lubricating the |
|
throttle grip and cable …………… |
6-26 |
Checking and lubricating the |
|
brake and shift pedals …………… |
6-27 |
Checking and lubricating the |
|
brake and clutch levers …………. |
6-27 |
Checking and lubricating the |
|
centerstand and sidestand …….. |
6-28 |
Checking the front fork …………….. |
6-28 |
Checking the steering ……………… |
6-29 |
Checking the wheel bearings ……. |
6-30 |
Battery …………………………………… |
6-30 |
Replacing the fuses …………………. |
6-31 |
Replacing a headlight bulb ……….. |
6-33 |
Replacing the tail/brake light |
|
bulb ……………………………………. |
6-34 |
Replacing a turn signal light |
|
bulb ……………………………………. |
6-35 |
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Replacing the license plate light |
|
bulb ……………………………………. |
6-36 |
Front wheel …………………………….. |
6-36 |
Rear wheel …………………………….. |
6-38 |
Troubleshooting ………………………. |
6-39 |
Troubleshooting charts …………….. |
6-40 |
MOTORCYCLE CARE AND |
|
STORAGE …………………………………… |
7-1 |
Matte color caution ……………………. |
7-1 |
Care ………………………………………… |
7-1 |
Storage ……………………………………. |
7-3 |
SPECIFICATIONS ……………………….. |
8-1 |
CONSUMER INFORMATION…………. |
9-1 |
Identification numbers ……………….. |
9-1 |
Reporting safety defects …………….. |
9-3 |
Motorcycle noise regulation ………… |
9-4 |
Maintenance record …………………… |
9-5 |
YAMAHA MOTOR CORPORATION, |
|
U.S.A. STREET AND ENDURO |
|
MOTORCYCLE LIMITED |
|
WARRANTY ………………………….. |
9-7 |
YAMAHA EXTENDED SERVICE |
|
(Y.E.S.) …………………………………. |
9-9 |
SAFETY INFORMATION
EAU10281
MOTORCYCLES ARE SINGLE TRACK VEHICLES. THEIR SAFE USE AND OPERATION ARE DEPENDENT UPON THE USE OF PROPER RIDING TECHNIQUES AS WELL AS THE EXPERTISE OF THE OPERATOR. EVERY OPERATOR SHOULD KNOW THE FOLLOWING REQUIREMENTS BEFORE RIDING THIS MOTORCYCLE.
HE OR SHE SHOULD:
●OBTAIN THOROUGH INSTRUCTIONS FROM A COMPETENT SOURCE ON ALL ASPECTS OF MOTORCYCLE OPERATION.
●OBSERVE THE WARNINGS AND MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS IN THE OWNER’S MANUAL.
●OBTAIN QUALIFIED TRAINING IN SAFE AND PROPER RIDING TECHNIQUES.
●OBTAIN PROFESSIONAL TECHNICAL SERVICE AS INDICATED BY THE OWNER’S MANUAL
AND/OR WHEN MADE NECESSARY BY MECHANICAL CONDITIONS.
Safe riding
●Always make pre-operation checks. Careful checks may help prevent an accident.
●This motorcycle is designed to carry the operator and a passenger.
●The failure of motorists to detect and recognize motorcycles in traffic is the predominating cause of automobile/motorcycle accidents. Many accidents have been caused by an automobile driver who did not see the motorcycle. Making yourself conspicuous appears to be very effective in reducing the chance of this type of accident.
Therefore:
•Wear a brightly colored jacket.
•Use extra caution when you are approaching and passing through intersections, since intersections are the most likely places for motorcycle accidents to occur.
•Ride where other motorists can see you. Avoid riding in another motorist’s blind spot.
● Many accidents involve inexperi- 1 enced operators. In fact, many operators who have been involved in accidents do not even have a current motorcycle license.
•Make sure that you are qualified and that you only lend your motorcycle to other qualified operators.
•Know your skills and limits. Staying within your limits may help you to avoid an accident.
•We recommend that you practice riding your motorcycle where there is no traffic until you have become thoroughly familiar with the motorcycle and all of its controls.
●Many accidents have been caused by error of the motorcycle operator. A typical error made by the operator is veering wide on a turn
1-1
SAFETY INFORMATION
due to EXCESSIVE SPEED or undercornering (insufficient lean angle for the speed).
1• Always obey the speed limit and never travel faster than warranted by road and traffic conditions.
•Always signal before turning or changing lanes. Make sure that other motorists can see you.
●The posture of the operator and passenger is important for proper control.
•The operator should keep both hands on the handlebar and both feet on the operator footrests during operation to maintain control of the motorcycle.
•The passenger should always hold onto the operator, the seat strap or grab bar, if equipped, with both hands and keep both feet on the passenger footrests.
•Never carry a passenger unless he or she can firmly place both feet on the passenger footrests.
●Never ride under the influence of alcohol or other drugs.
●This motorcycle is designed for onroad use only. It is not suitable for off-road use.
Protective apparel
The majority of fatalities from motorcycle accidents are the result of head injuries. The use of a safety helmet is the single most critical factor in the prevention or reduction of head injuries.
●Always wear an approved helmet.
●Wear a face shield or goggles. Wind in your unprotected eyes could contribute to an impairment of vision that could delay seeing a hazard.
●The use of a jacket, heavy boots, trousers, gloves, etc., is effective in preventing or reducing abrasions or lacerations.
●Never wear loose-fitting clothes, otherwise they could catch on the control levers, footrests, or wheels and cause injury or an accident.
●Never touch the engine or exhaust system during or after operation. They become very hot and can
cause burns. Always wear protective clothing that covers your legs, ankles, and feet.
●A passenger should also observe the above precautions.
Modifications
Modifications made to this motorcycle not approved by Yamaha, or the removal of original equipment, may render the motorcycle unsafe for use and may cause severe personal injury. Modifications may also make your motorcycle illegal to use.
Loading and accessories
Adding accessories or cargo to your motorcycle can adversely affect stability and handling if the weight distribution of the motorcycle is changed. To avoid the possibility of an accident, use extreme caution when adding cargo or accessories to your motorcycle. Use extra care when riding a motorcycle that has added cargo or accessories. Here are some general guidelines to follow if loading cargo or adding accessories to your motorcycle:
1-2
SAFETY INFORMATION
Loading
The total weight of the operator, passenger, accessories and cargo must not exceed the maximum load limit.
Maximum load:
189 kg (417 lb) (CAL)
190 kg (419 lb) (U49)
When loading within this weight limit, keep the following in mind:
●Cargo and accessory weight should be kept as low and close to the motorcycle as possible. Make sure to distribute the weight as evenly as possible on both sides of the motorcycle to minimize imbalance or instability.
●Shifting weights can create a sudden imbalance. Make sure that accessories and cargo are securely attached to the motorcycle before riding. Check accessory mounts and cargo restraints frequently.
●Never attach any large or heavy items to the handlebar, front fork, or front fender. These items, including such cargo as sleeping
bags, duffel bags, or tents, can create unstable handling or a slow steering response.
Accessories
Genuine Yamaha accessories have been specifically designed for use on this motorcycle. Since Yamaha cannot test all other accessories that may be available, you must personally be responsible for the proper selection, installation and use of non-Yamaha accessories. Use extreme caution when selecting and installing any accessories.
Keep the following guidelines in mind, as well as those provided under “Loading” when mounting accessories.
●Never install accessories or carry cargo that would impair the performance of your motorcycle. Carefully inspect the accessory before using it to make sure that it does not in any way reduce ground clearance or cornering clearance,
limit suspension travel, steering travel or control operation, or obscure lights or reflectors.
• Accessories fitted to the handle- 1 bar or the front fork area can create instability due to improper weight distribution or aerodynamic changes. If accessories
are added to the handlebar or front fork area, they must be as lightweight as possible and should be kept to a minimum.
•Bulky or large accessories may seriously affect the stability of the motorcycle due to aerodynamic effects. Wind may attempt to lift the motorcycle, or the motorcycle may become unstable in cross winds. These accessories may also cause instability when passing or being passed by large vehicles.
•Certain accessories can displace the operator from his or her normal riding position. This improper position limits the freedom of movement of the opera-
1-3
SAFETY INFORMATION
tor and may limit control ability, therefore, such accessories are not recommended.
1 ● Use caution when adding electrical accessories. If electrical accessories exceed the capacity of the motorcycle’s electrical system, an electric failure could result, which could cause a dangerous loss of lights or engine power.
Gasoline and exhaust gas
●GASOLINE IS HIGHLY FLAMMABLE:
•Always turn the engine off when refueling.
•Take care not to spill any gasoline on the engine or exhaust system when refueling.
•Never refuel while smoking or in the vicinity of an open flame.
●Never start the engine or let it run for any length of time in a closed area. The exhaust fumes are poisonous and may cause loss of consciousness and death within a short time. Always operate your motorcycle in an area that has adequate ventilation.
●Always turn the engine off before leaving the motorcycle unattended and remove the key from the main switch. When parking the motorcycle, note the following:
•The engine and exhaust system may be hot, therefore, park the motorcycle in a place where pedestrians or children are not likely to touch these hot areas.
•Do not park the motorcycle on a slope or soft ground, otherwise it may fall over.
•Do not park the motorcycle near a flammable source, (e.g., a kerosene heater, or near an open flame), otherwise it could catch fire.
●When transporting the motorcycle in another vehicle, make sure that it is kept upright. If the motorcycle should lean over, gasoline may leak out of the fuel tank.
●If you should swallow any gasoline, inhale a lot of gasoline vapor, or allow gasoline to get into your eyes, see your doctor immediately. If any gasoline spills on your skin
or clothing, immediately wash the affected area with soap and water and change your clothes.
1-4
SAFETY INFORMATION
EAU10381
Location of important labels
Please read the following important labels carefully before operating this vehicle.
1
1-5
SAFETY INFORMATION
1 |
CAUTION |
4 |
|||||||||||
1 |
|||||||||||||
Cleaning with |
alkaline |
or |
|||||||||||
acid |
cleaner, |
gasoline |
or |
||||||||||
solvent will |
damage |
||||||||||||
windshield. |
|||||||||||||
Use |
neutral |
detergent. |
|||||||||||
2 California only
6
3 |
7 |
|||
1-6
DESCRIPTION
EAU10410
Left view
2
1.Front fork spring preload adjusting bolt (page 3-14)
2.Front fork compression damping force adjusting screw (page 3-14)
3.Air filter element (page 6-15)
4.Main fuse (page 6-31)
5.Fuel injection system fuse (page 6-31)
6.Storage compartment (page 3-14)
7.Passenger seat lock (page 3-12)
8.Shock absorber assembly spring preload adjusting ring (page 3-16)
9.Shock absorber assembly rebound damping force adjusting screw (page 3-16)
10.Shift pedal (page 3-9) 11.Engine oil drain bolt (page 6-10)
12.Engine oil filter cartridge (page 6-10)
2-1
DESCRIPTION
EAU10420
Right view
2
1. |
Owner’s tool kit (page 6-1) |
9. Engine oil level check window (page 6-10) |
2. |
Rider seat lock lever (page 3-12) |
10.Brake pedal (page 3-10) |
3. |
Fuse box (page 6-31) |
11.Coolant reservoir (page 6-13) |
4. |
Battery (page 6-30) |
12.Luggage strap holder (page 3-18) |
5.Rear brake fluid reservoir (page 6-23)
6.Engine oil filler cap (page 6-10)
7.Front brake fluid reservoir (page 6-23)
8.Front fork rebound damping force adjusting screw (page 3-14)
2-2
DESCRIPTION
EAU10430
Controls and instruments
2
1.Clutch lever (page 3-9)
2.Left handlebar switches (page 3-8)
3.Main switch/steering lock (page 3-1)
4.Multi-function meter unit (page 3-4)
5.Right handlebar switches (page 3-8)
6.Throttle grip (page 6-17)
7.Brake lever (page 3-10)
2-3
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
EAU10460 |
EAU10660 |
Main switch/steering lock |
OFF |
All electrical systems are off. The key |
|||
can be removed. |
|||
EAU10680 |
|||
LOCK |
|||
The steering is locked, and all electrical |
|||
systems are off. The key can be re- |
|||
3 |
|||
moved. |
|||
To lock the steering |
|||
The main switch/steering lock controls the ignition and lighting systems, and is used to lock the steering. The various positions are described below.
EAU26900
ON
All electrical circuits are supplied with power, and the meter lighting, taillight, license plate light and position lights come on, and the engine can be started. The key cannot be removed.
NOTE:
The headlights come on automatically when the engine is started and stay on until the key is turned to “OFF”, even if the engine stalls.
1.Push.
2.Turn.
1.Turn the handlebars all the way to the left.
2.Push the key in from the “OFF” position, and then turn it to “LOCK” while still pushing it.
3.Remove the key.
To unlock the steering
1.Push.
2.Turn.
Push the key in, and then turn it to “OFF” while still pushing it.
EWA10060
WARNING
Never turn the key to “OFF” or “LOCK” while the vehicle is moving, otherwise the electrical systems will be switched off, which may result in loss of control or an accident. Make sure that the vehicle is stopped before turning the key to “OFF” or “LOCK”.
3-1
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
EAU11003
Indicator and warning lights
1.Left turn signal indicator light “”
2.Right turn signal indicator light “”
3.Neutral indicator light “ ”
4.High beam indicator light “ ”
5.Engine trouble warning light “ ”
6.Oil level warning light “ ”
7.Coolant temperature warning light “ ”
EAU11030
Turn signal indicator lights “” and
“”
The corresponding indicator light flashes when the turn signal switch is pushed to the left or right.
EAU11060
Neutral indicator light “ ”
This indicator light comes on when the transmission is in the neutral position.
EAU11080
High beam indicator light “”
This indicator light comes on when the high beam of the headlight is switched on.
EAU11250
Oil level warning light “”
This warning light comes on when the engine oil level is low.
The electrical circuit of the warning light can be checked by turning the key to “ON”.
If the warning light does not come on for a few seconds, then go off, have a Yamaha dealer check the electrical circuit.
NOTE:
●Even if the oil level is sufficient, the warning light may flicker when riding on a slope or during sudden acceleration or deceleration, but this is not a malfunction.
●This model is also equipped with a self-diagnosis device for the oil level detection circuit. If the oil level detection circuit is defective, the following cycle will be repeated until the malfunction is corrected: The
oil level warning light will flash ten times, then go off for 2.5 seconds. If this occurs, have a Yamaha dealer check the vehicle.
EAU11423
Coolant temperature warning light
“ ”
This warning light comes on when the 3 engine overheats. When this occurs, stop the engine immediately and allow
the engine to cool.
The electrical circuit of the warning light can be checked by turning the key to “ON”.
If the warning light does not come on for a few seconds, then go off, have a Yamaha dealer check the electrical circuit.
ECA10020
CAUTION:
Do not operate the engine if it is overheated.
3-2
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
Coolant |
Display |
Conditions |
What to do |
|
temperature |
||||
Under 39 °C |
Message “Lo” is displayed. |
OK. Go ahead with riding. |
||
(Under 103 °F) |
||||
3 |
||||
40–116 °C |
Temperature is displayed. |
OK. Go ahead with riding. |
||
(104–242 °F) |
||||
Stop the vehicle and allow it to idle until |
||||
117–139 °C |
Temperature display flashes. |
the coolant temperature goes down. |
||
(243–283 °F) |
Warning light comes on. |
If the temperature does not go down, |
||
stop the engine. (See page 6-40.) |
||||
Above 140 °C |
Message “HI” flashes. |
Stop the engine and allow it to cool. |
||
(Above 284 °F) |
Warning light comes on. |
(See page 6-40.) |
3-3
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
EAU11530
Engine trouble warning light “ ”
This warning light comes on or flashes when an electrical circuit monitoring the engine is defective. When this occurs, have a Yamaha dealer check the selfdiagnosis system. (See page 3-4 for an explanation of the self-diagnosis device.)
The electrical circuit of the warning light can be checked by turning the key to “ON”. If the warning light does not come on for a few seconds, then go off, have a Yamaha dealer check the electrical circuit.
EAU40172
Multi-function meter unit
1.Coolant temperature display/air intake temperature display
2.Speedometer
3.Tachometer
4.Odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter
5.“SELECT” button
6.“RESET” button
7.Clock
8.Fuel meter
EWA12421
WARNING
Be sure to stop the vehicle before making any setting changes to the multi-function meter unit.
The multi-function meter unit is equipped with the following:
●a speedometer (which shows the riding speed)
●a tachometer (which shows engine speed)
●an odometer (which shows the total distance traveled)
●two tripmeters (which show the distance traveled since they were last set to zero)
●a fuel reserve tripmeter (which
shows the distance traveled since |
3 |
the left segment of the fuel meter |
|
started flashing) |
●a clock
●a fuel meter
●a coolant temperature display
●an air intake temperature display
●a self-diagnosis device
●an LCD and tachometer brightness control mode
NOTE:
●Be sure to turn the key to “ON” before using the “SELECT” and “RESET” buttons.
●To switch the speedometer and odometer/tripmeter displays between kilometers and miles, press the “SELECT” button for at least one second.
3-4
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
Tachometer |
Clock |
4. |
Push the “SELECT” button, and |
the minute digits will start flashing. |
|||
5. |
Push the “RESET” button to set |
||
the minutes. |
|||
6. |
Push the “SELECT” button and |
||
then release it to start the clock. |
Odometer and tripmeter modes
3
1.Tachometer
2.Tachometer red zone
The electric tachometer allows the rider to monitor the engine speed and keep it within the ideal power range.
When the key is turned to “ON”, the tachometer needle will sweep once across the r/min range and then return to zero r/min in order to test the electrical circuit.
ECA10031
CAUTION:
Do not operate the engine in the tachometer red zone.
Red zone: 12000 r/min and above
1.Clock
2.Speedometer
The clock displays when the key is turned to “ON”. In addition, the clock can be displayed for 10 seconds by pushing the “SELECT” button when the main switch is in the “OFF” or “LOCK” position.
To set the clock
1.Turn the key to “ON”.
2.Push the “SELECT” button and “RESET” button together for at least two seconds.
3.When the hour digits start flashing, push the “RESET” button to set the hours.
1. Odometer/tripmeter/fuel reserve tripmeter
Push the “SELECT” button to switch the display between the odometer mode “ODO” and the tripmeter modes “TRIP A” and “TRIP B” in the following order:
TRIP A → TRIP B → ODO → TRIP A When the fuel amount in the fuel tank decreases to 3.4 L (0.90 US gal) (0.75 Imp.gal), the left segment of the fuel meter will start flashing, and the odom-
3-5
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
eter display will automatically change to the fuel reserve tripmeter mode “F- TRIP” and start counting the distance traveled from that point. In that case, push the “SELECT” button to switch the display between the various tripmeter and odometer modes in the following order:
F-TRIP → TRIP A → TRIP B → ODO → F-TRIP
To reset a tripmeter, select it by pushing the “SELECT” button, and then push the “RESET” button for at least one second. If you do not reset the fuel reserve tripmeter manually, it will reset itself automatically and the display will return to the prior mode after refueling and traveling 5 km (3 mi).
Fuel meter
1. Fuel meter
The fuel meter indicates the amount of fuel in the fuel tank. The display segments of the fuel meter disappear towards “E” (Empty) as the fuel level decreases. When only one segment is left near “E”, refuel as soon as possible.
NOTE:
This fuel meter is equipped with a selfdiagnosis system. If the electrical circuit is defective, the following cycle will be repeated until the malfunction is corrected: “E” (Empty), “F” (Full) and symbol “” will flash eight times, then go off for approximately 3 seconds. If this occurs, have a Yamaha dealer check the electrical circuit.
Coolant temperature mode
3
1. Coolant temperature display
The coolant temperature display indicates the temperature of the coolant. Push the “RESET” button to switch the coolant temperature display to the air intake temperature display.
NOTE:
When the coolant temperature display is selected, “C” is displayed for one second, and then the coolant temperature is displayed.
ECA10020
CAUTION:
Do not operate the engine if it is overheated.
3-6
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
Air intake temperature mode |
● When the air intake temperature |
display is selected, “A” is displayed |
|
for one second, and then the air in- |
|
take temperature is displayed. |
|
Self-diagnosis device |
3
1. Air intake temperature display
The air intake temperature display indicates the temperature of the air drawn into the air filter case. Push the “RESET” button to switch the coolant temperature display to the air intake temperature display.
NOTE:
●Even if the air intake temperature is set to be displayed, the coolant temperature warning light comes on when the engine overheats.
●When the key is turned to “ON”, the coolant temperature is automatically displayed, even if the air intake temperature was displayed prior to turning the key to “OFF”.
1. Error code display
This model is equipped with a self-diag- nosis device for various electrical circuits.
If any of those circuits are defective, the engine trouble warning light will come on, and then the display will indicate a two-digit error code.
If the display indicates any error codes, note the code number, and then have a Yamaha dealer check the vehicle.
ECA11590
CAUTION:
If the display indicates an error code, the vehicle should be checked as soon as possible in order to avoid engine damage.
LCD and tachometer brightness control mode
1.Tachometer panel
2.Tachometer needle
3.LCD
4.Brightness level
This function allows you to adjust the brightness of the LCD and the tachometer panel and needle to suit the outside lighting conditions.
3-7
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
To set the brightness
1.Turn the key to “OFF”.
2.Push and hold the “SELECT” button.
3.Turn the key to “ON”, and then release the “SELECT” button after five seconds.
4.Push the “RESET” button to select the desired brightness level.
5.Push the “SELECT” button to confirm the selected brightness level. The display will return to the odometer or tripmeter mode.
Handlebar switches
Left
1.Dimmer switch “ / ”
2.Turn signal switch “/ ”
3.Horn switch “ ”
4.Hazard switch “ ”
Right
1.Engine stop switch “ /”
2.Start switch “”
EAU12347 |
/ |
” |
EAU12400 |
||||
Dimmer switch “ |
|||||||
Set this switch to “ ” for the high |
|||||||
beam and to “ |
” for the low beam. |
||||||
Turn signal switch “ |
/ |
EAU12460 |
|||||
” |
|||||||
To signal a right-hand turn, push this |
|||||||
switch to “ ”. To |
signal a left-hand |
||||||
3 |
|||||||
turn, push this switch to “ |
”. When re- |
||||||
leased, the switch returns to the center |
|||||||
position. To cancel the turn signal |
|||||||
lights, push the switch in after it has re- |
|||||||
turned to the center position. |
|||||||
Horn switch “ |
” |
EAU12500 |
|||||
Press this switch to sound the horn. |
|||||||
Engine stop switch “ |
/ |
EAU12660 |
|||||
” |
|||||||
Set this switch to “ ” before starting |
|||||||
the engine. Set this switch to “ ” to |
|||||||
stop the engine in case of an emergen- |
|||||||
cy, such as when the vehicle overturns |
|||||||
or when the throttle cable is stuck. |
|||||||
Start switch “ |
” |
EAU12710 |
|||||
Push this switch to crank the engine with the starter.
3-8
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
ECA10050
CAUTION:
See page 5-1 for starting instructions prior to starting the engine.
EAU41700
The engine trouble warning light will come on when the key is turned to “ON”
3and the start switch is pushed, but this does not indicate a malfunction.
EAU12764
Hazard switch “ ”
With the key in the “ON” position, turn this switch to “ ” to turn on the hazard lights (simultaneous flashing of all turn signal lights).
The hazard lights are used in case of an emergency or to warn other drivers when your vehicle is stopped where it might be a traffic hazard.
ECA10061
CAUTION:
Do not use the hazard lights for an extended length of time with the engine not running, otherwise the battery may discharge.
EAU12820
Clutch lever
1. Clutch lever
The clutch lever is located at the left handlebar grip. To disengage the clutch, pull the lever toward the handlebar grip. To engage the clutch, release the lever. The lever should be pulled rapidly and released slowly for smooth clutch operation.
The clutch lever is equipped with a clutch switch, which is part of the ignition circuit cut-off system. (See page 3-19.)
EAU12870
Shift pedal
1. Shift pedal
The shift pedal is located on the left side of the engine and is used in combination with the clutch lever when shifting the gears of the 6-speed con- stant-mesh transmission equipped on this motorcycle.
3-9
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
EAU26822 |
EAU12941 |
EAU13072 |
Brake lever |
Brake pedal |
Fuel tank cap |
The brake lever is located at the right handlebar grip. To apply the front brake, pull the lever toward the handlebar grip.
3
1.Brake lever
2.Brake lever position adjusting dial
3.“ ” mark
4.Distance between brake lever and handlebar grip
The brake lever is equipped with a position adjusting dial. To adjust the distance between the brake lever and the handlebar grip, turn the adjusting dial while holding the lever pushed away from the handlebar grip. Make sure that the appropriate setting on the adjusting dial is aligned with the “ ” mark on the brake lever.
1. Brake pedal
The brake pedal is on the right side of the motorcycle. To apply the rear brake, press down on the brake pedal.
1.Fuel tank cap lock cover
2.Unlock.
To open the fuel tank cap
Open the fuel tank cap lock cover, insert the key into the lock, and then turn it 1/4 turn clockwise. The lock will be released and the fuel tank cap can be opened.
To close the fuel tank cap
1.Push the fuel tank cap into position with the key inserted in the lock.
2.Turn the key counterclockwise to the original position, remove it, and then close the lock cover.
3-10
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
NOTE:
The fuel tank cap cannot be closed unless the key is in the lock. In addition, the key cannot be removed if the cap is not properly closed and locked.
EWA11090
WARNING
3Make sure that the fuel tank cap is properly closed before riding.
EAU13220
Fuel
1.Fuel tank filler tube
2.Fuel level
Make sure that there is sufficient fuel in the tank. When refueling, be sure to insert the pump nozzle into the fuel tank filler hole and to fill the tank to the bottom of the filler tube as shown.
EWA10880
WARNING
●Do not overfill the fuel tank, otherwise it may overflow when the fuel warms up and expands.
●Avoid spilling fuel on the hot engine.
ECA10070
CAUTION:
Immediately wipe off spilled fuel with a clean, dry, soft cloth, since fuel may deteriorate painted surfaces or plastic parts.
EAU13300
Recommended fuel:
UNLEADED GASOLINE ONLY
Fuel tank capacity:
18.0 L (4.76 US gal) (3.96 Imp.gal)
Fuel reserve amount:
3.4 L (0.90 US gal) (0.75 Imp.gal)
ECA11400
CAUTION:
Use only unleaded gasoline. The use of leaded gasoline will cause severe damage to internal engine parts, such as the valves and piston rings, as well as to the exhaust system.
Your Yamaha engine has been designed to use regular unleaded gasoline with a pump octane number [(R+M)/2] of 86 or higher, or a research octane number of 91 or higher. If
3-11
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
knocking (or pinging) occurs, use a |
EAU13441 |
|||||
Catalytic converter |
||||||
gasoline of a different brand or premi- |
||||||
This vehicle is equipped with catalytic |
||||||
um unleaded fuel. Use of unleaded fuel |
||||||
converters in the exhaust system. |
||||||
will extend spark plug life and reduce |
||||||
EWA10860 |
||||||
maintenance costs. |
||||||
WARNING |
||||||
Gasohol |
||||||
The exhaust system is hot after op- |
||||||
There are two types of gasohol: gaso- |
||||||
eration. Make sure that the exhaust |
||||||
hol containing ethanol and that contain- |
||||||
system has cooled down before do- |
||||||
ing methanol. Gasohol containing |
||||||
ing any maintenance work. |
||||||
ethanol can be used if the ethanol con- |
||||||
tent does not exceed 10%. Gasohol |
ECA10700 |
|||||
containing methanol is not recom- |
CAUTION: |
|||||
mended by Yamaha because it can |
The following precautions must be |
|||||
cause damage to the fuel system or ve- |
observed to prevent a fire hazard or |
|||||
hicle performance problems. |
other damages. |
|||||
● Use only unleaded gasoline. |
||||||
The use of leaded gasoline will |
||||||
cause unrepairable damage to |
||||||
the catalytic converter. |
||||||
● Never park the vehicle near pos- |
||||||
sible fire hazards such as grass |
||||||
or other materials that easily |
||||||
burn. |
||||||
● Do not allow the engine to idle |
||||||
too long. |
||||||
EAU39322
Seats
Passenger seat
To remove the passenger seat
1.Insert the key into the seat lock, and then turn it counterclockwise.
3
1.Passenger seat lock
2.Unlock.
2.Pull the passenger seat forward, and then lift it up.
To install the passenger seat
1.Place the passenger seat in the original position, and then push the rear of the seat down to lock it in place.
3-12
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
3
2. Remove the key.
Rider seat
To remove the rider seat
1.Remove the passenger seat.
2.Push the rider seat lock lever, located under the back of the rider seat, to the right as shown, and then pull the seat off.
NOTE:
Make sure that the seats are properly secured before riding.
1. Rider seat lock lever
To install the rider seat
1.Insert the projection on the front of the rider seat into the seat holder as shown, and then push the rear of the seat down to lock it in place.
1.Projection
2.Seat holder
2.Install the passenger seat.
3-13
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
EAU14461
Storage compartment
1. Storage compartment
The storage compartment is located under the passenger seat. (See page 3-12.)
EWA10961
WARNING
●Do not exceed the load limit of 3 kg (7 lb) for the storage compartment.
●Do not exceed the maximum load of 189 kg (417 lb) (CAL) 190 kg (419 lb) (U49) for the vehicle.
EAU39332
Adjusting the front fork
Each front fork leg is equipped with a spring preload adjusting bolt, the right front fork leg is equipped with a rebound damping force adjusting screw and the left front fork leg with a compression damping force adjusting screw.
EWA14670
WARNING
Always adjust the spring preload on both fork legs equally, otherwise poor handling and loss of stability may result.
Spring preload
To increase the spring preload and thereby harden the suspension, turn the adjusting bolt on each fork leg in direction (a). To decrease the spring preload and thereby soften the suspension, turn the adjusting bolt on each fork leg in direction (b).
Align the appropriate groove on the adjusting mechanism with the top of the front fork cap bolt.
1.Current setting
2.Front fork cap bolt
1. Spring preload adjusting bolt
3-14
INSTRUMENT AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS
Spring preload setting:
Minimum (soft): 8
Standard:
5.5
Maximum (hard): 0
3 Rebound damping force
NOTE:
Be sure to perform this adjustment on the right front fork leg.
Rebound damping setting:
Minimum (soft):
26 click(s) in direction (b)* Standard:
18 click(s) in direction (b)* Maximum (hard):
1 click(s) in direction (b)*
*With the adjusting screw fully turned in direction (a)
Compression damping force
1. Rebound damping force adjusting screw
The rebound damping force is adjusted on the right front fork leg only. To increase the rebound damping force and thereby harden the rebound damping, turn the adjusting screw in direction (a). To decrease the rebound damping force and thereby soften the rebound damping, turn the adjusting screw in direction (b).
1. Compression damping force adjusting screw
The compression damping force is adjusted on the left front fork leg only. To increase the compression damping
force and thereby harden the compression damping, turn the adjusting screw in direction (a). To decrease the compression damping force and thereby soften the compression damping, turn the adjusting screw in direction (b).
NOTE:
Be sure to perform this adjustment on the left front fork leg.
Compression damping setting:
Minimum (soft):
26 click(s) in direction (b)* Standard:
5 click(s) in direction (b)* Maximum (hard):
1 click(s) in direction (b)*
*With the adjusting screw fully turned in direction (a)
ECA10100
CAUTION:
Never attempt to turn an adjusting mechanism beyond the maximum or minimum settings.
3-15
Loading…
Manufacturer: YAMAHA, Model Year: 2006,
Model line: FZ1-N,
Model: YAMAHA FZ1-N 2006
Pages: 98, PDF Size: 4.72 MB
Page 1 of 98
Page 2 of 98
Page 3 of 98
Page 4 of 98
Page 5 of 98
Page 6 of 98
Page 7 of 98
Page 8 of 98
Page 9 of 98
Page 10 of 98
- Load next 10 pages
View, print and download for free: YAMAHA FZ1-N 2006 Owners Manual, 98 Pages, PDF Size: 4.72 MB. Search in YAMAHA FZ1-N 2006 Owners Manual online. CarManualsOnline.info is the largest online database of car user manuals. YAMAHA FZ1-N 2006 Owners Manual PDF Download.
All product names, logos, and brands are property of their respective owners.
Privacy Policy | About Us & Contact
Complete PDF version of the Service Manual for the Yamaha FZ1-S/N. A MUST for every Fazer owner.
Download: Immediately after payment!
OEM Original factory workshop manual.
Models covered by this manual: 2006-2007
Number of pages: 451 pages
Table of contents:
This PDF repair manual can be downloaded right after the payment process in complete, on the device of your choice. You will also receive the download link by email along with your receipt.
We do not offer printed manuals, for the following reasons:
- it is more eco-friendly to use a digital version
- your manual never gets dirty or greasy
- you can always choose to print the specific page(s) you need to work on your bike
- you receive your manual immediately after payment
- it is searchable
The Yamaha FZ1 is a naked motorcycle manufactured by Yamaha Motor Company in Japan.
Second generation (FZ1 Fazer 2006–2015)
The bike received a fully new model in 2006, which is currently branded as the FZ1 in the United States. In Europe and other markets, it was known as the FZ1-S Fazer, which is semi-faired, as well as the FZ1-N, which is naked (without a fairing). The key differences were a new chassis, suspension, bodywork, and a whole new engine. The former tubular steel frame was replaced by a cast aluminum diecast diamond-shaped frame with the engine as a stressed element, as well as a control-filled diecast swingarm. This brought the bike up to speed with its current competitors.
The new model has a 150 horsepower 998 cc (60.9 cu in) 20-valve DOHC engine modified for greater middle torque from the 2004–2006 YZF-R1, housed in an all-new small diamond-shaped aluminum frame. The majority of this engine is the same as the YZF-R1. The main internal modifications include a 40% heavier crankshaft and a redesigned balancing shaft. New camshafts with decreased lift and duration attempt to improve performance at lower rpm, while the top two gearbox gears are higher to provide a more relaxed feel at cruising speeds.
The following changes have been made:
2006
- When it was originally released, the stiff rear spring with a 700 lb/in
- 2006 version featured obvious throttle snatch around 5,000––6,000 rpm, where rolling off the throttle and rolling back on generated a clear spike in acceleration owing to ‘fuel cut’ for pollution reasons.
06 – 07 Prone to weld frame fractures.
2007
- Rear shock spring has been softened.
- Fuel injection system has been updated. By delaying secondary butterfly opening, throttle snatch is decreased to normal. This smoothed out the surge created by the ‘fuel cut’ and subsequent re-fueling.
Source: Wikipedia
Yamaha FZ1: List of Available Documents
Note for Owners:
Guidesimo.com webproject is not a service center of Yamaha trademark and does not carries out works for diagnosis and repair of faulty Yamaha FZ1 equipment. For quality services, please contact an official service center of Yamaha company. On our website you can read and download documentation for your Yamaha FZ1 device for free and familiarize yourself with the technical specifications of device.
More Motorcycle Devices:
-
Yamaha YFM350XR(C)
5NF-28199-12LIT-11626-16-08READ THIS MANUAL CAREFULLY!It contains important safety information.This ATV should not be ridden by anyone under 16 years of age.WARNINGYFM350XR(C)OWNER’S MANUALPRINTED IN JAPAN2002.04-3.0×1 CR(E)PRINTED ON RECYCLED PAPERYAMAHA MOTOR CO., LTD.EBU00438LOCATE AND READ OWNER’S MANUAL. FOLLOW ALL INSTRUCTIONS AND WARNINGS.(For replacement manual, call 1-800-532-1558)WA …
YFM350XR(C) Motorcycle, 174
-
Yamaha YZ125 2009
PRINTED IN JAPAN2008.4—0.4 × 1 !(E)YAMAHA MOTOR CO., LTD.2500 SHINGAI IWATA SHIZUOKA JAPANPRINTED ON RECYCLED PAPERPROTECT YOUR INVESTMENTUse Genuine YAMAHA Parts And AccessoriesYZ125Y2009OWNER’S SERVICE MANUALYZ125Y1C3-28199-14LIT-11626-22-542009q Read this manual carefully before operating this vehicle. …
YZ125 2009 Motorcycle, 234
-
Mocka Rocket Bikes
spannerx1ALL nuts and bolts must be checked and tightened before first use. Regularly check all screws are tight to ensure safety. Mocka Rocket Bikes are designed for children aged 18 months — 4 years. These bikes should not be used on public roads or near traffic. Wearing a helmet is advisable. Only one child at a time should use the bike. Recommended for children under 30kgs.Adult super …
Rocket Bikes Motorcycle, 4
-
HERO MAESTRO EDGE 125 PROGRAMMED FI
PREFACEThank you for selecting a Hero MotoCorp MAESTRO EDGE 125 PROGRAMMED FI vehicle. We wish you many miles of continued riding pleasure in the years ahead.We, at Hero MotoCorp, are committed to demonstrate excellence in our environment performance on a continual basis, as an intrinsic element of our corporate philosophy. To achieve this we commit ourselves to continue product innovations to i …
MAESTRO EDGE 125 PROGRAMMED FI Motorcycle, 111
-
Baja motorsports DB30 Mini Bike
MinimumAge Requirement:16Weight capacity: 150 Ibs.Rev.l(US)020509Alwayswear a helmet;It couldsaveyour Life!Pleaseobtain,review,and followprovincial/ municipalgovernmentactsandregulationspertainingto owningand operatingan off-roadvehicle. …
DB30 Mini Bike Bicycle, 33